PR 15276: Add $_caller_is, $_caller_matches, $_any_caller_is, $_any_caller_matches
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 @cindex quotes in commands
1604 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1605 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1606 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1607 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1608 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1609 @value{GDBN} commands.
1610
1611 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1612 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1613 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1614 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1615 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1616 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1617 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1618 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1619 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1620 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1621 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1625 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1626 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1627 @end smallexample
1628
1629 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1630 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1631 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1632 place:
1633
1634 @smallexample
1635 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1636 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1637 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1638 @end smallexample
1639
1640 @noindent
1641 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1642 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1643 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1644
1645 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1646 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1647 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1648 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1649
1650 @cindex completion of structure field names
1651 @cindex structure field name completion
1652 @cindex completion of union field names
1653 @cindex union field name completion
1654 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1655 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1656 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1657 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1658 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1659 left-hand-side:
1660
1661 @smallexample
1662 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1663 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1664 to_data to_isatty to_write
1665 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1666 to_flush to_read
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @noindent
1670 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1671 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1672 follows:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 struct ui_file
1676 @{
1677 int *magic;
1678 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1679 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1680 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1681 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1682 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1683 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1684 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1685 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1686 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1687 void *to_data;
1688 @}
1689 @end smallexample
1690
1691
1692 @node Help
1693 @section Getting Help
1694 @cindex online documentation
1695 @kindex help
1696
1697 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1698 using the command @code{help}.
1699
1700 @table @code
1701 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1702 @item help
1703 @itemx h
1704 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1705 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 (@value{GDBP}) help
1709 List of classes of commands:
1710
1711 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1712 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1713 data -- Examining data
1714 files -- Specifying and examining files
1715 internals -- Maintenance commands
1716 obscure -- Obscure features
1717 running -- Running the program
1718 stack -- Examining the stack
1719 status -- Status inquiries
1720 support -- Support facilities
1721 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1722 stopping the program
1723 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1724
1725 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1726 commands in that class.
1727 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1728 documentation.
1729 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1730 (@value{GDBP})
1731 @end smallexample
1732 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1733
1734 @item help @var{class}
1735 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1736 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1737 help display for the class @code{status}:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1741 Status inquiries.
1742
1743 List of commands:
1744
1745 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1746 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1747 info -- Generic command for showing things
1748 about the program being debugged
1749 show -- Generic command for showing things
1750 about the debugger
1751
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757
1758 @item help @var{command}
1759 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1760 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1761
1762 @kindex apropos
1763 @item apropos @var{args}
1764 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1765 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1766 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1767
1768 @smallexample
1769 apropos alias
1770 @end smallexample
1771
1772 @noindent
1773 results in:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 @c @group
1777 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1778 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1779 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1780 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1781 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1782 @c @end group
1783 @end smallexample
1784
1785 @kindex complete
1786 @item complete @var{args}
1787 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1788 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1789 command you want completed. For example:
1790
1791 @smallexample
1792 complete i
1793 @end smallexample
1794
1795 @noindent results in:
1796
1797 @smallexample
1798 @group
1799 if
1800 ignore
1801 info
1802 inspect
1803 @end group
1804 @end smallexample
1805
1806 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1807 @end table
1808
1809 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1810 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1811 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1812 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1813 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1814 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1815 Index}.
1816
1817 @c @group
1818 @table @code
1819 @kindex info
1820 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1821 @item info
1822 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1823 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1824 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1825 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1826 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1827 @w{@code{help info}}.
1828
1829 @kindex set
1830 @item set
1831 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1832 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1833 @code{set prompt $}.
1834
1835 @kindex show
1836 @item show
1837 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1838 @value{GDBN} itself.
1839 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1840 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1841 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1842 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1843
1844 @kindex info set
1845 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1846 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1847 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1848 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1849 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1850 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1851 @end table
1852 @c @end group
1853
1854 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1855 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex show version
1859 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1860 @item show version
1861 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1862 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1863 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1864 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1865 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1866 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1867 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1868 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1869 @value{GDBN}.
1870
1871 @kindex show copying
1872 @kindex info copying
1873 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1874 @item show copying
1875 @itemx info copying
1876 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1877
1878 @kindex show warranty
1879 @kindex info warranty
1880 @item show warranty
1881 @itemx info warranty
1882 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1883 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1884
1885 @kindex show configuration
1886 @item show configuration
1887 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1888 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1889 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1890 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1891 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1892 your report.
1893
1894 @end table
1895
1896 @node Running
1897 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1898
1899 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1900 debugging information when you compile it.
1901
1902 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1903 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1904 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1905 kill a child process.
1906
1907 @menu
1908 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1909 * Starting:: Starting your program
1910 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1911 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1912
1913 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1914 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1915 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1916 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1917
1918 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1919 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1920 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1921 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1922 @end menu
1923
1924 @node Compilation
1925 @section Compiling for Debugging
1926
1927 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1928 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1929 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1930 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1931 and addresses in the executable code.
1932
1933 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1934 the compiler.
1935
1936 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1937 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1938 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1939 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1940 executables containing debugging information.
1941
1942 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1943 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1944 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1945 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1946 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1947
1948 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1949 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1950 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1951
1952 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1953 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1954 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1955 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1956 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1957 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1958
1959 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1960 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1961 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1962
1963 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1964 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1965 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1966 format in @value{GDBN}.
1967
1968 @need 2000
1969 @node Starting
1970 @section Starting your Program
1971 @cindex starting
1972 @cindex running
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex run
1976 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1977 @item run
1978 @itemx r
1979 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1980 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1981 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1982 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1983 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1984
1985 @end table
1986
1987 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1988 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1989 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1990 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1991 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1992 message like this one:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1996 Try "help target" or "continue".
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 @noindent
2000 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2001 first (@pxref{load}).
2002
2003 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2004 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2005 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2006 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2007 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2008 divided into four categories:
2009
2010 @table @asis
2011 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2012 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2013 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2014 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2015 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2016 the arguments.
2017 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2018 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2019 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2020 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2021 below for details).
2022
2023 @item The @emph{environment.}
2024 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2025 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2026 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2027 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2028
2029 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2030 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2031 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2032 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2033
2034 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2035 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2036 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2037 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2038 set a different device for your program.
2039 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2040
2041 @cindex pipes
2042 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2043 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2044 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2045 wrong program.
2046 @end table
2047
2048 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2049 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2050 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2051 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2052 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2053
2054 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2055 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2056 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2057 your current breakpoints.
2058
2059 @table @code
2060 @kindex start
2061 @item start
2062 @cindex run to main procedure
2063 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2064 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2065 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2066 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2067 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2068 procedure, depending on the language used.
2069
2070 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2071 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2072 the @samp{run} command.
2073
2074 @cindex elaboration phase
2075 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2076 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2077 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2078 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2079 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2080 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2081 will remain to halt execution.
2082
2083 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2084 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2085 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2086 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2087 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2088
2089 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2090 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2091 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2092 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2093 elaboration code before running your program.
2094
2095 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2096 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2097 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2098 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2099 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2100 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2101 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2102 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2103 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2104 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2105 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2106 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2107
2108 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2109 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2110 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2111 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2112
2113 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2114 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2115 environment:
2116
2117 @smallexample
2118 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2119 (@value{GDBP}) run
2120 @end smallexample
2121
2122 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2123 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2124
2125 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2126 @item set startup-with-shell
2127 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2128 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2129 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2130 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2131 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2132 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2133 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2134 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2135 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2136 startup failures such as:
2137
2138 @smallexample
2139 (@value{GDBP}) run
2140 Starting program: ./a.out
2141 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2142 @end smallexample
2143
2144 @noindent
2145 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2146 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2147 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2148 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2149 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2150 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2151
2152 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2153 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2154 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2155 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2156 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2157 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2158
2159 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2160 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2161 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2162 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2163 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2164 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2165
2166 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2167 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2168 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2169
2170 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2171 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2172
2173 @smallexample
2174 (@value{GDBP}) run
2175 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2176 @end smallexample
2177
2178 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2179 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2180
2181 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2182 @code{target native} command. For example,
2183
2184 @smallexample
2185 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2186 (@value{GDBP}) run
2187 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2188 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2189 (@value{GDBP}) run
2190 Starting program: ./a.out
2191 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2192 @end smallexample
2193
2194 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2195 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2196 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2197 disconnect.
2198
2199 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2200 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2201 proc}, @code{info os}.
2202
2203 @kindex set disable-randomization
2204 @item set disable-randomization
2205 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2206 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2207 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2208 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2209 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2210
2211 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2212 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2216 @end smallexample
2217
2218 @item set disable-randomization off
2219 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2220 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2221 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2222 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2223 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2224 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2225
2226 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2227 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2228 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2229 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2230 a code at its expected addresses.
2231
2232 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2233 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2234 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2235 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2236 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2237 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2238 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2239 a randomly chosen address.
2240
2241 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2242 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2243 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2244 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2245 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2246
2247 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2248 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2249
2250 @item show disable-randomization
2251 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2252 the virtual address space of the started program.
2253
2254 @end table
2255
2256 @node Arguments
2257 @section Your Program's Arguments
2258
2259 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2260 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2261 @code{run} command.
2262 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2263 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2264 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2265 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2266 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2267
2268 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2269 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2270 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2271 the program, not by the shell.
2272
2273 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2274 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @kindex set args
2278 @item set args
2279 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2280 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2281 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2282 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2283 it again without arguments.
2284
2285 @kindex show args
2286 @item show args
2287 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2288 @end table
2289
2290 @node Environment
2291 @section Your Program's Environment
2292
2293 @cindex environment (of your program)
2294 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2295 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2296 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2297 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2298 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2299 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2300 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex path
2304 @item path @var{directory}
2305 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2306 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2307 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2308 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2309 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2310 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2311 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2312
2313 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2314 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2315 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2316 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2317 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2318 @var{directory} to the search path.
2319 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2320 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2321
2322 @kindex show paths
2323 @item show paths
2324 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2325 environment variable).
2326
2327 @kindex show environment
2328 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2329 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2330 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2331 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2332 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2333
2334 @kindex set environment
2335 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2336 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2337 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2338 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2339 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2340 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2341 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2342 null value.
2343 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2344 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2345
2346 For example, this command:
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 set env USER = foo
2350 @end smallexample
2351
2352 @noindent
2353 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2354 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2355 are not actually required.)
2356
2357 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2358 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2359 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2360 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2361 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2362
2363 @kindex unset environment
2364 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2365 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2366 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2367 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2368 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2369 @end table
2370
2371 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2372 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2373 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2374 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2375 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2376 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2377 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2378 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2379 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2380 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2381
2382 @node Working Directory
2383 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2384
2385 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2386 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2387 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2388 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2389 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2390 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2391
2392 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2393 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2394 Specify Files}.
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @kindex cd
2398 @cindex change working directory
2399 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2400 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2401 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2402
2403 @kindex pwd
2404 @item pwd
2405 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2409 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2410 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2411 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2412 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2413 current working directory of the debuggee.
2414
2415 @node Input/Output
2416 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2417
2418 @cindex redirection
2419 @cindex i/o
2420 @cindex terminal
2421 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2422 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2423 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2424 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2425 running your program.
2426
2427 @table @code
2428 @kindex info terminal
2429 @item info terminal
2430 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2431 program is using.
2432 @end table
2433
2434 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2435 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2436
2437 @smallexample
2438 run > outfile
2439 @end smallexample
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2443
2444 @kindex tty
2445 @cindex controlling terminal
2446 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2447 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2448 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2449 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2450 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2451
2452 @smallexample
2453 tty /dev/ttyb
2454 @end smallexample
2455
2456 @noindent
2457 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2458 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2459 that as their controlling terminal.
2460
2461 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2462 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2463 terminal.
2464
2465 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2466 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2467 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2468 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2469
2470 @cindex inferior tty
2471 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2472 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2473 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2474 program.
2475
2476 @table @code
2477 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2478 @kindex set inferior-tty
2479 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2480
2481 @item show inferior-tty
2482 @kindex show inferior-tty
2483 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2484 @end table
2485
2486 @node Attach
2487 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2488 @kindex attach
2489 @cindex attach
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @item attach @var{process-id}
2493 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2494 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2495 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2496 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2497 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2498
2499 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2500 executing the command.
2501 @end table
2502
2503 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2504 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2505 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2506 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2507
2508 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2509 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2510 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2511 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2512 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2513 Specify Files}.
2514
2515 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2516 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2517 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2518 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2519 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2520 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2521 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @kindex detach
2525 @item detach
2526 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2527 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2528 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2529 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2530 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2531 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2536 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2537 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2538 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2539 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2540 Messages}).
2541
2542 @node Kill Process
2543 @section Killing the Child Process
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex kill
2547 @item kill
2548 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2549 @end table
2550
2551 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2552 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2553 is running.
2554
2555 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2556 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2557 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2558 outside the debugger.
2559
2560 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2561 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2562 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2563 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2564 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2565 breakpoint settings).
2566
2567 @node Inferiors and Programs
2568 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2569
2570 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2571 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2572 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2573 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2574 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2575 from multiple executables.
2576
2577 @cindex inferior
2578 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2579 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2580 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2581 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2582 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2583 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2584 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2585 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2586 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2587 threads running in it.
2588
2589 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2590 inferiors}}:
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex info inferiors
2594 @item info inferiors
2595 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2598
2599 @enumerate
2600 @item
2601 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2602
2603 @item
2604 the target system's inferior identifier
2605
2606 @item
2607 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2608
2609 @end enumerate
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2613 indicates the current inferior.
2614
2615 For example,
2616 @end table
2617 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2618
2619 @smallexample
2620 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2621 Num Description Executable
2622 2 process 2307 hello
2623 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2624 @end smallexample
2625
2626 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2630 @item inferior @var{infno}
2631 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2632 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2633 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2634 @end table
2635
2636
2637 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2638 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2639 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2640 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2641 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2642 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @kindex add-inferior
2646 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2647 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2648 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2649 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2650 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2651 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2652
2653 @kindex clone-inferior
2654 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2655 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2656 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2657 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2658 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2662 Num Description Executable
2663 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2664 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2665 Added inferior 2.
2666 1 inferiors added.
2667 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2668 Num Description Executable
2669 2 <null> helloworld
2670 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2671 @end smallexample
2672
2673 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2674
2675 @kindex remove-inferiors
2676 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2677 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2678 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2679 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2680
2681 @end table
2682
2683 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2684 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2685 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2686 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2687
2688 @table @code
2689 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2690 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2691 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2692 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2693 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2694 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2695
2696 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2697 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2698 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2699 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2700 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2701 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2702 @end table
2703
2704 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2705 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2706 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2707 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2708
2709
2710 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2711 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set print inferior-events
2715 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2716 @item set print inferior-events
2717 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2718 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2719 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2720 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2721 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2722 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2723
2724 @kindex show print inferior-events
2725 @item show print inferior-events
2726 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2727 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2728 @end table
2729
2730 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2731 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2732 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2733
2734
2735 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2736 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2737 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2738 info program-spaces}} command.
2739
2740 @table @code
2741 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2742 @item maint info program-spaces
2743 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2744 @value{GDBN}.
2745
2746 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2747
2748 @enumerate
2749 @item
2750 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2751
2752 @item
2753 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2754 the @code{file} command.
2755
2756 @end enumerate
2757
2758 @noindent
2759 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2760 indicates the current program space.
2761
2762 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2763 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2764 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2765
2766 @smallexample
2767 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2768 Id Executable
2769 2 goodbye
2770 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2771 * 1 hello
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2775 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2776 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2777 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2778 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2782 Id Executable
2783 * 1 vfork-test
2784 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2785 @end smallexample
2786
2787 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2788 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2789 @end table
2790
2791 @node Threads
2792 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2793
2794 @cindex threads of execution
2795 @cindex multiple threads
2796 @cindex switching threads
2797 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2798 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2799 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2800 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2801 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2802 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2803 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2804
2805 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2806 programs:
2807
2808 @itemize @bullet
2809 @item automatic notification of new threads
2810 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2811 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2812 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2813 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2814 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2815 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2816 messages on thread start and exit.
2817 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2818 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2819 isn't compatible with the program.
2820 @end itemize
2821
2822 @quotation
2823 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2824 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2825 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2826 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2827 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2828 like this:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2832 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2833 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2834 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2835 @end smallexample
2836 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2837 @c doesn't support threads"?
2838 @end quotation
2839
2840 @cindex focus of debugging
2841 @cindex current thread
2842 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2843 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2844 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2845 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2846 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2847
2848 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2849 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2850 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2851 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2852 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2853 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2854 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2855 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2856 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2857 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2861 @end smallexample
2862
2863 @noindent
2864 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2865 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2866 further qualifier.
2867
2868 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2869 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2870 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2871 @c program?
2872 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2873 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2874 @c threads ab initio?
2875
2876 @cindex thread number
2877 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2878 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2879 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @kindex info threads
2883 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2884 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2885 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2886 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2887 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2888
2889 @enumerate
2890 @item
2891 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2892
2893 @item
2894 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2895
2896 @item
2897 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2898 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2899 program itself.
2900
2901 @item
2902 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2903 @end enumerate
2904
2905 @noindent
2906 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2907 indicates the current thread.
2908
2909 For example,
2910 @end table
2911 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2915 Id Target Id Frame
2916 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2917 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2918 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2919 at threadtest.c:68
2920 @end smallexample
2921
2922 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2923 Solaris-specific command:
2924
2925 @table @code
2926 @item maint info sol-threads
2927 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2928 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2929 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2930 @end table
2931
2932 @table @code
2933 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2934 @item thread @var{threadno}
2935 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2936 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2937 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2938 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2939 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2943 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2944 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2945 8 printf ("hello\n");
2946 @end smallexample
2947
2948 @noindent
2949 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2950 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2951 threads.
2952
2953 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2954 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2955 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2956 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2957 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2958 information on convenience variables.
2959
2960 @kindex thread apply
2961 @cindex apply command to several threads
2962 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2963 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2964 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2965 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2966 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2967 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2968 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2969 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2970
2971 @kindex thread name
2972 @cindex name a thread
2973 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2974 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2975 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2976 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2977
2978 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2979 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2980 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2981 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2982 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2983
2984 @kindex thread find
2985 @cindex search for a thread
2986 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2987 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2988 matches the supplied regular expression.
2989
2990 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2991 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2992 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2993 is the LWP id.
2994
2995 @smallexample
2996 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2997 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2998 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2999 Id Target Id Frame
3000 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3001 @end smallexample
3002
3003 @kindex set print thread-events
3004 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3005 @item set print thread-events
3006 @itemx set print thread-events on
3007 @itemx set print thread-events off
3008 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3009 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3010 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3011 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3012 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3013
3014 @kindex show print thread-events
3015 @item show print thread-events
3016 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3017 have started and exited.
3018 @end table
3019
3020 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3021 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3022 programs with multiple threads.
3023
3024 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3025 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3026
3027 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3028 @table @code
3029 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3030 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3031 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3032 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3033 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3034 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3035 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3036 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3037 macro.
3038
3039 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3040 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3041 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3042 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3043 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3044 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3045
3046 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3047 refers to the default system directories that are
3048 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3049 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3050 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3051
3052 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3053 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3054 was loaded in the inferior process.
3055
3056 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3057 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3058 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3059 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3060 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3061 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3062 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3063
3064 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3065 only on some platforms.
3066
3067 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3068 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3069 Display current libthread_db search path.
3070
3071 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3072 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3073 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3074 @item set debug libthread-db
3075 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3076 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3077 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @node Forks
3081 @section Debugging Forks
3082
3083 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3084 @cindex multiple processes
3085 @cindex processes, multiple
3086 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3087 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3088 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3089 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3090 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3091 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3092 will cause it to terminate.
3093
3094 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3095 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3096 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3097 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3098 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3099 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3100 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3101 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3102 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3103 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3104
3105 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3106 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3107 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3108 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3109
3110 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3111 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3112
3113 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3114 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3115
3116 @table @code
3117 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3118 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3119 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3120 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3121 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3122
3123 @table @code
3124 @item parent
3125 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3126 unimpeded. This is the default.
3127
3128 @item child
3129 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3130 unimpeded.
3131
3132 @end table
3133
3134 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3135 @item show follow-fork-mode
3136 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3140 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3141 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3142
3143 @table @code
3144 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3145 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3146 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3147 retain debugger control over them both.
3148
3149 @table @code
3150 @item on
3151 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3152 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3153 independently. This is the default.
3154
3155 @item off
3156 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3157 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3158 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3159 is held suspended.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3164 @item show detach-on-fork
3165 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3166 @end table
3167
3168 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3169 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3170 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3171 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3172 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3173 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3174
3175 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3176 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3177 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3178 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3179 and Programs}.
3180
3181 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3182 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3183 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3184 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3185 the child process's @code{main}.
3186
3187 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3188 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3189
3190 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3191 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3192 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3193 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3194 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3195 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3196 command.
3197
3198 @table @code
3199 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3200 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3201
3202 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3203 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3204
3205 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3206
3207 @table @code
3208 @item new
3209 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3210 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3211 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3212 original inferior.
3213
3214 For example:
3215
3216 @smallexample
3217 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3218 (gdb) info inferior
3219 Id Description Executable
3220 * 1 <null> prog1
3221 (@value{GDBP}) run
3222 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3223 Program exited normally.
3224 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3225 Id Description Executable
3226 * 2 <null> prog2
3227 1 <null> prog1
3228 @end smallexample
3229
3230 @item same
3231 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3232 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3233 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3234 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3235 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3236
3237 For example:
3238
3239 @smallexample
3240 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3241 Id Description Executable
3242 * 1 <null> prog1
3243 (@value{GDBP}) run
3244 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3245 Program exited normally.
3246 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog2
3249 @end smallexample
3250
3251 @end table
3252 @end table
3253
3254 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3255 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3256 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3257
3258 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3259 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3260
3261 @cindex checkpoint
3262 @cindex restart
3263 @cindex bookmark
3264 @cindex snapshot of a process
3265 @cindex rewind program state
3266
3267 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3268 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3269 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3270 later.
3271
3272 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3273 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3274 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3275 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3276 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3277
3278 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3279 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3280 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3281 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3282 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3283 start again from there.
3284
3285 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3286 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3287
3288 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex checkpoint
3292 @item checkpoint
3293 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3294 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3295 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3296
3297 @kindex info checkpoints
3298 @item info checkpoints
3299 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3300 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3301 listed:
3302
3303 @table @code
3304 @item Checkpoint ID
3305 @item Process ID
3306 @item Code Address
3307 @item Source line, or label
3308 @end table
3309
3310 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3311 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3312 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3313 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3314 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3315 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3316 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3317
3318 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3319 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3320 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3321 the debugger.
3322
3323 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3324 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3325 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3326
3327 @end table
3328
3329 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3330 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3331 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3332 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3333 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3334 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3335 previously read data can be read again.
3336
3337 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3338 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3339 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3340 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3341 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3342 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3343
3344 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3345 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3346 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3347 different execution path this time.
3348
3349 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3350 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3351 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3352 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3353 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3354 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3355 potentially pose a problem.
3356
3357 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3358
3359 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3360 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3361 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3362 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3363 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3364 next.
3365
3366 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3367 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3368 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3369 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3370 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3371
3372 @node Stopping
3373 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3374
3375 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3376 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3377 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3378
3379 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3380 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3381 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3382 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3383 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3384 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3385 explicitly request this information at any time.
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @kindex info program
3389 @item info program
3390 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3391 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @menu
3395 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3396 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3397 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3398 Skipping over functions and files
3399 * Signals:: Signals
3400 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3401 @end menu
3402
3403 @node Breakpoints
3404 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3405
3406 @cindex breakpoints
3407 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3408 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3409 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3410 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3411 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3412 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3413 program.
3414
3415 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3416 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3417 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3418 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3419 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3420 call).
3421
3422 @cindex watchpoints
3423 @cindex data breakpoints
3424 @cindex memory tracing
3425 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3426 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3427 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3428 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3429 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3430 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3431 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3432 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3433 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3434 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3435 same commands.
3436
3437 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3438 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3439 Automatic Display}.
3440
3441 @cindex catchpoints
3442 @cindex breakpoint on events
3443 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3444 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3445 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3446 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3447 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3448 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3449 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3450
3451 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3452 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3453 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3454 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3455 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3456 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3457 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3458 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3459 enable it again.
3460
3461 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3462 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3463 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3464 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3465 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3466 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3467 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3468
3469 @menu
3470 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3471 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3472 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3473 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3474 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3475 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3476 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3477 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3478 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3479 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3480 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3481 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3482 @end menu
3483
3484 @node Set Breaks
3485 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3486
3487 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3488 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3489 @c
3490 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3491
3492 @kindex break
3493 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3494 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3495 @cindex latest breakpoint
3496 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3497 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3498 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3499 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3500 convenience variables.
3501
3502 @table @code
3503 @item break @var{location}
3504 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3505 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3506 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3507 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3508 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3509
3510 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3511 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3512 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3513 that situation.
3514
3515 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3516 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3517 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3518
3519 @item break
3520 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3521 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3522 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3523 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3524 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3525 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3526 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3527 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3528 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3529 inside loops.
3530
3531 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3532 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3533 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3534 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3535 existed when your program stopped.
3536
3537 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3538 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3539 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3540 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3541 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3542 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3543 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3544
3545 @kindex tbreak
3546 @item tbreak @var{args}
3547 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3548 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3549 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3550 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3551
3552 @kindex hbreak
3553 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3554 @item hbreak @var{args}
3555 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3556 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3557 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3558 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3559 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3560 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3561 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3562 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3563 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3564 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3565 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3566 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3567 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3568 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3569 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3570 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3571 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3572 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3573
3574 @kindex thbreak
3575 @item thbreak @var{args}
3576 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3577 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3578 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3579 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3580 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3581 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3582 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3583 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3584
3585 @kindex rbreak
3586 @cindex regular expression
3587 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3588 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3589 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3590 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3591 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3592 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3593 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3594 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3595 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3596
3597 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3598 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3599 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3600 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3601 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3602 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3603
3604 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3605 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3606 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3607 classes.
3608
3609 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3610 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3611 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3612
3613 @smallexample
3614 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3618 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3619 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3620 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3621 every function in a given file:
3622
3623 @smallexample
3624 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3625 @end smallexample
3626
3627 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3628 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3629
3630 @kindex info breakpoints
3631 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3632 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3633 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3634 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3635 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3636 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3637 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3638
3639 @table @emph
3640 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3641 @item Type
3642 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3643 @item Disposition
3644 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3645 @item Enabled or Disabled
3646 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3647 that are not enabled.
3648 @item Address
3649 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3650 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3651 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3652 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3653 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3654 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3655 @item What
3656 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3657 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3658 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3659 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @noindent
3663 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3664 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3665 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3666 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3667 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3668 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3669
3670 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3671 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3672 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3673 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3674
3675 @noindent
3676 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3677 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3678 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3679 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3680 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3681
3682 @noindent
3683 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3684 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3685 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3686 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3687 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3688 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3692 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3693
3694 @end table
3695
3696 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3697 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3698 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3699 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3700
3701 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3702 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3703 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3704 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3705
3706 @itemize @bullet
3707 @item
3708 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3709
3710 @item
3711 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3712 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3713
3714 @item
3715 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3716 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3717
3718 @item
3719 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3720 several places where that function is inlined.
3721 @end itemize
3722
3723 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3724 the relevant locations.
3725
3726 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3727 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3728 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3729 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3730 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3731 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3732 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3733
3734 For example:
3735
3736 @smallexample
3737 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3738 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3739 stop only if i==1
3740 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3741 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3742 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3743 @end smallexample
3744
3745 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3746 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3747 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3748 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3749 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3750 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3751 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3752 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3753 that belong to that breakpoint.
3754
3755 @cindex pending breakpoints
3756 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3757 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3758 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3759 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3760 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3761 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3762 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3763 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3764 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3765 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3766 is not yet resolved.
3767
3768 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3769 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3770 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3771 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3772 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3773 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3774
3775 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3776 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3777 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3778 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3779
3780 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3781 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3782 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3783
3784 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3785 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3786 address specification to an address:
3787
3788 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3789 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3790 @table @code
3791 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3792 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3793 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3794
3795 @item set breakpoint pending on
3796 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3797 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3798
3799 @item set breakpoint pending off
3800 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3801 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3802 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3803
3804 @item show breakpoint pending
3805 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3806 @end table
3807
3808 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3809 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3810 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3811
3812 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3813 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3814 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3815 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3816 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3817 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3818 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3819 breakpoints.
3820
3821 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3824 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3828 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3829 breakpoint must be used.
3830
3831 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3832 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3833 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3834 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3838 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3839 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3840 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3841 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3842 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3843 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3844 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3845 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3846
3847 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3848 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3849 @table @code
3850 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3851 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3852 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3853 removed from the target when it stops.
3854
3855 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3856 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3857 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3858 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3859 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3860
3861 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3862 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3863 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3864 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3865 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3866 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3867 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3868 @end table
3869
3870 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3871 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3872 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3873
3874 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3875 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3876
3877 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3878
3879 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3880 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3881 @table @code
3882 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3883 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3884 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3885 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3886 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3887
3888 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3889 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3890 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3891 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3892 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3893 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3894 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3895 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3896 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3897 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3898 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3899 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3900 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3901
3902 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3903 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3904 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3905 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3906 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3907 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3908 @end table
3909
3910
3911 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3912 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3913 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3914 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3915 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3916 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3917 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3918 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3919
3920
3921 @node Set Watchpoints
3922 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3923
3924 @cindex setting watchpoints
3925 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3926 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3927 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3928 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3929 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3930
3931 @itemize @bullet
3932 @item
3933 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3934
3935 @item
3936 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3937 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3938 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3939
3940 @item
3941 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3942 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3943 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3944 @end itemize
3945
3946 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3947 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3948 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3949 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3950 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3951 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3952 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3953 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3954 the expression changes.
3955
3956 @cindex software watchpoints
3957 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3958 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3959 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3960 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3961 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3962 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3963 culprit.)
3964
3965 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3966 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3967 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3968
3969 @table @code
3970 @kindex watch
3971 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3972 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3973 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3974 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3975 to watch the value of a single variable:
3976
3977 @smallexample
3978 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3979 @end smallexample
3980
3981 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3982 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3983 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3984 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3985 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3986 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3987
3988 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3989 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3990 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3991 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3992 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3993 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3994 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3995 error.
3996
3997 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3998 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3999 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4000 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4001 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4002 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4003 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4004 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4005 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4006 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4007 Examples:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4011 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4012 @end smallexample
4013
4014 @kindex rwatch
4015 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4016 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4017 by the program.
4018
4019 @kindex awatch
4020 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4021 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4022 or written into by the program.
4023
4024 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4025 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4026 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4027 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4028 @end table
4029
4030 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4031 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4032 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4033 a never-changing value:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4037 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4038 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4039 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4043 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4044 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4045 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4046 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4047 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4048
4049 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4050 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4051 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4052 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4053 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4054 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4055 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4056 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4057
4058 @table @code
4059 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4060 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4061 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4062
4063 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4064 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4065 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4066 @end table
4067
4068 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4069 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4070 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4071
4072 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4073
4074 @smallexample
4075 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4076 @end smallexample
4077
4078 @noindent
4079 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4080
4081 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4082 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4083 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4084 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4085 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4086 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4087 will print a message like this:
4088
4089 @smallexample
4090 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4091 @end smallexample
4092
4093 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4094 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4095 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4096 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4097 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4098 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4099 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4100 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4101
4102 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4103 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4104 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4105 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4106 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4107 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113 @noindent
4114 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4115
4116 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4117 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4118 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4119 expression with separately allocated resources.
4120
4121 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4122 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4123 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4126 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4127 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4128 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4129 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4130 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4131 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4132 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4133 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4134
4135 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4136 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4137 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4138 watched expression from every thread.
4139
4140 @quotation
4141 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4142 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4143 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4144 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4145 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4146 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4147 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4148 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4149 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4150 @end quotation
4151
4152 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4153
4154 @node Set Catchpoints
4155 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4156 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4157 @cindex exception handlers
4158 @cindex event handling
4159
4160 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4161 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4162 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4163
4164 @table @code
4165 @kindex catch
4166 @item catch @var{event}
4167 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4168
4169 @table @code
4170 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4171 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4172 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4173 @kindex catch throw
4174 @kindex catch rethrow
4175 @kindex catch catch
4176 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4177 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4178
4179 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4180 regular expression will be caught.
4181
4182 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4183 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4184 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4185 exception being thrown.
4186
4187 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4188 @value{GDBN}:
4189
4190 @itemize @bullet
4191 @item
4192 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4193 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4194 supported.
4195
4196 @item
4197 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4198 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4199 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4200 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4201 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4202 built.
4203
4204 @item
4205 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4206 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4207
4208 @item
4209 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4210 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4211 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4212 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4213
4214 @item
4215 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4216 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4217 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4218 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4219 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4220 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4221 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4222 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4223 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4224
4225 @item
4226 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4227
4228 @item
4229 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4230 @end itemize
4231
4232 @item exception
4233 @kindex catch exception
4234 @cindex Ada exception catching
4235 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4236 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4237 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4238 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4239 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4240
4241 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4242 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4243 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4244 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4245 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4246 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4247 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4248 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4249
4250 @item exception unhandled
4251 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4252 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4253
4254 @item assert
4255 @kindex catch assert
4256 A failed Ada assertion.
4257
4258 @item exec
4259 @kindex catch exec
4260 @cindex break on fork/exec
4261 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4262 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4263
4264 @item syscall
4265 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4266 @kindex catch syscall
4267 @cindex break on a system call.
4268 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4269 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4270 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4271 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4272 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4273 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4274 will be caught.
4275
4276 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4277 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4278 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4279 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4280
4281 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4282 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4283 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4284 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4285
4286 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4287 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4288 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4289 available choices.
4290
4291 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4292 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4293 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4294 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4295 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4296 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4297 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4298 behind the OS upgrades).
4299
4300 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4301 arguments to it:
4302
4303 @smallexample
4304 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4305 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4306 (@value{GDBP}) r
4307 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4308
4309 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4310 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4311 (@value{GDBP}) c
4312 Continuing.
4313
4314 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4315 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4316 (@value{GDBP})
4317 @end smallexample
4318
4319 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4320
4321 @smallexample
4322 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4323 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4324 (@value{GDBP}) r
4325 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4326
4327 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4328 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4329 (@value{GDBP}) c
4330 Continuing.
4331
4332 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4333 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4334 (@value{GDBP})
4335 @end smallexample
4336
4337 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4338 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4339 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4343 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4344 (@value{GDBP}) r
4345 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4346
4347 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4348 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4349 (@value{GDBP}) c
4350 Continuing.
4351
4352 Program exited normally.
4353 (@value{GDBP})
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4357 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4358 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4359 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4360
4361 @smallexample
4362 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4363 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4364 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4365 (@value{GDBP})
4366 @end smallexample
4367
4368 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4369 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4370 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4371 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4372 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4373 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4374
4375 @smallexample
4376 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4377 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4378 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4379 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4380 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4381 (@value{GDBP})
4382 @end smallexample
4383
4384 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4385
4386 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4387 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4391 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4392 @end smallexample
4393
4394 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4395
4396 @item fork
4397 @kindex catch fork
4398 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4399 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4400
4401 @item vfork
4402 @kindex catch vfork
4403 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4404 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4405
4406 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4407 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4408 @kindex catch load
4409 @kindex catch unload
4410 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4411 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4412 matches one of the affected libraries.
4413
4414 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4415 @kindex catch signal
4416 The delivery of a signal.
4417
4418 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4419 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4420 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4421
4422 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4423 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4424 signal names.
4425
4426 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4427 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4428 will be caught.
4429
4430 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4431 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4432 catchpoint.
4433
4434 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4435 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4436 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4437 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4438 commands.
4439
4440 @end table
4441
4442 @item tcatch @var{event}
4443 @kindex tcatch
4444 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4445 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4446
4447 @end table
4448
4449 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4450
4451
4452 @node Delete Breaks
4453 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4454
4455 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4456 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4457 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4458 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4459 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4460 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4461
4462 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4463 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4464 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4465 their breakpoint numbers.
4466
4467 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4468 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4469 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4470
4471 @table @code
4472 @kindex clear
4473 @item clear
4474 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4475 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4476 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4477 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4478
4479 @item clear @var{location}
4480 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4481 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4482 most useful ones are listed below:
4483
4484 @table @code
4485 @item clear @var{function}
4486 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4487 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4488
4489 @item clear @var{linenum}
4490 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4491 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4492 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4493 @end table
4494
4495 @cindex delete breakpoints
4496 @kindex delete
4497 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4498 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4499 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4500 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4501 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4502 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4503 @end table
4504
4505 @node Disabling
4506 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4507
4508 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4509 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4510 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4511 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4512 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4513
4514 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4515 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4516 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4517 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4518 do not know which numbers to use.
4519
4520 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4521 affects all of its locations.
4522
4523 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4524 different states of enablement:
4525
4526 @itemize @bullet
4527 @item
4528 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4529 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4530 @item
4531 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4532 @item
4533 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4534 disabled.
4535 @item
4536 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4537 N times, then becomes disabled.
4538 @item
4539 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4540 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4541 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4542 @end itemize
4543
4544 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4545 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4546
4547 @table @code
4548 @kindex disable
4549 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4550 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4551 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4552 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4553 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4554 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4555 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4556
4557 @kindex enable
4558 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4559 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4560 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4561
4562 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4563 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4564 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4565
4566 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4567 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4568 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4569 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4570 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4571 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4572 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4573
4574 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4575 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4576 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4577 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4578 @end table
4579
4580 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4581 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4582 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4583 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4584 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4585 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4586 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4587 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4588 Stepping}.)
4589
4590 @node Conditions
4591 @subsection Break Conditions
4592 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4593 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4594
4595 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4596 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4597 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4598 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4599 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4600 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4601 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4602 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4603
4604 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4605 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4606 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4607 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4608 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4609
4610 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4611 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4612 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4613 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4614 one.
4615
4616 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4617 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4618 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4619 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4620 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4621 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4622 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4623 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4624 conditions for the
4625 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4626 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4627
4628 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4629 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4630 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4631 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4632 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4633 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4634
4635 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4636 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4637 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4638 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4639 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4640
4641 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4642 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4643 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4644 with the @code{condition} command.
4645
4646 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4647 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4648 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4649 catchpoint.
4650
4651 @table @code
4652 @kindex condition
4653 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4654 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4655 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4656 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4657 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4658 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4659 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4660 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4661 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4662 prints an error message:
4663
4664 @smallexample
4665 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 @noindent
4669 @value{GDBN} does
4670 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4671 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4672 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4673
4674 @item condition @var{bnum}
4675 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4676 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4677 @end table
4678
4679 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4680 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4681 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4682 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4683 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4684 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4685 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4686 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4687 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4688 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4689 your program reaches it.
4690
4691 @table @code
4692 @kindex ignore
4693 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4694 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4695 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4696 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4697 takes no action.
4698
4699 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4700 a count of zero.
4701
4702 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4703 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4704 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4705 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4706
4707 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4708 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4709 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4710
4711 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4712 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4713 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4714 Variables}.
4715 @end table
4716
4717 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4718
4719
4720 @node Break Commands
4721 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4722
4723 @cindex breakpoint commands
4724 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4725 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4726 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4727 enable other breakpoints.
4728
4729 @table @code
4730 @kindex commands
4731 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4732 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4733 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4734 @itemx end
4735 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4736 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4737 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4738
4739 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4740 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4741
4742 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4743 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4744 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4745 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4746 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4747 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4748 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4749 Expressions}).
4750 @end table
4751
4752 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4753 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4754
4755 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4756 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4757 that resumes execution.
4758
4759 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4760 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4761 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4762 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4763 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4764
4765 @kindex silent
4766 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4767 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4768 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4769 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4770 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4771 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4772
4773 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4774 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4775 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4776
4777 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4778 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4779
4780 @smallexample
4781 break foo if x>0
4782 commands
4783 silent
4784 printf "x is %d\n",x
4785 cont
4786 end
4787 @end smallexample
4788
4789 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4790 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4791 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4792 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4793 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4794 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4795 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4796
4797 @smallexample
4798 break 403
4799 commands
4800 silent
4801 set x = y + 4
4802 cont
4803 end
4804 @end smallexample
4805
4806 @node Dynamic Printf
4807 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4808
4809 @cindex dynamic printf
4810 @cindex dprintf
4811 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4812 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4813 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4814 having to recompile it.
4815
4816 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4817 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4818 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4819 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4820 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4821 redirects to files and so forth.
4822
4823 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4824 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4825 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4826 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4827 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4828 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4829 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4830
4831 @table @code
4832 @kindex dprintf
4833 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4834 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4835 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4836 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4837
4838 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4839 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4840 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4841 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4842 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4843 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4844
4845 @item gdb
4846 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4847 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4848
4849 @item call
4850 @kindex dprintf-style call
4851 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4852 @code{printf}).
4853
4854 @item agent
4855 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4856 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4857 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4858 support running commands on the target.
4859
4860 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4861 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4862 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4863 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4864 command.
4865
4866 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4867 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4868 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4869 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4870 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4871 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4872
4873 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4874 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4875 you could do the following:
4876
4877 @example
4878 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4879 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4880 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4881 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4882 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4883 (gdb) info break
4884 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4885 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4886 continue
4887 (gdb)
4888 @end example
4889
4890 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4891 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4892 the variable settings.
4893
4894 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4895 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4896 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4897 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4898 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4899 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4900
4901 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4902 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4903 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4904
4905 @end table
4906
4907 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4908 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4909 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4910 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4911 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4912 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4913
4914 @node Save Breakpoints
4915 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4916
4917 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4918 breakpoints}} command.
4919
4920 @table @code
4921 @kindex save breakpoints
4922 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4923 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4924 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4925 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4926 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4927 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4928 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4929 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4930 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4931 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4932 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4933 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4934 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4935 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4936 that can no longer be recreated.
4937 @end table
4938
4939 @node Static Probe Points
4940 @subsection Static Probe Points
4941
4942 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4943 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4944 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4945 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4946 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4947 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4948 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4949
4950 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4951 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4952 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4953 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4954 in your applications.
4955
4956 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4957 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4958 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4959 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4960 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4961 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4962 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4963 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4964
4965 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4966 probes}, with optional arguments:
4967
4968 @table @code
4969 @kindex info probes
4970 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4971 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4972 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4973 probes from all providers are listed.
4974
4975 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4976 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4977 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4978
4979 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4980 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4981 given, all object files are considered.
4982
4983 @item info probes all
4984 List the available static probes, from all types.
4985 @end table
4986
4987 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4988 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4989 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4990 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4991 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4992 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4993 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4994 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4995 at the current probe point.
4996
4997 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4998 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4999 an error message.
5000
5001
5002 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5003 @node Error in Breakpoints
5004 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5005
5006 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5007 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5008
5009 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5010 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5011 @smallexample
5012 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5013 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5014 @end smallexample
5015
5016 @noindent
5017 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5018 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5019 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5020
5021 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5022 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5023
5024 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5025 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5026 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5027
5028 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5029 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5030 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5031 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5032
5033 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5034 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5035 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5036 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5037 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5038 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5039 first in the bundle.
5040
5041 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5042 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5043 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5044 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5045 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5046 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5047 is hit.
5048
5049 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5050 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5051
5052 @smallexample
5053 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5054 @end smallexample
5055
5056 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5057 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5058 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5059 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5060 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5061 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5062 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5063 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5064
5065 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5066 adjusted breakpoints:
5067
5068 @smallexample
5069 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5070 to 0x00010410.
5071 @end smallexample
5072
5073 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5074 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5075 frequently than expected.
5076
5077 @node Continuing and Stepping
5078 @section Continuing and Stepping
5079
5080 @cindex stepping
5081 @cindex continuing
5082 @cindex resuming execution
5083 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5084 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5085 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5086 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5087 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5088 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5089 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5090 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5091
5092 @table @code
5093 @kindex continue
5094 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5095 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5096 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5097 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5098 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5099 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5100 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5101 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5102 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5103 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5104
5105 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5106 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5107 @code{continue} is ignored.
5108
5109 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5110 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5111 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5112 @code{continue}.
5113 @end table
5114
5115 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5116 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5117 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5118 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5119
5120 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5121 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5122 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5123 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5124 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5125 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5126
5127 @table @code
5128 @kindex step
5129 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5130 @item step
5131 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5132 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5133 abbreviated @code{s}.
5134
5135 @quotation
5136 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5137 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5138 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5139 @c distinction here.
5140 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5141 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5142 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5143 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5144 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5145 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5146 below.
5147 @end quotation
5148
5149 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5150 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5151 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5152 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5153 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5154 called within the line.
5155
5156 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5157 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5158 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5159 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5160 was any debugging information about the routine.
5161
5162 @item step @var{count}
5163 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5164 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5165 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5166
5167 @kindex next
5168 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5169 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5170 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5171 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5172 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5173 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5174 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5175 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5176
5177 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5178
5179
5180 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5181 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5182 @c
5183 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5184 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5185 @c function are executed without stopping.
5186
5187 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5188 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5189 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5190
5191 @kindex set step-mode
5192 @item set step-mode
5193 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5194 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5195 @itemx set step-mode on
5196 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5197 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5198 information rather than stepping over it.
5199
5200 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5201 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5202 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5203
5204 @item set step-mode off
5205 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5206 debug information. This is the default.
5207
5208 @item show step-mode
5209 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5210 source line debug information.
5211
5212 @kindex finish
5213 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5214 @item finish
5215 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5216 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5217 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5218
5219 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5220 ,Returning from a Function}).
5221
5222 @kindex until
5223 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5224 @cindex run until specified location
5225 @item until
5226 @itemx u
5227 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5228 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5229 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5230 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5231 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5232 than the address of the jump.
5233
5234 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5235 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5236 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5237 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5238 through the next iteration.
5239
5240 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5241 stack frame.
5242
5243 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5244 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5245 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5246 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5247 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 (@value{GDBP}) f
5251 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5252 206 expand_input();
5253 (@value{GDBP}) until
5254 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5255 @end smallexample
5256
5257 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5258 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5259 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5260 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5261 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5262 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5263 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5264
5265 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5266 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5267 argument.
5268
5269 @item until @var{location}
5270 @itemx u @var{location}
5271 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5272 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5273 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5274 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5275 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5276 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5277 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5278 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5279 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5280 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5281 invocations have returned.
5282
5283 @smallexample
5284 94 int factorial (int value)
5285 95 @{
5286 96 if (value > 1) @{
5287 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5288 98 @}
5289 99 return (value);
5290 100 @}
5291 @end smallexample
5292
5293
5294 @kindex advance @var{location}
5295 @item advance @var{location}
5296 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5297 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5298 @ref{Specify Location}.
5299 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5300 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5301 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5302 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5303
5304
5305 @kindex stepi
5306 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5307 @item stepi
5308 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5309 @itemx si
5310 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5311
5312 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5313 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5314 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5315 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5316
5317 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5318
5319 @need 750
5320 @kindex nexti
5321 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5322 @item nexti
5323 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5324 @itemx ni
5325 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5326 proceed until the function returns.
5327
5328 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5329
5330 @end table
5331
5332 @anchor{range stepping}
5333 @cindex range stepping
5334 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5335 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5336 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5337 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5338 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5339 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5340 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5341 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5342 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5343 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5344 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5345 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5346 if necessary:
5347
5348 @table @code
5349 @kindex set range-stepping
5350 @kindex show range-stepping
5351 @item set range-stepping
5352 @itemx show range-stepping
5353 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5354
5355 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5356 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5357 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5358 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5359 default is @code{on}.
5360
5361 @end table
5362
5363 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5364 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5365 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5366
5367 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5368 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5369 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5370
5371 For example, consider the following C function:
5372
5373 @smallexample
5374 101 int func()
5375 102 @{
5376 103 foo(boring());
5377 104 bar(boring());
5378 105 @}
5379 @end smallexample
5380
5381 @noindent
5382 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5383 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5384 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5385 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5386
5387 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5388 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5389 is called from many places.
5390
5391 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5392 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5393 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5394 @code{foo}.
5395
5396 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5397 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5398
5399 @table @code
5400 @kindex skip function
5401 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5402 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5403 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5404 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5405 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5406
5407 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5408 will be skipped.
5409
5410 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5411 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5412
5413 @kindex skip file
5414 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5415 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5416 will be skipped over when stepping.
5417
5418 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5419 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5420 @end table
5421
5422 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5423 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5424
5425 @table @code
5426 @kindex info skip
5427 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5428 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5429 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5430 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5431
5432 @table @emph
5433 @item Identifier
5434 A number identifying this skip.
5435 @item Type
5436 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5437 @item Enabled or Disabled
5438 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5439 @item Address
5440 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5441 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5442 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5443 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5444 address here.
5445 @item What
5446 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5447 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5448 where it is defined.
5449 @end table
5450
5451 @kindex skip delete
5452 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5453 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5454 skips.
5455
5456 @kindex skip enable
5457 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5458 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5459 skips.
5460
5461 @kindex skip disable
5462 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5463 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5464 skips.
5465
5466 @end table
5467
5468 @node Signals
5469 @section Signals
5470 @cindex signals
5471
5472 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5473 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5474 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5475 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5476 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5477 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5478 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5479 requested an alarm).
5480
5481 @cindex fatal signals
5482 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5483 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5484 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5485 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5486 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5487 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5488
5489 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5490 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5491 signal.
5492
5493 @cindex handling signals
5494 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5495 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5496 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5497 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5498 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5499
5500 @table @code
5501 @kindex info signals
5502 @kindex info handle
5503 @item info signals
5504 @itemx info handle
5505 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5506 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5507 the defined types of signals.
5508
5509 @item info signals @var{sig}
5510 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5511
5512 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5513
5514 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5515 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5516 for details about this command.
5517
5518 @kindex handle
5519 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5520 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5521 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5522 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5523 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5524 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5525 say what change to make.
5526 @end table
5527
5528 @c @group
5529 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5530 Their full names are:
5531
5532 @table @code
5533 @item nostop
5534 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5535 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5536
5537 @item stop
5538 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5539 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5540
5541 @item print
5542 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5543
5544 @item noprint
5545 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5546 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5547
5548 @item pass
5549 @itemx noignore
5550 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5551 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5552 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5553
5554 @item nopass
5555 @itemx ignore
5556 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5557 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5558 @end table
5559 @c @end group
5560
5561 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5562 program until you
5563 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5564 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5565 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5566 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5567 program sees that signal when you continue.
5568
5569 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5570 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5571 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5572 erroneous signals.
5573
5574 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5575 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5576 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5577 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5578 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5579 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5580 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5581 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5582 Program a Signal}.
5583
5584 @cindex extra signal information
5585 @anchor{extra signal information}
5586
5587 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5588 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5589 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5590 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5591 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5592 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5593 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5594 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5595 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5596 system header.
5597
5598 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5599 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5600
5601 @smallexample
5602 @group
5603 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5604 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5605 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5606 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5607 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5608 type = struct @{
5609 int si_signo;
5610 int si_errno;
5611 int si_code;
5612 union @{
5613 int _pad[28];
5614 struct @{...@} _kill;
5615 struct @{...@} _timer;
5616 struct @{...@} _rt;
5617 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5618 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5619 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5620 @} _sifields;
5621 @}
5622 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5623 type = struct @{
5624 void *si_addr;
5625 @}
5626 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5627 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5628 @end group
5629 @end smallexample
5630
5631 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5632
5633 @node Thread Stops
5634 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5635
5636 @cindex stopped threads
5637 @cindex threads, stopped
5638
5639 @cindex continuing threads
5640 @cindex threads, continuing
5641
5642 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5643 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5644 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5645 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5646 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5647 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5648 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5649 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5650 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5651
5652 @menu
5653 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5654 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5655 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5656 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5657 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5658 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5659 @end menu
5660
5661 @node All-Stop Mode
5662 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5663
5664 @cindex all-stop mode
5665
5666 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5667 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5668 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5669 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5670 underfoot.
5671
5672 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5673 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5674 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5675
5676 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5677 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5678 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5679 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5680 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5681 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5682 stops.
5683
5684 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5685 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5686 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5687 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5688
5689 @cindex automatic thread selection
5690 @cindex switching threads automatically
5691 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5692 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5693 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5694 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5695 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5696 thread.
5697
5698 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5699 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5700
5701 @table @code
5702 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5703 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5704 @cindex lock scheduler
5705 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5706 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5707 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5708 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5709 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5710 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5711 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5712 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5713 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5714 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5715 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5716 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5717
5718 @item show scheduler-locking
5719 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5720 @end table
5721
5722 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5723 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5724 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5725 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5726 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5727 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5728 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5729 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5730 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5731 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5732 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5733 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5734 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5735 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5736
5737 @table @code
5738 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5739 @item set schedule-multiple
5740 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5741 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5742 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5743 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5744 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5745 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5746
5747 @item show schedule-multiple
5748 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5749 multiple processes.
5750 @end table
5751
5752 @node Non-Stop Mode
5753 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5754
5755 @cindex non-stop mode
5756
5757 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5758 @c with more details.
5759
5760 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5761 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5762 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5763 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5764 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5765 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5766
5767 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5768 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5769 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5770 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5771 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5772 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5773 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5774 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5775 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5776 independently and simultaneously.
5777
5778 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5779 or attach to your program:
5780
5781 @smallexample
5782 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5783 set pagination off
5784
5785 # Finally, turn it on!
5786 set non-stop on
5787 @end smallexample
5788
5789 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5790
5791 @table @code
5792 @kindex set non-stop
5793 @item set non-stop on
5794 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5795 @item set non-stop off
5796 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5797 @kindex show non-stop
5798 @item show non-stop
5799 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5800 @end table
5801
5802 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5803 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5804 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5805 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5806 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5807 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5808 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5809 default.
5810
5811 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5812 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5813 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5814
5815 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5816 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5817 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5818 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5819 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5820
5821 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5822 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5823 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5824 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5825 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5826
5827 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5828
5829 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5830 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5831 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5832 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5833 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5834 previously current thread.
5835
5836 @node Background Execution
5837 @subsection Background Execution
5838
5839 @cindex foreground execution
5840 @cindex background execution
5841 @cindex asynchronous execution
5842 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5843
5844 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5845 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5846 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5847 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5848 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5849 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5850
5851 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5852 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5853
5854 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5855 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5856 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5857 are:
5858
5859 @table @code
5860 @kindex run&
5861 @item run
5862 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5863
5864 @item attach
5865 @kindex attach&
5866 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5867
5868 @item step
5869 @kindex step&
5870 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5871
5872 @item stepi
5873 @kindex stepi&
5874 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5875
5876 @item next
5877 @kindex next&
5878 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5879
5880 @item nexti
5881 @kindex nexti&
5882 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5883
5884 @item continue
5885 @kindex continue&
5886 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5887
5888 @item finish
5889 @kindex finish&
5890 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5891
5892 @item until
5893 @kindex until&
5894 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5895
5896 @end table
5897
5898 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5899 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5900 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5901 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5902 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5903 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5904
5905 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5906 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5907
5908 @table @code
5909 @kindex interrupt
5910 @item interrupt
5911 @itemx interrupt -a
5912
5913 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5914 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5915 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5916 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5917 @end table
5918
5919 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5920 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5921
5922 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5923 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5924 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5925
5926 @table @code
5927 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5928 @cindex thread breakpoints
5929 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5930 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5931 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5932 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5933 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5934 specify some source line.
5935
5936 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5937 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5938 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
5939 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
5940 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5941
5942 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5943 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5944 program.
5945
5946 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5947 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5948 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5952 @end smallexample
5953
5954 @end table
5955
5956 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5957 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5958 thread list. For example:
5959
5960 @smallexample
5961 (@value{GDBP}) c
5962 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5963 @end smallexample
5964
5965 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5966 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5967 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5968 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5969 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5970 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5971 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5972 command.
5973
5974 @node Interrupted System Calls
5975 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5976
5977 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5978 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5979 @cindex premature return from system calls
5980 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5981 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5982 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5983 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5984 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5985 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5986 stop execution.
5987
5988 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5989 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5990 style anyways.
5991
5992 For example, do not write code like this:
5993
5994 @smallexample
5995 sleep (10);
5996 @end smallexample
5997
5998 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5999 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6000
6001 Instead, write this:
6002
6003 @smallexample
6004 int unslept = 10;
6005 while (unslept > 0)
6006 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6007 @end smallexample
6008
6009 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6010 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6011 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6012 @value{GDBN}.
6013
6014 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6015 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6016 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6017 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6018
6019 @node Observer Mode
6020 @subsection Observer Mode
6021
6022 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6023 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6024 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6025 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6026 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6027
6028 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6029 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6030 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6031 mode.
6032
6033 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6034 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6035 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6036 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6037 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6038
6039 @table @code
6040
6041 @kindex observer
6042 @item set observer on
6043 @itemx set observer off
6044 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6045 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6046 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6047 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6048
6049 @item show observer
6050 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6051
6052 @kindex may-write-registers
6053 @item set may-write-registers on
6054 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6055 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6056 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6057 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6058
6059 @item show may-write-registers
6060 Show the current permission to write registers.
6061
6062 @kindex may-write-memory
6063 @item set may-write-memory on
6064 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6065 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6066 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6067 defaults to @code{on}.
6068
6069 @item show may-write-memory
6070 Show the current permission to write memory.
6071
6072 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6073 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6074 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6075 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6076 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6077 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6078
6079 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6080 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6081
6082 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6083 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6084 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6085 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6086 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6087 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6088 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6089
6090 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6091 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6092
6093 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6094 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6095 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6096 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6097 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6098 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6099 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6100
6101 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6102 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6103
6104 @kindex may-interrupt
6105 @item set may-interrupt on
6106 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6107 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6108 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6109 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6110 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6111
6112 @item show may-interrupt
6113 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6114
6115 @end table
6116
6117 @node Reverse Execution
6118 @chapter Running programs backward
6119 @cindex reverse execution
6120 @cindex running programs backward
6121
6122 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6123 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6124 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6125 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6126
6127 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6128 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6129 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6130 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6131 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6132 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6133
6134 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6135 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6136 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6137 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6138 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6139 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6140 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6141 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6142 prior values@footnote{
6143 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6144 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6145 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6146
6147 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6148 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6149 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6150 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6151 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6152 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6153 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6154 }.
6155
6156 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6157 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @kindex reverse-continue
6161 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6162 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6163 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6164 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6165 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6166 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6167 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6168
6169 @kindex reverse-step
6170 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6171 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6172 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6173 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6174
6175 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6176 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6177 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6178 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6179 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6180 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6181
6182 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6183 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6184
6185 @kindex reverse-stepi
6186 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6187 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6188 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6189 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6190 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6191 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6192 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6193
6194 @kindex reverse-next
6195 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6196 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6197 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6198 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6199 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6200 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6201 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6202 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6203 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6204 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6205
6206 @kindex reverse-nexti
6207 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6208 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6209 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6210 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6211 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6212 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6213 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6214 frame) is reached.
6215
6216 @kindex reverse-finish
6217 @item reverse-finish
6218 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6219 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6220 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6221 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6222
6223 @kindex set exec-direction
6224 @item set exec-direction
6225 Set the direction of target execution.
6226 @item set exec-direction reverse
6227 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6228 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6229 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6230 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6231 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6232 @item set exec-direction forward
6233 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6234 This is the default.
6235 @end table
6236
6237
6238 @node Process Record and Replay
6239 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6240 @cindex process record and replay
6241 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6242
6243 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6244 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6245 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6246
6247 @cindex replay mode
6248 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6249 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6250 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6251 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6252 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6253 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6254 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6255 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6256 execution log.
6257
6258 @cindex record mode
6259 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6260 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6261 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6262 for future replay.
6263
6264 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6265 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6266 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6267 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6268 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6269 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6270
6271 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6272 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6273 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6274 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6275
6276 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6277 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6278
6279 @table @code
6280 @kindex target record
6281 @kindex target record-full
6282 @kindex target record-btrace
6283 @kindex record
6284 @kindex record full
6285 @kindex record btrace
6286 @kindex rec
6287 @kindex rec full
6288 @kindex rec btrace
6289 @item record @var{method}
6290 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6291 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6292 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6293 recording methods are available:
6294
6295 @table @code
6296 @item full
6297 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6298 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6299 execution.
6300
6301 @item btrace
6302 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6303 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6304 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6305 reverse execution.
6306
6307 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6308 @end table
6309
6310 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6311 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6312 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6313 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6314
6315 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6316 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6317
6318 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6319 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6320 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6321 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6322 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6323
6324 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6325 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6326 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6327 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6328 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6329 does not support these two modes.
6330
6331 @kindex record stop
6332 @kindex rec s
6333 @item record stop
6334 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6335 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6336 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6337
6338 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6339 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6340 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6341 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6342 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6343
6344 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6345 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6346 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6347 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6348 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6349
6350 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6351 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6352
6353 @kindex record goto
6354 @item record goto
6355 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6356 ways to specify the location to go to:
6357
6358 @table @code
6359 @item record goto begin
6360 @itemx record goto start
6361 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6362
6363 @item record goto end
6364 Go to the end of the execution log.
6365
6366 @item record goto @var{n}
6367 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6368 @end table
6369
6370 @kindex record save
6371 @item record save @var{filename}
6372 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6373 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6374 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6375
6376 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6377
6378 @kindex record restore
6379 @item record restore @var{filename}
6380 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6381 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6382
6383 @kindex set record full
6384 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6385 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6386 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6387 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6388
6389 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6390 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6391 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6392 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6393 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6394 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6395 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6396 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6397
6398 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6399 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6400 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6401
6402 @kindex show record full
6403 @item show record full insn-number-max
6404 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6405 recording method.
6406
6407 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6408 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6409 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6410 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6411 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6412 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6413 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6414 oldest one to be deleted.
6415
6416 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6417 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6418
6419 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6420 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6421
6422 @item set record full memory-query
6423 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6424 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6425 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6426 case.
6427
6428 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6429 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6430 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6431 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6432 results.
6433
6434 @item show record full memory-query
6435 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6436
6437 @kindex set record btrace
6438 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6439 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6440 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6441 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6442 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6443 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6444 You can use the following command for that:
6445
6446 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6447 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6448 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6449 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6450 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6451 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6452 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6453 position.
6454
6455 @kindex show record btrace
6456 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6457 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6458
6459 @kindex info record
6460 @item info record
6461 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6462 method:
6463
6464 @table @code
6465 @item full
6466 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6467 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6468
6469 @itemize @bullet
6470 @item
6471 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6472 @item
6473 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6474 @item
6475 Highest recorded instruction number.
6476 @item
6477 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6478 @item
6479 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6480 @item
6481 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6482 @end itemize
6483
6484 @item btrace
6485 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6486 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6487 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6488 @end table
6489
6490 @kindex record delete
6491 @kindex rec del
6492 @item record delete
6493 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6494 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6495 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6496 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6497
6498 @kindex record instruction-history
6499 @kindex rec instruction-history
6500 @item record instruction-history
6501 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6502 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6503 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6504 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6505 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6506
6507 @table @code
6508 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6509 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6510 @var{insn}.
6511
6512 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6513 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6514 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6515 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6516 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6517 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6518
6519 @item record instruction-history
6520 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6521
6522 @item record instruction-history -
6523 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6524
6525 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6526 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6527 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6528 number @var{end} is included.
6529 @end table
6530
6531 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6532
6533 @kindex set record
6534 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6535 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6536 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6537 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6538 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6539
6540 @kindex show record
6541 @item show record instruction-history-size
6542 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6543 instruction-history} command.
6544
6545 @kindex record function-call-history
6546 @kindex rec function-call-history
6547 @item record function-call-history
6548 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6549 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6550 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6551 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6552 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6553 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6554 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6555 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6556 given together.
6557
6558 @smallexample
6559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6560 1 void foo (void)
6561 2 @{
6562 3 @}
6563 4
6564 5 void bar (void)
6565 6 @{
6566 7 ...
6567 8 foo ();
6568 9 ...
6569 10 @}
6570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6571 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6572 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6573 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6574 @end smallexample
6575
6576 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6577 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6578 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6579 to print:
6580
6581 @table @code
6582 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6583 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6584
6585 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6586 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6587 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6588 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6589 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6590
6591 @item record function-call-history
6592 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6593
6594 @item record function-call-history -
6595 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6596
6597 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6598 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6599 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6600 @end table
6601
6602 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6603
6604 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6605 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6606 Define how many lines to print in the
6607 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6608 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6609
6610 @item show record function-call-history-size
6611 Show how many lines to print in the
6612 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6613 @end table
6614
6615
6616 @node Stack
6617 @chapter Examining the Stack
6618
6619 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6620 stopped and how it got there.
6621
6622 @cindex call stack
6623 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6624 is generated.
6625 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6626 the arguments of the call,
6627 and the local variables of the function being called.
6628 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6629 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6630 stack}.
6631
6632 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6633 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6634
6635 @cindex selected frame
6636 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6637 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6638 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6639 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6640 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6641 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6642
6643 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6644 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6645 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6646
6647 @menu
6648 * Frames:: Stack frames
6649 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6650 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6651 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6652 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6653
6654 @end menu
6655
6656 @node Frames
6657 @section Stack Frames
6658
6659 @cindex frame, definition
6660 @cindex stack frame
6661 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6662 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6663 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6664 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6665 which the function is executing.
6666
6667 @cindex initial frame
6668 @cindex outermost frame
6669 @cindex innermost frame
6670 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6671 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6672 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6673 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6674 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6675 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6676 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6677 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6678
6679 @cindex frame pointer
6680 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6681 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6682 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6683 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6684 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6685 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6686
6687 @cindex frame number
6688 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6689 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6690 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6691 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6692 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6693
6694 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6695 @c underflow problems.
6696 @cindex frameless execution
6697 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6698 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6699 @smallexample
6700 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6701 @end smallexample
6702 generates functions without a frame.)
6703 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6704 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6705 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6706 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6707 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6708 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6709 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6710
6711 @table @code
6712 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6713 @cindex current stack frame
6714 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6715 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6716 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6717 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6718 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6719
6720 @kindex select-frame
6721 @cindex selecting frame silently
6722 @item select-frame
6723 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6724 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6725 @code{frame}.
6726 @end table
6727
6728 @node Backtrace
6729 @section Backtraces
6730
6731 @cindex traceback
6732 @cindex call stack traces
6733 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6734 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6735 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6736 stack.
6737
6738 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6739 @table @code
6740 @kindex backtrace
6741 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6742 @item backtrace
6743 @itemx bt
6744 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6745 frames in the stack.
6746
6747 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6748 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6749
6750 @item backtrace @var{n}
6751 @itemx bt @var{n}
6752 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6753
6754 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6755 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6756 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6757
6758 @item backtrace full
6759 @itemx bt full
6760 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6761 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6762 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6763 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6764
6765 @item backtrace no-filters
6766 @itemx bt no-filters
6767 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6768 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6769 @itemx bt no-filters full
6770 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6771 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6772 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6773 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6774 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6775 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6776 support.
6777 @end table
6778
6779 @kindex where
6780 @kindex info stack
6781 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6782 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6783
6784 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6785 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6786 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6787 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6788 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6789 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6790 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6791 multi-threaded program.
6792
6793 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6794 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6795 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6796 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6797 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6798 line number.
6799
6800 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6801 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6802
6803 @smallexample
6804 @group
6805 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6806 at builtin.c:993
6807 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6808 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6809 at macro.c:71
6810 (More stack frames follow...)
6811 @end group
6812 @end smallexample
6813
6814 @noindent
6815 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6816 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6817 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6818
6819 @noindent
6820 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6821 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6822 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6823 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6824 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6825
6826 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6827 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6828 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6829 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6830 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6831 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6832 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6833 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6834 such a backtrace might look like:
6835
6836 @smallexample
6837 @group
6838 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6839 at builtin.c:993
6840 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6841 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6842 at macro.c:71
6843 (More stack frames follow...)
6844 @end group
6845 @end smallexample
6846
6847 @noindent
6848 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6849 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6850
6851 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6852 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6853 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6854
6855 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6856 @cindex program entry point
6857 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6858 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6859 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6860 @code{main}@footnote{
6861 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6862 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6863 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6864 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6865 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6866 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6867
6868 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6869 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6870
6871 @table @code
6872 @item set backtrace past-main
6873 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6874 @kindex set backtrace
6875 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6876
6877 @item set backtrace past-main off
6878 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6879 default.
6880
6881 @item show backtrace past-main
6882 @kindex show backtrace
6883 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6884
6885 @item set backtrace past-entry
6886 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6887 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6888 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6889 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6890
6891 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6892 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6893 application. This is the default.
6894
6895 @item show backtrace past-entry
6896 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6897
6898 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6899 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6900 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6901 @cindex backtrace limit
6902 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6903 or zero means unlimited levels.
6904
6905 @item show backtrace limit
6906 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6907 @end table
6908
6909 You can control how file names are displayed.
6910
6911 @table @code
6912 @item set filename-display
6913 @itemx set filename-display relative
6914 @cindex filename-display
6915 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6916
6917 @item set filename-display basename
6918 Display only basename of a filename.
6919
6920 @item set filename-display absolute
6921 Display an absolute filename.
6922
6923 @item show filename-display
6924 Show the current way to display filenames.
6925 @end table
6926
6927 @node Frame Filter Management
6928 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6929 @cindex managing frame filters
6930
6931 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6932 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6933
6934 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6935 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6936
6937 @table @code
6938 @kindex info frame-filter
6939 @item info frame-filter
6940 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6941 their name, priority and enabled status.
6942
6943 @kindex disable frame-filter
6944 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6945 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6946 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6947 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6948 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6949 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6950 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6951 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
6952 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6953 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6954 may be enabled again later.
6955
6956 @kindex enable frame-filter
6957 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6958 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6959 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6960 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6961 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6962 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6963 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6964 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6965 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6966
6967 Example:
6968
6969 @smallexample
6970 (gdb) info frame-filter
6971
6972 global frame-filters:
6973 Priority Enabled Name
6974 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6975 100 Yes Reverse
6976
6977 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6978 Priority Enabled Name
6979 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6980
6981 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6982 Priority Enabled Name
6983 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6984
6985 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6986 (gdb) info frame-filter
6987
6988 global frame-filters:
6989 Priority Enabled Name
6990 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6991 100 Yes Reverse
6992
6993 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6994 Priority Enabled Name
6995 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6996
6997 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6998 Priority Enabled Name
6999 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7000
7001 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7002 (gdb) info frame-filter
7003
7004 global frame-filters:
7005 Priority Enabled Name
7006 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7007 100 Yes Reverse
7008
7009 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7010 Priority Enabled Name
7011 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7012
7013 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7014 Priority Enabled Name
7015 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7016 @end smallexample
7017
7018 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7019 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7020 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7021 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7022 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7023 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7024 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7025
7026 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7027 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7028 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7029 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7030 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7031 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7032 dictionary resides.
7033
7034 Example:
7035
7036 @smallexample
7037 (gdb) info frame-filter
7038
7039 global frame-filters:
7040 Priority Enabled Name
7041 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7042 100 Yes Reverse
7043
7044 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7045 Priority Enabled Name
7046 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7047
7048 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7049 Priority Enabled Name
7050 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7051
7052 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7053 (gdb) info frame-filter
7054
7055 global frame-filters:
7056 Priority Enabled Name
7057 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7058 50 Yes Reverse
7059
7060 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7061 Priority Enabled Name
7062 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7063
7064 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7065 Priority Enabled Name
7066 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7067 @end smallexample
7068 @end table
7069
7070 @node Selection
7071 @section Selecting a Frame
7072
7073 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7074 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7075 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7076 of the stack frame just selected.
7077
7078 @table @code
7079 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7080 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7081 @item frame @var{n}
7082 @itemx f @var{n}
7083 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7084 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7085 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7086 @code{main}.
7087
7088 @item frame @var{addr}
7089 @itemx f @var{addr}
7090 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7091 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7092 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7093 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7094 switches between them.
7095
7096 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7097 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7098
7099 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7100 pointer and a program counter.
7101
7102 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7103 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7104
7105 @kindex up
7106 @item up @var{n}
7107 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7108 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7109 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7110
7111 @kindex down
7112 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7113 @item down @var{n}
7114 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7115 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7116 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7117 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7118 @end table
7119
7120 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7121 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7122 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7123 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7124
7125 @need 1000
7126 For example:
7127
7128 @smallexample
7129 @group
7130 (@value{GDBP}) up
7131 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7132 at env.c:10
7133 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7134 @end group
7135 @end smallexample
7136
7137 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7138 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7139 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7140 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7141 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7142 for details.
7143
7144 @table @code
7145 @kindex down-silently
7146 @kindex up-silently
7147 @item up-silently @var{n}
7148 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7149 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7150 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7151 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7152 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7153 distracting.
7154 @end table
7155
7156 @node Frame Info
7157 @section Information About a Frame
7158
7159 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7160 stack frame.
7161
7162 @table @code
7163 @item frame
7164 @itemx f
7165 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7166 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7167 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7168 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7169 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7170
7171 @kindex info frame
7172 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7173 @item info frame
7174 @itemx info f
7175 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7176 including:
7177
7178 @itemize @bullet
7179 @item
7180 the address of the frame
7181 @item
7182 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7183 @item
7184 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7185 @item
7186 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7187 @item
7188 the address of the frame's arguments
7189 @item
7190 the address of the frame's local variables
7191 @item
7192 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7193 @item
7194 which registers were saved in the frame
7195 @end itemize
7196
7197 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7198 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7199 the usual conventions.
7200
7201 @item info frame @var{addr}
7202 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7203 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7204 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7205 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7206 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7207 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7208
7209 @kindex info args
7210 @item info args
7211 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7212
7213 @item info locals
7214 @kindex info locals
7215 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7216 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7217 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7218
7219 @end table
7220
7221
7222 @node Source
7223 @chapter Examining Source Files
7224
7225 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7226 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7227 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7228 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7229 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7230 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7231 source files by explicit command.
7232
7233 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7234 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7235 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7236
7237 @menu
7238 * List:: Printing source lines
7239 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7240 * Edit:: Editing source files
7241 * Search:: Searching source files
7242 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7243 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7244 @end menu
7245
7246 @node List
7247 @section Printing Source Lines
7248
7249 @kindex list
7250 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7251 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7252 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7253 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7254 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7255
7256 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7257
7258 @table @code
7259 @item list @var{linenum}
7260 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7261 current source file.
7262
7263 @item list @var{function}
7264 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7265 @var{function}.
7266
7267 @item list
7268 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7269 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7270 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7271 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7272 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7273
7274 @item list -
7275 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7276 @end table
7277
7278 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7279 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7280 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7281
7282 @table @code
7283 @kindex set listsize
7284 @item set listsize @var{count}
7285 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7286 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7287 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7288 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7289
7290 @kindex show listsize
7291 @item show listsize
7292 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7293 @end table
7294
7295 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7296 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7297 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7298 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7299 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7300
7301 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7302 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7303 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7304 to specify some source line.
7305
7306 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7307
7308 @table @code
7309 @item list @var{linespec}
7310 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7311
7312 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7313 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7314 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7315 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7316 the same source file as the first linespec.
7317
7318 @item list ,@var{last}
7319 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7320
7321 @item list @var{first},
7322 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7323
7324 @item list +
7325 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7326
7327 @item list -
7328 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7329
7330 @item list
7331 As described in the preceding table.
7332 @end table
7333
7334 @node Specify Location
7335 @section Specifying a Location
7336 @cindex specifying location
7337 @cindex linespec
7338
7339 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7340 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7341 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7342 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7343
7344 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7345 @value{GDBN} understands:
7346
7347 @table @code
7348 @item @var{linenum}
7349 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7350
7351 @item -@var{offset}
7352 @itemx +@var{offset}
7353 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7354 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7355 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7356 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7357 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7358 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7359 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7360 linespec.
7361
7362 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7363 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7364 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7365 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7366 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7367 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7368 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7369
7370 @item @var{function}
7371 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7372 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7373
7374 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7375 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7376
7377 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7378 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7379 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7380 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7381 functions in different source files.
7382
7383 @item @var{label}
7384 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7385 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7386 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7387 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7388 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7389
7390 @item *@var{address}
7391 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7392 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7393 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7394 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7395 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7396 source files.
7397
7398 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7399 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7400 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7401 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7402 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7403 of @var{address}:
7404
7405 @table @code
7406 @item @var{expression}
7407 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7408
7409 @item @var{funcaddr}
7410 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7411 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7412 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7413 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7414 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7415 (although the Pascal form also works).
7416
7417 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7418 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7419
7420 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7421 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7422 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7423 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7424 functions with identical names in different source files.
7425 @end table
7426
7427 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7428 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7429 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7430 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7431 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7432 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7433
7434 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7435 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7436 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7437 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7438 each one of those probes.
7439
7440 @end table
7441
7442
7443 @node Edit
7444 @section Editing Source Files
7445 @cindex editing source files
7446
7447 @kindex edit
7448 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7449 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7450 The editing program of your choice
7451 is invoked with the current line set to
7452 the active line in the program.
7453 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7454 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @item edit @var{location}
7458 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7459 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7460 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7461 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7462 command most commonly used:
7463
7464 @table @code
7465 @item edit @var{number}
7466 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7467
7468 @item edit @var{function}
7469 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7470 @end table
7471
7472 @end table
7473
7474 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7475 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7476 @footnote{
7477 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7478 following command-line syntax:
7479 @smallexample
7480 ex +@var{number} file
7481 @end smallexample
7482 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7483 the file where to start editing.}.
7484 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7485 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7486 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7487 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7488 @smallexample
7489 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7490 export EDITOR
7491 gdb @dots{}
7492 @end smallexample
7493 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7494 @smallexample
7495 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7496 gdb @dots{}
7497 @end smallexample
7498
7499 @node Search
7500 @section Searching Source Files
7501 @cindex searching source files
7502
7503 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7504 regular expression.
7505
7506 @table @code
7507 @kindex search
7508 @kindex forward-search
7509 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7510 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7511 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7512 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7513 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7514 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7515 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7516 @code{fo}.
7517
7518 @kindex reverse-search
7519 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7520 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7521 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7522 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7523 this command as @code{rev}.
7524 @end table
7525
7526 @node Source Path
7527 @section Specifying Source Directories
7528
7529 @cindex source path
7530 @cindex directories for source files
7531 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7532 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7533 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7534 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7535 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7536 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7537 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7538
7539 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7540 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7541 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7542 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7543 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7544 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7545 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7546 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7547 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7548 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7549 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7550
7551 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7552 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7553 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7554 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7555 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7556 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7557
7558 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7559 source files.
7560
7561 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7562 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7563 each line is in the file.
7564
7565 @kindex directory
7566 @kindex dir
7567 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7568 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7569 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7570
7571 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7572 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7573
7574 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7575 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7576 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7577 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7578 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7579 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7580 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7581 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7582 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7583 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7584 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7585 name to look up the sources.
7586
7587 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7588 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7589 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7590 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7591 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7592 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7593 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7594 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7595
7596 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7597 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7598 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7599 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7600 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7601 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7602 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7603
7604 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7605 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7606 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7607 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7608 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7609 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7610 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7611 command.
7612
7613 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7614 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7615 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7616 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7617 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7618 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7619 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7620
7621 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7622 @cindex default source path substitution
7623 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7624 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7625 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7626 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7627 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7628 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7629 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7630 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7631 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7632 together.
7633
7634 @table @code
7635 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7636 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7637 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7638 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7639 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7640 part of absolute file names) or
7641 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7642 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7643
7644 @kindex cdir
7645 @kindex cwd
7646 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7647 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7648 @cindex compilation directory
7649 @cindex current directory
7650 @cindex working directory
7651 @cindex directory, current
7652 @cindex directory, compilation
7653 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7654 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7655 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7656 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7657 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7658 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7659
7660 @item directory
7661 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7662
7663 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7664 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7665
7666 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7667 @kindex set directories
7668 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7669 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7670
7671 @item show directories
7672 @kindex show directories
7673 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7674
7675 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7676 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7677 @kindex set substitute-path
7678 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7679 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7680 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7681
7682 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7683 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7684
7685 @smallexample
7686 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7687 @end smallexample
7688
7689 @noindent
7690 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7691 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7692 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7693
7694 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7695 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7696 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7697 the substitution.
7698
7699 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7700
7701 @smallexample
7702 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7703 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7704 @end smallexample
7705
7706 @noindent
7707 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7708 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7709 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7710 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7711
7712
7713 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7714 @kindex unset substitute-path
7715 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7716 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7717 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7718
7719 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7720
7721 @item show substitute-path [path]
7722 @kindex show substitute-path
7723 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7724 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7725
7726 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7727 rules.
7728
7729 @end table
7730
7731 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7732 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7733 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7734
7735 @enumerate
7736 @item
7737 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7738
7739 @item
7740 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7741 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7742 directories in one command.
7743 @end enumerate
7744
7745 @node Machine Code
7746 @section Source and Machine Code
7747 @cindex source line and its code address
7748
7749 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7750 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7751 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7752 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7753 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7754 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7755 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7756 well as hex.
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @kindex info line
7760 @item info line @var{linespec}
7761 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7762 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7763 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7764 @end table
7765
7766 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7767 the object code for the first line of function
7768 @code{m4_changequote}:
7769
7770 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7771 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7772 @smallexample
7773 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7774 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7775 @end smallexample
7776
7777 @noindent
7778 @cindex code address and its source line
7779 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7780 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7781 @smallexample
7782 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7783 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7784 @end smallexample
7785
7786 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7787 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7788 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7789 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7790 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7791 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7792 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7793 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7794 Variables}).
7795
7796 @table @code
7797 @kindex disassemble
7798 @cindex assembly instructions
7799 @cindex instructions, assembly
7800 @cindex machine instructions
7801 @cindex listing machine instructions
7802 @item disassemble
7803 @itemx disassemble /m
7804 @itemx disassemble /r
7805 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7806 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7807 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7808 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7809 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7810 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7811 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7812 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7813 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7814 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7815
7816 @table @code
7817 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7818 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7819 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7820 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7821 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7822 @end table
7823
7824 @noindent
7825 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7826 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7827
7828 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7829 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7830
7831 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7832 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7833 @end table
7834
7835 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7836 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7837
7838 @smallexample
7839 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7840 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7841 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7842 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7843 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7844 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7845 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7846 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7847 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7848 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7849 End of assembler dump.
7850 @end smallexample
7851
7852 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7853 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7854
7855 @smallexample
7856 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7857 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7858 5 @{
7859 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7860 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7861 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7862 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7863 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7864
7865 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7866 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7867 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7868
7869 7 return 0;
7870 8 @}
7871 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7872 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7873 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7874
7875 End of assembler dump.
7876 @end smallexample
7877
7878 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7879
7880 @smallexample
7881 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7882 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7883 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7884 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7885 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7886 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7887 End of assembler dump.
7888 @end smallexample
7889
7890 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7891 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7892 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7893 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7894
7895 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7896 mnemonics or other syntax.
7897
7898 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7899 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7900 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7901 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7902 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7903
7904 @table @code
7905 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7906 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7907 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7908 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7909 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7910 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7911
7912 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7913 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7914 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7915 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7916
7917 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7918 @item show disassembly-flavor
7919 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7920 @end table
7921
7922 @table @code
7923 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7924 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7925 @item set disassemble-next-line
7926 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7927 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7928 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7929 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7930 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7931 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7932 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7933 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7934 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7935 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7936 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7937 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7938 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7939 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7940 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7941 instruction.
7942 @end table
7943
7944
7945 @node Data
7946 @chapter Examining Data
7947
7948 @cindex printing data
7949 @cindex examining data
7950 @kindex print
7951 @kindex inspect
7952 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7953 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7954 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7955 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7956 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7957 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7958
7959 @table @code
7960 @item print @var{expr}
7961 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7962 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7963 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7964 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7965 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7966 Formats}.
7967
7968 @item print
7969 @itemx print /@var{f}
7970 @cindex reprint the last value
7971 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7972 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7973 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7977 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7978 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7979
7980 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7981 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7982 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7983 Table}.
7984
7985 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7986 @kindex explore
7987 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7988 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7989 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7990 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7991 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7992 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7993 embedded in the higher level data types.
7994
7995 @table @code
7996 @item explore @var{arg}
7997 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7998 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7999 @end table
8000
8001 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8002 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8003 C program as
8004
8005 @smallexample
8006 struct SimpleStruct
8007 @{
8008 int i;
8009 double d;
8010 @};
8011
8012 struct ComplexStruct
8013 @{
8014 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8015 int arr[10];
8016 @};
8017 @end smallexample
8018
8019 @noindent
8020 followed by variable declarations as
8021
8022 @smallexample
8023 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8024 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8025 @end smallexample
8026
8027 @noindent
8028 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8029 @code{explore} command as follows.
8030
8031 @smallexample
8032 (gdb) explore cs
8033 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8034 the following fields:
8035
8036 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8037 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8038
8039 Enter the field number of choice:
8040 @end smallexample
8041
8042 @noindent
8043 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8044 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8045 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8046 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8047 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8048 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8049 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8050 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8051
8052 @smallexample
8053 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8054 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8055 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8056 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8057
8058 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8059 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8060
8061 Press enter to return to parent value:
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 @noindent
8065 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8066 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8067 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8068 to explore.
8069
8070 @smallexample
8071 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8072 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8073
8074 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8075
8076 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8077
8078 Press enter to return to parent value:
8079 @end smallexample
8080
8081 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8082 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8083 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8084 level data structure).
8085
8086 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8087 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8088 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8089 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8090 same example as above, your can explore the type
8091 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8092 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8093
8094 @smallexample
8095 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8096 @end smallexample
8097
8098 @noindent
8099 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8100 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8101 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8102 example.
8103
8104 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8105 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8106 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8107 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8108 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8109
8110 @table @code
8111 @item explore value @var{expr}
8112 @cindex explore value
8113 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8114 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8115 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8116 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8117 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8118
8119 @item explore type @var{arg}
8120 @cindex explore type
8121 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8122 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8123 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8124 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8125 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8126 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8127 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8128 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8129 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8130 @end table
8131
8132 @menu
8133 * Expressions:: Expressions
8134 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8135 * Variables:: Program variables
8136 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8137 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8138 * Memory:: Examining memory
8139 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8140 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8141 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8142 * Value History:: Value history
8143 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8144 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8145 * Registers:: Registers
8146 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8147 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8148 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8149 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8150 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8151 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8152 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8153 character set than GDB does
8154 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8155 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8156 @end menu
8157
8158 @node Expressions
8159 @section Expressions
8160
8161 @cindex expressions
8162 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8163 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8164 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8165 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8166 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8167 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8168 @ref{Compilation}.
8169
8170 @cindex arrays in expressions
8171 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8172 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8173 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8174 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8175 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8176 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8177
8178 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8179 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8180 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8181 languages.
8182
8183 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8184 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8185
8186 @cindex casts, in expressions
8187 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8188 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8189 at that address in memory.
8190 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8191
8192 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8193 to programming languages:
8194
8195 @table @code
8196 @item @@
8197 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8198 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8199
8200 @item ::
8201 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8202 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8203
8204 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8205 @cindex type casting memory
8206 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8207 @cindex casts, to view memory
8208 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8209 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8210 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8211 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8212 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8213 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8214 @end table
8215
8216 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8217 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8218 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8219
8220 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8221 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8222 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8223 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8224 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8225 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8226 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8227
8228 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8229 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8230 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8231 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8232 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8233 as well.
8234
8235 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8236 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8237 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8238 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8239 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8240 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8241 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8242 choices.
8243
8244 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8245 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8246 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8247
8248 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8249 @smallexample
8250 @group
8251 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8252 [0] cancel
8253 [1] all
8254 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8255 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8256 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8257 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8258 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8259 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8260 > 2 4 6
8261 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8262 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8263 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8264 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8265 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8266 breakpoints.
8267 (@value{GDBP})
8268 @end group
8269 @end smallexample
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8273 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8274 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8275
8276 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8277 is ambiguous.
8278
8279 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8280 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8281 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8282 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8283 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8284 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8285 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8286 in the use of the menu.
8287
8288 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8289 when an ambiguity is detected.
8290
8291 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8292 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8293
8294 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8295 @item show multiple-symbols
8296 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8297 @end table
8298
8299 @node Variables
8300 @section Program Variables
8301
8302 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8303 in your program.
8304
8305 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8306 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8307
8308 @itemize @bullet
8309 @item
8310 global (or file-static)
8311 @end itemize
8312
8313 @noindent or
8314
8315 @itemize @bullet
8316 @item
8317 visible according to the scope rules of the
8318 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8319 @end itemize
8320
8321 @noindent This means that in the function
8322
8323 @smallexample
8324 foo (a)
8325 int a;
8326 @{
8327 bar (a);
8328 @{
8329 int b = test ();
8330 bar (b);
8331 @}
8332 @}
8333 @end smallexample
8334
8335 @noindent
8336 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8337 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8338 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8339 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8340
8341 @cindex variable name conflict
8342 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8343 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8344 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8345 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8346 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8347 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8348 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8349
8350 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8351 @ifnotinfo
8352 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8353 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8354 @end ifnotinfo
8355 @smallexample
8356 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8357 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8358 @end smallexample
8359
8360 @noindent
8361 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8362 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8363 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8364 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8365
8366 @smallexample
8367 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8368 @end smallexample
8369
8370 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8371 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8372 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8373 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8374 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8375
8376 @smallexample
8377 void
8378 foo (int a)
8379 @{
8380 if (a < 10)
8381 bar (a);
8382 else
8383 process (a); /* Stop here */
8384 @}
8385
8386 int
8387 bar (int a)
8388 @{
8389 foo (a + 5);
8390 @}
8391 @end smallexample
8392
8393 @noindent
8394 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8395 here is what you might see
8396 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8397
8398 @smallexample
8399 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8400 $1 = 10
8401 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8402 $2 = 5
8403 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8404 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8405 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8406 $3 = 5
8407 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8408 $4 = 0
8409 @end smallexample
8410
8411 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8412 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8413 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8414 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8415 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8416
8417 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8418 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8419 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8420 @code{some_global}.
8421
8422 @smallexample
8423 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8424 $1 = 23
8425 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8426 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8427 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8428 $2 = 27
8429 @end smallexample
8430
8431 @cindex wrong values
8432 @cindex variable values, wrong
8433 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8434 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8435 @quotation
8436 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8437 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8438 scope, and just before exit.
8439 @end quotation
8440 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8441 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8442 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8443 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8444 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8445 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8446 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8447 variable definitions may be gone.
8448
8449 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8450 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8451 when compiling.
8452
8453 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8454 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8455 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8456 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8457 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8458 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8459 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8460
8461 @smallexample
8462 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8463 @end smallexample
8464
8465 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8466 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8467 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8468 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8469 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8470
8471 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8472 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8473 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8474 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8475
8476 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8477 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8478 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8479 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8480 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8481
8482 @smallexample
8483 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8484 29 i++;
8485 (gdb) next
8486 30 e (i);
8487 (gdb) print i
8488 $1 = 31
8489 (gdb) print i@@entry
8490 $2 = 30
8491 @end smallexample
8492
8493 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8494 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8495 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8496 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8497 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8498 For program code
8499
8500 @smallexample
8501 char var0[] = "A";
8502 signed char var1[] = "A";
8503 @end smallexample
8504
8505 You get during debugging
8506 @smallexample
8507 (gdb) print var0
8508 $1 = "A"
8509 (gdb) print var1
8510 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8511 @end smallexample
8512
8513 @node Arrays
8514 @section Artificial Arrays
8515
8516 @cindex artificial array
8517 @cindex arrays
8518 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8519 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8520 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8521 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8522 program.
8523
8524 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8525 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8526 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8527 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8528 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8529 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8530 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8531 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8532 example. If a program says
8533
8534 @smallexample
8535 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8536 @end smallexample
8537
8538 @noindent
8539 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8540
8541 @smallexample
8542 p *array@@len
8543 @end smallexample
8544
8545 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8546 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8547 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8548 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8549 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8550
8551 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8552 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8553 The value need not be in memory:
8554 @smallexample
8555 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8556 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8557 @end smallexample
8558
8559 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8560 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8561 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8562 @smallexample
8563 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8564 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8568 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8569 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8570 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8571 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8572 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8573 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8574 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8575 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8576 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8577
8578 @smallexample
8579 set $i = 0
8580 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8581 @key{RET}
8582 @key{RET}
8583 @dots{}
8584 @end smallexample
8585
8586 @node Output Formats
8587 @section Output Formats
8588
8589 @cindex formatted output
8590 @cindex output formats
8591 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8592 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8593 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8594 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8595 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8596
8597 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8598 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8599 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8600 letters supported are:
8601
8602 @table @code
8603 @item x
8604 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8605 hexadecimal.
8606
8607 @item d
8608 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8609
8610 @item u
8611 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8612
8613 @item o
8614 Print as integer in octal.
8615
8616 @item t
8617 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8618 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8619 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8620 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8621
8622 @item a
8623 @cindex unknown address, locating
8624 @cindex locate address
8625 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8626 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8627 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8628
8629 @smallexample
8630 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8631 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8632 @end smallexample
8633
8634 @noindent
8635 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8636 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8637
8638 @item c
8639 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8640 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8641 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8642 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8643
8644 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8645 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8646 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8647 data.
8648
8649 @item f
8650 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8651 using typical floating point syntax.
8652
8653 @item s
8654 @cindex printing strings
8655 @cindex printing byte arrays
8656 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8657 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8658 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8659 natural types.
8660
8661 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8662 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8663 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8664 array.
8665
8666 @item z
8667 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8668 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8669 to the size of the integer type.
8670
8671 @item r
8672 @cindex raw printing
8673 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8674 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8675 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8676 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8677 pretty-printer which might exist.
8678 @end table
8679
8680 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8681
8682 @smallexample
8683 p/x $pc
8684 @end smallexample
8685
8686 @noindent
8687 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8688 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8689
8690 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8691 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8692 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8693
8694 @node Memory
8695 @section Examining Memory
8696
8697 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8698 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8699
8700 @cindex examining memory
8701 @table @code
8702 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8703 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8704 @itemx x @var{addr}
8705 @itemx x
8706 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8707 @end table
8708
8709 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8710 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8711 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8712 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8713 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8714
8715 @table @r
8716 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8717 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8718 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8719 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8720 @c 4.1.2.
8721
8722 @item @var{f}, the display format
8723 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8724 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8725 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8726 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8727 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8728
8729 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8730 The unit size is any of
8731
8732 @table @code
8733 @item b
8734 Bytes.
8735 @item h
8736 Halfwords (two bytes).
8737 @item w
8738 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8739 @item g
8740 Giant words (eight bytes).
8741 @end table
8742
8743 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8744 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8745 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8746 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8747 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8748 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8749 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8750 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8751 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8752 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8753 be altered.
8754
8755 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8756 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8757 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8758 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8759 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8760 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8761 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8762 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8763 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8764 a value from memory).
8765 @end table
8766
8767 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8768 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8769 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8770 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8771 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8772
8773 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8774 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8775 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8776 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8777 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8778
8779 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8780 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8781 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8782 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8783 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8784 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8785 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8786 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8787 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8788
8789 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8790 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8791 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8792 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8793 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8794 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8795 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8796
8797 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8798 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8799
8800 @smallexample
8801 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8802 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8803 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8804 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8805 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8806 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8807 @end smallexample
8808
8809 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8810 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8811 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8812 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8813 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8814 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8815 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8816 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8817 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8818
8819 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8820 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8821 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8822
8823 @cindex remote memory comparison
8824 @cindex target memory comparison
8825 @cindex verify remote memory image
8826 @cindex verify target memory image
8827 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8828 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
8829 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
8830 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
8831 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
8832 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
8833
8834 @table @code
8835 @kindex compare-sections
8836 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8837 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8838 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8839 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8840 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8841 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
8842
8843 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
8844 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
8845 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
8846 @end table
8847
8848 @node Auto Display
8849 @section Automatic Display
8850 @cindex automatic display
8851 @cindex display of expressions
8852
8853 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8854 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8855 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8856 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8857 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8858 The automatic display looks like this:
8859
8860 @smallexample
8861 2: foo = 38
8862 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8867 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8868 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8869 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8870 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8871 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8872
8873 @table @code
8874 @kindex display
8875 @item display @var{expr}
8876 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8877 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8878
8879 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8880
8881 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8882 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8883 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8884 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8885 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8886
8887 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8888 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8889 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8890 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8891 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8892 @end table
8893
8894 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8895 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8896 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8897
8898 @table @code
8899 @kindex delete display
8900 @kindex undisplay
8901 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8902 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8903 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8904 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8905 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8906 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8907 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8908
8909 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8910 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8911
8912 @kindex disable display
8913 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8914 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8915 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8916 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8917 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8918 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8919 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8920 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8921
8922 @kindex enable display
8923 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8924 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8925 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8926 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8927 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8928 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8929 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8930
8931 @item display
8932 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8933 done when your program stops.
8934
8935 @kindex info display
8936 @item info display
8937 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8938 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8939 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8940 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8941 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8942 @end table
8943
8944 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8945 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8946 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8947 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8948 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8949 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8950 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8951 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8952 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8953 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8954 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8955
8956 @node Print Settings
8957 @section Print Settings
8958
8959 @cindex format options
8960 @cindex print settings
8961 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8962 and symbols are printed.
8963
8964 @noindent
8965 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8966
8967 @table @code
8968 @kindex set print
8969 @item set print address
8970 @itemx set print address on
8971 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8972 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8973 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8974 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8975 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8976 @code{set print address on}:
8977
8978 @smallexample
8979 @group
8980 (@value{GDBP}) f
8981 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8982 at input.c:530
8983 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8984 @end group
8985 @end smallexample
8986
8987 @item set print address off
8988 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8989 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8990
8991 @smallexample
8992 @group
8993 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8994 (@value{GDBP}) f
8995 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8996 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8997 @end group
8998 @end smallexample
8999
9000 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9001 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9002 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9003 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9004
9005 @kindex show print
9006 @item show print address
9007 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9008 @end table
9009
9010 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9011 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9012 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9013 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9014 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9015 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9016 it prints a symbolic address:
9017
9018 @table @code
9019 @item set print symbol-filename on
9020 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9021 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9022 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9023 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9024
9025 @item set print symbol-filename off
9026 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9027 default.
9028
9029 @item show print symbol-filename
9030 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9031 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9032 @end table
9033
9034 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9035 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9036 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9037
9038 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9039 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9040
9041 @table @code
9042 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9043 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9044 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9045 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9046 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9047 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9048 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9049 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9050
9051 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9052 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9053 symbolic address.
9054 @end table
9055
9056 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9057 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9058 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9059 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9060 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9061 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9062 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9063 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9064
9065 @smallexample
9066 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9067 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9068 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9069 @end smallexample
9070
9071 @quotation
9072 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9073 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9074 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9075 @end quotation
9076
9077 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9078 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9079
9080 @table @code
9081 @item set print symbol on
9082 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9083 one exists.
9084
9085 @item set print symbol off
9086 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9087 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9088 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9089
9090 @item show print symbol
9091 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9092 address.
9093 @end table
9094
9095 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9096
9097 @table @code
9098 @item set print array
9099 @itemx set print array on
9100 @cindex pretty print arrays
9101 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9102 but uses more space. The default is off.
9103
9104 @item set print array off
9105 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9106
9107 @item show print array
9108 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9109 arrays.
9110
9111 @cindex print array indexes
9112 @item set print array-indexes
9113 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9114 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9115 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9116 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9117
9118 @item set print array-indexes off
9119 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9120
9121 @item show print array-indexes
9122 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9123 arrays.
9124
9125 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9126 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9127 @cindex number of array elements to print
9128 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9129 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9130 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9131 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9132 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9133 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9134 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9135 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9136
9137 @item show print elements
9138 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9139 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9140
9141 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9142 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9143 @cindex printing frame argument values
9144 @cindex print all frame argument values
9145 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9146 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9147 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9148 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9149 values are:
9150
9151 @table @code
9152 @item all
9153 The values of all arguments are printed.
9154
9155 @item scalars
9156 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9157 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9158 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9159 only scalar arguments are shown:
9160
9161 @smallexample
9162 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9163 at frame-args.c:23
9164 @end smallexample
9165
9166 @item none
9167 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9168 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9169
9170 @smallexample
9171 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9172 at frame-args.c:23
9173 @end smallexample
9174 @end table
9175
9176 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9177 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9178 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9179 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9180 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9181 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9182 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9183 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9184 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9185 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9186
9187 @item show print frame-arguments
9188 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9189
9190 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9191 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9192
9193 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9194 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9195 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9196 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9197 This is the default.
9198
9199 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9200 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9201
9202 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9203 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9204 @kindex set print entry-values
9205 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9206 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9207 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9208 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9209 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9210
9211 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9212 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9213 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9214 @code{no} setting.
9215
9216 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9217 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9218 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9219 this information.
9220
9221 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9222
9223 @table @code
9224 @item no
9225 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9226 point.
9227 @smallexample
9228 #0 equal (val=5)
9229 #0 different (val=6)
9230 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9231 #0 born (val=10)
9232 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9233 @end smallexample
9234
9235 @item only
9236 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9237 values are never printed.
9238 @smallexample
9239 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9240 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9241 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9242 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9243 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9244 @end smallexample
9245
9246 @item preferred
9247 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9248 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9249 value for such parameter.
9250 @smallexample
9251 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9252 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9253 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9254 #0 born (val=10)
9255 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9256 @end smallexample
9257
9258 @item if-needed
9259 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9260 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9261 parameter.
9262 @smallexample
9263 #0 equal (val=5)
9264 #0 different (val=6)
9265 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9266 #0 born (val=10)
9267 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 @item both
9271 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9272 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9273 optimizations.
9274 @smallexample
9275 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9276 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9277 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9278 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9279 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9280 @end smallexample
9281
9282 @item compact
9283 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9284 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9285 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9286 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9287 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9288 @smallexample
9289 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9290 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9291 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9292 #0 born (val=10)
9293 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 @item default
9297 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9298 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9299 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9300 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9301 @smallexample
9302 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9303 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9304 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9305 #0 born (val=10)
9306 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9307 @end smallexample
9308 @end table
9309
9310 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9311 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9312
9313 @item show print entry-values
9314 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9315 entry.
9316
9317 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9318 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9319 @cindex repeated array elements
9320 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9321 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9322 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9323 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9324 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9325 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9326 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9327 is 10.
9328
9329 @item show print repeats
9330 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9331 elements.
9332
9333 @item set print null-stop
9334 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9335 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9336 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9337 contain only short strings.
9338 The default is off.
9339
9340 @item show print null-stop
9341 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9342 @sc{null} character.
9343
9344 @item set print pretty on
9345 @cindex print structures in indented form
9346 @cindex indentation in structure display
9347 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9348 per line, like this:
9349
9350 @smallexample
9351 @group
9352 $1 = @{
9353 next = 0x0,
9354 flags = @{
9355 sweet = 1,
9356 sour = 1
9357 @},
9358 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9359 @}
9360 @end group
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 @item set print pretty off
9364 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9365
9366 @smallexample
9367 @group
9368 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9369 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9370 @end group
9371 @end smallexample
9372
9373 @noindent
9374 This is the default format.
9375
9376 @item show print pretty
9377 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9378
9379 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9380 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9381 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9382 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9383 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9384 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9385 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9386 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9387
9388 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9389 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9390 international character sets, and is the default.
9391
9392 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9393 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9394
9395 @item set print union on
9396 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9397 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9398 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9399
9400 @item set print union off
9401 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9402 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9403 instead.
9404
9405 @item show print union
9406 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9407 structures and other unions.
9408
9409 For example, given the declarations
9410
9411 @smallexample
9412 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9413 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9414 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9415 Bug_forms;
9416
9417 struct thing @{
9418 Species it;
9419 union @{
9420 Tree_forms tree;
9421 Bug_forms bug;
9422 @} form;
9423 @};
9424
9425 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9426 @end smallexample
9427
9428 @noindent
9429 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9430
9431 @smallexample
9432 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9433 @end smallexample
9434
9435 @noindent
9436 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9437
9438 @smallexample
9439 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9440 @end smallexample
9441
9442 @noindent
9443 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9444 and in Pascal.
9445 @end table
9446
9447 @need 1000
9448 @noindent
9449 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9450
9451 @table @code
9452 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9453 @item set print demangle
9454 @itemx set print demangle on
9455 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9456 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9457 linkage. The default is on.
9458
9459 @item show print demangle
9460 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9461
9462 @item set print asm-demangle
9463 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9464 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9465 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9466 The default is off.
9467
9468 @item show print asm-demangle
9469 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9470 or demangled form.
9471
9472 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9473 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9474 @kindex set demangle-style
9475 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9476 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9477 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9478
9479 @table @code
9480 @item auto
9481 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9482 This is the default.
9483
9484 @item gnu
9485 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9486
9487 @item hp
9488 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9489
9490 @item lucid
9491 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9492
9493 @item arm
9494 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9495 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9496 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9497 require further enhancement to permit that.
9498
9499 @end table
9500 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9501
9502 @item show demangle-style
9503 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9504
9505 @item set print object
9506 @itemx set print object on
9507 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9508 @cindex display derived types
9509 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9510 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9511 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9512 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9513 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9514 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9515 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9516
9517 @item set print object off
9518 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9519 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9520
9521 @item show print object
9522 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9523
9524 @item set print static-members
9525 @itemx set print static-members on
9526 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9527 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9528
9529 @item set print static-members off
9530 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9531
9532 @item show print static-members
9533 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9534
9535 @item set print pascal_static-members
9536 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9537 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9538 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9539 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9540
9541 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9542 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9543
9544 @item show print pascal_static-members
9545 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9546
9547 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9548 @item set print vtbl
9549 @itemx set print vtbl on
9550 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9551 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9552 @cindex VTBL display
9553 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9554 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9555 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9556
9557 @item set print vtbl off
9558 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9559
9560 @item show print vtbl
9561 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9562 @end table
9563
9564 @node Pretty Printing
9565 @section Pretty Printing
9566
9567 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9568 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9569 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9570
9571 @menu
9572 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9573 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9574 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9575 @end menu
9576
9577 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9578 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9579
9580 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9581 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9582 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9583
9584 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9585 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9586 pretty-printers with their names.
9587 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9588 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9589 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9590 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9591
9592 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9593 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9594 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9595 do anything special.
9596
9597 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9598
9599 @itemize @bullet
9600 @item
9601 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9602 all inferiors.
9603
9604 @item
9605 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9606 when debugging that program.
9607 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9608
9609 @item
9610 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9611 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9612 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9613 @end itemize
9614
9615 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9616 pretty-printers are selected,
9617
9618 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9619 for new types.
9620
9621 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9622 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9623
9624 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9625
9626 @smallexample
9627 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9628 $1 = @{
9629 static npos = 4294967295,
9630 _M_dataplus = @{
9631 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9632 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9633 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9634 @},
9635 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9636 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9637 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9638 @}
9639 @}
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9643
9644 @smallexample
9645 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9646 $2 = "abcd"
9647 @end smallexample
9648
9649 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9650 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9651 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9652
9653 @table @code
9654 @kindex info pretty-printer
9655 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9656 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9657 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9658
9659 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9660 whose pretty-printers to list.
9661 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9662 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9663 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9664 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9665 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9666
9667 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9668 to list.
9669
9670 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9671 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9672 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9673 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9674
9675 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9676 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9677 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9678 @end table
9679
9680 Example:
9681
9682 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9683 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9684 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9685 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9686
9687 @smallexample
9688 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9689 library1.so:
9690 foo
9691 library2.so:
9692 bar
9693 bar1
9694 bar2
9695 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9696 library2.so:
9697 bar
9698 bar1
9699 bar2
9700 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9701 1 printer disabled
9702 2 of 3 printers enabled
9703 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9704 library1.so:
9705 foo [disabled]
9706 library2.so:
9707 bar
9708 bar1
9709 bar2
9710 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9711 1 printer disabled
9712 1 of 3 printers enabled
9713 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9714 library1.so:
9715 foo [disabled]
9716 library2.so:
9717 bar
9718 bar1 [disabled]
9719 bar2
9720 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9721 1 printer disabled
9722 0 of 3 printers enabled
9723 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9724 library1.so:
9725 foo [disabled]
9726 library2.so:
9727 bar [disabled]
9728 bar1 [disabled]
9729 bar2
9730 @end smallexample
9731
9732 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9733 as can each individual subprinter.
9734
9735 @node Value History
9736 @section Value History
9737
9738 @cindex value history
9739 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9740 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9741 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9742 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9743 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9744 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9745 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9746 symbol table.
9747
9748 @cindex @code{$}
9749 @cindex @code{$$}
9750 @cindex history number
9751 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9752 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9753 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9754 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9755 history number.
9756
9757 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9758 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9759 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9760 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9761 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9762 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9763 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9764
9765 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9766 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9767
9768 @smallexample
9769 p *$
9770 @end smallexample
9771
9772 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9773 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9774
9775 @smallexample
9776 p *$.next
9777 @end smallexample
9778
9779 @noindent
9780 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9781 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9782
9783 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9784 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9785
9786 @smallexample
9787 print x
9788 set x=5
9789 @end smallexample
9790
9791 @noindent
9792 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9793 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9794
9795 @table @code
9796 @kindex show values
9797 @item show values
9798 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9799 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9800 values} does not change the history.
9801
9802 @item show values @var{n}
9803 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9804
9805 @item show values +
9806 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9807 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9808 @end table
9809
9810 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9811 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9812
9813 @node Convenience Vars
9814 @section Convenience Variables
9815
9816 @cindex convenience variables
9817 @cindex user-defined variables
9818 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9819 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9820 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9821 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9822 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9823
9824 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9825 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9826 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9827 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9828 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9829
9830 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9831 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9832 For example:
9833
9834 @smallexample
9835 set $foo = *object_ptr
9836 @end smallexample
9837
9838 @noindent
9839 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9840 @code{object_ptr}.
9841
9842 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9843 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9844 value with another assignment at any time.
9845
9846 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9847 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9848 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9849 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9850
9851 @table @code
9852 @kindex show convenience
9853 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9854 @item show convenience
9855 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9856 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9857 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9858
9859 @kindex init-if-undefined
9860 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9861 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9862 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9863 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9864 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9865 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9866 override default values used in a command script.
9867
9868 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9869 any side-effects do not occur.
9870 @end table
9871
9872 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9873 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9874 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9875
9876 @smallexample
9877 set $i = 0
9878 print bar[$i++]->contents
9879 @end smallexample
9880
9881 @noindent
9882 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9883
9884 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9885 values likely to be useful.
9886
9887 @table @code
9888 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9889 @item $_
9890 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9891 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9892 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9893 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9894 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9895 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9896 to the type of @code{$__}.
9897
9898 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9899 @item $__
9900 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9901 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9902 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9903
9904 @item $_exitcode
9905 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9906 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9907 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9908 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9909
9910 @item $_exitsignal
9911 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9912 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9913 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9914 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9915
9916 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9917 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9918 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9919 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9920 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9921
9922 @smallexample
9923 #include <signal.h>
9924
9925 int
9926 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9927 @{
9928 raise (SIGALRM);
9929 return 0;
9930 @}
9931 @end smallexample
9932
9933 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9934 or signalled would be:
9935
9936 @smallexample
9937 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9938 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9939 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9940 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9941 >echo The program has exited\n
9942 >else
9943 >echo The program has signalled\n
9944 >end
9945 >end
9946 (@value{GDBP}) run
9947 Starting program:
9948
9949 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9950 The program no longer exists.
9951 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9952 The program has signalled
9953 @end smallexample
9954
9955 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9956 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9957 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9958 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9959
9960 @smallexample
9961 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9962 The program has exited
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @item $_exception
9966 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9967 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9968
9969 @item $_probe_argc
9970 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9971 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9972
9973 @item $_sdata
9974 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9975 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9976 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9977 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9978 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9979
9980 @item $_siginfo
9981 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9982 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9983 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9984 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9985 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9986
9987 @item $_tlb
9988 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9989 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9990 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9991 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9992 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9993 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9994
9995 @end table
9996
9997 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9998 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9999 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10000
10001 @node Convenience Funs
10002 @section Convenience Functions
10003
10004 @cindex convenience functions
10005 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10006 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10007 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10008 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10009 @value{GDBN}.
10010
10011 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10012 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10013
10014 @table @code
10015
10016 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10017 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10018 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10019 returns zero.
10020
10021 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10022 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10023 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10024 it is @code{void}:
10025
10026 @smallexample
10027 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10028 $1 = void
10029 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10030 $2 = 1
10031 (@value{GDBP}) run
10032 Starting program: ./a.out
10033 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10034 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10035 $3 = 0
10036 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10037 $4 = 0
10038 @end smallexample
10039
10040 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10041 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10042 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10043 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10044 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10045 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10046 anymore.
10047
10048 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10049 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 void
10053 foo (void)
10054 @{
10055 @}
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10059
10060 @smallexample
10061 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10062 $1 = void
10063 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10064 $2 = 1
10065 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10066 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10067 $3 = void
10068 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10069 $4 = 1
10070 @end smallexample
10071
10072 @end table
10073
10074 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10075 @code{Python} support.
10076
10077 @table @code
10078
10079 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10080 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10081 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10082 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10083 Otherwise it returns zero.
10084
10085 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10086 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10087 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10088 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10089 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10090 regular expression support.
10091
10092 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10093 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10094 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10095 Otherwise it returns zero.
10096
10097 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10098 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10099 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10100
10101 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10102 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10103 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10104 Otherwise it returns zero.
10105
10106 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10107 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10108 The default is 1.
10109
10110 Example:
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 (gdb) backtrace
10114 #0 bottom_func ()
10115 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10116 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10117 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10118 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10119 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10120 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10121 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10122 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10123 $1 = 1
10124 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10125 $1 = 1
10126 @end smallexample
10127
10128 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10129 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10130 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10131 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10132
10133 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10134 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10135 The default is 1.
10136
10137 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10138 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10139 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10140 Otherwise it returns zero.
10141
10142 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10143 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10144 The default is 1.
10145
10146 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10147 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10148 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10149 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10150
10151 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10152 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10153 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10154 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10155
10156 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10157 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10158 The default is 1.
10159
10160 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10161 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10162 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10163 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10164
10165 @end table
10166
10167 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10168 convenience functions.
10169
10170 @table @code
10171 @item help function
10172 @kindex help function
10173 @cindex show all convenience functions
10174 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10175 @end table
10176
10177 @node Registers
10178 @section Registers
10179
10180 @cindex registers
10181 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10182 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10183 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10184 your machine.
10185
10186 @table @code
10187 @kindex info registers
10188 @item info registers
10189 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10190 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10191
10192 @kindex info all-registers
10193 @cindex floating point registers
10194 @item info all-registers
10195 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10196 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10197
10198 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10199 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10200 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10201 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10202 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10203 @end table
10204
10205 @cindex stack pointer register
10206 @cindex program counter register
10207 @cindex process status register
10208 @cindex frame pointer register
10209 @cindex standard registers
10210 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10211 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10212 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10213 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10214 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10215 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10216 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10217 you could print the program counter in hex with
10218
10219 @smallexample
10220 p/x $pc
10221 @end smallexample
10222
10223 @noindent
10224 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10225
10226 @smallexample
10227 x/i $pc
10228 @end smallexample
10229
10230 @noindent
10231 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10232 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10233 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10234 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10235 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10236 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10237 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10238
10239 @smallexample
10240 set $sp += 4
10241 @end smallexample
10242
10243 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10244 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10245 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10246 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10247 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10248 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10249 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10250
10251 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10252 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10253 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10254 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10255 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10256 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10257 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10258
10259 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10260 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10261 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10262 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10263 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10264 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10265 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10266 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10267 prints the data in both formats.
10268
10269 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10270 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10271 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10272 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10273 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10274 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10275 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10276
10277 @smallexample
10278 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10279 $1 = @{
10280 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10281 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10282 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10283 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10284 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10285 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10286 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10287 @}
10288 @end smallexample
10289
10290 @noindent
10291 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10292 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10293 value to a @code{struct} member:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10297 @end smallexample
10298
10299 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10300 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10301 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10302 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10303 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10304 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10305
10306 @cindex caller-saved registers
10307 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10308 @cindex volatile registers
10309 @cindex <not saved> values
10310 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10311 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10312 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10313 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10314 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10315 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10316 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10317 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10318 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10319 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10320 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10321 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10322 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10323 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10324 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10325 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10326 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10327 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10328 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10329 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10330 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10331 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10332 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10333
10334 @node Floating Point Hardware
10335 @section Floating Point Hardware
10336 @cindex floating point
10337
10338 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10339 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10340
10341 @table @code
10342 @kindex info float
10343 @item info float
10344 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10345 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10346 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10347 the ARM and x86 machines.
10348 @end table
10349
10350 @node Vector Unit
10351 @section Vector Unit
10352 @cindex vector unit
10353
10354 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10355 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10356
10357 @table @code
10358 @kindex info vector
10359 @item info vector
10360 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10361 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10362 @end table
10363
10364 @node OS Information
10365 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10366 @cindex OS information
10367
10368 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10369 you debug your program.
10370
10371 @cindex auxiliary vector
10372 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10373 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10374 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10375 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10376 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10377 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10378 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10379 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10380 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10381 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10382 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10383 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10384
10385 @table @code
10386 @kindex info auxv
10387 @item info auxv
10388 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10389 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10390 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10391 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10392 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10393 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10394 an unrecognized tag.
10395 @end table
10396
10397 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10398 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10399 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10400 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10401 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10402 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10403 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10404
10405 @table @code
10406 @kindex info os
10407 @item info os @var{infotype}
10408
10409 Display OS information of the requested type.
10410
10411 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10412
10413 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10414 @table @code
10415 @kindex info os processes
10416 @item processes
10417 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10418 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10419 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10420 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10421 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10422 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10423
10424 @kindex info os procgroups
10425 @item procgroups
10426 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10427 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10428 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10429 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10430 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10431 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10432 and the process group leader is listed first.
10433
10434 @kindex info os threads
10435 @item threads
10436 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10437 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10438 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10439 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10440 process is not listed.
10441
10442 @kindex info os files
10443 @item files
10444 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10445 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10446 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10447 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10448
10449 @kindex info os sockets
10450 @item sockets
10451 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10452 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10453 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10454 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10455 connection.
10456
10457 @kindex info os shm
10458 @item shm
10459 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10460 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10461 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10462 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10463 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10464 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10465 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10466
10467 @kindex info os semaphores
10468 @item semaphores
10469 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10470 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10471 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10472 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10473 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10474
10475 @kindex info os msg
10476 @item msg
10477 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10478 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10479 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10480 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10481 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10482 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10483 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10484 the message queue was last changed.
10485
10486 @kindex info os modules
10487 @item modules
10488 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10489 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10490 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10491 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10492 in memory.
10493 @end table
10494
10495 @item info os
10496 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10497 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10498 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10499 types, this command will report an error.
10500 @end table
10501
10502 @node Memory Region Attributes
10503 @section Memory Region Attributes
10504 @cindex memory region attributes
10505
10506 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10507 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10508 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10509 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10510 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10511 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10512 user can override the fetched regions.
10513
10514 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10515 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10516 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10517 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10518 all memory.
10519
10520 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10521 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10522
10523 @table @code
10524 @kindex mem
10525 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10526 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10527 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10528 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10529 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10530 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10531
10532 @item mem auto
10533 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10534 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10535
10536 @kindex delete mem
10537 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10538 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10539 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10540
10541 @kindex disable mem
10542 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10543 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10544 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10545 It may be enabled again later.
10546
10547 @kindex enable mem
10548 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10549 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10550
10551 @kindex info mem
10552 @item info mem
10553 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10554 for each region:
10555
10556 @table @emph
10557 @item Memory Region Number
10558 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10559 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10560 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10561
10562 @item Lo Address
10563 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10564
10565 @item Hi Address
10566 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10567
10568 @item Attributes
10569 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10570 @end table
10571 @end table
10572
10573
10574 @subsection Attributes
10575
10576 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10577 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10578 write accesses to a memory region.
10579
10580 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10581 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10582 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10583
10584 @table @code
10585 @item ro
10586 Memory is read only.
10587 @item wo
10588 Memory is write only.
10589 @item rw
10590 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10591 @end table
10592
10593 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10594 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10595 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10596 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10597 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10598
10599 @table @code
10600 @item 8
10601 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10602 @item 16
10603 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10604 @item 32
10605 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10606 @item 64
10607 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10608 @end table
10609
10610 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10611 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10612 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10613 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10614 @c
10615 @c @table @code
10616 @c @item hwbreak
10617 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10618 @c @item swbreak (default)
10619 @c @end table
10620
10621 @subsubsection Data Cache
10622 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10623 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10624 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10625 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10626 registers.
10627
10628 @table @code
10629 @item cache
10630 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10631 @item nocache
10632 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10633 @end table
10634
10635 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10636 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10637 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10638 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10639 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10640
10641 @table @code
10642 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10643 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10644 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10645 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10646 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10647 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10648 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10649 The default value is @code{on}.
10650 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10651 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10652 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10653 @end table
10654
10655
10656 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10657 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10658 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10659 @c
10660 @c @table @code
10661 @c @item verify
10662 @c @item noverify (default)
10663 @c @end table
10664
10665 @node Dump/Restore Files
10666 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10667 @cindex dump/restore files
10668 @cindex append data to a file
10669 @cindex dump data to a file
10670 @cindex restore data from a file
10671
10672 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10673 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10674 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10675 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10676 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10677 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10678 files.
10679
10680 @table @code
10681
10682 @kindex dump
10683 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10684 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10685 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10686 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10687
10688 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10689 @table @code
10690 @item binary
10691 Raw binary form.
10692 @item ihex
10693 Intel hex format.
10694 @item srec
10695 Motorola S-record format.
10696 @item tekhex
10697 Tektronix Hex format.
10698 @end table
10699
10700 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10701 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10702 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10703 form.
10704
10705 @kindex append
10706 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10707 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10708 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10709 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10710 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10711
10712 @kindex restore
10713 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10714 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10715 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10716 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10717 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10718
10719 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10720 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10721 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10722 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10723 from that location.
10724
10725 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10726 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10727 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10728 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10729
10730 @end table
10731
10732 @node Core File Generation
10733 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10734 @cindex dump core from inferior
10735
10736 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10737 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10738 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10739 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10740 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10741 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10742 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10743
10744 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10745 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10746 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10747
10748 @table @code
10749 @kindex gcore
10750 @kindex generate-core-file
10751 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10752 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10753 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10754 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10755 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10756 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10757
10758 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10759 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10760 @end table
10761
10762 @node Character Sets
10763 @section Character Sets
10764 @cindex character sets
10765 @cindex charset
10766 @cindex translating between character sets
10767 @cindex host character set
10768 @cindex target character set
10769
10770 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10771 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10772 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10773 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10774 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10775 @dfn{target character set}.
10776
10777 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10778 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10779 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10780 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10781 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10782 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10783 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10784 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10785 character and string literals in expressions.
10786
10787 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10788 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10789 target-charset} command, described below.
10790
10791 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10792 support:
10793
10794 @table @code
10795 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10796 @kindex set target-charset
10797 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10798 list of supported target character sets, type
10799 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10800
10801 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10802 @kindex set host-charset
10803 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10804
10805 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10806 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10807 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10808 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10809 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10810
10811 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10812 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10813 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10814
10815 @item set charset @var{charset}
10816 @kindex set charset
10817 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10818 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10819 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10820 for both host and target.
10821
10822 @item show charset
10823 @kindex show charset
10824 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10825
10826 @item show host-charset
10827 @kindex show host-charset
10828 Show the name of the current host character set.
10829
10830 @item show target-charset
10831 @kindex show target-charset
10832 Show the name of the current target character set.
10833
10834 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10835 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10836 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10837 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10838 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10839 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10840
10841 @item show target-wide-charset
10842 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10843 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10844 @end table
10845
10846 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10847 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10848 @file{charset-test.c}:
10849
10850 @smallexample
10851 #include <stdio.h>
10852
10853 char ascii_hello[]
10854 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10855 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10856 char ibm1047_hello[]
10857 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10858 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10859
10860 main ()
10861 @{
10862 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10863 @}
10864 @end smallexample
10865
10866 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10867 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10868 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10869
10870 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10871
10872 @smallexample
10873 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10874 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10875 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10876 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10877 @dots{}
10878 (@value{GDBP})
10879 @end smallexample
10880
10881 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10882 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10883 strings:
10884
10885 @smallexample
10886 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10887 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10888 (@value{GDBP})
10889 @end smallexample
10890
10891 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10892 initial character set:
10893 @smallexample
10894 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10895 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10896 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10897 (@value{GDBP})
10898 @end smallexample
10899
10900 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10901 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10902 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10903 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10904 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10905
10906 @smallexample
10907 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10908 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10909 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10910 $2 = 72 'H'
10911 (@value{GDBP})
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10915 literals you use in expressions:
10916
10917 @smallexample
10918 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10919 $3 = 43 '+'
10920 (@value{GDBP})
10921 @end smallexample
10922
10923 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10924 character.
10925
10926 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10927 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10928 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10932 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10933 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10934 $5 = 200 '\310'
10935 (@value{GDBP})
10936 @end smallexample
10937
10938 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10939 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10940
10941 @smallexample
10942 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10943 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10944 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10945 @end smallexample
10946
10947 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10948 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10949 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10950 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10951 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10952
10953 @smallexample
10954 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10955 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10956 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10957 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10958 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10959 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10960 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10961 $7 = 72 '\110'
10962 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10963 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10964 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10965 $9 = 200 'H'
10966 (@value{GDBP})
10967 @end smallexample
10968
10969 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10970 string literals you use in expressions:
10971
10972 @smallexample
10973 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10974 $10 = 78 '+'
10975 (@value{GDBP})
10976 @end smallexample
10977
10978 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10979 character.
10980
10981 @node Caching Target Data
10982 @section Caching Data of Targets
10983 @cindex caching data of targets
10984
10985 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10986 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10987 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10988 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10989 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10990 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10991 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10992 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10993 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10994 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10995 is executing.
10996 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10997 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10998 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10999 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11000 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11001 in the code segment.
11002 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11003 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11004
11005 @table @code
11006 @kindex set remotecache
11007 @item set remotecache on
11008 @itemx set remotecache off
11009 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11010 with old scripts.
11011
11012 @kindex show remotecache
11013 @item show remotecache
11014 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11015
11016 @kindex set stack-cache
11017 @item set stack-cache on
11018 @itemx set stack-cache off
11019 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11020 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11021
11022 @kindex show stack-cache
11023 @item show stack-cache
11024 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11025
11026 @kindex set code-cache
11027 @item set code-cache on
11028 @itemx set code-cache off
11029 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11030 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11031 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11032
11033 @kindex show code-cache
11034 @item show code-cache
11035 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11036 accesses.
11037
11038 @kindex info dcache
11039 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11040 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11041 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11042 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11043 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11044 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11045
11046 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11047 printed in hex.
11048
11049 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11050 @cindex dcache size
11051 @kindex set dcache size
11052 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11053
11054 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11055 @cindex dcache line-size
11056 @kindex set dcache line-size
11057 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11058 Must be a power of 2.
11059
11060 @item show dcache size
11061 @kindex show dcache size
11062 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11063
11064 @item show dcache line-size
11065 @kindex show dcache line-size
11066 Show default size of dcache lines.
11067
11068 @end table
11069
11070 @node Searching Memory
11071 @section Search Memory
11072 @cindex searching memory
11073
11074 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11075 @code{find} command.
11076
11077 @table @code
11078 @kindex find
11079 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11080 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11081 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11082 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11083 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11084 @end table
11085
11086 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11087 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11088
11089 @table @r
11090 @item @var{s}, search query size
11091 The size of each search query value.
11092
11093 @table @code
11094 @item b
11095 bytes
11096 @item h
11097 halfwords (two bytes)
11098 @item w
11099 words (four bytes)
11100 @item g
11101 giant words (eight bytes)
11102 @end table
11103
11104 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11105 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11106 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11107
11108 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11109 value's type in the current language.
11110 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11111 pattern as a mixture of types.
11112 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11113 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11114 which is typically four bytes.
11115
11116 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11117 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11118 @end table
11119
11120 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11121 (@code{"}).
11122 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11123 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11124
11125 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11126 number of matches found.
11127
11128 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11129 @samp{$_}.
11130 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11131
11132 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11133
11134 @smallexample
11135 void
11136 hello ()
11137 @{
11138 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11139 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11140 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11141 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11142 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11143 @}
11144 @end smallexample
11145
11146 @noindent
11147 you get during debugging:
11148
11149 @smallexample
11150 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11151 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11152 1 pattern found
11153 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11154 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11155 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11156 2 patterns found
11157 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11158 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11159 1 pattern found
11160 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11161 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11162 1 pattern found
11163 (gdb) print $numfound
11164 $1 = 1
11165 (gdb) print $_
11166 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11167 @end smallexample
11168
11169 @node Optimized Code
11170 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11171 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11172 @cindex debugging optimized code
11173
11174 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11175 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11176 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11177 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11178 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11179 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11180 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11181
11182 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11183 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11184 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11185 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11186
11187 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11188 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11189 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11190 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11191 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11192 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11193
11194 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11195 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11196 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11197 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11198 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11199
11200 @menu
11201 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11202 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11203 @end menu
11204
11205 @node Inline Functions
11206 @section Inline Functions
11207 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11208
11209 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11210 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11211 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11212 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11213 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11214 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11215 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11216 @code{info frame} command.
11217
11218 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11219 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11220 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11221 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11222 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11223 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11224 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11225 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11226 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11227 local variables in the caller.
11228
11229 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11230 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11231 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11232 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11233 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11234 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11235 instructions are executed.
11236
11237 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11238 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11239 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11240 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11241
11242 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11243 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11244
11245 @itemize @bullet
11246 @item
11247 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11248 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11249 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11250 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11251 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11252 or inside the inlined function instead.
11253
11254 @item
11255 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11256 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11257 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11258 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11259
11260 @end itemize
11261
11262 @node Tail Call Frames
11263 @section Tail Call Frames
11264 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11265
11266 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11267 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11268 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11269 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11270 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11271
11272 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11273 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11274 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11275 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11276 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11277 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11278 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11279
11280 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11281 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11282 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11283 this information.
11284
11285 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11286 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11287
11288 @smallexample
11289 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11290 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11291 (gdb) info frame
11292 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11293 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11294 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11295 source language c++.
11296 Arglist at unknown address.
11297 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11298 @end smallexample
11299
11300 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11301 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11302 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11303 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11304 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11305 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11306
11307 @table @code
11308 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11309 @item set debug entry-values
11310 @kindex set debug entry-values
11311 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11312 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11313 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11314 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11315 result.
11316
11317 @item show debug entry-values
11318 @kindex show debug entry-values
11319 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11320 values at function entry and tail calls.
11321 @end table
11322
11323 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11324 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11325 reference by variable @code{x}):
11326
11327 @smallexample
11328 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11329 void (*x) (void) = c;
11330 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11331 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11332 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11333
11334 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11335 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11336 a () at t.c:3
11337 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11338 (gdb) bt
11339 #0 a () at t.c:3
11340 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11341 @end smallexample
11342
11343 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11344
11345 @smallexample
11346 int i;
11347 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11348 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11349 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11350 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11351 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11352 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11353 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11354 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11355
11356 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11357 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11358 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11359 (gdb) bt
11360 #0 f () at t.c:2
11361 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11362 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11363 @end smallexample
11364
11365 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11366 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11367
11368 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11369 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11370 @set ARROW @click{}
11371 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11372 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11373 @end ifset
11374 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11375 @set ARROW ->
11376 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11377 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11378 @end ifclear
11379
11380 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11381 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11382 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11383
11384 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11385 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11386 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11387 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11388 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11389 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11390
11391 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11392 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11393 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11394 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11395 omitted.
11396
11397 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11398 entry may fail:
11399
11400 @smallexample
11401 int v;
11402 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11403 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11404 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11405 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11406 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11407 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11408
11409 (gdb) bt
11410 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11411 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11412 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11413 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11414 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11415 @end smallexample
11416
11417 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11418 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11419 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11420 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11421 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11422
11423 @node Macros
11424 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11425
11426 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11427 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11428 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11429 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11430 where it was defined.
11431
11432 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11433 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11434 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11435 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11436
11437 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11438 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11439 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11440 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11441 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11442 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11443 see @ref{List}.
11444
11445 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11446 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11447 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11448
11449 @table @code
11450
11451 @kindex macro expand
11452 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11453 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11454 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11455 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11456 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11457 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11458 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11459 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11460 it can be any string of tokens.
11461
11462 @kindex macro exp1
11463 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11464 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11465 @cindex expand macro once
11466 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11467 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11468 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11469 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11470 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11471 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11472 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11473 can be any string of tokens.
11474
11475 @kindex info macro
11476 @cindex macro definition, showing
11477 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11478 @cindex macros, from debug info
11479 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11480 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11481 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11482 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11483 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11484 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11485
11486 @kindex info macros
11487 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11488 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11489 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11490 command-line where those definitions were established.
11491
11492 @kindex macro define
11493 @cindex user-defined macros
11494 @cindex defining macros interactively
11495 @cindex macros, user-defined
11496 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11497 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11498 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11499 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11500 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11501 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11502 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11503 @var{arglist}.
11504
11505 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11506 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11507 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11508 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11509 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11510
11511 @kindex macro undef
11512 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11513 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11514 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11515 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11516 in the program being debugged.
11517
11518 @kindex macro list
11519 @item macro list
11520 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11521 @end table
11522
11523 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11524 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11525 show our source files:
11526
11527 @smallexample
11528 $ cat sample.c
11529 #include <stdio.h>
11530 #include "sample.h"
11531
11532 #define M 42
11533 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11534
11535 main ()
11536 @{
11537 #define N 28
11538 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11539 #undef N
11540 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11541 #define N 1729
11542 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11543 @}
11544 $ cat sample.h
11545 #define Q <
11546 $
11547 @end smallexample
11548
11549 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11550 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11551 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11552 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11553 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11554 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11555 information.
11556
11557 @smallexample
11558 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11559 $
11560 @end smallexample
11561
11562 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11563
11564 @smallexample
11565 $ gdb -nw sample
11566 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11567 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11568 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11569 (@value{GDBP})
11570 @end smallexample
11571
11572 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11573 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11574 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11575
11576 @smallexample
11577 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11578 3
11579 4 #define M 42
11580 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11581 6
11582 7 main ()
11583 8 @{
11584 9 #define N 28
11585 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11586 11 #undef N
11587 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11588 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11589 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11590 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11591 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11592 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11593 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11594 #define Q <
11595 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11596 expands to: (42 + 1)
11597 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11598 expands to: once (M + 1)
11599 (@value{GDBP})
11600 @end smallexample
11601
11602 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11603 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11604 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11605 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11606
11607 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11608 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11609
11610 @smallexample
11611 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11612 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11613 (@value{GDBP}) run
11614 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11615
11616 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11617 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11618 (@value{GDBP})
11619 @end smallexample
11620
11621 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11622
11623 @smallexample
11624 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11625 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11626 #define N 28
11627 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11628 expands to: 28 < 42
11629 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11630 $1 = 1
11631 (@value{GDBP})
11632 @end smallexample
11633
11634 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11635 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11636 thereof) in force at each point:
11637
11638 @smallexample
11639 (@value{GDBP}) next
11640 Hello, world!
11641 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11642 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11643 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11644 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11645 (@value{GDBP}) next
11646 We're so creative.
11647 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11648 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11649 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11650 #define N 1729
11651 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11652 expands to: 1729 < 42
11653 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11654 $2 = 0
11655 (@value{GDBP})
11656 @end smallexample
11657
11658 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11659 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11660 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11661 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11662
11663 @smallexample
11664 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11665 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11666 -D__STDC__=1
11667 (@value{GDBP})
11668 @end smallexample
11669
11670
11671 @node Tracepoints
11672 @chapter Tracepoints
11673 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11674 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11675
11676 @cindex tracepoints
11677 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11678 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11679 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11680 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11681 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11682 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11683 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11684
11685 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11686 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11687 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11688 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11689 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11690 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11691 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11692 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11693 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11694 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11695 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11696
11697 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11698 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11699 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11700 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11701 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11702 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11703 Packets}.
11704
11705 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11706 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11707 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11708
11709 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11710
11711 @menu
11712 * Set Tracepoints::
11713 * Analyze Collected Data::
11714 * Tracepoint Variables::
11715 * Trace Files::
11716 @end menu
11717
11718 @node Set Tracepoints
11719 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11720
11721 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11722 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11723 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11724 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11725 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11726 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11727 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11728
11729 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11730 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11731 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11732 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11733 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11734 tracepoint was hit.
11735
11736 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11737 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11738 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11739 either.
11740
11741 @cindex fast tracepoints
11742 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11743 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11744 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11745
11746 @cindex static tracepoints
11747 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11748 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11749 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11750 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11751 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11752 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11753 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11754 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11755 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11756 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11757 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11758 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11759 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11760 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11761 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11762 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11763 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11764 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11765 static tracepoint marker.
11766
11767 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11768 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11769
11770 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11771 conditions and actions.
11772
11773 @menu
11774 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11775 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11776 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11777 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11778 * Trace State Variables::
11779 * Tracepoint Actions::
11780 * Listing Tracepoints::
11781 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11782 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11783 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11784 @end menu
11785
11786 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11787 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11788
11789 @table @code
11790 @cindex set tracepoint
11791 @kindex trace
11792 @item trace @var{location}
11793 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11794 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11795 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11796 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11797 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11798 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11799 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11800 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11801 in tracing}).
11802 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11803 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11804 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11805 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11806 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11807 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11808 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11809 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11810 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11811 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11812 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11813 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11814
11815 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11816
11817 @smallexample
11818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11819
11820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11821
11822 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11823
11824 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11825
11826 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11827 @end smallexample
11828
11829 @noindent
11830 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11831
11832 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11833 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11834 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11835 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11836 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11837 information on tracepoint conditions.
11838
11839 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11840 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11841 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11842 @kindex ftrace
11843 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11844 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11845 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11846 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11847 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11848 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11849 message.
11850
11851 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11852 @code{trace}.
11853
11854 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11855 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11856 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11857 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11858 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11859 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11860 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11861 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11862
11863 @example
11864 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11865 @end example
11866
11867 @noindent
11868 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11869 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11870
11871 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11872 @cindex set static tracepoint
11873 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11874 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11875 @kindex strace
11876 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11877 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11878 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11879 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11880 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11881
11882 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11883 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11884 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11885 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11886 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11887 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11888 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11889 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11890 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11891 tracing engine:
11892
11893 @smallexample
11894 main ()
11895 @{
11896 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11897 @}
11898 @end smallexample
11899
11900 @noindent
11901 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11902 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11903
11904 @smallexample
11905 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11906 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11907 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11908 Data: "str %s"
11909 [etc...]
11910 @end smallexample
11911
11912 @noindent
11913 so you may probe the marker above with:
11914
11915 @smallexample
11916 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11917 @end smallexample
11918
11919 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11920 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11921 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11922 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11923 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11924 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11925 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11926 the @samp{Data:} field.
11927
11928 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11929 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11930 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11931
11932 @vindex $tpnum
11933 @cindex last tracepoint number
11934 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11935 @cindex tracepoint number
11936 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11937 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11938
11939 @kindex delete tracepoint
11940 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11941 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11942 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11943 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11944 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11945
11946 Examples:
11947
11948 @smallexample
11949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11950
11951 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11952 @end smallexample
11953
11954 @noindent
11955 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11956 @end table
11957
11958 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11959 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11960
11961 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11962
11963 @table @code
11964 @kindex disable tracepoint
11965 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11966 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11967 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11968 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11969 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11970 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11971 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11972 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11973 next trace experiment.
11974
11975 @kindex enable tracepoint
11976 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11977 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11978 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11979 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11980 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11981 next time a trace experiment is run.
11982 @end table
11983
11984 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11985 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11986
11987 @table @code
11988 @kindex passcount
11989 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11990 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11991 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11992 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11993 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11994 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11995 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11996 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11997 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11998 user.
11999
12000 Examples:
12001
12002 @smallexample
12003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12004 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12005
12006 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12007 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12009 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12013 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12014 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12015 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12016 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12017 @end smallexample
12018 @end table
12019
12020 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12021 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12022 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12023 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12024
12025 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12026 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12027 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12028 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12029 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12030 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12031 is true.
12032
12033 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12034 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12035 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12036 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12037 just as with breakpoints.
12038
12039 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12040 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12041 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12042 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12043 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12044 accesses, and so forth.
12045
12046 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12047 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12048 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12049 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12050 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12051 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12052 search through.
12053
12054 @smallexample
12055 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12056 @end smallexample
12057
12058 @node Trace State Variables
12059 @subsection Trace State Variables
12060 @cindex trace state variables
12061
12062 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12063 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12064 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12065 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12066 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12067 integers.
12068
12069 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12070 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12071 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12072 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12073
12074 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12075 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12076 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12077 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12078 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12079 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12080 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12081 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12082 variable with the same name.
12083
12084 @table @code
12085
12086 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12087 @kindex tvariable
12088 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12089 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12090 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12091 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12092 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12093 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12094 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12095 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12096 value. The default initial value is 0.
12097
12098 @item info tvariables
12099 @kindex info tvariables
12100 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12101 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12102 currently running.
12103
12104 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12105 @kindex delete tvariable
12106 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12107 are specified.
12108
12109 @end table
12110
12111 @node Tracepoint Actions
12112 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12113
12114 @table @code
12115 @kindex actions
12116 @cindex tracepoint actions
12117 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12118 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12119 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12120 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12121 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12122 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12123 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12124 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12125 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12126 @code{while-stepping}.
12127
12128 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12129 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12130 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12131
12132 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12133 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12134 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12135
12136 @smallexample
12137 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12138
12139 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12140
12141 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12142 @end smallexample
12143
12144 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12145 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12146 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12147 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12148 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12149 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12150 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12151 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12152
12153 @smallexample
12154 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12155 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12156 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12157 > collect bar,baz
12158 > collect $regs
12159 > while-stepping 12
12160 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12161 > end
12162 end
12163 @end smallexample
12164
12165 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12166 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12167 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12168 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12169 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12170 special arguments are supported:
12171
12172 @table @code
12173 @item $regs
12174 Collect all registers.
12175
12176 @item $args
12177 Collect all function arguments.
12178
12179 @item $locals
12180 Collect all local variables.
12181
12182 @item $_ret
12183 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12184 of a backtrace.
12185
12186 @item $_probe_argc
12187 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12188 tracepoint is located.
12189 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12190
12191 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12192 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12193 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12194 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12195
12196 @item $_sdata
12197 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12198 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12199 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12200 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12201 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12202 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12203 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12204 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12205 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12206
12207 @smallexample
12208 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12209 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12210 @end smallexample
12211
12212 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12213 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12214 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12215 @value{GDBN}.
12216 @end table
12217
12218 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12219 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12220 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12221
12222 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12223 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12224 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12225 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12226 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12227 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12228 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12229 @samp{mystr}.
12230
12231 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12232 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12233
12234 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12235 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12236 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12237 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12238 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12239 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12240 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12241 action were used.
12242
12243 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12244 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12245 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12246 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12247 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12248 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12249
12250 @smallexample
12251 > while-stepping 12
12252 > collect $regs, myglobal
12253 > end
12254 >
12255 @end smallexample
12256
12257 @noindent
12258 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12259 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12260 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12261 @code{stepping}.
12262
12263 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12264 @kindex set default-collect
12265 @cindex default collection action
12266 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12267 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12268 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12269 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12270 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12271 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12272
12273 @item show default-collect
12274 @kindex show default-collect
12275 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12276 tracepoint hit.
12277
12278 @end table
12279
12280 @node Listing Tracepoints
12281 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12282
12283 @table @code
12284 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12285 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12286 @cindex information about tracepoints
12287 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12288 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12289 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12290 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12291 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12292 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12293
12294 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12295 tracing:
12296
12297 @itemize @bullet
12298 @item
12299 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12300
12301 @item
12302 the state about installed on target of each location
12303 @end itemize
12304
12305 @smallexample
12306 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12307 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12308 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12309 while-stepping 20
12310 collect globfoo, $regs
12311 end
12312 collect globfoo2
12313 end
12314 pass count 1200
12315 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12316 collect $eip
12317 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12318 installed on target
12319 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12320 installed on target
12321 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12322 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12323 not installed on target
12324 (@value{GDBP})
12325 @end smallexample
12326
12327 @noindent
12328 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12329 @end table
12330
12331 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12332 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12333
12334 @table @code
12335 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12336 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12337 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12338 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12339 program.
12340
12341 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12342
12343 @table @emph
12344 @item Count
12345 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12346 stable identifier.
12347 @item ID
12348 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12349 @item Enabled or Disabled
12350 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12351 that are not enabled.
12352 @item Address
12353 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12354 @item What
12355 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12356 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12357 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12358 will be left blank.
12359 @end table
12360
12361 @noindent
12362 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12363
12364 @table @emph
12365 @item Data
12366 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12367 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12368 marker call.
12369 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12370 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12371 @end table
12372
12373 @smallexample
12374 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12375 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12376 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12377 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12378 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12379 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12380 Data: str %s
12381 (@value{GDBP})
12382 @end smallexample
12383 @end table
12384
12385 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12386 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12387
12388 @table @code
12389 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12390 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12391 @cindex collected data discarded
12392 @item tstart
12393 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12394 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12395 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12396 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12397 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12398 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12399 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12400 information, and so forth.
12401
12402 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12403 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12404 @item tstop
12405 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12406 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12407 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12408 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12409 needs to be stopped quickly.
12410
12411 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12412 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12413 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12414
12415 @kindex tstatus
12416 @cindex status of trace data collection
12417 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12418 @item tstatus
12419 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12420 collection.
12421 @end table
12422
12423 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12424
12425 @smallexample
12426 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12428 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12429 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12430 > while-stepping 11
12431 > collect $regs
12432 > end
12433 > end
12434 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12435 [time passes @dots{}]
12436 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12437 @end smallexample
12438
12439 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12440 @cindex disconnected tracing
12441 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12442 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12443 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12444 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12445 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12446 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12447 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12448 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12449
12450 @table @code
12451 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12452 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12453 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12454 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12455 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12456 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12457 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12458 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12459
12460 @item show disconnected-tracing
12461 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12462 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12463
12464 @end table
12465
12466 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12467 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12468 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12469 it will continue after reconnection.
12470
12471 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12472 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12473 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12474 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12475 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12476 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12477 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12478 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12479 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12480 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12481
12482 @cindex circular trace buffer
12483 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12484 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12485 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12486 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12487 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12488 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12489 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12490 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12491 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12492 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12493 the next run.
12494
12495 @table @code
12496 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12497 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12498 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12499 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12500 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12501 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12502 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12503
12504 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12505 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12506 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12507 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12508 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12509 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12510
12511 @end table
12512
12513 @table @code
12514 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12515 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12516 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12517 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12518 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12519 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12520 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12521 likes. This is also the default.
12522
12523 @item show trace-buffer-size
12524 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12525 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12526 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12527 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12528 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12529 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12530 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12531 @end table
12532
12533 @table @code
12534 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12535 @kindex set trace-user
12536
12537 @item show trace-user
12538 @kindex show trace-user
12539
12540 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12541 @kindex set trace-notes
12542 Set the trace run's notes.
12543
12544 @item show trace-notes
12545 @kindex show trace-notes
12546 Show the trace run's notes.
12547
12548 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12549 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12550 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12551 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12552 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12553
12554 @item show trace-stop-notes
12555 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12556 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12557
12558 @end table
12559
12560 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12561 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12562
12563 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12564 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12565 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12566 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12567 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12568 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12569 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12570 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12571 mentioned here.
12572
12573 @itemize @bullet
12574
12575 @item
12576 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12577 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12578 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12579 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12580 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12581 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12582 cannot be collected either.
12583
12584 @item
12585 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12586 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12587 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12588 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12589 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12590 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12591 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12592 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12593 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12594 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12595
12596 @item
12597 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12598 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12599 in a misleading way.
12600
12601 @item
12602 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12603 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12604 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12605 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12606 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12607 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12608 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12609 by @code{ptr}.
12610
12611 @item
12612 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12613 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12614 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12615 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12616 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12617 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12618 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12619 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12620 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12621 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12622 invalid address.
12623
12624 @item
12625 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12626 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12627 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12628 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12629 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12630 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12631 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12632 it to zero.
12633
12634 @end itemize
12635
12636 @node Analyze Collected Data
12637 @section Using the Collected Data
12638
12639 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12640 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12641 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12642 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12643 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12644 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12645 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12646 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12647 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12648 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12649 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12650 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12651 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12652 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12653 the buffer will fail.
12654
12655 @menu
12656 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12657 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12658 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12659 @end menu
12660
12661 @node tfind
12662 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12663
12664 @kindex tfind
12665 @cindex select trace snapshot
12666 @cindex find trace snapshot
12667 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12668 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12669 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12670 snapshot is selected.
12671
12672 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12673
12674 @table @code
12675 @item tfind start
12676 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12677 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12678
12679 @item tfind none
12680 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12681
12682 @item tfind end
12683 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12684
12685 @item tfind
12686 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12687
12688 @item tfind -
12689 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12690 retracing earlier steps.
12691
12692 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12693 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12694 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12695 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12696 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12697
12698 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12699 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12700 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12701 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12702 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12703
12704 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12705 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12706 addresses (exclusive).
12707
12708 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12709 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12710 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12711
12712 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12713 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12714 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12715 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12716 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12717 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12718 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12719 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12720 @end table
12721
12722 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12723 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12724 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12725 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12726 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12727 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12728 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12729 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12730 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12731 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12732 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12733 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12734 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12735 tracepoint as the current one.
12736
12737 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12738 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12739 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12740 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12741 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12742
12743 @smallexample
12744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12746 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12747 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12748 > tfind
12749 > end
12750
12751 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12752 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12753 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12754 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12755 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12756 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12757 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12758 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12759 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12760 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12761 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12762 @end smallexample
12763
12764 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12765 the buffer:
12766
12767 @smallexample
12768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12769 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12770 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12771 > tfind line
12772 > end
12773
12774 Frame 0, X = 1
12775 Frame 7, X = 2
12776 Frame 13, X = 255
12777 @end smallexample
12778
12779 @node tdump
12780 @subsection @code{tdump}
12781 @kindex tdump
12782 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12783 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12784
12785 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12786 the current trace snapshot.
12787
12788 @smallexample
12789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12791 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12792 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12793 > end
12794
12795 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12796
12797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12798 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12799 at gdb_test.c:444
12800 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12801
12802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12803 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12804 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12805 d1 0x18 24
12806 d2 0x80 128
12807 d3 0x33 51
12808 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12809 d5 0x22 34
12810 d6 0xe0 224
12811 d7 0x380035 3670069
12812 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12813 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12814 a2 0x100 256
12815 a3 0x322000 3284992
12816 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12817 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12818 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12819 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12820 ps 0x0 0
12821 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12822 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12823 fpstatus 0x0 0
12824 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12825 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12826 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12827 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12828 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12829 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12830 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12831 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12832 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12833
12834 (@value{GDBP})
12835 @end smallexample
12836
12837 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12838 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12839 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12840 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12841
12842 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12843 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12844 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12845 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12846 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12847 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12848 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12849 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12850 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12851 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12852
12853 @node save tracepoints
12854 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12855 @kindex save tracepoints
12856 @kindex save-tracepoints
12857 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12858
12859 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12860 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12861 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12862 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12863 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12864 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12865
12866 @node Tracepoint Variables
12867 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12868 @cindex tracepoint variables
12869 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12870
12871 @table @code
12872 @vindex $trace_frame
12873 @item (int) $trace_frame
12874 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12875 snapshot is selected.
12876
12877 @vindex $tracepoint
12878 @item (int) $tracepoint
12879 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12880
12881 @vindex $trace_line
12882 @item (int) $trace_line
12883 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12884
12885 @vindex $trace_file
12886 @item (char []) $trace_file
12887 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12888
12889 @vindex $trace_func
12890 @item (char []) $trace_func
12891 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12892 @end table
12893
12894 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12895 use @code{output} instead.
12896
12897 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12898 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12899 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12900 which are managed by the target.
12901
12902 @smallexample
12903 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12904
12905 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12906 > output $trace_file
12907 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12908 > tfind
12909 > end
12910 @end smallexample
12911
12912 @node Trace Files
12913 @section Using Trace Files
12914 @cindex trace files
12915
12916 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12917 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12918 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12919 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12920 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12921
12922 @table @code
12923
12924 @kindex tsave
12925 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12926 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12927 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12928 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12929 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12930 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12931 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12932 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12933 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12934 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12935 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12936 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12937 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12938 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12939 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12940
12941 @kindex target tfile
12942 @kindex tfile
12943 @kindex target ctf
12944 @kindex ctf
12945 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12946 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12947 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12948 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12949 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12950 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12951 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12952 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12953 the host.
12954
12955 @smallexample
12956 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12957 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12958 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12959 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12960 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12961 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12962 i = 0
12963 a = 0
12964 b = 1 '\001'
12965 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12966 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12967 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12968 $1 = 1
12969 @end smallexample
12970
12971 @end table
12972
12973 @node Overlays
12974 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12975 @cindex overlays
12976
12977 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12978 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12979 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12980 use overlays.
12981
12982 @menu
12983 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12984 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12985 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12986 mapped by asking the inferior.
12987 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12988 @end menu
12989
12990 @node How Overlays Work
12991 @section How Overlays Work
12992 @cindex mapped overlays
12993 @cindex unmapped overlays
12994 @cindex load address, overlay's
12995 @cindex mapped address
12996 @cindex overlay area
12997
12998 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12999 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13000 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13001 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13002 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13003
13004 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13005 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13006 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13007 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13008 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13009 largest overlay as well.
13010
13011 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13012 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13013 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13014 there.
13015
13016 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13017 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13018 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13019
13020 @smallexample
13021 @group
13022 Data Instruction Larger
13023 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13024 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13025 | | | | | |
13026 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13027 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13028 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13029 | and heap | | | | | |
13030 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13031 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13032 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13033 | | | | | |
13034 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13035 address | | | | | |
13036 | overlay | <-' | | |
13037 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13038 | | <---. | | load address
13039 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13040 | | | |
13041 +-----------+ | |
13042 +-----------+
13043 | |
13044 +-----------+
13045
13046 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13047 @end group
13048 @end smallexample
13049
13050 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13051 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13052 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13053 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13054 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13055 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13056 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13057 program and the overlay area.
13058
13059 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13060 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13061 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13062 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13063 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13064 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13065 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13066
13067 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13068 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13069 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13070
13071 @itemize @bullet
13072
13073 @item
13074 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13075 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13076 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13077 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13078
13079 @item
13080 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13081 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13082 your program's performance.
13083
13084 @item
13085 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13086 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13087 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13088 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13089 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13090 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13091 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13092
13093 @item
13094 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13095 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13096 instruction and data spaces.
13097
13098 @end itemize
13099
13100 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13101 improved in many ways:
13102
13103 @itemize @bullet
13104
13105 @item
13106 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13107 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13108 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13109 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13110 area in the usual way.
13111
13112 @item
13113 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13114 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13115
13116 @item
13117 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13118 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13119 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13120 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13121 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13122 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13123 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13124
13125 @end itemize
13126
13127
13128 @node Overlay Commands
13129 @section Overlay Commands
13130
13131 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13132 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13133 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13134 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13135 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13136 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13137
13138 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13139 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13140
13141 @table @code
13142 @item overlay off
13143 @kindex overlay
13144 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13145 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13146 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13147 overlay support is disabled.
13148
13149 @item overlay manual
13150 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13151 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13152 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13153 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13154 commands described below.
13155
13156 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13157 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13158 @cindex map an overlay
13159 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13160 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13161 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13162 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13163 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13164 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13165
13166 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13167 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13168 @cindex unmap an overlay
13169 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13170 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13171 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13172 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13173
13174 @item overlay auto
13175 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13176 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13177 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13178 Overlay Debugging}.
13179
13180 @item overlay load-target
13181 @itemx overlay load
13182 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13183 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13184 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13185 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13186 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13187 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13188
13189 @item overlay list-overlays
13190 @itemx overlay list
13191 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13192 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13193 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13194
13195 @end table
13196
13197 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13198 of the function the address falls in:
13199
13200 @smallexample
13201 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13202 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13203 @end smallexample
13204 @noindent
13205 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13206 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13207 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13208 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13209
13210 @smallexample
13211 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13212 No sections are mapped.
13213 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13214 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13215 @end smallexample
13216 @noindent
13217 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13218 name normally:
13219
13220 @smallexample
13221 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13222 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13223 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13224 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13225 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13226 @end smallexample
13227
13228 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13229 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13230 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13231 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13232 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13233
13234 @itemize @bullet
13235 @item
13236 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13237 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13238 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13239 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13240 @item
13241 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13242 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13243 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13244 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13245 breakpoints properly.
13246 @end itemize
13247
13248
13249 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13250 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13251 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13252
13253 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13254 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13255 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13256 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13257 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13258 current state of the overlays.
13259
13260 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13261 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13262
13263 @table @asis
13264
13265 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13266 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13267
13268 @smallexample
13269 struct
13270 @{
13271 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13272 unsigned long vma;
13273
13274 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13275 unsigned long size;
13276
13277 /* The overlay's load address. */
13278 unsigned long lma;
13279
13280 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13281 zero otherwise. */
13282 unsigned long mapped;
13283 @}
13284 @end smallexample
13285
13286 @item @code{_novlys}:
13287 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13288 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13289
13290 @end table
13291
13292 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13293 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13294 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13295 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13296 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13297 currently mapped.
13298
13299 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13300 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13301 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13302 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13303 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13304 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13305 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13306 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13307 are not being executed.
13308
13309 @node Overlay Sample Program
13310 @section Overlay Sample Program
13311 @cindex overlay example program
13312
13313 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13314 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13315 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13316 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13317 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13318 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13319 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13320
13321 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13322 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13323 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13324 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13325
13326 @table @file
13327 @item overlays.c
13328 The main program file.
13329 @item ovlymgr.c
13330 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13331 @item foo.c
13332 @itemx bar.c
13333 @itemx baz.c
13334 @itemx grbx.c
13335 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13336 @item d10v.ld
13337 @itemx m32r.ld
13338 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13339 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13340 @end table
13341
13342 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13343 cross-compiler like this:
13344
13345 @smallexample
13346 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13347 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13348 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13349 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13350 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13351 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13352 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13353 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13354 @end smallexample
13355
13356 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13357 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13358 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13359
13360
13361 @node Languages
13362 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13363 @cindex languages
13364
13365 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13366 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13367 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13368 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13369 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13370 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13371
13372 @cindex working language
13373 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13374 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13375 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13376 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13377 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13378 language}.
13379
13380 @menu
13381 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13382 * Show:: Displaying the language
13383 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13384 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13385 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13386 @end menu
13387
13388 @node Setting
13389 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13390
13391 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13392 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13393 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13394 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13395 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13396 are printed, etc.
13397
13398 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13399 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13400 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13401 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13402 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13403 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13404 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13405 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13406 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13407 Displaying the Language}.
13408
13409 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13410 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13411 another language. In that case, make the
13412 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13413 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13414 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13415
13416 @menu
13417 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13418 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13419 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13420 @end menu
13421
13422 @node Filenames
13423 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13424
13425 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13426 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13427
13428 @table @file
13429 @item .ada
13430 @itemx .ads
13431 @itemx .adb
13432 @itemx .a
13433 Ada source file.
13434
13435 @item .c
13436 C source file
13437
13438 @item .C
13439 @itemx .cc
13440 @itemx .cp
13441 @itemx .cpp
13442 @itemx .cxx
13443 @itemx .c++
13444 C@t{++} source file
13445
13446 @item .d
13447 D source file
13448
13449 @item .m
13450 Objective-C source file
13451
13452 @item .f
13453 @itemx .F
13454 Fortran source file
13455
13456 @item .mod
13457 Modula-2 source file
13458
13459 @item .s
13460 @itemx .S
13461 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13462 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13463 @end table
13464
13465 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13466 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13467
13468 @node Manually
13469 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13470
13471 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13472 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13473 your program.
13474
13475 @kindex set language
13476 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13477 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13478 a language, such as
13479 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13480 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13481
13482 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13483 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13484 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13485 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13486 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13487 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13488 command such as:
13489
13490 @smallexample
13491 print a = b + c
13492 @end smallexample
13493
13494 @noindent
13495 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13496 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13497 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13498 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13499
13500 @node Automatically
13501 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13502
13503 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13504 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13505 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13506 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13507 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13508 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13509 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13510 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13511 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13512
13513 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13514 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13515 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13516 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13517 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13518
13519 @node Show
13520 @section Displaying the Language
13521
13522 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13523 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13524
13525 @table @code
13526 @item show language
13527 @anchor{show language}
13528 @kindex show language
13529 Display the current working language. This is the
13530 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13531 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13532
13533 @item info frame
13534 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13535 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13536 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13537 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13538 information listed here.
13539
13540 @item info source
13541 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13542 Display the source language of this source file.
13543 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13544 information listed here.
13545 @end table
13546
13547 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13548 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13549 with a language explicitly:
13550
13551 @table @code
13552 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13553 @kindex set extension-language
13554 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13555 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13556
13557 @item info extensions
13558 @kindex info extensions
13559 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13560 @end table
13561
13562 @node Checks
13563 @section Type and Range Checking
13564
13565 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13566 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13567 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13568 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13569 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13570 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13571 errors when your program is running.
13572
13573 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13574 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13575 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13576 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13577
13578 @menu
13579 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13580 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13581 @end menu
13582
13583 @cindex type checking
13584 @cindex checks, type
13585 @node Type Checking
13586 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13587
13588 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13589 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13590 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13591 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13592
13593 @smallexample
13594 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13595
13596 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13597 $1 = 2
13598 @exdent but
13599 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13600 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13601 @end smallexample
13602
13603 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13604 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13605
13606 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13607 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13608 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13609 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13610 expressions like the second example above.
13611
13612 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13613 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13614 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13615 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13616 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13617 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13618
13619 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13620
13621 @kindex set check type
13622 @kindex show check type
13623 @table @code
13624 @item set check type on
13625 @itemx set check type off
13626 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13627 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13628 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13629
13630 @item show check type
13631 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13632 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13633 @end table
13634
13635 @cindex range checking
13636 @cindex checks, range
13637 @node Range Checking
13638 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13639
13640 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13641 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13642 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13643 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13644 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13645
13646 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13647 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13648 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13649 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13650
13651 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13652 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13653 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13654 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13655 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13656 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13657
13658 @smallexample
13659 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13660 @end smallexample
13661
13662 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13663 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13664 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13665
13666 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13667
13668 @kindex set check range
13669 @kindex show check range
13670 @table @code
13671 @item set check range auto
13672 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13673 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13674 each language.
13675
13676 @item set check range on
13677 @itemx set check range off
13678 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13679 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13680 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13681 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13682
13683 @item set check range warn
13684 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13685 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13686 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13687 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13688 systems).
13689
13690 @item show range
13691 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13692 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13693 @end table
13694
13695 @node Supported Languages
13696 @section Supported Languages
13697
13698 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13699 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13700 @c This is false ...
13701 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13702 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13703 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13704 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13705 language.
13706
13707 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13708 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13709 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13710 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13711 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13712 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13713 language reference or tutorial.
13714
13715 @menu
13716 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13717 * D:: D
13718 * Go:: Go
13719 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13720 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13721 * Fortran:: Fortran
13722 * Pascal:: Pascal
13723 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13724 * Ada:: Ada
13725 @end menu
13726
13727 @node C
13728 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13729
13730 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13731 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13732
13733 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13734 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13735 together.
13736
13737 @cindex C@t{++}
13738 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13739 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13740 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13741 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13742 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13743 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13744 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13745
13746 @menu
13747 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13748 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13749 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13750 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13751 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13752 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13753 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13754 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13755 @end menu
13756
13757 @node C Operators
13758 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13759
13760 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13761
13762 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13763 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13764 often defined on groups of types.
13765
13766 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13767
13768 @itemize @bullet
13769
13770 @item
13771 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13772 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13773
13774 @item
13775 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13776 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13777
13778 @item
13779 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13780
13781 @item
13782 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13783
13784 @end itemize
13785
13786 @noindent
13787 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13788 in order of increasing precedence:
13789
13790 @table @code
13791 @item ,
13792 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13793 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13794 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13795
13796 @item =
13797 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13798 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13799
13800 @item @var{op}=
13801 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13802 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13803 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13804 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13805 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13806
13807 @item ?:
13808 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13809 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13810 should be of an integral type.
13811
13812 @item ||
13813 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13814
13815 @item &&
13816 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13817
13818 @item |
13819 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13820
13821 @item ^
13822 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13823
13824 @item &
13825 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13826
13827 @item ==@r{, }!=
13828 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13829 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13830
13831 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13832 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13833 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13834 and non-zero for true.
13835
13836 @item <<@r{, }>>
13837 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13838
13839 @item @@
13840 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13841
13842 @item +@r{, }-
13843 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13844 pointer types.
13845
13846 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13847 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13848 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13849 integral types.
13850
13851 @item ++@r{, }--
13852 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13853 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13854 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13855 operation takes place.
13856
13857 @item *
13858 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13859 @code{++}.
13860
13861 @item &
13862 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13863
13864 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13865 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13866 to examine the address
13867 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13868 stored.
13869
13870 @item -
13871 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13872 precedence as @code{++}.
13873
13874 @item !
13875 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13876 @code{++}.
13877
13878 @item ~
13879 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13880 @code{++}.
13881
13882
13883 @item .@r{, }->
13884 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13885 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13886 pointer based on the stored type information.
13887 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13888
13889 @item .*@r{, }->*
13890 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13891
13892 @item []
13893 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13894 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13895
13896 @item ()
13897 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13898
13899 @item ::
13900 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13901 and @code{class} types.
13902
13903 @item ::
13904 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13905 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13906 above.
13907 @end table
13908
13909 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13910 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13911 predefined meaning.
13912
13913 @node C Constants
13914 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13915
13916 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13917
13918 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13919 following ways:
13920
13921 @itemize @bullet
13922 @item
13923 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13924 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13925 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13926 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13927 @code{long} value.
13928
13929 @item
13930 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13931 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13932 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13933 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13934 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13935 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13936 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13937 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13938 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13939 constant.
13940
13941 @item
13942 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13943 integral equivalents.
13944
13945 @item
13946 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13947 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13948 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13949 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13950 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13951 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13952 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13953 @samp{\n} for newline.
13954
13955 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13956 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13957 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13958 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13959
13960 @item
13961 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13962 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13963 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13964 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13965 characters.
13966
13967 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13968 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13969 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13970
13971 @item
13972 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13973 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13974
13975 @item
13976 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13977 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13978 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13979 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13980 @end itemize
13981
13982 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13983 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13984
13985 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13986 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13987
13988 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13989 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13990 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13991 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13992 @quotation
13993 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13994 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13995 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13996 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13997 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13998 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13999 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14000 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14001 @end quotation
14002
14003 @enumerate
14004
14005 @cindex member functions
14006 @item
14007 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14008
14009 @smallexample
14010 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14011 @end smallexample
14012
14013 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14014 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14015 @item
14016 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14017 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14018 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14019 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14020 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14021
14022 @cindex call overloaded functions
14023 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14024 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14025 @item
14026 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14027 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14028 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14029 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14030 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14031 default arguments.
14032
14033 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14034 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14035 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14036 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14037 number of function arguments.
14038
14039 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14040 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14041 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14042
14043 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14044 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14045 @smallexample
14046 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14047 @end smallexample
14048
14049 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14050 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14051
14052 @cindex reference declarations
14053 @item
14054 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14055 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14056 dereferenced.
14057
14058 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14059 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14060 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14061 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14062 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14063
14064 @item
14065 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14066 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14067 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14068 necessary, for example in an expression like
14069 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14070 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14071 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14072
14073 @item
14074 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14075 specification.
14076 @end enumerate
14077
14078 @node C Defaults
14079 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14080
14081 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14082
14083 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14084 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14085 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14086 selects the working language.
14087
14088 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14089 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14090 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14091 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14092 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14093 for further details.
14094
14095 @node C Checks
14096 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14097
14098 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14099
14100 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14101 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14102 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14103 constants to pointers.
14104
14105 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14106 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14107 that is not itself an array.
14108
14109 @node Debugging C
14110 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14111
14112 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14113 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14114 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14115 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14116
14117 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14118 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14119 ,Expressions}.
14120
14121 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14122 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14123
14124 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14125
14126 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14127 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14128
14129 @table @code
14130 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14131 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14132 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14133 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14134 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14135 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14136
14137 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14138 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14139 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14140 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14141 classes.
14142 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14143
14144 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14145 @item catch throw
14146 @itemx catch rethrow
14147 @itemx catch catch
14148 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14149 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14150
14151 @cindex inheritance
14152 @item ptype @var{typename}
14153 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14154 @var{typename}.
14155 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14156
14157 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14158 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14159 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14160 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14161 multiple inheritance is in use.
14162
14163 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14164 @item set print demangle
14165 @itemx show print demangle
14166 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14167 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14168 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14169 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14170 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14171
14172 @item set print object
14173 @itemx show print object
14174 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14175 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14176
14177 @item set print vtbl
14178 @itemx show print vtbl
14179 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14180 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14181 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14182 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14183
14184 @kindex set overload-resolution
14185 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14186 @item set overload-resolution on
14187 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14188 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14189 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14190 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14191 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14192 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14193
14194 @item set overload-resolution off
14195 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14196 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14197 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14198 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14199 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14200 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14201 argument types.
14202
14203 @kindex show overload-resolution
14204 @item show overload-resolution
14205 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14206
14207 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14208 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14209 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14210 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14211 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14212 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14213 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14214 @end table
14215
14216 @node Decimal Floating Point
14217 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14218 @cindex decimal floating point format
14219
14220 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14221 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14222 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14223 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14224
14225 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14226 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14227 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14228 configured target.
14229
14230 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14231 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14232 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14233
14234 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14235 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14236 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14237
14238 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14239 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14240 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14241
14242 @node D
14243 @subsection D
14244
14245 @cindex D
14246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14247 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14248 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14249
14250 @node Go
14251 @subsection Go
14252
14253 @cindex Go (programming language)
14254 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14255 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14256
14257 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14258
14259 @table @code
14260 @cindex current Go package
14261 @item The current Go package
14262 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14263 specifying global variables and functions.
14264
14265 For example, given the program:
14266
14267 @example
14268 package main
14269 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14270 func main () @{
14271 // ...
14272 @}
14273 @end example
14274
14275 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14276
14277 @example
14278 (gdb) p myglob
14279 (gdb) p main.myglob
14280 @end example
14281
14282 @cindex builtin Go types
14283 @item Builtin Go types
14284 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14285 as a string.
14286
14287 @cindex builtin Go functions
14288 @item Builtin Go functions
14289 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14290 function and handles it internally.
14291
14292 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14293 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14294 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14295 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14296 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14297 @end table
14298
14299 @node Objective-C
14300 @subsection Objective-C
14301
14302 @cindex Objective-C
14303 This section provides information about some commands and command
14304 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14305 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14306 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14307
14308 @menu
14309 * Method Names in Commands::
14310 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14311 @end menu
14312
14313 @node Method Names in Commands
14314 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14315
14316 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14317 names as line specifications:
14318
14319 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14320 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14321 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14322 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14323 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14324 @itemize
14325 @item @code{clear}
14326 @item @code{break}
14327 @item @code{info line}
14328 @item @code{jump}
14329 @item @code{list}
14330 @end itemize
14331
14332 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14333
14334 @smallexample
14335 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14336 @end smallexample
14337
14338 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14339 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14340 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14341 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14342 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14343 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14344 debugged, enter:
14345
14346 @smallexample
14347 break -[Fruit create]
14348 @end smallexample
14349
14350 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14351 enter:
14352
14353 @smallexample
14354 list +[NSText initialize]
14355 @end smallexample
14356
14357 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14358 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14359 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14360 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14361
14362 @smallexample
14363 break create
14364 @end smallexample
14365
14366 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14367 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14368 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14369 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14370 none apply.
14371
14372 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14373 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14374
14375 @smallexample
14376 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14377 @end smallexample
14378
14379 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14380 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14381 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14382 @kindex print-object
14383 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14384
14385 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14386
14387 @smallexample
14388 print -[@var{object} hash]
14389 @end smallexample
14390
14391 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14392 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14393 @noindent
14394 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14395 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14396 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14397 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14398 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14399 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14400
14401 @node OpenCL C
14402 @subsection OpenCL C
14403
14404 @cindex OpenCL C
14405 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14406
14407 @menu
14408 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14409 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14410 * OpenCL C Operators::
14411 @end menu
14412
14413 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14414 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14415
14416 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14417 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14418 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14419 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14420 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14421
14422 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14423 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14424
14425 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14426 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14427 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14428 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14429
14430 @node OpenCL C Operators
14431 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14432
14433 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14434 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14435 vector data types.
14436
14437 @node Fortran
14438 @subsection Fortran
14439 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14440
14441 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14442 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14443
14444 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14445 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14446 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14447 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14448 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14449 underscore.
14450
14451 @menu
14452 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14453 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14454 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14455 @end menu
14456
14457 @node Fortran Operators
14458 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14459
14460 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14461
14462 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14463 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14464 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14465
14466 @table @code
14467 @item **
14468 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14469 of the second one.
14470
14471 @item :
14472 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14473 represent a section of array.
14474
14475 @item %
14476 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14477 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14478 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14479 union type.
14480 @end table
14481
14482 @node Fortran Defaults
14483 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14484
14485 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14486
14487 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14488 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14489 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14490 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14491
14492 @node Special Fortran Commands
14493 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14494
14495 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14496
14497 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14498 such as displaying common blocks.
14499
14500 @table @code
14501 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14502 @kindex info common
14503 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14504 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14505 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14506 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14507 printed.
14508 @end table
14509
14510 @node Pascal
14511 @subsection Pascal
14512
14513 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14514 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14515 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14516 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14517 syntax.
14518
14519 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14520 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14521 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14522
14523 @node Modula-2
14524 @subsection Modula-2
14525
14526 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14527
14528 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14529 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14530 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14531 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14532 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14533 table.
14534
14535 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14536 @menu
14537 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14538 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14539 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14540 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14541 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14542 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14543 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14544 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14545 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14546 @end menu
14547
14548 @node M2 Operators
14549 @subsubsection Operators
14550 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14551
14552 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14553 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14554 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14555 following definitions hold:
14556
14557 @itemize @bullet
14558
14559 @item
14560 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14561 their subranges.
14562
14563 @item
14564 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14565
14566 @item
14567 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14568
14569 @item
14570 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14571 @var{type}}.
14572
14573 @item
14574 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14575
14576 @item
14577 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14578
14579 @item
14580 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14581 @end itemize
14582
14583 @noindent
14584 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14585 increasing precedence:
14586
14587 @table @code
14588 @item ,
14589 Function argument or array index separator.
14590
14591 @item :=
14592 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14593 @var{value}.
14594
14595 @item <@r{, }>
14596 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14597 types.
14598
14599 @item <=@r{, }>=
14600 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14601 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14602 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14603
14604 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14605 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14606 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14607 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14608 comment character.
14609
14610 @item IN
14611 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14612 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14613
14614 @item OR
14615 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14616
14617 @item AND@r{, }&
14618 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14619
14620 @item @@
14621 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14622
14623 @item +@r{, }-
14624 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14625 and difference on set types.
14626
14627 @item *
14628 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14629 on set types.
14630
14631 @item /
14632 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14633 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14634
14635 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14636 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14637 precedence as @code{*}.
14638
14639 @item -
14640 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14641
14642 @item ^
14643 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14644
14645 @item NOT
14646 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14647 @code{^}.
14648
14649 @item .
14650 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14651 precedence as @code{^}.
14652
14653 @item []
14654 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14655
14656 @item ()
14657 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14658 as @code{^}.
14659
14660 @item ::@r{, }.
14661 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14662 @end table
14663
14664 @quotation
14665 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14666 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14667 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14668 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14669 @end quotation
14670
14671
14672 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14673 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14674 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14675
14676 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14677 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14678
14679 @table @var
14680
14681 @item a
14682 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14683
14684 @item c
14685 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14686
14687 @item i
14688 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14689
14690 @item m
14691 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14692 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14693 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14694
14695 @item n
14696 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14697
14698 @item r
14699 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14700
14701 @item t
14702 represents a type.
14703
14704 @item v
14705 represents a variable.
14706
14707 @item x
14708 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14709 explanation of the function for details.
14710 @end table
14711
14712 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14713
14714 @table @code
14715 @item ABS(@var{n})
14716 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14717
14718 @item CAP(@var{c})
14719 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14720 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14721
14722 @item CHR(@var{i})
14723 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14724
14725 @item DEC(@var{v})
14726 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14727
14728 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14729 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14730 new value.
14731
14732 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14733 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14734 set.
14735
14736 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14737 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14738
14739 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14740 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14741
14742 @item INC(@var{v})
14743 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14744
14745 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14746 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14747 new value.
14748
14749 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14750 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14751 there. Returns the new set.
14752
14753 @item MAX(@var{t})
14754 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14755
14756 @item MIN(@var{t})
14757 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14758
14759 @item ODD(@var{i})
14760 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14761
14762 @item ORD(@var{x})
14763 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14764 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14765 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14766 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14767
14768 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14769 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14770 variable or a type.
14771
14772 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14773 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14774
14775 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14776 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14777 variable or a type.
14778
14779 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14780 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14781 @end table
14782
14783 @quotation
14784 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14785 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14786 an error.
14787 @end quotation
14788
14789 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14790 @node M2 Constants
14791 @subsubsection Constants
14792
14793 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14794 ways:
14795
14796 @itemize @bullet
14797
14798 @item
14799 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14800 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14801 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14802 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14803
14804 @item
14805 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14806 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14807 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14808 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14809 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14810 digits.
14811
14812 @item
14813 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14814 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14815 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14816 followed by a @samp{C}.
14817
14818 @item
14819 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14820 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14821 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14822 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14823 sequences.
14824
14825 @item
14826 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14827
14828 @item
14829 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14830 @code{FALSE}.
14831
14832 @item
14833 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14834
14835 @item
14836 Set constants are not yet supported.
14837 @end itemize
14838
14839 @node M2 Types
14840 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14841 @cindex Modula-2 types
14842
14843 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14844 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14845 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14846 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14847 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14848 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14849
14850 The first example contains the following section of code:
14851
14852 @smallexample
14853 VAR
14854 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14855 r: [20..40] ;
14856 @end smallexample
14857
14858 @noindent
14859 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14860 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14861
14862 @smallexample
14863 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14864 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14865 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14866 SET OF CHAR
14867 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14868 21
14869 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14870 [20..40]
14871 @end smallexample
14872
14873 @noindent
14874 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14875
14876 @smallexample
14877 VAR
14878 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14879 @end smallexample
14880
14881 @noindent
14882 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14883
14884 @smallexample
14885 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14886 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14887 @end smallexample
14888
14889 @noindent
14890 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14891 expressions using the debugger.
14892
14893 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14894 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14895
14896 @smallexample
14897 VAR
14898 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14899 @end smallexample
14900
14901 @smallexample
14902 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14903 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14904 @end smallexample
14905
14906 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14907 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14908 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14909 above.
14910
14911 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14912
14913 @smallexample
14914 TYPE
14915 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14916 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14917 VAR
14918 s: t ;
14919 BEGIN
14920 s := blue ;
14921 @end smallexample
14922
14923 @noindent
14924 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14925 and value of a variable.
14926
14927 @smallexample
14928 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14929 $1 = blue
14930 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14931 type = [blue..yellow]
14932 @end smallexample
14933
14934 @noindent
14935 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14936 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14937 their @code{C} counterparts.
14938
14939 @smallexample
14940 VAR
14941 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14942 BEGIN
14943 s[1] := 1 ;
14944 @end smallexample
14945
14946 @smallexample
14947 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14948 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14949 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14950 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14951 @end smallexample
14952
14953 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14954 pointer types as shown in this example:
14955
14956 @smallexample
14957 VAR
14958 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14959 BEGIN
14960 NEW(s) ;
14961 s^[1] := 1 ;
14962 @end smallexample
14963
14964 @noindent
14965 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14966
14967 @smallexample
14968 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14969 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14970 @end smallexample
14971
14972 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14973 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14974 types:
14975
14976 @smallexample
14977 TYPE
14978 foo = RECORD
14979 f1: CARDINAL ;
14980 f2: CHAR ;
14981 f3: myarray ;
14982 END ;
14983
14984 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14985 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14986 VAR
14987 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14988 @end smallexample
14989
14990 @noindent
14991 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14992 below.
14993
14994 @smallexample
14995 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14996 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14997 f1 : CARDINAL;
14998 f2 : CHAR;
14999 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15000 END
15001 @end smallexample
15002
15003 @node M2 Defaults
15004 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15005 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15006
15007 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15008 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15009 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15010 selected the working language.
15011
15012 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15013 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15014 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15015 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15016
15017 @node Deviations
15018 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15019 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15020
15021 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15022 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15023
15024 @itemize @bullet
15025 @item
15026 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15027 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15028 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15029 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15030 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15031 returned a pointer.)
15032
15033 @item
15034 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15035 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15036 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15037 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15038
15039 @item
15040 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15041 argument.
15042
15043 @item
15044 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15045 @end itemize
15046
15047 @node M2 Checks
15048 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15049 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15050
15051 @quotation
15052 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15053 range checking.
15054 @end quotation
15055 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15056
15057 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15058
15059 @itemize @bullet
15060 @item
15061 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15062 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15063
15064 @item
15065 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15066 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15067 @end itemize
15068
15069 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15070 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15071
15072 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15073 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15074
15075 @node M2 Scope
15076 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15077 @cindex scope
15078 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15079 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15080 @ifinfo
15081 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15082 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15083 @end ifinfo
15084 @ifnotinfo
15085 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15086 @end ifnotinfo
15087
15088 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15089 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15090 similar syntax:
15091
15092 @smallexample
15093
15094 @var{module} . @var{id}
15095 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15096 @end smallexample
15097
15098 @noindent
15099 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15100 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15101 identifier within your program, except another module.
15102
15103 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15104 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15105 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15106 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15107
15108 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15109 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15110 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15111 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15112 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15113 @var{module}.
15114
15115 @node GDB/M2
15116 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15117
15118 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15119 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15120 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15121 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15122 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15123 analogue in Modula-2.
15124
15125 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15126 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15127 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15128 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15129 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15130 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15131
15132 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15133 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15134 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15135
15136 @node Ada
15137 @subsection Ada
15138 @cindex Ada
15139
15140 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15141 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15142 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15143 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15144 to be difficult.
15145
15146
15147 @cindex expressions in Ada
15148 @menu
15149 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15150 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15151 in @value{GDBN}.
15152 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15153 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15154 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15155 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15156 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15157 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15158 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15159 Profile
15160 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15161 @end menu
15162
15163 @node Ada Mode Intro
15164 @subsubsection Introduction
15165 @cindex Ada mode, general
15166
15167 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15168 syntax, with some extensions.
15169 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15170
15171 @itemize @bullet
15172 @item
15173 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15174 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15175 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15176 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15177
15178 @item
15179 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15180 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15181
15182 @item
15183 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15184 @end itemize
15185
15186 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15187 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15188 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15189 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15190 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15191
15192 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15193 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15194 was translated from an Ada source file.
15195
15196 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15197 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15198 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15199 middle (to allow based literals).
15200
15201 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15202 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15203 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15204 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15205 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15206 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15207
15208 @node Omissions from Ada
15209 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15210 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15211
15212 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15213
15214 @itemize @bullet
15215 @item
15216 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15217
15218 @itemize @minus
15219 @item
15220 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15221 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15222
15223 @item
15224 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15225
15226 @item
15227 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15228
15229 @item
15230 @t{'Tag}.
15231
15232 @item
15233 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15234 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15235
15236 @item
15237 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15238 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15239
15240 @item
15241 @t{'Address}.
15242 @end itemize
15243
15244 @item
15245 The names in
15246 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15247 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15248 not currently available.
15249
15250 @item
15251 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15252 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15253 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15254 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15255 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15256 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15257 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15258 indeterminate values.
15259
15260 @item
15261 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15262 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15263 are not implemented.
15264
15265 @item
15266 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15267 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15268 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15269 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15270 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15271
15272 @smallexample
15273 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15274 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15275 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15276 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15277 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15278 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15279 @end smallexample
15280
15281 Changing a
15282 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15283 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15284 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15285 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15286 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15287 declared to have a type such as:
15288
15289 @smallexample
15290 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15291 Id : Integer;
15292 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15293 end record;
15294 @end smallexample
15295
15296 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15297 assignments:
15298
15299 @smallexample
15300 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15301 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15302 @end smallexample
15303
15304 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15305 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15306 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15307 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15308 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15309 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15310 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15311 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15312
15313 @item
15314 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15315
15316 @item
15317 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15318 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15319 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15320 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15321 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15322 the proper resolution.
15323
15324 @item
15325 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15326
15327 @item
15328 Entry calls are not implemented.
15329
15330 @item
15331 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15332 formats are not supported.
15333
15334 @item
15335 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15336
15337 @item
15338 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15339 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15340 context.
15341 Should your program
15342 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15343 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15344 @end itemize
15345
15346 @node Additions to Ada
15347 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15348 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15349
15350 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15351 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15352
15353 @itemize @bullet
15354 @item
15355 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15356 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15357 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15358 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15359 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15360 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15361 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15362 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15363
15364 @item
15365 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15366 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15367 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15368
15369 @item
15370 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15371 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15372
15373 @item
15374 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15375 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15376 @end itemize
15377
15378 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15379 additions specific to Ada:
15380
15381 @itemize @bullet
15382 @item
15383 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15384 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15385
15386 @smallexample
15387 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15388 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15389 @end smallexample
15390
15391 @item
15392 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15393 the value of its right-hand operand.
15394 This allows, for example,
15395 complex conditional breaks:
15396
15397 @smallexample
15398 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15399 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15400 @end smallexample
15401
15402 @item
15403 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15404 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15405 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15406 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15407 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15408 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15409 in strings. For example,
15410 @smallexample
15411 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15412 @end smallexample
15413 @noindent
15414 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15415 after each period.
15416
15417 @item
15418 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15419 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15420 to write
15421
15422 @smallexample
15423 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15424 @end smallexample
15425
15426 @item
15427 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15428 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15429 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15430 of 3 might print as
15431
15432 @smallexample
15433 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15434 @end smallexample
15435
15436 @noindent
15437 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15438 clause.
15439
15440 @item
15441 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15442 multi-character subsequence of
15443 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15444 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15445 in place of @t{a'length}.
15446
15447 @item
15448 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15449 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15450 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15451 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15452 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15453 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15454 For example,
15455 @smallexample
15456 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15457 @end smallexample
15458
15459 @item
15460 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15461 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15462 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15463 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15464 object.
15465
15466 @end itemize
15467
15468 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15469 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15470
15471 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15472 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15473 before reaching the main procedure.
15474 As defined in the Ada Reference
15475 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15476 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15477 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15478 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15479
15480 @node Ada Exceptions
15481 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15482
15483 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15484
15485 @table @code
15486 @kindex info exceptions
15487 @item info exceptions
15488 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15489 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15490 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15491 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15492 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15493 @end table
15494
15495 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15496 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15497 argument.
15498
15499 @smallexample
15500 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15501 All defined Ada exceptions:
15502 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15503 program_error: 0x613d20
15504 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15505 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15506 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15507 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15508 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15509 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15510 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15511 @end smallexample
15512
15513 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15514 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15515
15516 @node Ada Tasks
15517 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15518 @cindex Ada, tasking
15519
15520 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15521 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15522
15523 @table @code
15524 @kindex info tasks
15525 @item info tasks
15526 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15527
15528
15529 @smallexample
15530 @iftex
15531 @leftskip=0.5cm
15532 @end iftex
15533 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15534 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15535 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15536 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15537 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15538 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15539
15540 @end smallexample
15541
15542 @noindent
15543 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15544 task currently being inspected.
15545
15546 @table @asis
15547 @item ID
15548 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15549
15550 @item TID
15551 The Ada task ID.
15552
15553 @item P-ID
15554 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15555
15556 @item Pri
15557 The base priority of the task.
15558
15559 @item State
15560 Current state of the task.
15561
15562 @table @code
15563 @item Unactivated
15564 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15565 executing.
15566
15567 @item Runnable
15568 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15569 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15570
15571 @item Terminated
15572 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15573 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15574 terminated themselves.
15575
15576 @item Child Activation Wait
15577 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15578
15579 @item Accept Statement
15580 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15581
15582 @item Waiting on entry call
15583 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15584
15585 @item Async Select Wait
15586 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15587 select statement.
15588
15589 @item Delay Sleep
15590 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15591 alternative open.
15592
15593 @item Child Termination Wait
15594 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15595 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15596 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15597
15598 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15599 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15600 finish terminating.
15601
15602 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15603 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15604 @end table
15605
15606 @item Name
15607 Name of the task in the program.
15608
15609 @end table
15610
15611 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15612 @item info task @var{taskno}
15613 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15614 the following example:
15615 @smallexample
15616 @iftex
15617 @leftskip=0.5cm
15618 @end iftex
15619 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15620 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15621 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15622 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15623 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15624 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15625 Name: task_1
15626 Thread: 0x807f378
15627 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15628 Base Priority: 15
15629 State: Runnable
15630 @end smallexample
15631
15632 @item task
15633 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15634 @cindex current Ada task ID
15635 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15636
15637 @smallexample
15638 @iftex
15639 @leftskip=0.5cm
15640 @end iftex
15641 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15642 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15643 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15644 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15645 (@value{GDBP}) task
15646 [Current task is 2]
15647 @end smallexample
15648
15649 @item task @var{taskno}
15650 @cindex Ada task switching
15651 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15652 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15653 from the current task to the given task.
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 @iftex
15657 @leftskip=0.5cm
15658 @end iftex
15659 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15660 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15661 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15662 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15663 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15664 [Switching to task 1]
15665 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15666 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15667 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15668 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15669 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15670 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15671 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15672 @end smallexample
15673
15674 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15675 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15676 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15677 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15678 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15679 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15680 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15681 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15682 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15683
15684 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15685 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15686 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15687 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15688 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15689
15690 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15691 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15692 program.
15693
15694 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15695 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15696 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15697
15698 For example,
15699
15700 @smallexample
15701 @iftex
15702 @leftskip=0.5cm
15703 @end iftex
15704 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15705 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15706 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15707 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15708 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15709 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15710 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15711 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15712 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15713 Continuing.
15714 task # 1 running
15715 task # 2 running
15716
15717 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15718 15 flush;
15719 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15720 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15721 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15722 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15723 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15724 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15725 @end smallexample
15726 @end table
15727
15728 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15729 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15730 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15731
15732 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15733 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15734 the platform being used.
15735 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15736 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15737 as usual.
15738
15739 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15740 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15741 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15742 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15743 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15744 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15745
15746 @node Ravenscar Profile
15747 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15748 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15749
15750 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15751 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15752 requirements.
15753
15754 @table @code
15755 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15756 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15757 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15758 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15759 Profile. This is the default.
15760
15761 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15762 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15763 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15764 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15765 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15766 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15767 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15768
15769 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15770 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15771 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15772 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15773
15774 @end table
15775
15776 @node Ada Glitches
15777 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15778 @cindex Ada, problems
15779
15780 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15781 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15782 @value{GDBN},
15783 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15784 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15785
15786 @itemize @bullet
15787 @item
15788 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15789 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15790
15791 @item
15792 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15793 argument lists are treated as positional).
15794
15795 @item
15796 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15797
15798 @item
15799 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15800 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15801 the host machine.
15802
15803 @item
15804 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15805 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15806 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15807 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15808 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15809 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15810 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15811 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15812 you can usually resolve the confusion
15813 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15814 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15815 @end itemize
15816
15817 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15818 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15819 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15820 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15821 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15822 enabled.
15823
15824 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15825 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15826 @table @code
15827
15828 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15829 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15830 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15831 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15832 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15833 This is the default.
15834
15835 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15836 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15837 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15838 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15839 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15840 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15841 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15842
15843 @end table
15844
15845 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15846 @cindex GNAT encoding
15847 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15848 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15849 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15850 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15851 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15852 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15853
15854 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15855 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15856 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15857 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15858 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15859 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15860 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15861 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15862
15863 @table @code
15864
15865 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15866 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15867 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15868 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15869
15870 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15871 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15872 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15873
15874 @end table
15875
15876 @node Unsupported Languages
15877 @section Unsupported Languages
15878
15879 @cindex unsupported languages
15880 @cindex minimal language
15881 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15882 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15883 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15884 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15885 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15886 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15887
15888 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15889 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15890 language.
15891
15892 @node Symbols
15893 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15894
15895 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15896 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15897 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15898 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15899 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15900 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15901 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15902
15903 @cindex symbol names
15904 @cindex names of symbols
15905 @cindex quoting names
15906 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15907 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15908 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15909 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15910 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15911 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15912 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15913 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15914
15915 @smallexample
15916 p 'foo.c'::x
15917 @end smallexample
15918
15919 @noindent
15920 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15921
15922 @table @code
15923 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15924 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15925 @kindex set case-sensitive
15926 @item set case-sensitive on
15927 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15928 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15929 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15930 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15931 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15932 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15933 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15934 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15935 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15936 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15937 case-insensitive matches.
15938
15939 @kindex show case-sensitive
15940 @item show case-sensitive
15941 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15942 lookups.
15943
15944 @kindex set print type methods
15945 @item set print type methods
15946 @itemx set print type methods on
15947 @itemx set print type methods off
15948 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15949 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15950 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15951 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15952 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15953 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15954
15955 @kindex show print type methods
15956 @item show print type methods
15957 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15958 classes.
15959
15960 @kindex set print type typedefs
15961 @item set print type typedefs
15962 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15963 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15964
15965 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15966 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15967 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15968 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15969 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15970 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15971 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15972 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15973 types.
15974
15975 @kindex show print type typedefs
15976 @item show print type typedefs
15977 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15978 printing classes.
15979
15980 @kindex info address
15981 @cindex address of a symbol
15982 @item info address @var{symbol}
15983 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15984 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15985 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15986 is always stored.
15987
15988 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15989 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15990 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15991
15992 @kindex info symbol
15993 @cindex symbol from address
15994 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15995 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15996 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15997 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15998 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15999
16000 @smallexample
16001 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16002 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16003 @end smallexample
16004
16005 @noindent
16006 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16007 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16008
16009 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16010 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16011
16012 @smallexample
16013 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16014 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16015 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16016 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16017 @end smallexample
16018
16019 @kindex whatis
16020 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16021 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16022 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16023 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16024
16025 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16026 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16027 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16028
16029 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16030 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16031 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16032 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16033 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16034 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16035 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16036 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16037 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16038
16039 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16040 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16041 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16042 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16043 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16044 unroll it.
16045
16046 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16047 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16048 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16049
16050 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16051 Available flags are:
16052
16053 @table @code
16054 @item r
16055 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16056 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16057 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16058
16059 @item m
16060 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16061
16062 @item M
16063 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16064 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16065
16066 @item t
16067 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16068 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16069 names are substituted when printing other types.
16070
16071 @item T
16072 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16073 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16074 @end table
16075
16076 @kindex ptype
16077 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16078 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16079 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16080 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16081
16082 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16083 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16084 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16085 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16086 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16087 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16088 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16089 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16090
16091 For example, for this variable declaration:
16092
16093 @smallexample
16094 typedef double real_t;
16095 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16096 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16097 complex_t var;
16098 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16099 @end smallexample
16100
16101 @noindent
16102 the two commands give this output:
16103
16104 @smallexample
16105 @group
16106 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16107 type = complex_t
16108 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16109 type = struct complex @{
16110 real_t real;
16111 double imag;
16112 @}
16113 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16114 type = struct complex
16115 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16116 type = struct complex
16117 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16118 type = struct complex @{
16119 real_t real;
16120 double imag;
16121 @}
16122 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16123 type = real_t *
16124 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16125 type = double *
16126 @end group
16127 @end smallexample
16128
16129 @noindent
16130 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16131 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16132
16133 @cindex incomplete type
16134 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16135 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16136 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16137 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16138 given these declarations:
16139
16140 @smallexample
16141 struct foo;
16142 struct foo *fooptr;
16143 @end smallexample
16144
16145 @noindent
16146 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16147
16148 @smallexample
16149 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16150 $1 = <incomplete type>
16151 @end smallexample
16152
16153 @noindent
16154 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16155 completely specified.
16156
16157 @kindex info types
16158 @item info types @var{regexp}
16159 @itemx info types
16160 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16161 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16162 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16163 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16164 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16165 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16166 name is @code{value}.
16167
16168 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16169 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16170 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16171
16172 @kindex info type-printers
16173 @item info type-printers
16174 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16175 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16176 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16177 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16178 type printers.
16179
16180 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16181
16182 @kindex enable type-printer
16183 @kindex disable type-printer
16184 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16185 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16186 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16187
16188 @kindex info scope
16189 @cindex local variables
16190 @item info scope @var{location}
16191 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16192 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16193 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16194 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16195 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16196
16197 @smallexample
16198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16199 Scope for command_line_handler:
16200 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16201 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16202 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16203 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16204 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16205 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16206 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16207 @end smallexample
16208
16209 @noindent
16210 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16211 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16212 collect}.
16213
16214 @kindex info source
16215 @item info source
16216 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16217 the function containing the current point of execution:
16218 @itemize @bullet
16219 @item
16220 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16221 @item
16222 the directory it was compiled in,
16223 @item
16224 its length, in lines,
16225 @item
16226 which programming language it is written in,
16227 @item
16228 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16229 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16230 @item
16231 whether the debugging information includes information about
16232 preprocessor macros.
16233 @end itemize
16234
16235
16236 @kindex info sources
16237 @item info sources
16238 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16239 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16240 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16241
16242 @kindex info functions
16243 @item info functions
16244 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16245
16246 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16247 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16248 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16249 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16250 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16251 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16252 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16253 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16254
16255 @kindex info variables
16256 @item info variables
16257 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16258 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16259
16260 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16261 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16262 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16263 @var{regexp}.
16264
16265 @kindex info classes
16266 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16267 @item info classes
16268 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16269 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16270 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16271 expression.
16272
16273 @kindex info selectors
16274 @item info selectors
16275 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16276 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16277 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16278 expression.
16279
16280 @ignore
16281 This was never implemented.
16282 @kindex info methods
16283 @item info methods
16284 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16285 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16286 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16287 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16288 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16289 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16290 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16291 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16292 @end ignore
16293
16294 @cindex opaque data types
16295 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16296 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16297 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16298 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16299 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16300 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16301 another source file. The default is on.
16302
16303 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16304 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16305
16306 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16307 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16308 is printed as follows:
16309 @smallexample
16310 @{<no data fields>@}
16311 @end smallexample
16312
16313 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16314 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16315 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16316
16317 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16318 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16319 @item set print symbol-loading
16320 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16321 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16322 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16323 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16324 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16325 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16326 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16327 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16328 can be annoying.
16329 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16330 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16331 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16332 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16333
16334 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16335 @item show print symbol-loading
16336 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16337 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16338
16339 @kindex maint print symbols
16340 @cindex symbol dump
16341 @kindex maint print psymbols
16342 @cindex partial symbol dump
16343 @kindex maint print msymbols
16344 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16345 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16346 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16347 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16348 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16349 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16350 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16351 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16352 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16353 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16354 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16355 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16356 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16357 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16358 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16359 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16360 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16361 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16362
16363 @kindex maint info symtabs
16364 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16365 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16366 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16367 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16368 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16369 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16370 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16371
16372 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16373 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16374 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16375 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16376 structure in more detail. For example:
16377
16378 @smallexample
16379 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16380 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16381 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16382 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16383 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16384 readin no
16385 fullname (null)
16386 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16387 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16388 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16389 dependencies (none)
16390 @}
16391 @}
16392 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16393 (@value{GDBP})
16394 @end smallexample
16395 @noindent
16396 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16397 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16398 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16399 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16400 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16401
16402 @smallexample
16403 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16404 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16405 line 1574.
16406 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16407 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16408 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16409 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16410 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16411 dirname (null)
16412 fullname (null)
16413 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16414 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16415 debugformat DWARF 2
16416 @}
16417 @}
16418 (@value{GDBP})
16419 @end smallexample
16420 @end table
16421
16422
16423 @node Altering
16424 @chapter Altering Execution
16425
16426 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16427 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16428 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16429 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16430 program.
16431
16432 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16433 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16434 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16435
16436 @menu
16437 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16438 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16439 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16440 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16441 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16442 * Patching:: Patching your program
16443 @end menu
16444
16445 @node Assignment
16446 @section Assignment to Variables
16447
16448 @cindex assignment
16449 @cindex setting variables
16450 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16451 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16452
16453 @smallexample
16454 print x=4
16455 @end smallexample
16456
16457 @noindent
16458 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16459 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16460 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16461 information on operators in supported languages.
16462
16463 @kindex set variable
16464 @cindex variables, setting
16465 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16466 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16467 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16468 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16469 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16470
16471 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16472 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16473 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16474 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16475 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16476 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16477 command @code{set width}:
16478
16479 @smallexample
16480 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16481 type = double
16482 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16483 $4 = 13
16484 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16485 Invalid syntax in expression.
16486 @end smallexample
16487
16488 @noindent
16489 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16490 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16491
16492 @smallexample
16493 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16494 @end smallexample
16495
16496 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16497 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16498 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16499 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16500 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16501 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16502
16503 @smallexample
16504 @group
16505 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16506 type = double
16507 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16508 $1 = 1
16509 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16510 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16511 $2 = 1
16512 (@value{GDBP}) r
16513 The program being debugged has been started already.
16514 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16515 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16516 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16517 Invalid bfd target.
16518 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16519 The current BFD target is "=4".
16520 @end group
16521 @end smallexample
16522
16523 @noindent
16524 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16525 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16526 @code{g}, use
16527
16528 @smallexample
16529 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16530 @end smallexample
16531
16532 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16533 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16534 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16535 same length or shorter.
16536 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16537 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16538
16539 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16540 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16541 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16542 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16543 and representation in memory), and
16544
16545 @smallexample
16546 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16547 @end smallexample
16548
16549 @noindent
16550 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16551
16552 @node Jumping
16553 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16554
16555 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16556 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16557 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16558
16559 @table @code
16560 @kindex jump
16561 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16562 @item jump @var{linespec}
16563 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16564 @itemx jump @var{location}
16565 @itemx j @var{location}
16566 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16567 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16568 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16569 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16570 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16571 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16572
16573 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16574 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16575 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16576 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16577 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16578 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16579 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16580 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16581 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16582 @end table
16583
16584 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16585 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16586 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16587 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16588 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16589 example,
16590
16591 @smallexample
16592 set $pc = 0x485
16593 @end smallexample
16594
16595 @noindent
16596 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16597 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16598 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16599
16600 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16601 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16602 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16603 detail.
16604
16605 @c @group
16606 @node Signaling
16607 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16608 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16609
16610 @table @code
16611 @kindex signal
16612 @item signal @var{signal}
16613 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16614 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16615 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16616 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16617
16618 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16619 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16620 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16621 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16622 signal.
16623
16624 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16625 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16626 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16627 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16628 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16629 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16630 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16631 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16632
16633 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16634 after executing the command.
16635 @end table
16636 @c @end group
16637
16638 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16639 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16640 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16641 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16642 passes the signal directly to your program.
16643
16644
16645 @node Returning
16646 @section Returning from a Function
16647
16648 @table @code
16649 @cindex returning from a function
16650 @kindex return
16651 @item return
16652 @itemx return @var{expression}
16653 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16654 command. If you give an
16655 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16656 value.
16657 @end table
16658
16659 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16660 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16661 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16662 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16663
16664 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16665 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16666 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16667 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16668 of functions.
16669
16670 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16671 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16672 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16673 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16674 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16675
16676 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16677 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16678 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16679 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16680 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16681 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16682 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16683 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16684 assignment into the right register(s).
16685
16686 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16687 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16688 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16689 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16690 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16691 into a @code{long long int}:
16692
16693 @smallexample
16694 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16695 29 return 31;
16696 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16697 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16698 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16699 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16700 (@value{GDBP})
16701 @end smallexample
16702
16703 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16704 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16705 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16706 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16707 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16708 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16709 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16710 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16711
16712 @smallexample
16713 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16714 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16715 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16716 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16717 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16718 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16719 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16720 (@value{GDBP})
16721 @end smallexample
16722
16723 @node Calling
16724 @section Calling Program Functions
16725
16726 @table @code
16727 @cindex calling functions
16728 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16729 @item print @var{expr}
16730 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16731 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16732 debugged.
16733
16734 @kindex call
16735 @item call @var{expr}
16736 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16737 returned values.
16738
16739 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16740 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16741 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16742 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16743 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16744 value history.
16745 @end table
16746
16747 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16748 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16749 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16750 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16751
16752 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16753 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16754 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16755 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16756 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16757 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16758 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16759 in that case is controlled by the
16760 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16761
16762 @table @code
16763 @item set unwindonsignal
16764 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16765 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16766 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16767 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16768 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16769 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16770 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16771 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16772 received.
16773
16774 @item show unwindonsignal
16775 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16776 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16777 @value{GDBN}.
16778
16779 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16780 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16781 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16782 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16783 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16784 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16785 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16786 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16787 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16788 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16789
16790 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16791 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16792 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16793 @value{GDBN}.
16794
16795 @end table
16796
16797 @cindex weak alias functions
16798 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16799 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16800 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16801 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16802 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16803 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16804 function instead.
16805
16806 @node Patching
16807 @section Patching Programs
16808
16809 @cindex patching binaries
16810 @cindex writing into executables
16811 @cindex writing into corefiles
16812
16813 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16814 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16815 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16816 patching your program's binary.
16817
16818 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16819 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16820 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16821 repairs.
16822
16823 @table @code
16824 @kindex set write
16825 @item set write on
16826 @itemx set write off
16827 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16828 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16829 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16830
16831 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16832 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16833 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16834
16835 @item show write
16836 @kindex show write
16837 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16838 as well as reading.
16839 @end table
16840
16841 @node GDB Files
16842 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16843
16844 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16845 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16846 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16847 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16848
16849 @menu
16850 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16851 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16852 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16853 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16854 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16855 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16856 @end menu
16857
16858 @node Files
16859 @section Commands to Specify Files
16860
16861 @cindex symbol table
16862 @cindex core dump file
16863
16864 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16865 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16866 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16867 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16868
16869 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16870 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16871 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16872 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16873 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16874 new files are useful.
16875
16876 @table @code
16877 @cindex executable file
16878 @kindex file
16879 @item file @var{filename}
16880 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16881 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16882 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16883 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16884 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16885 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16886 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16887 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16888
16889 @cindex unlinked object files
16890 @cindex patching object files
16891 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16892 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16893 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16894 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16895 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16896 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16897 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16898 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16899
16900 @item file
16901 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16902 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16903
16904 @kindex exec-file
16905 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16906 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16907 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16908 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16909 discard information on the executable file.
16910
16911 @kindex symbol-file
16912 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16913 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16914 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16915 table and program to run from the same file.
16916
16917 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16918 program's symbol table.
16919
16920 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16921 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16922 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16923 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16924 @value{GDBN}.
16925
16926 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16927 executing it once.
16928
16929 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16930 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16931 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16932 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16933 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16934 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16935 optimized code.
16936
16937 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16938 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16939 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16940 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16941 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16942
16943 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16944 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16945 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16946 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16947 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16948 Warnings and Messages}.)
16949
16950 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16951 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16952 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16953 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16954 in stabs format.
16955
16956 @kindex readnow
16957 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16958 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16959 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16960 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16961 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16962 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16963 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16964 entire symbol table available.
16965
16966 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16967 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16968 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16969 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16970 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16971 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16972 @c files.
16973
16974 @kindex core-file
16975 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16976 @itemx core
16977 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16978 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16979 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16980 executable file itself for other parts.
16981
16982 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16983 to be used.
16984
16985 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16986 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16987 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16988 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16989 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16990
16991 @kindex add-symbol-file
16992 @cindex dynamic linking
16993 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16994 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16995 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16996 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16997 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16998 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16999 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17000 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17001 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17002 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17003 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17004 @var{address} as an expression.
17005
17006 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17007 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17008 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17009 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17010
17011 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17012
17013 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17014 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17015 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17016 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17017 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17018 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17019 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17020 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17021 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17022
17023 @itemize @bullet
17024 @item
17025 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17026 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17027 @item
17028 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17029 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17030 @item
17031 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17032 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17033 @end itemize
17034
17035 @noindent
17036 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17037 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17038 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17039 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17040 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17041 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17042 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17043 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17044 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17045 way.
17046
17047 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17048
17049 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17050 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17051 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17052 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17053 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17054 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17055
17056 @smallexample
17057 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17058 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17059 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17060 (y or n) y
17061 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17062 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17063 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17064 (gdb)
17065 @end smallexample
17066
17067
17068 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17069
17070 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17071 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17072 @cindex load symbols from memory
17073 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17074 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17075 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17076 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17077 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17078 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17079 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17080 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17081 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17082
17083 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
17084 @kindex assf
17085 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
17086 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
17087 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
17088 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
17089
17090 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
17091 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
17092 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
17093 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
17094 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
17095 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
17096 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
17097 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
17098
17099 @kindex section
17100 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17101 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17102 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17103 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17104 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17105 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17106 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17107 their addresses.
17108
17109 @kindex info files
17110 @kindex info target
17111 @item info files
17112 @itemx info target
17113 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17114 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17115 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17116 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17117 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17118 current ones.
17119
17120 @kindex maint info sections
17121 @item maint info sections
17122 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17123 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17124 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17125 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17126 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17127 may be arbitrarily combined):
17128
17129 @table @code
17130 @item ALLOBJ
17131 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17132 @item @var{sections}
17133 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17134 @item @var{section-flags}
17135 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17136 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17137 @table @code
17138 @item ALLOC
17139 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17140 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17141 @item LOAD
17142 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17143 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17144 @item RELOC
17145 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17146 @item READONLY
17147 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17148 @item CODE
17149 Section contains executable code only.
17150 @item DATA
17151 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17152 @item ROM
17153 Section will reside in ROM.
17154 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17155 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17156 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17157 Section is not empty.
17158 @item NEVER_LOAD
17159 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17160 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17161 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17162 COFF shared library information.
17163 @item IS_COMMON
17164 Section contains common symbols.
17165 @end table
17166 @end table
17167 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17168 @cindex read-only sections
17169 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17170 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17171 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17172 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17173 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17174 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17175 enhancement to debugging performance.
17176
17177 The default is off.
17178
17179 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17180 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17181 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17182 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17183
17184 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17185 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17186 @end table
17187
17188 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17189 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17190 name and remembers it that way.
17191
17192 @cindex shared libraries
17193 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17194 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17195 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17196
17197 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17198 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17199
17200 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17201 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17202 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17203 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17204 debugging a core file).
17205
17206 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17207 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17208
17209 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17210 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17211 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17212
17213 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17214 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17215 particularly large or there are many of them.
17216
17217 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17218 commands:
17219
17220 @table @code
17221 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17222 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17223 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17224 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17225 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17226 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17227 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17228 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17229
17230 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17231 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17232 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17233 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17234 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17235 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17236 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17237 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17238 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17239
17240 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17241 @item show auto-solib-add
17242 Display the current autoloading mode.
17243 @end table
17244
17245 @cindex load shared library
17246 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17247 command:
17248
17249 @table @code
17250 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17251 @kindex info share
17252 @item info share @var{regex}
17253 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17254 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17255 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17256 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17257
17258 @kindex sharedlibrary
17259 @kindex share
17260 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17261 @itemx share @var{regex}
17262 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17263 Unix regular expression.
17264 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17265 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17266 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17267 loaded.
17268
17269 @item nosharedlibrary
17270 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17271 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17272 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17273 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17274 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17275 discarded.
17276 @end table
17277
17278 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17279 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17280 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17281 Catchpoints}).
17282
17283 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17284 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17285 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17286 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17287
17288 @table @code
17289 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17290 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17291 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17292 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17293 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17294 shared library.
17295
17296 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17297 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17298 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17299 library events happen.
17300 @end table
17301
17302 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17303 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17304 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17305 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17306 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17307 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17308 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17309 not.
17310
17311 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17312 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17313 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17314 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17315 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17316
17317 @table @code
17318 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17319 @cindex system root, alternate
17320 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17321 @kindex set sysroot
17322 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17323 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17324 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17325 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17326 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17327 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17328 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17329 under @var{path}.
17330
17331 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17332 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17333 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17334 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17335 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17336 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17337 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17338 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17339 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17340
17341 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17342 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17343 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17344 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17345 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17346
17347 @smallexample
17348 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17349 @end smallexample
17350
17351 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17352 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17353 system:
17354
17355 @smallexample
17356 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17357 @end smallexample
17358
17359 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17360 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17361 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17362 colons:
17363
17364 @smallexample
17365 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17366 @end smallexample
17367
17368 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17369 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17370 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17371 @samp{z}):
17372
17373 @smallexample
17374 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17375 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17376 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17377 @end smallexample
17378
17379 @noindent
17380 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17381 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17382 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17383
17384 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17385 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17386
17387 @smallexample
17388 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17389 @end smallexample
17390
17391 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17392 if you don't want or need to.
17393
17394 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17395 sysroot}.
17396
17397 @cindex default system root
17398 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17399 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17400 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17401 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17402 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17403 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17404 location.
17405
17406 @kindex show sysroot
17407 @item show sysroot
17408 Display the current shared library prefix.
17409
17410 @kindex set solib-search-path
17411 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17412 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17413 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17414 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17415 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17416 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17417 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17418 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17419 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17420 of shared library symbols.
17421
17422 @kindex show solib-search-path
17423 @item show solib-search-path
17424 Display the current shared library search path.
17425
17426 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17427 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17428 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17429 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17430 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17431
17432 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17433 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17434 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17435 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17436 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17437 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17438 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17439 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17440 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17441 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17442 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17443 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17444 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17445 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17446 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17447 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17448 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17449 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17450 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17451 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17452 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17453 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17454
17455 @table @code
17456 @item unix
17457 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17458 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17459 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17460 the forward slash.
17461
17462 @item dos-based
17463 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17464 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17465 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17466 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17467 considered directory separators.
17468
17469 @item auto
17470 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17471 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17472 This is the default.
17473 @end table
17474 @end table
17475
17476 @cindex file name canonicalization
17477 @cindex base name differences
17478 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17479 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17480 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17481 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17482 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17483 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17484 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17485 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17486 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17487 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17488 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17489 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17490 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17491 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17492 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17493
17494 @table @code
17495 @item set basenames-may-differ
17496 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17497 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17498
17499 @item show basenames-may-differ
17500 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17501 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17502 @end table
17503
17504 @node Separate Debug Files
17505 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17506 @cindex separate debugging information files
17507 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17508 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17509 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17510 @cindex global debugging information directories
17511 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17512 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17513
17514 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17515 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17516 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17517 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17518 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17519 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17520 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17521
17522 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17523 file:
17524
17525 @itemize @bullet
17526 @item
17527 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17528 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17529 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17530 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17531 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17532 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17533 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17534 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17535
17536 @item
17537 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17538 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17539 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17540 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17541 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17542 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17543 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17544 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17545 below.
17546 @end itemize
17547
17548 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17549 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17550
17551 @itemize @bullet
17552 @item
17553 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17554 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17555 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17556 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17557 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17558
17559 @item
17560 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17561 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17562 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17563 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17564 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17565 hex characters, not 10.)
17566 @end itemize
17567
17568 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17569 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17570 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17571 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17572 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17573 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17574
17575 @itemize @minus
17576 @item
17577 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17578 @item
17579 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17580 @item
17581 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17582 @item
17583 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17584 @end itemize
17585
17586 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17587 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17588 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17589 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17590 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17591
17592 @table @code
17593
17594 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17595 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17596 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17597 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17598 concatenating them by a path separator.
17599
17600 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17601 @item show debug-file-directory
17602 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17603 information files.
17604
17605 @end table
17606
17607 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17608 @cindex debug link sections
17609 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17610 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17611
17612 @itemize
17613 @item
17614 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17615 a zero byte,
17616 @item
17617 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17618 boundary within the section, and
17619 @item
17620 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17621 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17622 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17623 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17624 @end itemize
17625
17626 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17627 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17628 described above.
17629
17630 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17631 @cindex build ID sections
17632 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17633 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17634 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17635 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17636 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17637 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17638 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17639 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17640 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17641
17642 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17643 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17644 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17645 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17646 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17647 in an ordinary executable.
17648
17649 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17650 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17651 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17652 following commands:
17653
17654 @smallexample
17655 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17656 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17657 @end smallexample
17658
17659 @noindent
17660 These commands remove the debugging
17661 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17662 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17663 two files:
17664
17665 @itemize @bullet
17666 @item
17667 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17668 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17669
17670 @smallexample
17671 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17672 @end smallexample
17673
17674 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17675 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17676 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17677 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17678
17679 @item
17680 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17681 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17682 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17683 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17684 @end itemize
17685
17686 @noindent
17687
17688 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17689 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17690 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17691
17692 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17693 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17694 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17695 @c different ways!
17696 @ifhtml
17697 @display
17698 @html
17699 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17700 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17701 @end html
17702 @end display
17703 @end ifhtml
17704 @ifnothtml
17705 @display
17706 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17707 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17708 @end display
17709 @end ifnothtml
17710
17711 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17712 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17713 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17714 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17715 CRC.
17716
17717 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17718 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
17719 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
17720 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
17721 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17722
17723 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17724 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17725 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17726 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17727 @code{0xffffffff}.
17728
17729 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17730 @smallexample
17731 unsigned long
17732 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17733 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17734 @{
17735 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17736 @{
17737 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17738 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17739 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17740 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17741 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17742 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17743 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17744 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17745 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17746 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17747 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17748 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17749 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17750 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17751 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17752 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17753 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17754 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17755 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17756 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17757 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17758 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17759 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17760 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17761 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17762 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17763 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17764 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17765 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17766 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17767 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17768 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17769 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17770 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17771 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17772 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17773 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17774 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17775 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17776 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17777 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17778 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17779 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17780 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17781 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17782 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17783 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17784 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17785 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17786 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17787 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17788 0x2d02ef8d
17789 @};
17790 unsigned char *end;
17791
17792 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17793 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17794 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17795 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17796 @}
17797 @end smallexample
17798
17799 @noindent
17800 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17801
17802 @node MiniDebugInfo
17803 @section Debugging information in a special section
17804 @cindex separate debug sections
17805 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17806
17807 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17808 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17809 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17810 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17811
17812 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17813 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17814 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17815 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17816 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17817 debugging information might be included in the section.
17818
17819 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17820 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17821 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17822
17823 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17824 standard utilities:
17825
17826 @smallexample
17827 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17828 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17829 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17830 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17831
17832 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17833 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17834 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17835 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17836 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17837 | sort > funcsyms
17838
17839 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17840 # table.
17841 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17842
17843 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17844 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17845
17846 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17847 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17848 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17849 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17850
17851 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17852 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17853
17854 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17855 # original binary.
17856 xz mini_debuginfo
17857 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17858 @end smallexample
17859
17860 @node Index Files
17861 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17862 @cindex index files
17863 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17864
17865 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17866 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17867 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17868 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17869 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17870 startup.
17871
17872 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17873 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17874 using @command{objcopy}.
17875
17876 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17877
17878 @table @code
17879 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17880 @kindex save gdb-index
17881 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17882 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17883 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17884 @var{directory}.
17885 @end table
17886
17887 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17888 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17889
17890 @smallexample
17891 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17892 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17893 @end smallexample
17894
17895 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17896 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17897 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17898 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17899 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17900 The default is @code{off}.
17901 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17902 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17903
17904 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17905 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17906
17907 @smallexample
17908 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17909 @end smallexample
17910
17911 Instead you must do, for example,
17912
17913 @smallexample
17914 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17915 @end smallexample
17916
17917 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17918 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17919 currently work for programs using Ada.
17920
17921 @node Symbol Errors
17922 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17923
17924 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17925 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17926 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17927 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17928 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17929 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17930 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17931 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17932 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17933 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17934 Messages}).
17935
17936 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17937
17938 @table @code
17939 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17940
17941 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17942 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17943 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17944 in its outer scope blocks.
17945
17946 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17947 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17948 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17949 function.
17950
17951 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17952
17953 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17954 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17955 do so.
17956
17957 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17958 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17959 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17960 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17961 Messages}.)
17962
17963 @item bad block start address patched
17964
17965 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17966 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17967 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17968
17969 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17970 starting on the previous source line.
17971
17972 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17973
17974 @cindex foo
17975 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17976 larger than the size of the string table.
17977
17978 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17979 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17980 with this name.
17981
17982 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17983
17984 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17985 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17986 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17987
17988 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17989 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17990 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17991 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17992 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17993 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17994
17995 @item stub type has NULL name
17996
17997 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17998
17999 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18000 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18001 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18002 it.
18003
18004 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18005
18006 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18007
18008 @end table
18009
18010 @node Data Files
18011 @section GDB Data Files
18012
18013 @cindex prefix for data files
18014 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18015 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18016
18017 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18018 is currently using.
18019
18020 @table @code
18021 @kindex set data-directory
18022 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18023 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18024 to @var{directory}.
18025
18026 @kindex show data-directory
18027 @item show data-directory
18028 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18029 @end table
18030
18031 @cindex default data directory
18032 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18033 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18034 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18035 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18036 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18037 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18038 location.
18039
18040 The data directory may also be specified with the
18041 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18042 @xref{Mode Options}.
18043
18044 @node Targets
18045 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18046
18047 @cindex debugging target
18048 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18049
18050 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18051 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18052 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18053 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18054 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18055 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18056 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18057 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18058
18059 @cindex target architecture
18060 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18061 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18062 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18063 command.
18064
18065 @table @code
18066 @kindex set architecture
18067 @kindex show architecture
18068 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18069 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18070 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18071 supported architectures.
18072
18073 @item show architecture
18074 Show the current target architecture.
18075
18076 @item set processor
18077 @itemx processor
18078 @kindex set processor
18079 @kindex show processor
18080 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18081 and @code{show architecture}.
18082 @end table
18083
18084 @menu
18085 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18086 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18087 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18088 @end menu
18089
18090 @node Active Targets
18091 @section Active Targets
18092
18093 @cindex stacking targets
18094 @cindex active targets
18095 @cindex multiple targets
18096
18097 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18098 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18099 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18100 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18101 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18102 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18103 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18104 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18105 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18106
18107 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18108 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18109 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18110 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18111
18112 @node Target Commands
18113 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18114
18115 @table @code
18116 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18117 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18118 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18119 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18120 protocol of the target machine.
18121
18122 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18123 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18124 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18125
18126 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18127 after executing the command.
18128
18129 @kindex help target
18130 @item help target
18131 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18132 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18133 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18134
18135 @item help target @var{name}
18136 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18137 select it.
18138
18139 @kindex set gnutarget
18140 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18141 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18142 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18143 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18144 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18145 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18146
18147 @quotation
18148 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18149 you must know the actual BFD name.
18150 @end quotation
18151
18152 @noindent
18153 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18154
18155 @kindex show gnutarget
18156 @item show gnutarget
18157 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18158 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18159 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18160 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18161 @end table
18162
18163 @cindex common targets
18164 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18165 configuration):
18166
18167 @table @code
18168 @kindex target
18169 @item target exec @var{program}
18170 @cindex executable file target
18171 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18172 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18173
18174 @item target core @var{filename}
18175 @cindex core dump file target
18176 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18177 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18178
18179 @item target remote @var{medium}
18180 @cindex remote target
18181 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18182 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18183 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18184
18185 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18186 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18187
18188 @smallexample
18189 target remote /dev/ttya
18190 @end smallexample
18191
18192 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18193 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18194 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18195 clobbered by the download.
18196
18197 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18198 @cindex built-in simulator target
18199 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18200 In general,
18201 @smallexample
18202 target sim
18203 load
18204 run
18205 @end smallexample
18206 @noindent
18207 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18208 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18209 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18210 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18211 Processors}.
18212
18213 @item target native
18214 @cindex native target
18215 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18216 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18217 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18218 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18219
18220 @end table
18221
18222 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18223 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18224
18225 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18226 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18227 various aspects of this process.
18228
18229 @table @code
18230
18231 @item set hash
18232 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18233 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18234 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18235 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18236 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18237 monitor.
18238
18239 @item show hash
18240 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18241 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18242
18243 @item set debug monitor
18244 @kindex set debug monitor
18245 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18246 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18247 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18248
18249 @item show debug monitor
18250 @kindex show debug monitor
18251 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18252 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18253 @end table
18254
18255 @table @code
18256
18257 @kindex load @var{filename}
18258 @item load @var{filename}
18259 @anchor{load}
18260 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18261 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18262 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18263 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18264 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18265 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18266
18267 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18268 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18269 target is @dots{}}''
18270
18271 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18272 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18273 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18274 specifies a fixed address.
18275 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18276
18277 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18278 load programs into flash memory.
18279
18280 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18281 @end table
18282
18283 @node Byte Order
18284 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18285
18286 @cindex choosing target byte order
18287 @cindex target byte order
18288
18289 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18290 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18291 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18292 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18293 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18294 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18295
18296 @table @code
18297 @kindex set endian
18298 @item set endian big
18299 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18300
18301 @item set endian little
18302 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18303
18304 @item set endian auto
18305 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18306 executable.
18307
18308 @item show endian
18309 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18310
18311 @end table
18312
18313 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18314 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18315 target system.
18316
18317
18318 @node Remote Debugging
18319 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18320 @cindex remote debugging
18321
18322 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18323 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18324 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18325 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18326 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18327
18328 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18329 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18330 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18331 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18332 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18333 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18334
18335 Other remote targets may be available in your
18336 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18337
18338 @menu
18339 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18340 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18341 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18342 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18343 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18344 @end menu
18345
18346 @node Connecting
18347 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18348
18349 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18350 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18351 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18352 program as the first argument.
18353
18354 @cindex @code{target remote}
18355 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18356 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18357 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18358 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18359 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18360 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18361
18362 @table @code
18363
18364 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18365 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18366 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18367 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18368
18369 @smallexample
18370 target remote /dev/ttyb
18371 @end smallexample
18372
18373 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18374 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18375 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18376 @code{target} command.
18377
18378 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18379 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18380 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18381 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18382 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18383 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18384 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18385 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18386 target.
18387
18388 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18389 @code{manyfarms}:
18390
18391 @smallexample
18392 target remote manyfarms:2828
18393 @end smallexample
18394
18395 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18396 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18397 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18398 port 1234 on your local machine:
18399
18400 @smallexample
18401 target remote :1234
18402 @end smallexample
18403 @noindent
18404
18405 Note that the colon is still required here.
18406
18407 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18408 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18409 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18410 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18411
18412 @smallexample
18413 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18414 @end smallexample
18415
18416 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18417 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18418 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18419 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18420
18421 @item target remote | @var{command}
18422 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18423 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18424 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18425 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18426 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18427 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18428 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18429 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18430
18431 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18432 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18433 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18434
18435 @end table
18436
18437 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18438 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18439 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18440 need to use @kbd{run}.
18441
18442 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18443 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18444 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18445 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18446 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18447 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18448 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18449
18450 @smallexample
18451 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18452 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18453 @end smallexample
18454
18455 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18456 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18457 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18458 goes back to waiting.
18459
18460 @table @code
18461 @kindex detach (remote)
18462 @item detach
18463 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18464 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18465 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18466 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18467 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18468
18469 @kindex disconnect
18470 @item disconnect
18471 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18472 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18473 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18474 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18475 another target.
18476
18477 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18478 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18479 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18480 @kindex monitor
18481 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18482 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18483 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18484 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18485 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18486 and implement.
18487 @end table
18488
18489 @node File Transfer
18490 @section Sending files to a remote system
18491 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18492 @cindex file transfer
18493 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18494
18495 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18496 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18497 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18498 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18499 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18500 the only way to upload or download files.
18501
18502 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18503
18504 @table @code
18505 @kindex remote put
18506 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18507 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18508 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18509
18510 @kindex remote get
18511 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18512 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18513 on the host system.
18514
18515 @kindex remote delete
18516 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18517 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18518
18519 @end table
18520
18521 @node Server
18522 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18523
18524 @kindex gdbserver
18525 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18526 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18527 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18528 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18529
18530 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18531 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18532 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18533 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18534 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18535 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18536 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18537 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18538 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18539 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18540 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18541 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18542 choice for debugging.
18543
18544 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18545 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18546 protocol.
18547
18548 @quotation
18549 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18550 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18551 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18552 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18553 @code{gdbserver}.
18554 @end quotation
18555
18556 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18557 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18558 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18559
18560 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18561 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18562 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18563 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18564 system does all the symbol handling.
18565
18566 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18567 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18568 syntax is:
18569
18570 @smallexample
18571 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18572 @end smallexample
18573
18574 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18575 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18576 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18577 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18578 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18579 @file{/dev/com1}:
18580
18581 @smallexample
18582 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18583 @end smallexample
18584
18585 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18586 with it.
18587
18588 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18589
18590 @smallexample
18591 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18592 @end smallexample
18593
18594 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18595 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18596 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18597 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18598 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18599 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18600 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18601 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18602 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18603 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18604 @code{target remote} command.
18605
18606 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18607 with ssh:
18608
18609 @smallexample
18610 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18611 @end smallexample
18612
18613 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18614 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18615 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18616 You could elide it if you want to.
18617
18618 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18619 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18620 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18621 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18622
18623 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18624 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18625 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18626
18627 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18628 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18629
18630 @smallexample
18631 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18632 @end smallexample
18633
18634 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18635 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18636
18637 @pindex pidof
18638 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18639 @code{pidof} utility:
18640
18641 @smallexample
18642 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18643 @end smallexample
18644
18645 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18646 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18647 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18648
18649 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18650 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18651 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18652
18653 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18654 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18655 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18656 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18657
18658 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18659 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18660 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18661 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18662 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18663 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18664 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18665 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18666 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18667
18668 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18669 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18670 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18671 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18672 the program you want to debug.
18673
18674 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18675 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18676 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18677 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18678 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18679 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18680
18681 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18682
18683 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18684
18685 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18686 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18687 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18688 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18689 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18690 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18691 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18692 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18693
18694 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18695 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18696 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18697
18698 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18699 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18700 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18701 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18702 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18703 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18704 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18705 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18706 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18707 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18708 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18709 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18710
18711 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18712 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18713
18714 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18715 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18716 status information about the debugging process.
18717 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18718 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18719 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18720 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18721
18722 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18723 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18724 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18725 Possible options are:
18726
18727 @table @code
18728 @item none
18729 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18730 @item all
18731 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18732 @item timestamps
18733 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18734 @end table
18735
18736 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18737 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18738
18739 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18740 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18741 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18742 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18743 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18744
18745 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18746 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18747 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18748 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18749
18750 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18751 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18752 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18753 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18754
18755 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18756 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18757 environment:
18758
18759 @smallexample
18760 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18761 @end smallexample
18762
18763 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18764
18765 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18766
18767 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18768 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18769 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18770 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18771
18772 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18773 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18774 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18775 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18776 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18777 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18778 programs.
18779
18780 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18781 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18782 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18783 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18784 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18785 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18786 already on the target.
18787
18788 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18789 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18790 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18791
18792 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18793 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18794 Here are the available commands.
18795
18796 @table @code
18797 @item monitor help
18798 List the available monitor commands.
18799
18800 @item monitor set debug 0
18801 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18802 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18803
18804 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18805 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18806 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18807 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18808
18809 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18810 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18811 Possible options are:
18812
18813 @table @code
18814 @item none
18815 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18816 @item all
18817 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18818 @item timestamps
18819 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18820 @end table
18821
18822 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18823 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18824
18825 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18826 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18827 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18828 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18829 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18830 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18831
18832 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18833 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18834
18835 @item monitor exit
18836 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18837 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18838 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18839 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18840 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18841
18842 @end table
18843
18844 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18845 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18846
18847 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18848 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18849
18850 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18851 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18852 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18853 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18854 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18855 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18856 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18857 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18858 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18859 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18860 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18861 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18862
18863 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18864
18865 @table @code
18866 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18867
18868 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18869 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18870 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18871
18872 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18873
18874 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18875 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18876 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18877 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18878 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18879 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18880
18881 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18882
18883 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18884 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18885 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18886 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18887 command for that. For example:
18888
18889 @smallexample
18890 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18891 @end smallexample
18892
18893 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18894 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18895 @end table
18896
18897 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18898 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18899 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18900 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18901 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18902 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18903 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18904 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18905 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18906 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18907
18908 @smallexample
18909 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18910 @end smallexample
18911
18912 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18913
18914 @smallexample
18915 $ gdb myprogram
18916 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18917 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18918 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18919 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18920 @end smallexample
18921
18922 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18923 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18924 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18925 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18926 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18927 tracing.
18928
18929 @node Remote Configuration
18930 @section Remote Configuration
18931
18932 @kindex set remote
18933 @kindex show remote
18934 This section documents the configuration options available when
18935 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18936 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18937 system-call-allowed}.
18938
18939 @table @code
18940 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18941 @cindex address size for remote targets
18942 @cindex bits in remote address
18943 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18944 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18945 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18946 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18947
18948 @item show remoteaddresssize
18949 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18950
18951 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18952 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18953 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18954 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18955 remote targets.
18956
18957 @item show serial baud
18958 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18959
18960 @item set remotebreak
18961 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18962 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18963 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18964 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18965 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18966 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18967 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18968 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18969
18970 @item show remotebreak
18971 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18972 interrupt the remote program.
18973
18974 @item set remoteflow on
18975 @itemx set remoteflow off
18976 @kindex set remoteflow
18977 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18978 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18979
18980 @item show remoteflow
18981 @kindex show remoteflow
18982 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18983
18984 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18985 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18986 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18987 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18988 @code{ascii}.
18989
18990 @item show remotelogbase
18991 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18992 protocol.
18993
18994 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18995 @cindex record serial communications on file
18996 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18997 default is not to record at all.
18998
18999 @item show remotelogfile.
19000 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19001 serial communications.
19002
19003 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19004 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19005 @cindex remote timeout
19006 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19007 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19008
19009 @item show remotetimeout
19010 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19011 responses.
19012
19013 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19014 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19015 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19016 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19017 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19018 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19019 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19020 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19021
19022 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19023 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19024 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19025 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19026 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19027 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19028 as unlimited.
19029
19030 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19031 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19032 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19033
19034 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19035 @itemx show remote exec-file
19036 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19037 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19038 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19039 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19040 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19041 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19042
19043 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19044 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19045 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19046 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19047 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19048 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19049 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19050 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19051 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19052 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19053
19054 @item show interrupt-sequence
19055 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19056 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19057 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19058 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19059
19060 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19061 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19062 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19063 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19064 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19065 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19066
19067 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19068 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19069 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19070
19071 @kindex set tcp
19072 @kindex show tcp
19073 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19074 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19075 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19076 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19077 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19078 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19079 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19080 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19081 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19082
19083 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19084 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19085
19086 @item show tcp auto-retry
19087 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19088
19089 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19090 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19091 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19092 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19093 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19094 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19095 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19096 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19097 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19098 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19099 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19100
19101 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19102 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19103 @end table
19104
19105 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19106 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19107 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19108 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19109 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19110 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19111 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19112 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19113 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19114
19115 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19116 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19117 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19118 @value{GDBN} developers.
19119
19120 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19121 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19122 are:
19123
19124 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19125 @item Command Name
19126 @tab Remote Packet
19127 @tab Related Features
19128
19129 @item @code{fetch-register}
19130 @tab @code{p}
19131 @tab @code{info registers}
19132
19133 @item @code{set-register}
19134 @tab @code{P}
19135 @tab @code{set}
19136
19137 @item @code{binary-download}
19138 @tab @code{X}
19139 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19140
19141 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19142 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19143 @tab @code{info auxv}
19144
19145 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19146 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19147 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19148
19149 @item @code{attach}
19150 @tab @code{vAttach}
19151 @tab @code{attach}
19152
19153 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19154 @tab @code{vCont}
19155 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19156
19157 @item @code{run}
19158 @tab @code{vRun}
19159 @tab @code{run}
19160
19161 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19162 @tab @code{Z0}
19163 @tab @code{break}
19164
19165 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19166 @tab @code{Z1}
19167 @tab @code{hbreak}
19168
19169 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19170 @tab @code{Z2}
19171 @tab @code{watch}
19172
19173 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19174 @tab @code{Z3}
19175 @tab @code{rwatch}
19176
19177 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19178 @tab @code{Z4}
19179 @tab @code{awatch}
19180
19181 @item @code{target-features}
19182 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19183 @tab @code{set architecture}
19184
19185 @item @code{library-info}
19186 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19187 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19188
19189 @item @code{memory-map}
19190 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19191 @tab @code{info mem}
19192
19193 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19194 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19195 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19196
19197 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19198 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19199 @tab @code{info spu}
19200
19201 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19202 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19203 @tab @code{info spu}
19204
19205 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19206 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19207 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19208
19209 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19210 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19211 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19212
19213 @item @code{threads}
19214 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19215 @tab @code{info threads}
19216
19217 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19218 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19219 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19220
19221 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19222 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19223 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19224
19225 @item @code{search-memory}
19226 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19227 @tab @code{find}
19228
19229 @item @code{supported-packets}
19230 @tab @code{qSupported}
19231 @tab Remote communications parameters
19232
19233 @item @code{pass-signals}
19234 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19235 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19236
19237 @item @code{program-signals}
19238 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19239 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19240
19241 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19242 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19243 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19244
19245 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19246 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19247 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19248
19249 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19250 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19251 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19252
19253 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19254 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19255 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19256
19257 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19258 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19259 @tab @code{remote delete}
19260
19261 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19262 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19263 @tab Host I/O
19264
19265 @item @code{noack-packet}
19266 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19267 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19268
19269 @item @code{osdata}
19270 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19271 @tab @code{info os}
19272
19273 @item @code{query-attached}
19274 @tab @code{qAttached}
19275 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19276
19277 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19278 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19279 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19280
19281 @item @code{trace-status}
19282 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19283 @tab @code{tstatus}
19284
19285 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19286 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19287 @tab Traceframe info
19288
19289 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19290 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19291 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19292
19293 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19294 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19295 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19296
19297 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19298 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19299 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19300 @end multitable
19301
19302 @node Remote Stub
19303 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19304
19305 @cindex debugging stub, example
19306 @cindex remote stub, example
19307 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19308 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19309 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19310 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19311 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19312 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19313 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19314 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19315
19316 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19317 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19318 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19319 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19320 program, you need:
19321
19322 @enumerate
19323 @item
19324 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19325 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19326 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19327
19328 @item
19329 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19330 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19331
19332 @item
19333 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19334 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19335 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19336 documentation.
19337 @end enumerate
19338
19339 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19340 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19341 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19342
19343 @table @emph
19344 @item On the host,
19345 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19346 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19347 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19348
19349 @item On the target,
19350 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19351 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19352 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19353
19354 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19355 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19356 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19357 @end table
19358
19359 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19360 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19361 @sc{sparc} boards.
19362
19363 @cindex remote serial stub list
19364 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19365
19366 @table @code
19367
19368 @item i386-stub.c
19369 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19370 @cindex Intel
19371 @cindex i386
19372 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19373
19374 @item m68k-stub.c
19375 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19376 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19377 @cindex m680x0
19378 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19379
19380 @item sh-stub.c
19381 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19382 @cindex Renesas
19383 @cindex SH
19384 For Renesas SH architectures.
19385
19386 @item sparc-stub.c
19387 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19388 @cindex Sparc
19389 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19390
19391 @item sparcl-stub.c
19392 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19393 @cindex Fujitsu
19394 @cindex SparcLite
19395 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19396
19397 @end table
19398
19399 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19400 recently added stubs.
19401
19402 @menu
19403 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19404 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19405 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19406 @end menu
19407
19408 @node Stub Contents
19409 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19410
19411 @cindex remote serial stub
19412 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19413 subroutines:
19414
19415 @table @code
19416 @item set_debug_traps
19417 @findex set_debug_traps
19418 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19419 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19420 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19421 program's startup code.
19422
19423 @item handle_exception
19424 @findex handle_exception
19425 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19426 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19427 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19428 run when a trap is triggered.
19429
19430 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19431 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19432 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19433 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19434 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19435 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19436 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19437 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19438 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19439 machine.
19440
19441 @item breakpoint
19442 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19443 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19444 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19445 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19446 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19447 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19448 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19449 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19450 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19451 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19452 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19453
19454 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19455 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19456 start of your debugging session.
19457 @end table
19458
19459 @node Bootstrapping
19460 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19461
19462 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19463 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19464 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19465 debugging target machine.
19466
19467 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19468 serial port.
19469
19470 @table @code
19471 @item int getDebugChar()
19472 @findex getDebugChar
19473 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19474 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19475 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19476
19477 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19478 @findex putDebugChar
19479 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19480 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19481 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19482 @end table
19483
19484 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19485 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19486 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19487 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19488 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19489 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19490 remote system to stop.
19491
19492 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19493 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19494 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19495 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19496
19497 Other routines you need to supply are:
19498
19499 @table @code
19500 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19501 @findex exceptionHandler
19502 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19503 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19504 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19505 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19506 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19507 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19508 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19509 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19510 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19511 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19512 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19513 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19514 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19515
19516 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19517 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19518 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19519 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19520 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19521
19522 @item void flush_i_cache()
19523 @findex flush_i_cache
19524 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19525 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19526 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19527
19528 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19529 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19530 @end table
19531
19532 @noindent
19533 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19534
19535 @table @code
19536 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19537 @findex memset
19538 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19539 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19540 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19541 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19542 @end table
19543
19544 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19545 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19546 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19547 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19548
19549
19550 @node Debug Session
19551 @subsection Putting it All Together
19552
19553 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19554 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19555 steps.
19556
19557 @enumerate
19558 @item
19559 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19560 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19561 @display
19562 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19563 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19564 @end display
19565
19566 @item
19567 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19568 procedure is called:
19569
19570 @smallexample
19571 set_debug_traps();
19572 breakpoint();
19573 @end smallexample
19574
19575 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19576 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19577 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19578 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19579 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19580 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19581 progress.
19582
19583 @item
19584 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19585 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19586
19587 @smallexample
19588 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19589 @end smallexample
19590
19591 @noindent
19592 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19593 function in your program, that function is called when
19594 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19595 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19596 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19597
19598 @item
19599 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19600 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19601
19602 @item
19603 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19604 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19605
19606 @item
19607 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19608 @c document that. FIXME.
19609 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19610 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19611
19612 @item
19613 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19614 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19615
19616 @end enumerate
19617
19618 @node Configurations
19619 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19620
19621 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19622 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19623 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19624
19625 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19626 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19627 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19628 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19629 are quite different from each other.
19630
19631 @menu
19632 * Native::
19633 * Embedded OS::
19634 * Embedded Processors::
19635 * Architectures::
19636 @end menu
19637
19638 @node Native
19639 @section Native
19640
19641 This section describes details specific to particular native
19642 configurations.
19643
19644 @menu
19645 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19646 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19647 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19648 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19649 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19650 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19651 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19652 @end menu
19653
19654 @node HP-UX
19655 @subsection HP-UX
19656
19657 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19658 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19659 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19660
19661
19662 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19663 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19664
19665 @cindex libkvm
19666 @cindex kernel memory image
19667 @cindex kernel crash dump
19668
19669 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19670 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19671 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19672 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19673 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19674 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19675 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19676 @code{kvm} target:
19677
19678 @smallexample
19679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19680 @end smallexample
19681
19682 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19683 argument:
19684
19685 @smallexample
19686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19687 @end smallexample
19688
19689 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19690 available:
19691
19692 @table @code
19693 @kindex kvm
19694 @item kvm pcb
19695 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19696
19697 @item kvm proc
19698 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19699 modern FreeBSD systems.
19700 @end table
19701
19702 @node SVR4 Process Information
19703 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19704 @cindex /proc
19705 @cindex examine process image
19706 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19707
19708 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19709 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19710 process using file-system subroutines.
19711
19712 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19713 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19714 information about the process running your program, or about any
19715 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19716 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19717 not HP-UX, for example.
19718
19719 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19720 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19721
19722 @table @code
19723 @kindex info proc
19724 @cindex process ID
19725 @item info proc
19726 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19727 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19728 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19729 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19730 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19731 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19732 executable file's absolute file name.
19733
19734 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19735 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19736 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19737 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19738 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19739 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19740
19741 @item info proc cmdline
19742 @cindex info proc cmdline
19743 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19744 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19745
19746 @item info proc cwd
19747 @cindex info proc cwd
19748 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19749 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19750
19751 @item info proc exe
19752 @cindex info proc exe
19753 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19754 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19755
19756 @item info proc mappings
19757 @cindex memory address space mappings
19758 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19759 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19760 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19761 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19762 memory access rights to that range.
19763
19764 @item info proc stat
19765 @itemx info proc status
19766 @cindex process detailed status information
19767 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19768 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19769 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19770 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19771 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19772 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19773 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19774
19775 @item info proc all
19776 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19777 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19778
19779 @ignore
19780 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19781 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19782 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19783 @kindex info proc times
19784 @item info proc times
19785 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19786 its children.
19787
19788 @kindex info proc id
19789 @item info proc id
19790 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19791 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19792 @end ignore
19793
19794 @item set procfs-trace
19795 @kindex set procfs-trace
19796 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19797 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19798
19799 @item show procfs-trace
19800 @kindex show procfs-trace
19801 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19802
19803 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19804 @kindex set procfs-file
19805 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19806 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19807 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19808 standard output.
19809
19810 @item show procfs-file
19811 @kindex show procfs-file
19812 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19813
19814 @item proc-trace-entry
19815 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19816 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19817 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19818 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19819 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19820 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19821 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19822 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19823 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19824
19825 @item info pidlist
19826 @kindex info pidlist
19827 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19828 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19829 processes and all the threads within each process.
19830
19831 @item info meminfo
19832 @kindex info meminfo
19833 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19834 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19835 @end table
19836
19837 @node DJGPP Native
19838 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19839 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19840 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19841 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19842
19843 @cindex DPMI
19844 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19845 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19846 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19847 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19848
19849 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19850 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19851 subsection describes those commands.
19852
19853 @table @code
19854 @kindex info dos
19855 @item info dos
19856 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19857 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19858
19859 @kindex sysinfo
19860 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19861 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19862 @item info dos sysinfo
19863 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19864 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19865 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19866
19867 @cindex GDT
19868 @cindex LDT
19869 @cindex IDT
19870 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19871 @cindex descriptor tables display
19872 @item info dos gdt
19873 @itemx info dos ldt
19874 @itemx info dos idt
19875 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19876 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19877 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19878 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19879 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19880 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19881 rights.
19882
19883 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19884 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19885 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19886 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19887 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19888
19889 @cindex garbled pointers
19890 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19891 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19892 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19893 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19894 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19895 debugged program's data segment:
19896
19897 @smallexample
19898 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19899 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19900 @end smallexample
19901
19902 @noindent
19903 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19904 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19905
19906 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19907 @item info dos pde
19908 @itemx info dos pte
19909 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19910 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19911 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19912 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19913 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19914 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19915 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19916 that is currently in use.
19917
19918 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19919 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19920 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19921 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19922 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19923 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19924 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19925
19926 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19927 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19928 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19929 controller.
19930
19931 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19932
19933 @cindex physical address from linear address
19934 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19935 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19936 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19937 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19938 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19939 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19940 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19941
19942 @smallexample
19943 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19944 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19945 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19946 @end smallexample
19947
19948 @noindent
19949 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19950 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19951 attributes of that page.
19952
19953 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19954 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19955 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19956 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19957 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19958 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19959
19960 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19961 transfer buffer:
19962
19963 @smallexample
19964 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19965 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19966 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19967 @end smallexample
19968
19969 @noindent
19970 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19971 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19972 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19973 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19974 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19975
19976 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19977 @end table
19978
19979 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19980 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19981 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19982 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19983
19984 @table @code
19985 @kindex set com1base
19986 @kindex set com1irq
19987 @kindex set com2base
19988 @kindex set com2irq
19989 @kindex set com3base
19990 @kindex set com3irq
19991 @kindex set com4base
19992 @kindex set com4irq
19993 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19994 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19995 port.
19996
19997 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19998 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19999 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20000
20001 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20002 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20003 other 3 COM ports.
20004
20005 @kindex show com1base
20006 @kindex show com1irq
20007 @kindex show com2base
20008 @kindex show com2irq
20009 @kindex show com3base
20010 @kindex show com3irq
20011 @kindex show com4base
20012 @kindex show com4irq
20013 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20014 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20015 lines used by the COM ports.
20016
20017 @item info serial
20018 @kindex info serial
20019 @cindex DOS serial port status
20020 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20021 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20022 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20023 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20024 @end table
20025
20026
20027 @node Cygwin Native
20028 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20029 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20030 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20031 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20032
20033 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20034 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20035
20036 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20037 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20038 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20039 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20040 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20041 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20042 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20043 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20044
20045 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20046 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20047 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20048
20049 @table @code
20050 @kindex info w32
20051 @item info w32
20052 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20053 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20054
20055 @item info w32 selector
20056 This command displays information returned by
20057 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20058 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20059 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20060 Without argument, this command displays information
20061 about the six segment registers.
20062
20063 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20064 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20065 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20066 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20067
20068 @kindex info dll
20069 @item info dll
20070 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20071
20072 @kindex dll-symbols
20073 @item dll-symbols
20074 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
20075 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
20076
20077 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
20078 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
20079
20080 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20081 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20082 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20083 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20084 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20085 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20086 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20087 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20088 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20089 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20090 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20091
20092 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20093 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20094 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20095 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20096
20097 @kindex set new-console
20098 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20099 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20100 be started in a new console on next start.
20101 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20102 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20103
20104 @kindex show new-console
20105 @item show new-console
20106 Displays whether a new console is used
20107 when the debuggee is started.
20108
20109 @kindex set new-group
20110 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20111 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20112 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20113 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20114 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20115
20116 @kindex show new-group
20117 @item show new-group
20118 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20119
20120 @kindex set debugevents
20121 @item set debugevents
20122 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20123 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20124 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20125 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20126 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20127
20128 @kindex set debugexec
20129 @item set debugexec
20130 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20131 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20132
20133 @kindex set debugexceptions
20134 @item set debugexceptions
20135 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20136 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20137
20138 @kindex set debugmemory
20139 @item set debugmemory
20140 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20141 and writes by the debugger.
20142
20143 @kindex set shell
20144 @item set shell
20145 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20146 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20147
20148 @kindex show shell
20149 @item show shell
20150 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20151
20152 @end table
20153
20154 @menu
20155 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20156 @end menu
20157
20158 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20159 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20160 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20161 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20162
20163 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20164 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20165 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20166 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20167 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20168 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20169 ``minimal symbols''.
20170
20171 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20172 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20173 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20174 program run once to completion.
20175
20176 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20177
20178 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20179 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20180 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20181 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20182 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20183 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20184 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20185 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20186 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20187
20188 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20189 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20190 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20191 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20192 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20193 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20194
20195 @smallexample
20196 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20197 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20198
20199 Non-debugging symbols:
20200 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20201 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20202 @end smallexample
20203
20204 @smallexample
20205 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20206 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20207
20208 Non-debugging symbols:
20209 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20210 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20211 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20212 [etc...]
20213 @end smallexample
20214
20215 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20216
20217 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20218 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20219 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20220 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20221 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20222 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20223 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20224
20225 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20226 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20227 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20228 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20229 problem:
20230
20231 @smallexample
20232 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20233 $1 = 268572168
20234 @end smallexample
20235
20236 @smallexample
20237 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20238 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20239 @end smallexample
20240
20241 And two possible solutions:
20242
20243 @smallexample
20244 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20245 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20246 @end smallexample
20247
20248 @smallexample
20249 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20250 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20251 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20252 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20253 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20254 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20255 @end smallexample
20256
20257 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20258 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20259 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20260 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20261 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20262
20263 @smallexample
20264 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20265 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20266 @end smallexample
20267
20268 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20269 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20270 safe.
20271
20272 @node Hurd Native
20273 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20274 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20275
20276 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20277 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20278
20279 @table @code
20280 @item set signals
20281 @itemx set sigs
20282 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20283 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20284 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20285 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20286 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20287 @code{signals}.
20288
20289 @item show signals
20290 @itemx show sigs
20291 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20292 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20293 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20294
20295 @item set signal-thread
20296 @itemx set sigthread
20297 @kindex set signal-thread
20298 @kindex set sigthread
20299 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20300 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20301 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20302 signal-thread}.
20303
20304 @item show signal-thread
20305 @itemx show sigthread
20306 @kindex show signal-thread
20307 @kindex show sigthread
20308 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20309 delivered a signal.
20310
20311 @item set stopped
20312 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20313 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20314 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20315 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20316
20317 @item show stopped
20318 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20319 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20320 stopped.
20321
20322 @item set exceptions
20323 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20324 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20325 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20326 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20327 trapping on.
20328
20329 @item show exceptions
20330 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20331 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20332
20333 @item set task pause
20334 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20335 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20336 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20337 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20338 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20339 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20340 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20341 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20342 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20343
20344 @item show task pause
20345 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20346 Show the current state of task suspension.
20347
20348 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20349 @cindex task suspend count
20350 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20351 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20352 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20353
20354 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20355 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20356
20357 @item set task exception-port
20358 @itemx set task excp
20359 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20360 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20361 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20362 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20363
20364 @item set noninvasive
20365 @cindex noninvasive task options
20366 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20367 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20368 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20369 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20370
20371 @item info send-rights
20372 @itemx info receive-rights
20373 @itemx info port-rights
20374 @itemx info port-sets
20375 @itemx info dead-names
20376 @itemx info ports
20377 @itemx info psets
20378 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20379 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20380 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20381 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20382 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20383 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20384 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20385 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20386 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20387
20388 @item set thread pause
20389 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20390 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20391 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20392 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20393 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20394 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20395 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20396 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20397 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20398 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20399 only the current thread.
20400
20401 @item show thread pause
20402 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20403 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20404
20405 @item set thread run
20406 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20407
20408 @item show thread run
20409 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20410
20411 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20412 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20413 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20414 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20415 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20416 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20417 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20418
20419 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20420 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20421 detaching.
20422
20423 @item set thread exception-port
20424 @itemx set thread excp
20425 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20426 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20427 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20428
20429 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20430 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20431 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20432 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20433
20434 @item set thread default
20435 @itemx show thread default
20436 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20437 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20438 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20439 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20440 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20441 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20442 the non-default commands.
20443 @end table
20444
20445 @node Darwin
20446 @subsection Darwin
20447 @cindex Darwin
20448
20449 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20450
20451 @table @code
20452 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20453 @kindex set debug darwin
20454 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20455 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20456
20457 @item show debug darwin
20458 @kindex show debug darwin
20459 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20460
20461 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20462 @kindex set debug mach-o
20463 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20464 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20465 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20466 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20467 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20468 usage.
20469
20470 @item show debug mach-o
20471 @kindex show debug mach-o
20472 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20473
20474 @item set mach-exceptions on
20475 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20476 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20477 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20478 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20479 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20480 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20481
20482 @item show mach-exceptions
20483 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20484 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20485 @end table
20486
20487
20488 @node Embedded OS
20489 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20490
20491 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20492 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20493 architectures.
20494
20495 @menu
20496 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20497 @end menu
20498
20499 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20500 various real-time operating systems.
20501
20502 @node VxWorks
20503 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20504
20505 @cindex VxWorks
20506
20507 @table @code
20508
20509 @kindex target vxworks
20510 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
20511 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
20512 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
20513
20514 @end table
20515
20516 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
20517 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
20518
20519 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
20520 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
20521 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20522 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
20523 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
20524 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
20525 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
20526
20527 @table @code
20528 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
20529 @kindex vxworks-timeout
20530 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
20531 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20532 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
20533 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
20534 of a thin network line.
20535 @end table
20536
20537 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
20538 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
20539 procedures.
20540
20541 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
20542 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
20543 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
20544 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
20545 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
20546 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
20547 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
20548 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
20549 manual.
20550 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
20551
20552 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
20553 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20554 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20555 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20556
20557 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20558
20559 @smallexample
20560 (vxgdb)
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 @menu
20564 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20565 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20566 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20567 @end menu
20568
20569 @node VxWorks Connection
20570 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20571
20572 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20573 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20574
20575 @smallexample
20576 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20577 @end smallexample
20578
20579 @need 750
20580 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20581
20582 @smallexample
20583 Attaching remote machine across net...
20584 Connected to tt.
20585 @end smallexample
20586
20587 @need 1000
20588 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20589 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20590 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20591 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20592 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20593
20594 @smallexample
20595 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20596 @end smallexample
20597
20598 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20599 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20600 command again.
20601
20602 @node VxWorks Download
20603 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20604
20605 @cindex download to VxWorks
20606 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20607 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20608 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20609 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20610 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20611 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20612 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20613 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20614 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20615 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20616 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20617 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20618 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20619 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20620 program, type this on VxWorks:
20621
20622 @smallexample
20623 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20624 @end smallexample
20625
20626 @noindent
20627 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20628
20629 @smallexample
20630 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20631 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20632 @end smallexample
20633
20634 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20635
20636 @smallexample
20637 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20638 @end smallexample
20639
20640 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20641 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20642 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20643 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20644 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20645 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20646 table.)
20647
20648 @node VxWorks Attach
20649 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20650
20651 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20652 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20653 follows:
20654
20655 @smallexample
20656 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20657 @end smallexample
20658
20659 @noindent
20660 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20661 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20662 the time of attachment.
20663
20664 @node Embedded Processors
20665 @section Embedded Processors
20666
20667 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20668 configurations.
20669
20670 @cindex send command to simulator
20671 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20672 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20673
20674 @table @code
20675 @item sim @var{command}
20676 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20677 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20678 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20679 acceptable commands.
20680 @end table
20681
20682
20683 @menu
20684 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20685 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20686 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20687 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20688 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20689 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20690 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20691 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20692 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20693 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20694 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20695 * CRIS:: CRIS
20696 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20697 @end menu
20698
20699 @node ARM
20700 @subsection ARM
20701 @cindex ARM RDI
20702
20703 @table @code
20704 @kindex target rdi
20705 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20706 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20707 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20708 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20709
20710 @kindex target rdp
20711 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20712 ARM Demon monitor.
20713
20714 @end table
20715
20716 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20717
20718 @table @code
20719 @item set arm disassembler
20720 @kindex set arm
20721 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20722 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20723
20724 @item show arm disassembler
20725 @kindex show arm
20726 Show the current disassembly style.
20727
20728 @item set arm apcs32
20729 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20730 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20731
20732 @item show arm apcs32
20733 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20734
20735 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20736 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20737 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20738
20739 @table @code
20740 @item auto
20741 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20742 @item softfpa
20743 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20744 processors.
20745 @item fpa
20746 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20747 @item softvfp
20748 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20749 @item vfp
20750 VFP co-processor.
20751 @end table
20752
20753 @item show arm fpu
20754 Show the current type of the FPU.
20755
20756 @item set arm abi
20757 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20758
20759 @item show arm abi
20760 Show the currently used ABI.
20761
20762 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20763 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20764 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20765 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20766 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20767 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20768 register).
20769
20770 @item show arm fallback-mode
20771 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20772
20773 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20774 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20775 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20776 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20777 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20778
20779 @item show arm force-mode
20780 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20781
20782 @item set debug arm
20783 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20784 target support subsystem.
20785
20786 @item show debug arm
20787 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20788 @end table
20789
20790 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20791 using the RDI interface:
20792
20793 @table @code
20794 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20795 @kindex rdilogfile
20796 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20797 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20798 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20799 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20800 @file{rdi.log}.
20801
20802 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20803 @kindex rdilogenable
20804 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20805 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20806 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20807 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20808 are logged to a file.
20809
20810 @item set rdiromatzero
20811 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20812 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20813 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20814 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20815 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20816 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20817
20818 @item show rdiromatzero
20819 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20820 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20821
20822 @item set rdiheartbeat
20823 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20824 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20825 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20826 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20827 well as the Angel monitor.
20828
20829 @item show rdiheartbeat
20830 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20831 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20832 @end table
20833
20834 @table @code
20835 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20836 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20837
20838 @table @code
20839 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20840 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
20841 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20842 The default value is @code{all}.
20843
20844 @table @code
20845 @item none
20846 @item demon
20847 @item angel
20848 @item redboot
20849 @item all
20850 @end table
20851 @end table
20852 @end table
20853
20854 @node M32R/D
20855 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20856
20857 @table @code
20858 @kindex target m32r
20859 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20860 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20861
20862 @kindex target m32rsdi
20863 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20864 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20865 @end table
20866
20867 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20868
20869 @table @code
20870 @item set download-path @var{path}
20871 @kindex set download-path
20872 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20873 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20874
20875 @item show download-path
20876 @kindex show download-path
20877 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20878
20879 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20880 @kindex set board-address
20881 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20882 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20883
20884 @item show board-address
20885 @kindex show board-address
20886 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20887
20888 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20889 @kindex set server-address
20890 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20891 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20892 host machine.
20893
20894 @item show server-address
20895 @kindex show server-address
20896 Display the IP address of the download server.
20897
20898 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20899 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20900 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20901 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20902 executable file is uploaded.
20903
20904 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20905 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20906 Test the @code{upload} command.
20907 @end table
20908
20909 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20910
20911 @table @code
20912 @item sdireset
20913 @kindex sdireset
20914 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20915 This command resets the SDI connection.
20916
20917 @item sdistatus
20918 @kindex sdistatus
20919 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20920
20921 @item debug_chaos
20922 @kindex debug_chaos
20923 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20924 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20925
20926 @item use_debug_dma
20927 @kindex use_debug_dma
20928 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20929
20930 @item use_mon_code
20931 @kindex use_mon_code
20932 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20933
20934 @item use_ib_break
20935 @kindex use_ib_break
20936 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20937
20938 @item use_dbt_break
20939 @kindex use_dbt_break
20940 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20941 @end table
20942
20943 @node M68K
20944 @subsection M68k
20945
20946 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20947 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20948
20949 @table @code
20950
20951 @kindex target dbug
20952 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20953 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20954
20955 @end table
20956
20957 @node MicroBlaze
20958 @subsection MicroBlaze
20959 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20960 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20961
20962 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20963 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20964 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20965 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20966 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20967 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20968 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20969 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20970 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20971 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20972 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20973
20974 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20975
20976 @table @code
20977 @item target remote :1234
20978 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20979 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20980
20981 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20982 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20983 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20984
20985 @item load
20986 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20987
20988 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20989 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20990
20991 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20992 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20993 @end table
20994
20995 @node MIPS Embedded
20996 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20997
20998 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20999 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21000 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21001 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21002
21003 @need 1000
21004 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21005
21006 @table @code
21007 @item target mips @var{port}
21008 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21009 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21010 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21011 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21012 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21013 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21014 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21015
21016 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21017 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21018 debugger:
21019
21020 @smallexample
21021 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21022 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21023 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21024 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21025 (@value{GDBP}) run
21026 @end smallexample
21027
21028 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21029 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21030 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21031 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21032 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21033
21034 @item target pmon @var{port}
21035 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21036 PMON ROM monitor.
21037
21038 @item target ddb @var{port}
21039 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21040 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21041
21042 @item target lsi @var{port}
21043 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21044 LSI variant of PMON.
21045
21046 @kindex target r3900
21047 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21048 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21049
21050 @kindex target array
21051 @item target array @var{dev}
21052 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21053
21054 @end table
21055
21056
21057 @noindent
21058 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21059
21060 @table @code
21061 @item set mipsfpu double
21062 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21063 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21064 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21065 @itemx show mipsfpu
21066 @kindex set mipsfpu
21067 @kindex show mipsfpu
21068 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21069 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21070 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21071 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21072 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21073 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21074 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21075 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21076 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21077 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21078 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21079 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21080 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21081
21082 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21083 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21084 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21085
21086 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21087 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21088
21089 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21090 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21091 @itemx show timeout
21092 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21093 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21094 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21095 @kindex set timeout
21096 @kindex show timeout
21097 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21098 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21099 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21100 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21101 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21102 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21103 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21104 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21105 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21106 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21107
21108 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21109 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21110 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21111 to run before stopping.
21112
21113 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21114 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21115 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21116 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21117 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21118 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21119
21120 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21121 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21122 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21123 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21124
21125 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21126 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21127 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21128 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21129 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21130 @table @asis
21131 @item pmon target
21132 @samp{PMON}
21133 @item ddb target
21134 @samp{NEC010}
21135 @item lsi target
21136 @samp{PMON>}
21137 @end table
21138
21139 @item show monitor-prompt
21140 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21141 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21142 remote monitor.
21143
21144 @item set monitor-warnings
21145 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21146 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21147 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21148 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21149 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21150
21151 @item show monitor-warnings
21152 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21153 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21154
21155 @item pmon @var{command}
21156 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21157 @cindex send PMON command
21158 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21159 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21160 @end table
21161
21162 @node PowerPC Embedded
21163 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21164
21165 @cindex DVC register
21166 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21167 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21168
21169 @smallexample
21170 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21171 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21172 @end smallexample
21173
21174 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21175 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21176 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21177 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21178 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21179 or newer.
21180
21181 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21182 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21183 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21184 watching variables of scalar types.
21185
21186 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21187 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21188
21189 @smallexample
21190 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21191 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21192 @end smallexample
21193
21194 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21195 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21196
21197 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21198 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21199 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21200 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21201 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21202 use the @code{break-range} command.
21203
21204 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21205
21206 @table @code
21207 @kindex break-range
21208 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21209 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21210 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21211 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21212 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21213 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21214 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21215 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21216 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21217
21218 @kindex set powerpc
21219 @item set powerpc soft-float
21220 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21221 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21222 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21223 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21224
21225 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21226 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21227 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21228 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21229 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21230 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21231 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21232 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21233
21234 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21235 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21236 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21237 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21238 address of its first byte.
21239
21240 @kindex target dink32
21241 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21242 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21243
21244 @kindex target ppcbug
21245 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21246 @kindex target ppcbug1
21247 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21248 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21249
21250 @kindex target sds
21251 @item target sds @var{dev}
21252 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21253 @end table
21254
21255 @cindex SDS protocol
21256 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21257 by @value{GDBN}:
21258
21259 @table @code
21260 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21261 @kindex set sdstimeout
21262 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21263 default is 2 seconds.
21264
21265 @item show sdstimeout
21266 @kindex show sdstimeout
21267 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21268
21269 @item sds @var{command}
21270 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21271 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21272 @end table
21273
21274
21275 @node PA
21276 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21277
21278 @table @code
21279
21280 @kindex target op50n
21281 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21282 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21283
21284 @kindex target w89k
21285 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21286 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21287
21288 @end table
21289
21290 @node Sparclet
21291 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21292
21293 @cindex Sparclet
21294
21295 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21296 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21297 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21298 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21299 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21300
21301 @table @code
21302 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21303 @kindex remotetimeout
21304 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21305 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21306 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21307 @end table
21308
21309 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21310 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21311 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21312 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21313 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21314
21315 @smallexample
21316 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21317 @end smallexample
21318
21319 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21320
21321 @smallexample
21322 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21323 @end smallexample
21324
21325 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21326 Once you have set
21327 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21328 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21329 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21330
21331 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21332
21333 @smallexample
21334 (gdbslet)
21335 @end smallexample
21336
21337 @menu
21338 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21339 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21340 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21341 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21342 @end menu
21343
21344 @node Sparclet File
21345 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21346
21347 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21348
21349 @smallexample
21350 (gdbslet) file prog
21351 @end smallexample
21352
21353 @need 1000
21354 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21355 @value{GDBN} locates
21356 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21357 path.
21358 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21359 files will be searched as well.
21360 @value{GDBN} locates
21361 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21362 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21363 If it fails
21364 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21365
21366 @smallexample
21367 prog: No such file or directory.
21368 @end smallexample
21369
21370 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21371 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21372 @code{target} command again.
21373
21374 @node Sparclet Connection
21375 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21376
21377 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21378 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21379
21380 @smallexample
21381 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21382 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21383 main () at ../prog.c:3
21384 @end smallexample
21385
21386 @need 750
21387 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21388
21389 @smallexample
21390 Connected to ttya.
21391 @end smallexample
21392
21393 @node Sparclet Download
21394 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21395
21396 @cindex download to Sparclet
21397 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21398 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21399 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21400 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21401 command.
21402 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21403 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21404 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21405 of each of the file's sections.
21406 For instance, if the program
21407 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21408 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21409
21410 @smallexample
21411 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21412 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21413 @end smallexample
21414
21415 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21416 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21417 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21418
21419 @node Sparclet Execution
21420 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21421
21422 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21423 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21424 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21425 manual for the list of commands.
21426
21427 @smallexample
21428 (gdbslet) b main
21429 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21430 (gdbslet) run
21431 Starting program: prog
21432 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21433 3 char *symarg = 0;
21434 (gdbslet) step
21435 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21436 (gdbslet)
21437 @end smallexample
21438
21439 @node Sparclite
21440 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21441
21442 @table @code
21443
21444 @kindex target sparclite
21445 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21446 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21447 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21448 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21449 remote protocol.
21450
21451 @end table
21452
21453 @node Z8000
21454 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21455
21456 @cindex Z8000
21457 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21458 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21459
21460 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21461 a Z8000 simulator.
21462
21463 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21464 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21465 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21466 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21467
21468 @table @code
21469 @item target sim @var{args}
21470 @kindex sim
21471 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21472 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21473 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21474 @end table
21475
21476 @noindent
21477 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21478 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21479 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21480 to run your program, and so on.
21481
21482 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21483 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21484 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21485
21486 @table @code
21487
21488 @item cycles
21489 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21490
21491 @item insts
21492 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21493
21494 @item time
21495 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21496
21497 @end table
21498
21499 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21500 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21501 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21502 simulated clock ticks.
21503
21504 @node AVR
21505 @subsection Atmel AVR
21506 @cindex AVR
21507
21508 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21509 following AVR-specific commands:
21510
21511 @table @code
21512 @item info io_registers
21513 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21514 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21515 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21516 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21517 @end table
21518
21519 @node CRIS
21520 @subsection CRIS
21521 @cindex CRIS
21522
21523 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21524 following CRIS-specific commands:
21525
21526 @table @code
21527 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21528 @cindex CRIS version
21529 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21530 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21531 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21532
21533 @item show cris-version
21534 Show the current CRIS version.
21535
21536 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21537 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21538 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21539 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21540 @code{R59}.
21541
21542 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21543 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21544
21545 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21546 @cindex CRIS mode
21547 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21548 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21549 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21550
21551 @item show cris-mode
21552 Show the current CRIS mode.
21553 @end table
21554
21555 @node Super-H
21556 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21557 @cindex Super-H
21558
21559 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21560 commands:
21561
21562 @table @code
21563 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21564 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21565 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21566 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21567 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21568 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21569 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21570 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21571 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21572 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21573 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21574 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21575
21576 @item show sh calling-convention
21577 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21578 Show the current calling convention setting.
21579
21580 @end table
21581
21582
21583 @node Architectures
21584 @section Architectures
21585
21586 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21587 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21588
21589 @menu
21590 * AArch64::
21591 * i386::
21592 * Alpha::
21593 * MIPS::
21594 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21595 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21596 * PowerPC::
21597 * Nios II::
21598 @end menu
21599
21600 @node AArch64
21601 @subsection AArch64
21602 @cindex AArch64 support
21603
21604 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21605 following special commands:
21606
21607 @table @code
21608 @item set debug aarch64
21609 @kindex set debug aarch64
21610 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21611 messages are to be displayed.
21612
21613 @item show debug aarch64
21614 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21615
21616 @end table
21617
21618 @node i386
21619 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21620
21621 @table @code
21622 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21623 @kindex set struct-convention
21624 @cindex struct return convention
21625 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21626 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21627 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21628 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21629 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21630 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21631 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21632 be returned in a register.
21633
21634 @item show struct-convention
21635 @kindex show struct-convention
21636 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21637 from functions.
21638 @end table
21639
21640 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21641 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21642
21643 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21644 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21645 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21646 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21647 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21648 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21649 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21650
21651 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21652 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21653 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21654 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21655 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21656 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21657
21658 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21659 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21660 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21661
21662 @smallexample
21663 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21664 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21665 @end smallexample
21666
21667 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21668 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21669 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21670 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21671 the pointer.
21672
21673 @node Alpha
21674 @subsection Alpha
21675
21676 See the following section.
21677
21678 @node MIPS
21679 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21680
21681 @cindex stack on Alpha
21682 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21683 @cindex Alpha stack
21684 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21685 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21686 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21687 find the beginning of a function.
21688
21689 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21690 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21691 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21692 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21693 commands:
21694
21695 @table @code
21696 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21697 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21698 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21699 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21700 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21701 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21702 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21703 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21704
21705 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21706 Display the current limit.
21707 @end table
21708
21709 @noindent
21710 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21711 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21712
21713 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21714 programs:
21715
21716 @table @code
21717 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21718 @kindex set mips abi
21719 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21720 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21721 values of @var{arg} are:
21722
21723 @table @samp
21724 @item auto
21725 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21726 default).
21727 @item o32
21728 @item o64
21729 @item n32
21730 @item n64
21731 @item eabi32
21732 @item eabi64
21733 @end table
21734
21735 @item show mips abi
21736 @kindex show mips abi
21737 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21738
21739 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21740 @kindex set mips compression
21741 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21742 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21743 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21744 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21745 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21746 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21747 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21748 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21749 provided by the executable.
21750
21751 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21752 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21753 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21754 identified as such.
21755
21756 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21757 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21758 implicitly from an executable.
21759
21760 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21761 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21762 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21763 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21764 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21765
21766 @item show mips compression
21767 @kindex show mips compression
21768 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21769 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21770
21771 @item set mipsfpu
21772 @itemx show mipsfpu
21773 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21774
21775 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21776 @kindex set mips mask-address
21777 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21778 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21779 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21780 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21781 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21782
21783 @item show mips mask-address
21784 @kindex show mips mask-address
21785 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21786 not.
21787
21788 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21789 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21790 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21791 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21792 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21793 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21794
21795 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21796 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21797 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21798
21799 @item set debug mips
21800 @kindex set debug mips
21801 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21802 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21803
21804 @item show debug mips
21805 @kindex show debug mips
21806 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21807 @end table
21808
21809
21810 @node HPPA
21811 @subsection HPPA
21812 @cindex HPPA support
21813
21814 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21815 following special commands:
21816
21817 @table @code
21818 @item set debug hppa
21819 @kindex set debug hppa
21820 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21821 messages are to be displayed.
21822
21823 @item show debug hppa
21824 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21825
21826 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21827 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21828 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21829 given @var{address}.
21830
21831 @end table
21832
21833
21834 @node SPU
21835 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21836 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21837 @cindex SPU
21838
21839 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21840 it provides the following special commands:
21841
21842 @table @code
21843 @item info spu event
21844 @kindex info spu
21845 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21846 and pending event status.
21847
21848 @item info spu signal
21849 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21850 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21851 notification channels.
21852
21853 @item info spu mailbox
21854 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21855 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21856 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21857
21858 @item info spu dma
21859 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21860 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21861 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21862
21863 @item info spu proxydma
21864 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21865 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21866 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21867
21868 @end table
21869
21870 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21871 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21872 special commands:
21873
21874 @table @code
21875 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21876 @kindex set spu
21877 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21878 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21879 function. The default is @code{off}.
21880
21881 @item show spu stop-on-load
21882 @kindex show spu
21883 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21884
21885 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21886 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21887 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21888 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21889 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21890 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21891
21892 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21893 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21894
21895 @end table
21896
21897 @node PowerPC
21898 @subsection PowerPC
21899 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21900
21901 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21902 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21903 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21904 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21905 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21906
21907 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21908 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21909 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21910
21911 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21912 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21913
21914 @node Nios II
21915 @subsection Nios II
21916 @cindex Nios II architecture
21917
21918 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21919 it provides the following special commands:
21920
21921 @table @code
21922
21923 @item set debug nios2
21924 @kindex set debug nios2
21925 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21926 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21927
21928 @item show debug nios2
21929 @kindex show debug nios2
21930 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21931 @end table
21932
21933 @node Controlling GDB
21934 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21935
21936 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21937 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21938 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21939 described here.
21940
21941 @menu
21942 * Prompt:: Prompt
21943 * Editing:: Command editing
21944 * Command History:: Command history
21945 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21946 * Numbers:: Numbers
21947 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21948 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21949 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21950 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21951 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21952 @end menu
21953
21954 @node Prompt
21955 @section Prompt
21956
21957 @cindex prompt
21958
21959 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21960 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21961 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21962 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21963 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21964 which one you are talking to.
21965
21966 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21967 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21968 or a prompt that does not.
21969
21970 @table @code
21971 @kindex set prompt
21972 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21973 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21974
21975 @kindex show prompt
21976 @item show prompt
21977 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21978 @end table
21979
21980 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21981 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21982 are:
21983
21984 @table @code
21985 @kindex set extended-prompt
21986 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21987 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21988 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21989 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21990 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21991 is displayed.
21992
21993 For example:
21994
21995 @smallexample
21996 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21997 @end smallexample
21998
21999 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22000 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22001
22002 @kindex show extended-prompt
22003 @item show extended-prompt
22004 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22005 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22006 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22007 @end table
22008
22009 @node Editing
22010 @section Command Editing
22011 @cindex readline
22012 @cindex command line editing
22013
22014 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22015 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22016 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22017 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22018 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22019 debugging sessions.
22020
22021 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22022 command @code{set}.
22023
22024 @table @code
22025 @kindex set editing
22026 @cindex editing
22027 @item set editing
22028 @itemx set editing on
22029 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22030
22031 @item set editing off
22032 Disable command line editing.
22033
22034 @kindex show editing
22035 @item show editing
22036 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22037 @end table
22038
22039 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22040 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22041 @end ifset
22042 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22043 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22044 @end ifclear
22045 for more details about the Readline
22046 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22047 encouraged to read that chapter.
22048
22049 @node Command History
22050 @section Command History
22051 @cindex command history
22052
22053 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22054 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22055 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22056 history facility.
22057
22058 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22059 package, to provide the history facility.
22060 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22061 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22062 @end ifset
22063 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22064 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22065 @end ifclear
22066 for the detailed description of the History library.
22067
22068 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22069 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22070 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22071 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22072 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22073 pressed on a line by itself.
22074
22075 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22076 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22077 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22078 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22079
22080 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22081 history.
22082
22083 @table @code
22084 @cindex history substitution
22085 @cindex history file
22086 @kindex set history filename
22087 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22088 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22089 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22090 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22091 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22092 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22093 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22094 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22095 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22096 is not set.
22097
22098 @cindex save command history
22099 @kindex set history save
22100 @item set history save
22101 @itemx set history save on
22102 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22103 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22104
22105 @item set history save off
22106 Stop recording command history in a file.
22107
22108 @cindex history size
22109 @kindex set history size
22110 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22111 @item set history size @var{size}
22112 @itemx set history size unlimited
22113 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22114 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22115 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22116 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22117 history list is unlimited.
22118 @end table
22119
22120 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22121 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22122 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22123 @end ifset
22124 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22125 @xref{Event Designators},
22126 @end ifclear
22127 for more details.
22128
22129 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22130 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22131 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22132 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22133 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22134 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22135 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22136 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22137
22138 The commands to control history expansion are:
22139
22140 @table @code
22141 @item set history expansion on
22142 @itemx set history expansion
22143 @kindex set history expansion
22144 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22145
22146 @item set history expansion off
22147 Disable history expansion.
22148
22149 @c @group
22150 @kindex show history
22151 @item show history
22152 @itemx show history filename
22153 @itemx show history save
22154 @itemx show history size
22155 @itemx show history expansion
22156 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22157 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22158 @c @end group
22159 @end table
22160
22161 @table @code
22162 @kindex show commands
22163 @cindex show last commands
22164 @cindex display command history
22165 @item show commands
22166 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22167
22168 @item show commands @var{n}
22169 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22170
22171 @item show commands +
22172 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22173 @end table
22174
22175 @node Screen Size
22176 @section Screen Size
22177 @cindex size of screen
22178 @cindex screen size
22179 @cindex pagination
22180 @cindex page size
22181 @cindex pauses in output
22182
22183 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22184 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22185 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22186 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22187 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22188 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22189 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22190 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22191
22192 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22193 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22194 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22195 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22196 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22197 width} commands:
22198
22199 @table @code
22200 @kindex set height
22201 @kindex set width
22202 @kindex show width
22203 @kindex show height
22204 @item set height @var{lpp}
22205 @itemx set height unlimited
22206 @itemx show height
22207 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22208 @itemx set width unlimited
22209 @itemx show width
22210 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22211 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22212 commands display the current settings.
22213
22214 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22215 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22216 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22217 buffer.
22218
22219 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22220 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22221
22222 @item set pagination on
22223 @itemx set pagination off
22224 @kindex set pagination
22225 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22226 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22227 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22228 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22229
22230 @item show pagination
22231 @kindex show pagination
22232 Show the current pagination mode.
22233 @end table
22234
22235 @node Numbers
22236 @section Numbers
22237 @cindex number representation
22238 @cindex entering numbers
22239
22240 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22241 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22242 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22243 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22244 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22245 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22246 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22247 both input and output with the commands described below.
22248
22249 @table @code
22250 @kindex set input-radix
22251 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22252 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22253 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22254 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22255 example, any of
22256
22257 @smallexample
22258 set input-radix 012
22259 set input-radix 10.
22260 set input-radix 0xa
22261 @end smallexample
22262
22263 @noindent
22264 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22265 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22266 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22267 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22268 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22269 change the radix.
22270
22271 @kindex set output-radix
22272 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22273 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22274 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22275 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22276
22277 @kindex show input-radix
22278 @item show input-radix
22279 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22280
22281 @kindex show output-radix
22282 @item show output-radix
22283 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22284
22285 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22286 @itemx show radix
22287 @kindex set radix
22288 @kindex show radix
22289 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22290 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22291 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22292 default value of 10.
22293
22294 @end table
22295
22296 @node ABI
22297 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22298
22299 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22300 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22301 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22302 current ABI.
22303
22304 @cindex OS ABI
22305 @kindex set osabi
22306 @kindex show osabi
22307 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22308
22309 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22310 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22311 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22312 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22313 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22314 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22315 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22316 platform provides.
22317
22318 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22319 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22320 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22321 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22322
22323 @table @code
22324 @item show osabi
22325 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22326
22327 @item set osabi
22328 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22329
22330 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22331 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22332 @end table
22333
22334 @cindex float promotion
22335
22336 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22337 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22338 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22339 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22340 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22341 @code{double} and then passed.
22342
22343 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22344 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22345 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22346
22347 @table @code
22348 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22349 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22350 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22351 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22352 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22353
22354 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22355 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22356 functions.
22357
22358 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22359 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22360 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22361 @end table
22362
22363 @kindex set cp-abi
22364 @kindex show cp-abi
22365 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22366 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22367 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22368 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22369 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22370 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22371 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22372 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22373 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22374 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22375 ``auto''.
22376
22377 @table @code
22378 @item show cp-abi
22379 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22380
22381 @item set cp-abi
22382 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22383
22384 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22385 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22386 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22387 @end table
22388
22389 @node Auto-loading
22390 @section Automatically loading associated files
22391 @cindex auto-loading
22392
22393 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22394 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22395 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22396 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22397 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22398 sources).
22399
22400 @menu
22401 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22402 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22403
22404 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22405 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22406 @end menu
22407
22408 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22409 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22410 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22411
22412 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22413 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22414 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22415
22416 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22417 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22418
22419 @table @code
22420 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22421 @kindex set auto-load off
22422 @item set auto-load off
22423 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22424 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22425 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22426 @smallexample
22427 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22428 @end smallexample
22429
22430 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22431 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22432 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22433 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22434 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22435 @code{set auto-load no}.
22436
22437 @anchor{show auto-load}
22438 @kindex show auto-load
22439 @item show auto-load
22440 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22441 or disabled.
22442
22443 @smallexample
22444 (gdb) show auto-load
22445 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22446 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22447 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22448 is on.
22449 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22450 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22451 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22452 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22453 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22454 @end smallexample
22455
22456 @anchor{info auto-load}
22457 @kindex info auto-load
22458 @item info auto-load
22459 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22460 not.
22461
22462 @smallexample
22463 (gdb) info auto-load
22464 gdb-scripts:
22465 Loaded Script
22466 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22467 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22468 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22469 loaded.
22470 python-scripts:
22471 Loaded Script
22472 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22473 @end smallexample
22474 @end table
22475
22476 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22477
22478 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22479 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22480 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22481 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22482 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22483 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22484 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22485 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22486 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22487 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22488 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22489 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22490 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22491 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22492 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22493 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22494 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22495 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22496 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22497 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22498 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22499 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22500 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22501 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22502 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22503 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22504 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22505 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22506 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22507 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22508 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22509 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22510 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22511 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22512 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22513 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22514 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22515 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22516 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22517 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22518 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22519 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22520 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22521 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22522 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22523 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22524 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22525 @end multitable
22526
22527 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22528 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22529 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22530
22531 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22532 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22533 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22534
22535 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22536 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22537
22538 @table @code
22539 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22540 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22541 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22542 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22543 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22544
22545 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22546 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22547 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22548 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22549 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22550
22551 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22552 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22553 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22554 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22555 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22556 @end table
22557
22558 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22559 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22560 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22561
22562 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22563
22564 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22565 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22566
22567 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22568 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22569 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22570 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22571 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22572 library.
22573
22574 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22575 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22576
22577 @table @code
22578 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22579 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22580 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22581 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22582
22583 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22584 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22585 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22586 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22587 enabled or disabled.
22588
22589 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22590 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22591 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22592 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22593 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22594 @end table
22595
22596 @node Auto-loading safe path
22597 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22598 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22599
22600 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22601 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22602 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22603 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22604 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22605
22606 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22607 get loaded:
22608
22609 @smallexample
22610 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22611 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22612 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22613 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22614 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22615 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22616 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22617 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22618 @end smallexample
22619
22620 @noindent
22621 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22622 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22623
22624 @smallexample
22625 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22626 @end smallexample
22627
22628 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22629
22630 @table @code
22631 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22632 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22633 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22634 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22635 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22636 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22637 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22638 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22639 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22640 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22641
22642 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22643 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22644 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22645
22646 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22647 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22648 @item show auto-load safe-path
22649 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22650 scripts.
22651
22652 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22653 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22654 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22655 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22656 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22657 host platform path separator in use.
22658 @end table
22659
22660 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22661 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22662 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22663 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22664 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22665
22666 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22667 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22668 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22669 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22670 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22671 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22672 init file in the current directory
22673 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22674
22675 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22676 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22677
22678 @table @asis
22679 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22680 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22681 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22682 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22683
22684 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22685 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22686 @value{GDBN} session.
22687
22688 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22689 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22690 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22691 from trusted sources.
22692
22693 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22694 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22695 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22696 trusted sources.
22697 @end table
22698
22699 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22700 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22701
22702 @table @asis
22703 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22704 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22705
22706 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22707 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22708 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22709 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22710 @end table
22711
22712 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22713 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22714 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22715 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22716 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22717 recommended to be entered.
22718
22719 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22720 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22721 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22722
22723 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22724 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22725 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22726 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22727 be printed.
22728
22729 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22730 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22731 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22732
22733 @smallexample
22734 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22735 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22736 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22737 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22738 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22739 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22740 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22741 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22742 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22743 @end smallexample
22744
22745 @table @code
22746 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22747 @kindex set debug auto-load
22748 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22749 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22750
22751 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22752 @kindex show debug auto-load
22753 @item show debug auto-load
22754 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22755 on or off.
22756 @end table
22757
22758 @node Messages/Warnings
22759 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22760
22761 @cindex verbose operation
22762 @cindex optional warnings
22763 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22764 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22765 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22766 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22767
22768 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22769 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22770 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22771
22772 @table @code
22773 @kindex set verbose
22774 @item set verbose on
22775 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22776
22777 @item set verbose off
22778 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22779
22780 @kindex show verbose
22781 @item show verbose
22782 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22783 @end table
22784
22785 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22786 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22787 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22788 Symbol Files}).
22789
22790 @table @code
22791
22792 @kindex set complaints
22793 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22794 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22795 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22796 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22797 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22798
22799 @kindex show complaints
22800 @item show complaints
22801 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22802
22803 @end table
22804
22805 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22806 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22807 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22808 you try to run a program which is already running:
22809
22810 @smallexample
22811 (@value{GDBP}) run
22812 The program being debugged has been started already.
22813 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22814 @end smallexample
22815
22816 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22817 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22818
22819 @table @code
22820
22821 @kindex set confirm
22822 @cindex flinching
22823 @cindex confirmation
22824 @cindex stupid questions
22825 @item set confirm off
22826 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22827 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22828 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22829
22830 @item set confirm on
22831 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22832
22833 @kindex show confirm
22834 @item show confirm
22835 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22836
22837 @end table
22838
22839 @cindex command tracing
22840 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22841 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22842 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22843 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22844
22845 @table @code
22846 @kindex set trace-commands
22847 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22848 @item set trace-commands on
22849 Enable command tracing.
22850 @item set trace-commands off
22851 Disable command tracing.
22852 @item show trace-commands
22853 Display the current state of command tracing.
22854 @end table
22855
22856 @node Debugging Output
22857 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22858 @cindex optional debugging messages
22859
22860 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22861 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22862 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22863 section documents those commands.
22864
22865 @table @code
22866 @kindex set exec-done-display
22867 @item set exec-done-display
22868 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22869 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22870 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22871 @kindex show exec-done-display
22872 @item show exec-done-display
22873 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22874 notification.
22875 @kindex set debug
22876 @cindex ARM AArch64
22877 @item set debug aarch64
22878 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22879 The default is off.
22880 @kindex show debug
22881 @item show debug aarch64
22882 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22883 ARM AArch64.
22884 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22885 @cindex architecture debugging info
22886 @item set debug arch
22887 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22888 @item show debug arch
22889 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22890 @item set debug aix-solib
22891 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22892 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22893 support module. The default is off.
22894 @item show debug aix-thread
22895 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22896 @item set debug aix-thread
22897 @cindex AIX threads
22898 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22899 module.
22900 @item show debug aix-thread
22901 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22902 @item set debug check-physname
22903 @cindex physname
22904 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22905 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22906 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22907 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22908 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22909 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22910 @item show debug check-physname
22911 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22912 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22913 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22914 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22915 exported symbols. The default is off.
22916 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22917 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22918 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22919 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22920 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22921 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22922 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22923 A value of zero turns off the display.
22924 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22925 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22926 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22927 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22928 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22929 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22930 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22931 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22932 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22933 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22934 @item set debug displaced
22935 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22936 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22937 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22938 @item show debug displaced
22939 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22940 related to displaced stepping.
22941 @item set debug event
22942 @cindex event debugging info
22943 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22944 default is off.
22945 @item show debug event
22946 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22947 info.
22948 @item set debug expression
22949 @cindex expression debugging info
22950 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22951 expression parsing. The default is off.
22952 @item show debug expression
22953 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22954 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22955 @item set debug frame
22956 @cindex frame debugging info
22957 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22958 default is off.
22959 @item show debug frame
22960 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22961 info.
22962 @item set debug gnu-nat
22963 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22964 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22965 @item show debug gnu-nat
22966 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22967 @item set debug infrun
22968 @cindex inferior debugging info
22969 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22970 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22971 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22972 @item show debug infrun
22973 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22974 @item set debug jit
22975 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22976 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22977 @item show debug jit
22978 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22979 @item set debug lin-lwp
22980 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22981 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22982 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22983 @item show debug lin-lwp
22984 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22985 @item set debug mach-o
22986 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22987 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22988 processing. The default is off.
22989 @item show debug mach-o
22990 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22991 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22992 @item set debug notification
22993 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22994 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22995 The default is off.
22996 @item show debug notification
22997 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22998 @item set debug observer
22999 @cindex observer debugging info
23000 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23001 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23002 @item show debug observer
23003 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23004 @item set debug overload
23005 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23006 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23007 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23008 is off.
23009 @item show debug overload
23010 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23011 debugging info.
23012 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23013 @cindex debug expression parser
23014 @item set debug parser
23015 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23016 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23017 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23018 details. The default is off.
23019 @item show debug parser
23020 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23021 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23022 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23023 @cindex debug remote protocol
23024 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23025 @cindex display remote packets
23026 @item set debug remote
23027 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23028 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23029 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23030 @item show debug remote
23031 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23032 @item set debug serial
23033 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23034 default is off.
23035 @item show debug serial
23036 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23037 info.
23038 @item set debug solib-frv
23039 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23040 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23041 @item show debug solib-frv
23042 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23043 messages.
23044 @item set debug symfile
23045 @cindex symbol file functions
23046 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23047 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23048 @item show debug symfile
23049 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23050 @item set debug symtab-create
23051 @cindex symbol table creation
23052 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23053 The default is 0 (off).
23054 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23055 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23056 @item show debug symtab-create
23057 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23058 @item set debug target
23059 @cindex target debugging info
23060 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23061 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23062 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23063 value of large memory transfers.
23064 @item show debug target
23065 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23066 info.
23067 @item set debug timestamp
23068 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23069 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23070 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23071 message.
23072 @item show debug timestamp
23073 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23074 debugging info.
23075 @item set debug varobj
23076 @cindex variable object debugging info
23077 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23078 info. The default is off.
23079 @item show debug varobj
23080 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23081 debugging info.
23082 @item set debug xml
23083 @cindex XML parser debugging
23084 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23085 @item show debug xml
23086 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23087 @end table
23088
23089 @node Other Misc Settings
23090 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23091 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23092
23093 @table @code
23094 @kindex set interactive-mode
23095 @item set interactive-mode
23096 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23097 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23098 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23099 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23100 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23101 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23102 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23103 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23104
23105 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23106 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23107 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23108 inside a cygwin window.
23109
23110 @kindex show interactive-mode
23111 @item show interactive-mode
23112 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23113 @end table
23114
23115 @node Extending GDB
23116 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23117 @cindex extending GDB
23118
23119 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23120 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23121 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23122 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23123 being debugged.
23124
23125 @menu
23126 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23127 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23128 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23129 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23130 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23131 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23132 @end menu
23133
23134 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23135 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23136 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23137 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23138 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23139 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23140
23141 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23142 setting:
23143
23144 @table @code
23145 @kindex set script-extension
23146 @kindex show script-extension
23147 @item set script-extension off
23148 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23149
23150 @item set script-extension soft
23151 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23152 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23153 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23154 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23155
23156 @item set script-extension strict
23157 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23158 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23159 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23160
23161 @item show script-extension
23162 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23163
23164 @end table
23165
23166 @node Sequences
23167 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23168
23169 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23170 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23171 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23172 files.
23173
23174 @menu
23175 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23176 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23177 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23178 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23179 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23180 @end menu
23181
23182 @node Define
23183 @subsection User-defined Commands
23184
23185 @cindex user-defined command
23186 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23187 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23188 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23189 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23190 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23191 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23192
23193 @smallexample
23194 define adder
23195 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23196 end
23197 @end smallexample
23198
23199 @noindent
23200 To execute the command use:
23201
23202 @smallexample
23203 adder 1 2 3
23204 @end smallexample
23205
23206 @noindent
23207 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23208 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23209 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23210 functions calls.
23211
23212 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23213 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23214 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23215 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23216
23217 @smallexample
23218 define adder
23219 if $argc == 2
23220 print $arg0 + $arg1
23221 end
23222 if $argc == 3
23223 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23224 end
23225 end
23226 @end smallexample
23227
23228 @table @code
23229
23230 @kindex define
23231 @item define @var{commandname}
23232 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23233 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23234 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23235 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23236 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23237 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23238
23239 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23240 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23241 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23242
23243 @kindex document
23244 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23245 @item document @var{commandname}
23246 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23247 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23248 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23249 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23250 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23251 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23252
23253 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23254 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23255 does not change the documentation.
23256
23257 @kindex dont-repeat
23258 @cindex don't repeat command
23259 @item dont-repeat
23260 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23261 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23262 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23263
23264 @kindex help user-defined
23265 @item help user-defined
23266 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23267 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23268 included (if any).
23269
23270 @kindex show user
23271 @item show user
23272 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23273 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23274 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23275 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23276 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23277
23278 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23279 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23280 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23281 @item show max-user-call-depth
23282 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23283 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23284 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23285 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23286 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23287 @end table
23288
23289 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23290 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23291
23292 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23293 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23294 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23295
23296 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23297 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23298 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23299 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23300
23301 @node Hooks
23302 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23303 @cindex command hooks
23304 @cindex hooks, for commands
23305 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23306
23307 @kindex hook
23308 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23309 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23310 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23311 before that command.
23312
23313 @cindex hooks, post-command
23314 @kindex hookpost
23315 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23316 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23317 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23318 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23319 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23320
23321 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23322 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23323
23324 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23325 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23326
23327 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23328 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23329 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23330 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23331 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23332
23333 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23334 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23335 you could define:
23336
23337 @smallexample
23338 define hook-stop
23339 handle SIGALRM nopass
23340 end
23341
23342 define hook-run
23343 handle SIGALRM pass
23344 end
23345
23346 define hook-continue
23347 handle SIGALRM pass
23348 end
23349 @end smallexample
23350
23351 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23352 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23353 you could define:
23354
23355 @smallexample
23356 define hook-echo
23357 echo <<<---
23358 end
23359
23360 define hookpost-echo
23361 echo --->>>\n
23362 end
23363
23364 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23365 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23366 (@value{GDBP})
23367
23368 @end smallexample
23369
23370 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23371 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23372 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23373 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23374 @c or not?
23375 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23376 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23377 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23378
23379 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23380 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23381 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23382
23383 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23384 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23385
23386 @node Command Files
23387 @subsection Command Files
23388
23389 @cindex command files
23390 @cindex scripting commands
23391 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23392 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23393 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23394 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23395 terminal.
23396
23397 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23398 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23399 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23400 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23401 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23402
23403 @table @code
23404 @kindex source
23405 @cindex execute commands from a file
23406 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23407 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23408 @end table
23409
23410 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23411 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23412 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23413 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23414 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23415
23416 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23417 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23418 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23419 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23420 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23421 is not relevant to scripts.
23422
23423 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23424 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23425 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23426 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23427 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23428 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23429 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23430 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23431 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23432 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23433 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23434 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23435 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23436 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23437
23438 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23439 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23440 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23441
23442 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23443 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23444 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23445 when called from command files.
23446
23447 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23448 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23449 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23450 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23451 the next command.
23452
23453 @smallexample
23454 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23455 @end smallexample
23456
23457 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23458 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23459 would be directed to @file{log}.
23460
23461 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23462 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23463 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23464 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23465 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23466 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23467 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23468 conditionally, etc.
23469
23470 @table @code
23471 @kindex if
23472 @kindex else
23473 @item if
23474 @itemx else
23475 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23476 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23477 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23478 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23479 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23480 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23481 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23482
23483 @kindex while
23484 @item while
23485 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23486 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23487 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23488 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23489 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23490 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23491
23492 @kindex loop_break
23493 @item loop_break
23494 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23495 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23496 line.
23497
23498 @kindex loop_continue
23499 @item loop_continue
23500 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23501 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23502 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23503 the controlling expression.
23504
23505 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23506 @item end
23507 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23508 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23509 @end table
23510
23511
23512 @node Output
23513 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23514
23515 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23516 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23517 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23518 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23519 want.
23520
23521 @table @code
23522 @kindex echo
23523 @item echo @var{text}
23524 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23525 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23526 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23527 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23528 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23529 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23530 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23531 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23532 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23533 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23534 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23535
23536 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23537 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23538
23539 @smallexample
23540 echo This is some text\n\
23541 which is continued\n\
23542 onto several lines.\n
23543 @end smallexample
23544
23545 produces the same output as
23546
23547 @smallexample
23548 echo This is some text\n
23549 echo which is continued\n
23550 echo onto several lines.\n
23551 @end smallexample
23552
23553 @kindex output
23554 @item output @var{expression}
23555 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23556 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23557 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23558 on expressions.
23559
23560 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23561 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23562 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23563 Formats}, for more information.
23564
23565 @kindex printf
23566 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23567 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23568 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23569 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23570 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23571 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23572 executing the code below:
23573
23574 @smallexample
23575 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23576 @end smallexample
23577
23578 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23579 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23580 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23581 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23582 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23583 printed.
23584
23585 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23586
23587 @smallexample
23588 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23589 @end smallexample
23590
23591 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23592 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23593 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23594
23595 @itemize @bullet
23596 @item
23597 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23598
23599 @item
23600 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23601 width.
23602
23603 @item
23604 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23605 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23606
23607 @item
23608 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23609 supported.
23610
23611 @item
23612 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23613
23614 @item
23615 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23616 @end itemize
23617
23618 @noindent
23619 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23620 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23621 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23622 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23623
23624 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23625 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23626 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23627 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23628 supported.
23629
23630 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23631 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23632 together with a floating point specifier.
23633 letters:
23634
23635 @itemize @bullet
23636 @item
23637 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23638
23639 @item
23640 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23641
23642 @item
23643 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23644 @end itemize
23645
23646 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23647 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23648 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23649
23650 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23651 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23652
23653 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23654 @smallexample
23655 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23656 @end smallexample
23657
23658 @kindex eval
23659 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23660 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23661 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23662
23663 @end table
23664
23665 @node Auto-loading sequences
23666 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23667 @cindex native script auto-loading
23668
23669 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23670 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23671 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23672 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23673
23674 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23675 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23676
23677 @table @code
23678 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23679 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23680 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23681 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23682
23683 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23684 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23685 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23686 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23687 disabled.
23688
23689 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23690 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23691 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23692 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23693 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23694 auto-loaded.
23695 @end table
23696
23697 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23698 matching names are printed.
23699
23700 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23701 @include python.texi
23702
23703 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23704 @include guile.texi
23705
23706 @node Auto-loading extensions
23707 @section Auto-loading extensions
23708 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23709
23710 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23711 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23712 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23713 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23714 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23715
23716 @menu
23717 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23718 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23719 * Which flavor to choose?::
23720 @end menu
23721
23722 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23723 debugging commands and features.
23724
23725 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23726 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23727 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23728 for more information.
23729 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23730 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23731
23732 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23733 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23734
23735 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23736 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23737 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23738 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23739 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23740
23741 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23742 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23743 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23744 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23745
23746 @table @code
23747 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23748 GDB's own command language
23749 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23750 Python
23751 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23752 Guile
23753 @end table
23754
23755 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23756 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23757 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23758 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23759 script in the specified extension language.
23760
23761 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23762 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23763
23764 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23765 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23766
23767 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23768 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23769 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23770 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23771 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23772 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23773
23774 @table @code
23775 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23776 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23777 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23778 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23779 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23780 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23781
23782 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23783 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23784
23785 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23786 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23787 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23788 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23789
23790 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23791 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23792 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23793 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23794 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23795 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23796 platform.
23797
23798 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23799 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23800 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23801
23802 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23803 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23804 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23805 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23806 @end table
23807
23808 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23809 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23810 @var{objfile} is opened.
23811 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23812 is evaluated more than once.
23813
23814 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23815 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23816 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23817
23818 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23819 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23820 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23821 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23822 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23823 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23824
23825 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23826 current directory and then along the source search path
23827 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23828 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23829 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23830
23831 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23832 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23833
23834 @example
23835 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23836 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23837 asm("\
23838 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23839 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23840 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23841 .popsection \n\
23842 ");
23843 @end example
23844
23845 @noindent
23846 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23847 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23848
23849 @example
23850 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23851 @end example
23852
23853 The script name may include directories if desired.
23854
23855 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23856 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23857
23858 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23859 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23860 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23861 will remove duplicates.
23862
23863 @node Which flavor to choose?
23864 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23865
23866 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23867 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23868
23869 @noindent
23870 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23871
23872 @itemize @bullet
23873 @item
23874 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23875
23876 @item
23877 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23878
23879 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23880 in the source search path.
23881 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23882 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23883
23884 @item
23885 Doesn't require source code additions.
23886 @end itemize
23887
23888 @noindent
23889 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23890
23891 @itemize @bullet
23892 @item
23893 Works with static linking.
23894
23895 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23896 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23897 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23898 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23899 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23900
23901 @item
23902 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23903
23904 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23905 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23906
23907 @item
23908 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23909
23910 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23911 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23912 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23913 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23914 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23915 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23916 @end itemize
23917
23918 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23919 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23920
23921 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23922 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23923 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23924
23925 @subsection Python comes first
23926
23927 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23928 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23929 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23930 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23931 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23932 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23933 pretty-printed form of a value).
23934 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23935 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23936 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23937
23938 @node Aliases
23939 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23940 @cindex aliases for commands
23941
23942 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23943 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23944 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23945 that involves less typing.
23946
23947 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23948 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23949 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23950
23951 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23952 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23953 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23954
23955 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23956
23957 @table @code
23958
23959 @kindex alias
23960 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23961
23962 @end table
23963
23964 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23965 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23966 underscores.
23967
23968 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23969 that is being aliased.
23970
23971 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23972 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23973 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23974
23975 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23976 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23977
23978 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23979 of a command so that there is less to type.
23980 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23981 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23982 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23983 The following will accomplish this.
23984
23985 @smallexample
23986 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23987 @end smallexample
23988
23989 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23990 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23991 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23992 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23993
23994 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23995 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23996 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23997 of a command.
23998
23999 @smallexample
24000 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24001 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24002 (gdb) set p elms 20
24003 (gdb) show p elms
24004 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24005 @end smallexample
24006
24007 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24008 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24009 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24010
24011 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24012 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24013
24014 @smallexample
24015 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24016 @end smallexample
24017
24018 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24019 alias for a more complex command.
24020 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24021
24022 @smallexample
24023 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24024 (gdb) spe 20
24025 @end smallexample
24026
24027 @node Interpreters
24028 @chapter Command Interpreters
24029 @cindex command interpreters
24030
24031 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24032 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24033 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24034
24035 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24036 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24037 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24038 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24039
24040 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24041 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24042 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24043 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24044
24045 @table @code
24046 @item console
24047 @cindex console interpreter
24048 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24049 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24050 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24051
24052 @item mi
24053 @cindex mi interpreter
24054 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24055 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24056 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24057 Interface}.
24058
24059 @item mi2
24060 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24061 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24062
24063 @item mi1
24064 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24065 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24066
24067 @end table
24068
24069 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24070 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24071 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24072 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24073 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24074 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24075 the IDE inoperable!
24076
24077 @kindex interpreter-exec
24078 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24079 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24080 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24081 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24082
24083 @smallexample
24084 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24085 @end smallexample
24086
24087 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24088 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24089
24090 @node TUI
24091 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24092 @cindex TUI
24093 @cindex Text User Interface
24094
24095 @menu
24096 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24097 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24098 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24099 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24100 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24101 @end menu
24102
24103 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24104 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24105 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24106 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24107 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24108 is available.
24109
24110 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24111 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24112 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24113 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24114 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24115
24116 @node TUI Overview
24117 @section TUI Overview
24118
24119 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24120
24121 @table @emph
24122 @item command
24123 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24124 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24125 managed using readline.
24126
24127 @item source
24128 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24129 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24130
24131 @item assembly
24132 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24133
24134 @item register
24135 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24136 when their values change.
24137 @end table
24138
24139 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24140 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24141 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24142 indicates the breakpoint type:
24143
24144 @table @code
24145 @item B
24146 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24147
24148 @item b
24149 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24150
24151 @item H
24152 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24153
24154 @item h
24155 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24156 @end table
24157
24158 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24159
24160 @table @code
24161 @item +
24162 Breakpoint is enabled.
24163
24164 @item -
24165 Breakpoint is disabled.
24166 @end table
24167
24168 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24169 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24170 changes.
24171
24172 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24173 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24174 layouts:
24175
24176 @itemize @bullet
24177 @item
24178 source only,
24179
24180 @item
24181 assembly only,
24182
24183 @item
24184 source and assembly,
24185
24186 @item
24187 source and registers, or
24188
24189 @item
24190 assembly and registers.
24191 @end itemize
24192
24193 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24194
24195 @table @emph
24196 @item target
24197 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24198 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24199
24200 @item process
24201 Gives the current process or thread number.
24202 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24203
24204 @item function
24205 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24206 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24207 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24208 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24209
24210 @item line
24211 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24212 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24213
24214 @item pc
24215 Indicates the current program counter address.
24216 @end table
24217
24218 @node TUI Keys
24219 @section TUI Key Bindings
24220 @cindex TUI key bindings
24221
24222 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24223 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24224 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24225 @end ifset
24226 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24227 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24228 @end ifclear
24229 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24230 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24231
24232 @table @kbd
24233 @kindex C-x C-a
24234 @item C-x C-a
24235 @kindex C-x a
24236 @itemx C-x a
24237 @kindex C-x A
24238 @itemx C-x A
24239 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24240 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24241 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24242 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24243 The screen is then refreshed.
24244
24245 @kindex C-x 1
24246 @item C-x 1
24247 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24248 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24249 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24250
24251 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24252
24253 @kindex C-x 2
24254 @item C-x 2
24255 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24256 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24257 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24258 previous layout and the new one.
24259
24260 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24261
24262 @kindex C-x o
24263 @item C-x o
24264 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24265 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24266 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24267
24268 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24269
24270 @kindex C-x s
24271 @item C-x s
24272 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24273 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24274 @end table
24275
24276 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24277
24278 @table @asis
24279 @kindex PgUp
24280 @item @key{PgUp}
24281 Scroll the active window one page up.
24282
24283 @kindex PgDn
24284 @item @key{PgDn}
24285 Scroll the active window one page down.
24286
24287 @kindex Up
24288 @item @key{Up}
24289 Scroll the active window one line up.
24290
24291 @kindex Down
24292 @item @key{Down}
24293 Scroll the active window one line down.
24294
24295 @kindex Left
24296 @item @key{Left}
24297 Scroll the active window one column left.
24298
24299 @kindex Right
24300 @item @key{Right}
24301 Scroll the active window one column right.
24302
24303 @kindex C-L
24304 @item @kbd{C-L}
24305 Refresh the screen.
24306 @end table
24307
24308 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24309 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24310 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24311 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24312 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24313
24314 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24315 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24316 @cindex TUI single key mode
24317
24318 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24319 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24320 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24321
24322 @table @kbd
24323 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24324 @item c
24325 continue
24326
24327 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24328 @item d
24329 down
24330
24331 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24332 @item f
24333 finish
24334
24335 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24336 @item n
24337 next
24338
24339 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24340 @item q
24341 exit the SingleKey mode.
24342
24343 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24344 @item r
24345 run
24346
24347 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24348 @item s
24349 step
24350
24351 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24352 @item u
24353 up
24354
24355 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24356 @item v
24357 info locals
24358
24359 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24360 @item w
24361 where
24362 @end table
24363
24364 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24365 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24366 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24367 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24368 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24369 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24370
24371
24372 @node TUI Commands
24373 @section TUI-specific Commands
24374 @cindex TUI commands
24375
24376 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24377 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24378 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24379 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24380
24381 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24382 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24383 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24384 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24385 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24386
24387 @table @code
24388 @item info win
24389 @kindex info win
24390 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24391
24392 @item layout next
24393 @kindex layout
24394 Display the next layout.
24395
24396 @item layout prev
24397 Display the previous layout.
24398
24399 @item layout src
24400 Display the source window only.
24401
24402 @item layout asm
24403 Display the assembly window only.
24404
24405 @item layout split
24406 Display the source and assembly window.
24407
24408 @item layout regs
24409 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24410
24411 @item focus next
24412 @kindex focus
24413 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24414
24415 @item focus prev
24416 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24417
24418 @item focus src
24419 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24420
24421 @item focus asm
24422 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24423
24424 @item focus regs
24425 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24426
24427 @item focus cmd
24428 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24429
24430 @item refresh
24431 @kindex refresh
24432 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24433
24434 @item tui reg float
24435 @kindex tui reg
24436 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24437
24438 @item tui reg general
24439 Show the general registers in the register window.
24440
24441 @item tui reg next
24442 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24443 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24444 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24445 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24446
24447 @item tui reg system
24448 Show the system registers in the register window.
24449
24450 @item update
24451 @kindex update
24452 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24453
24454 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24455 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24456 @kindex winheight
24457 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24458 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24459 decrease it.
24460
24461 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24462 @kindex tabset
24463 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24464 @end table
24465
24466 @node TUI Configuration
24467 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24468 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24469
24470 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24471
24472 @table @code
24473 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24474 @kindex set tui border-kind
24475 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24476 The possible values are the following:
24477 @table @code
24478 @item space
24479 Use a space character to draw the border.
24480
24481 @item ascii
24482 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24483
24484 @item acs
24485 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24486 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24487 @end table
24488
24489 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24490 @kindex set tui border-mode
24491 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24492 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24493 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24494 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24495 @table @code
24496 @item normal
24497 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24498
24499 @item standout
24500 Use standout mode.
24501
24502 @item reverse
24503 Use reverse video mode.
24504
24505 @item half
24506 Use half bright mode.
24507
24508 @item half-standout
24509 Use half bright and standout mode.
24510
24511 @item bold
24512 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24513
24514 @item bold-standout
24515 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24516 @end table
24517 @end table
24518
24519 @node Emacs
24520 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24521
24522 @cindex Emacs
24523 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24524 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24525 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24526 @value{GDBN}.
24527
24528 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24529 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24530 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24531 created Emacs buffer.
24532 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24533
24534 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24535 things:
24536
24537 @itemize @bullet
24538 @item
24539 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24540 the GUD buffer.
24541
24542 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24543 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24544
24545 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24546 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24547 in this way.
24548
24549 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24550 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24551 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24552 stop.
24553
24554 @item
24555 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24556
24557 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24558 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24559 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24560 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24561 and the source.
24562
24563 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24564 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24565 @end itemize
24566
24567 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24568 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24569 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24570 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24571
24572 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24573 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24574 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24575 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24576 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24577 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24578 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24579 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24580 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24581
24582 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24583 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24584 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24585 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24586
24587 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24588 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24589 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24590 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24591 one you want.
24592
24593 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24594 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24595
24596 @table @kbd
24597 @item C-h m
24598 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24599
24600 @item C-c C-s
24601 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24602 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24603
24604 @item C-c C-n
24605 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24606 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24607 to show the current file and location.
24608
24609 @item C-c C-i
24610 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24611 display window accordingly.
24612
24613 @item C-c C-f
24614 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24615 @code{finish} command.
24616
24617 @item C-c C-r
24618 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24619 command.
24620
24621 @item C-c <
24622 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24623 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24624 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24625
24626 @item C-c >
24627 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24628 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24629 @end table
24630
24631 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24632 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24633
24634 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24635 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24636 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24637 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24638 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24639 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24640 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24641
24642 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24643 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24644 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24645 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24646 frame.
24647
24648 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24649 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24650 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24651 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24652 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24653 to correspond properly with the code.
24654
24655 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24656 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24657 Emacs Manual}).
24658
24659 @node GDB/MI
24660 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24661
24662 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24663
24664 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24665 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24666 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24667 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24668 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24669 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24670
24671 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24672 in the form of a reference manual.
24673
24674 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24675 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24676 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24677
24678 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24679
24680 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24681 This chapter uses the following notation:
24682
24683 @itemize @bullet
24684 @item
24685 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24686
24687 @item
24688 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24689 it may or may not be given.
24690
24691 @item
24692 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24693 may repeat zero or more times.
24694
24695 @item
24696 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24697 may repeat one or more times.
24698
24699 @item
24700 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24701 @end itemize
24702
24703 @ignore
24704 @heading Dependencies
24705 @end ignore
24706
24707 @menu
24708 * GDB/MI General Design::
24709 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24710 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24711 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24712 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24713 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24714 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24715 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24716 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24717 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24718 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24719 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24720 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24721 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24722 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24723 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24724 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24725 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24726 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24727 @ignore
24728 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24729 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24730 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24731 @end ignore
24732 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24733 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24734 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24735 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24736 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24737 @end menu
24738
24739 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24740 @node GDB/MI General Design
24741 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24742 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24743
24744 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24745 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24746 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24747 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24748 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24749 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24750 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24751 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24752 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24753 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24754
24755 The important examples of notifications are:
24756 @itemize @bullet
24757
24758 @item
24759 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24760 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24761 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24762 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24763 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24764 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24765 command itself was successfully executed.
24766
24767 @item
24768 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24769 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24770 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24771 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24772 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24773 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24774
24775 @item
24776 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24777 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24778 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24779 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24780 orthogonal frontend design.
24781
24782 @end itemize
24783
24784 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24785 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24786 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24787 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24788 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24789 the user interface.
24790
24791
24792 @menu
24793 * Context management::
24794 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24795 * Thread groups::
24796 @end menu
24797
24798 @node Context management
24799 @subsection Context management
24800
24801 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24802
24803 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24804 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24805 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24806 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24807 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24808 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24809 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24810 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24811 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24812
24813 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24814 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24815 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24816 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24817 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24818 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24819 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24820 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24821 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24822 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24823 for thread and frame to operate on.
24824
24825 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24826 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24827 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24828 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24829 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24830 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24831 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24832 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24833 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24834 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24835
24836 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24837 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24838 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24839 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24840 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24841 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24842 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24843 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24844 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24845 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24846 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24847 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24848 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24849 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24850 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24851 @samp{--frame} options.
24852
24853 @subsubsection Language
24854
24855 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24856 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24857 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24858 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24859 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24860 For instance:
24861
24862 @smallexample
24863 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24864 ^done,value="4"
24865 (gdb)
24866 @end smallexample
24867
24868 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24869 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24870 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24871
24872 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24873 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24874
24875 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24876 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24877 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24878 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24879 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24880 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24881 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24882 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24883 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24884
24885 @table @code
24886 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
24887 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
24888 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
24889
24890 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
24891 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
24892 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
24893
24894 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
24895 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
24896 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
24897 MI commands even while the target is running.
24898
24899 @item -gdb-show mi-async
24900 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
24901 @end table
24902
24903 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
24904 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
24905 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
24906 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
24907 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
24908 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
24909
24910 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24911 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24912 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24913 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24914 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24915 are running.
24916
24917 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24918 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24919 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24920 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24921 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24922 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24923 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24924 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24925 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24926 @samp{--thread} option).
24927
24928 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24929 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24930 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24931 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24932
24933 @node Thread groups
24934 @subsection Thread groups
24935 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24936 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24937 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24938 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24939 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24940
24941 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24942 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24943 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24944 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24945 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24946 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24947 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24948 into processes.
24949
24950 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24951 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24952 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24953 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24954 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24955 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24956 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24957 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24958 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24959 the members of specific thread group.
24960
24961 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24962 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24963 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24964 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24965 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24966 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24967 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24968 after attaching to that thread group.
24969
24970 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24971 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24972 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24973 such thread groups.
24974
24975 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24976 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24977 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24978
24979 @menu
24980 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24981 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24982 @end menu
24983
24984 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24985 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24986
24987 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24988 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24989 @table @code
24990 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24991 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24992
24993 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24994 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24995 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24996
24997 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24998 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24999 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25000
25001 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25002 "any sequence of digits"
25003
25004 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25005 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25006
25007 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25008 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25009
25010 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25011 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25012
25013 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25014 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25015 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25016
25017 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25018 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25019
25020 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25021 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25022 @end table
25023
25024 @noindent
25025 Notes:
25026
25027 @itemize @bullet
25028 @item
25029 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25030 output is described below.
25031
25032 @item
25033 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25034 finishes.
25035
25036 @item
25037 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25038 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25039 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25040 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25041 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25042 @end itemize
25043
25044 Pragmatics:
25045
25046 @itemize @bullet
25047 @item
25048 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25049
25050 @item
25051 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25052 @end itemize
25053
25054 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25055 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25056
25057 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25058 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25059 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25060 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25061 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25062 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25063
25064 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25065 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25066 @var{token}.
25067
25068 @table @code
25069 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25070 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25071
25072 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25073 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25074
25075 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25076 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25077
25078 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25079 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25080
25081 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25082 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25083
25084 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25085 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25086
25087 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25088 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25089
25090 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25091 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25092
25093 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25094 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25095
25096 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25097 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25098 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25099
25100 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25101 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25102
25103 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25104 @code{ @var{string} }
25105
25106 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25107 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25108
25109 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25110 @code{@var{c-string}}
25111
25112 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25113 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25114
25115 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25116 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25117 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25118
25119 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25120 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25121
25122 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25123 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25124
25125 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25126 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25127
25128 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25129 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25130
25131 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25132 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25133
25134 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25135 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25136 @end table
25137
25138 @noindent
25139 Notes:
25140
25141 @itemize @bullet
25142 @item
25143 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25144
25145 @item
25146 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25147 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25148 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25149 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25150 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25151 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25152 prior command.
25153
25154 @item
25155 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25156 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25157 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25158 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25159
25160 @item
25161 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25162 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25163 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25164 @samp{*}.
25165
25166 @item
25167 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25168 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25169 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25170 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25171
25172 @item
25173 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25174 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25175 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25176 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25177
25178 @item
25179 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25180 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25181 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25182
25183 @item
25184 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25185 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25186 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25187 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25188
25189 @item
25190 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25191 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25192 @var{values}.
25193
25194
25195 @end itemize
25196
25197 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25198 details about the various output records.
25199
25200 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25201 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25202 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25203
25204 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25205 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25206
25207 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25208 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25209 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25210 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25211 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25212 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25213
25214 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25215 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25216 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25217
25218 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25219 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25220 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25221 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25222
25223 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25224 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25225
25226 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25227 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25228 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25229 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25230 might change.
25231
25232 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25233 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25234 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25235 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25236
25237 @itemize @bullet
25238 @item
25239 New MI commands may be added.
25240
25241 @item
25242 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25243
25244 @item
25245 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25246 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25247
25248 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25249 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25250
25251 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25252 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25253 @end itemize
25254
25255 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25256 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25257 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25258 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25259 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25260
25261 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25262 @c version?
25263
25264 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25265 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25266 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25267 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25268 @cindex mailing lists
25269
25270 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25271 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25272 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25273
25274 @menu
25275 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25276 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25277 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25278 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25279 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25280 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25281 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25282 @end menu
25283
25284 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25285 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25286
25287 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25288 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25289 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25290 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25291
25292 @table @code
25293 @findex ^done
25294 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25295 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25296 values.
25297
25298 @item "^running"
25299 @findex ^running
25300 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25301 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25302 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25303 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25304 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25305 which threads are resumed.
25306
25307 @item "^connected"
25308 @findex ^connected
25309 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25310
25311 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25312 @findex ^error
25313 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25314 the corresponding error message.
25315
25316 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25317 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25318 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25319
25320 @table @samp
25321 @item "undefined-command"
25322 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25323 @end table
25324
25325 @item "^exit"
25326 @findex ^exit
25327 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25328
25329 @end table
25330
25331 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25332 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25333
25334 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25335 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25336 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25337 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25338 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25339
25340 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25341 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25342 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25343 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25344 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25345
25346 @table @code
25347 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25348 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25349 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25350
25351 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25352 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25353 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25354 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25355
25356 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25357 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25358 internals.
25359 @end table
25360
25361 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25362 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25363
25364 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25365 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25366 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25367 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25368 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25369 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25370
25371 The following is the list of possible async records:
25372
25373 @table @code
25374
25375 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25376 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25377 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25378 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25379 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25380 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25381 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25382 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25383 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25384 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25385
25386 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25387 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25388 following values:
25389
25390 @table @code
25391 @item breakpoint-hit
25392 A breakpoint was reached.
25393 @item watchpoint-trigger
25394 A watchpoint was triggered.
25395 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25396 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25397 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25398 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25399 @item function-finished
25400 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25401 @item location-reached
25402 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25403 @item watchpoint-scope
25404 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25405 @item end-stepping-range
25406 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25407 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25408 @item exited-signalled
25409 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25410 @item exited
25411 The inferior exited.
25412 @item exited-normally
25413 The inferior exited normally.
25414 @item signal-received
25415 A signal was received by the inferior.
25416 @item solib-event
25417 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25418 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25419 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25420 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25421 @item fork
25422 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25423 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25424 @item vfork
25425 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25426 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25427 @item syscall-entry
25428 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25429 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25430 @item syscall-entry
25431 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25432 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25433 @item exec
25434 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25435 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25436 @end table
25437
25438 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25439 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25440 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25441 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25442 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25443 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25444 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25445 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25446 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25447 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25448 if such information is not available.
25449
25450 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25451 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25452 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25453 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25454 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25455 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25456 cannot be used in any way.
25457
25458 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25459 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25460 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25461 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25462 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25463 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25464
25465 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25466 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25467 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25468 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25469 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25470 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25471
25472 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25473 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25474 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25475 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25476 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25477
25478 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25479 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25480 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25481 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25482 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25483 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25484 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25485
25486 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25487 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25488 that thread.
25489
25490 @item =library-loaded,...
25491 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25492 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25493 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25494 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25495 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25496 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25497 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25498 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25499 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25500 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25501 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25502 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25503 thread groups.
25504
25505 @item =library-unloaded,...
25506 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25507 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25508 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25509 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25510 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25511 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25512 thread groups.
25513
25514 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25515 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25516 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25517 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25518 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25519
25520 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25521 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25522 initial value @var{initial}.
25523
25524 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25525 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25526 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25527 trace state variables are deleted.
25528
25529 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25530 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25531 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25532 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25533 value of trace state variable is known.
25534
25535 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25536 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25537 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25538 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25539 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25540 user.
25541
25542 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25543 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25544 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25545
25546 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25547 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25548
25549 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25550 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25551 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25552 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25553 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25554
25555 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25556 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25557 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25558 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25559 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25560 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25561
25562 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25563 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25564 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25565 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25566 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25567 executable code.
25568 @end table
25569
25570 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25571 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25572
25573 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25574 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25575 following fields:
25576
25577 @table @code
25578 @item number
25579 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25580 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25581 @samp{1.2}.
25582
25583 @item type
25584 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25585 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25586
25587 @item catch-type
25588 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25589 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25590
25591 @item disp
25592 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25593 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25594 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25595
25596 @item enabled
25597 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25598 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25599 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25600
25601 @item addr
25602 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25603 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25604 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25605 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25606 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25607
25608 @item func
25609 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25610 If not known, this field is not present.
25611
25612 @item filename
25613 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25614 If not known, this field is not present.
25615
25616 @item fullname
25617 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25618 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25619
25620 @item line
25621 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25622 If not known, this field is not present.
25623
25624 @item at
25625 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25626 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25627 by a symbol name.
25628
25629 @item pending
25630 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25631 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25632
25633 @item evaluated-by
25634 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25635 @samp{target}.
25636
25637 @item thread
25638 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25639 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25640
25641 @item task
25642 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25643 field will hold the task identifier.
25644
25645 @item cond
25646 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25647
25648 @item ignore
25649 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25650
25651 @item enable
25652 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25653
25654 @item traceframe-usage
25655 FIXME.
25656
25657 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25658 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25659
25660 @item mask
25661 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25662
25663 @item pass
25664 A tracepoint's pass count.
25665
25666 @item original-location
25667 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25668 This field is optional.
25669
25670 @item times
25671 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25672
25673 @item installed
25674 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25675 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25676 is not.
25677
25678 @item what
25679 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25680
25681 @end table
25682
25683 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25684 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25685
25686 @smallexample
25687 -> -break-insert main
25688 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25689 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25690 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25691 times="0"@}
25692 <- (gdb)
25693 @end smallexample
25694
25695 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25696 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25697
25698 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25699 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25700 fields:
25701
25702 @table @code
25703 @item level
25704 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25705 zero. This field is always present.
25706
25707 @item func
25708 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25709 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25710
25711 @item addr
25712 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25713
25714 @item file
25715 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25716 address. This field may be absent.
25717
25718 @item line
25719 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25720 may be absent.
25721
25722 @item from
25723 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25724 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25725
25726 @end table
25727
25728 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25729 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25730
25731 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25732 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25733
25734 @table @code
25735 @item id
25736 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25737 always present.
25738
25739 @item target-id
25740 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25741
25742 @item details
25743 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25744 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25745 frontend. This field is optional.
25746
25747 @item state
25748 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25749 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25750
25751 @item core
25752 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25753 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25754 @end table
25755
25756 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25757 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25758
25759 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25760 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25761 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25762 the @code{exception-name} field.
25763
25764 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25765 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25766 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25767 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25768
25769 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25770 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25771 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25772 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25773
25774 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25775 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25776
25777 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25778
25779 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25780 information of the breakpoint.
25781
25782 @smallexample
25783 -> -break-insert main
25784 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25785 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25786 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25787 times="0"@}
25788 <- (gdb)
25789 @end smallexample
25790
25791 @subheading Program Execution
25792
25793 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25794 reason that execution stopped.
25795
25796 @smallexample
25797 -> -exec-run
25798 <- ^running
25799 <- (gdb)
25800 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25801 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25802 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25803 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25804 <- (gdb)
25805 -> -exec-continue
25806 <- ^running
25807 <- (gdb)
25808 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25809 <- (gdb)
25810 @end smallexample
25811
25812 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25813
25814 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25815
25816 @smallexample
25817 -> (gdb)
25818 <- -gdb-exit
25819 <- ^exit
25820 @end smallexample
25821
25822 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25823 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25824 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25825 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25826 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25827 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25828
25829 @subheading A Bad Command
25830
25831 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25832
25833 @smallexample
25834 -> -rubbish
25835 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25836 <- (gdb)
25837 @end smallexample
25838
25839
25840 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25841 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25842 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25843
25844 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25845 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25846
25847 @subheading Motivation
25848
25849 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25850
25851 @subheading Introduction
25852
25853 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25854
25855 @subheading Commands
25856
25857 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25858
25859 @subsubheading Synopsis
25860
25861 @smallexample
25862 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25863 @end smallexample
25864
25865 @subsubheading Result
25866
25867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25868
25869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25870
25871 @subsubheading Example
25872
25873 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25874 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25875
25876
25877 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25878 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25879 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25880
25881 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25882 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25883 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25884 breakpoints.
25885
25886 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25887 @findex -break-after
25888
25889 @subsubheading Synopsis
25890
25891 @smallexample
25892 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25893 @end smallexample
25894
25895 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25896 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25897 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25898 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25899
25900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25901
25902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25903
25904 @subsubheading Example
25905
25906 @smallexample
25907 (gdb)
25908 -break-insert main
25909 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25910 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25911 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25912 times="0"@}
25913 (gdb)
25914 -break-after 1 3
25915 ~
25916 ^done
25917 (gdb)
25918 -break-list
25919 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25920 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25921 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25922 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25923 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25924 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25925 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25926 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25927 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25928 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25929 (gdb)
25930 @end smallexample
25931
25932 @ignore
25933 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25934 @findex -break-catch
25935 @end ignore
25936
25937 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25938 @findex -break-commands
25939
25940 @subsubheading Synopsis
25941
25942 @smallexample
25943 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25944 @end smallexample
25945
25946 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25947 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25948 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25949 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25950 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25951 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25952
25953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25954
25955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25956
25957 @subsubheading Example
25958
25959 @smallexample
25960 (gdb)
25961 -break-insert main
25962 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25963 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25964 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25965 times="0"@}
25966 (gdb)
25967 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25968 ^done
25969 (gdb)
25970 @end smallexample
25971
25972 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25973 @findex -break-condition
25974
25975 @subsubheading Synopsis
25976
25977 @smallexample
25978 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25979 @end smallexample
25980
25981 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25982 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25983 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25984 command below).
25985
25986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25987
25988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25989
25990 @subsubheading Example
25991
25992 @smallexample
25993 (gdb)
25994 -break-condition 1 1
25995 ^done
25996 (gdb)
25997 -break-list
25998 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25999 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26000 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26001 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26002 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26003 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26004 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26005 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26006 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26007 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26008 (gdb)
26009 @end smallexample
26010
26011 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26012 @findex -break-delete
26013
26014 @subsubheading Synopsis
26015
26016 @smallexample
26017 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26018 @end smallexample
26019
26020 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26021 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26022
26023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26024
26025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26026
26027 @subsubheading Example
26028
26029 @smallexample
26030 (gdb)
26031 -break-delete 1
26032 ^done
26033 (gdb)
26034 -break-list
26035 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26036 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26037 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26038 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26039 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26040 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26041 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26042 body=[]@}
26043 (gdb)
26044 @end smallexample
26045
26046 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26047 @findex -break-disable
26048
26049 @subsubheading Synopsis
26050
26051 @smallexample
26052 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26053 @end smallexample
26054
26055 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26056 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26057
26058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26059
26060 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26061
26062 @subsubheading Example
26063
26064 @smallexample
26065 (gdb)
26066 -break-disable 2
26067 ^done
26068 (gdb)
26069 -break-list
26070 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26071 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26072 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26073 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26074 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26075 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26076 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26077 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26078 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26079 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26080 (gdb)
26081 @end smallexample
26082
26083 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26084 @findex -break-enable
26085
26086 @subsubheading Synopsis
26087
26088 @smallexample
26089 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26090 @end smallexample
26091
26092 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26093
26094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26095
26096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26097
26098 @subsubheading Example
26099
26100 @smallexample
26101 (gdb)
26102 -break-enable 2
26103 ^done
26104 (gdb)
26105 -break-list
26106 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26107 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26108 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26109 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26110 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26111 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26112 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26113 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26114 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26115 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26116 (gdb)
26117 @end smallexample
26118
26119 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26120 @findex -break-info
26121
26122 @subsubheading Synopsis
26123
26124 @smallexample
26125 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26126 @end smallexample
26127
26128 @c REDUNDANT???
26129 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26130
26131 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26132 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26133 table.
26134
26135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26136
26137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26138
26139 @subsubheading Example
26140 N.A.
26141
26142 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26143 @findex -break-insert
26144
26145 @subsubheading Synopsis
26146
26147 @smallexample
26148 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26149 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26150 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26151 @end smallexample
26152
26153 @noindent
26154 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26155
26156 @itemize @bullet
26157 @item function
26158 @c @item +offset
26159 @c @item -offset
26160 @c @item linenum
26161 @item filename:linenum
26162 @item filename:function
26163 @item *address
26164 @end itemize
26165
26166 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26167
26168 @table @samp
26169 @item -t
26170 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26171 @item -h
26172 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26173 @item -f
26174 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26175 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26176 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26177 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26178 cannot be parsed.
26179 @item -d
26180 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26181 @item -a
26182 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26183 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26184 @item -c @var{condition}
26185 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26186 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26187 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26188 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26189 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26190 @end table
26191
26192 @subsubheading Result
26193
26194 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26195 resulting breakpoint.
26196
26197 Note: this format is open to change.
26198 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26199
26200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26201
26202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26203 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26204
26205 @subsubheading Example
26206
26207 @smallexample
26208 (gdb)
26209 -break-insert main
26210 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26211 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26212 times="0"@}
26213 (gdb)
26214 -break-insert -t foo
26215 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26216 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26217 times="0"@}
26218 (gdb)
26219 -break-list
26220 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26221 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26222 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26223 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26224 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26225 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26226 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26227 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26228 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26229 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26230 times="0"@},
26231 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26232 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26233 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26234 times="0"@}]@}
26235 (gdb)
26236 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26237 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26238 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26239 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26240 @c times="0"@}
26241 @c (gdb)
26242 @end smallexample
26243
26244 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26245 @findex -dprintf-insert
26246
26247 @subsubheading Synopsis
26248
26249 @smallexample
26250 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26251 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26252 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26253 [ @var{argument} ]
26254 @end smallexample
26255
26256 @noindent
26257 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26258
26259 @itemize @bullet
26260 @item @var{function}
26261 @c @item +offset
26262 @c @item -offset
26263 @c @item @var{linenum}
26264 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26265 @item @var{filename}:function
26266 @item *@var{address}
26267 @end itemize
26268
26269 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26270
26271 @table @samp
26272 @item -t
26273 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26274 @item -f
26275 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26276 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26277 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26278 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26279 cannot be parsed.
26280 @item -d
26281 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26282 @item -c @var{condition}
26283 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26284 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26285 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26286 to @var{ignore-count}.
26287 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26288 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26289 @end table
26290
26291 @subsubheading Result
26292
26293 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26294 resulting breakpoint.
26295
26296 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26297
26298 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26299
26300 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26301
26302 @subsubheading Example
26303
26304 @smallexample
26305 (gdb)
26306 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26307 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26308 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26309 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26310 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26311 original-location="foo"@}
26312 (gdb)
26313 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26314 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26315 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26316 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26317 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26318 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26319 (gdb)
26320 @end smallexample
26321
26322 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26323 @findex -break-list
26324
26325 @subsubheading Synopsis
26326
26327 @smallexample
26328 -break-list
26329 @end smallexample
26330
26331 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26332
26333 @table @samp
26334 @item Number
26335 number of the breakpoint
26336 @item Type
26337 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26338 @item Disposition
26339 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26340 or @samp{nokeep}
26341 @item Enabled
26342 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26343 @item Address
26344 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26345 @item What
26346 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26347 name, line number
26348 @item Thread-groups
26349 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26350 @item Times
26351 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26352 @end table
26353
26354 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26355 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26356
26357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26358
26359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26360
26361 @subsubheading Example
26362
26363 @smallexample
26364 (gdb)
26365 -break-list
26366 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26367 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26368 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26369 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26370 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26371 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26372 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26373 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26374 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26375 times="0"@},
26376 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26377 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26378 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26379 (gdb)
26380 @end smallexample
26381
26382 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26383
26384 @smallexample
26385 (gdb)
26386 -break-list
26387 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26388 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26389 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26390 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26391 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26392 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26393 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26394 body=[]@}
26395 (gdb)
26396 @end smallexample
26397
26398 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26399 @findex -break-passcount
26400
26401 @subsubheading Synopsis
26402
26403 @smallexample
26404 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26405 @end smallexample
26406
26407 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26408 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26409 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26410 command @samp{passcount}.
26411
26412 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26413 @findex -break-watch
26414
26415 @subsubheading Synopsis
26416
26417 @smallexample
26418 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26419 @end smallexample
26420
26421 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26422 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26423 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26424 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26425 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26426 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26427 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26428 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26429
26430 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26431 breakpoints inserted.
26432
26433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26434
26435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26436 @samp{rwatch}.
26437
26438 @subsubheading Example
26439
26440 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26441
26442 @smallexample
26443 (gdb)
26444 -break-watch x
26445 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26446 (gdb)
26447 -exec-continue
26448 ^running
26449 (gdb)
26450 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26451 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26452 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26453 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26454 (gdb)
26455 @end smallexample
26456
26457 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26458 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26459 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26460
26461 @smallexample
26462 (gdb)
26463 -break-watch C
26464 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26465 (gdb)
26466 -exec-continue
26467 ^running
26468 (gdb)
26469 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26470 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26471 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26472 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26473 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26474 (gdb)
26475 -exec-continue
26476 ^running
26477 (gdb)
26478 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26479 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26480 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26481 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26482 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26483 (gdb)
26484 @end smallexample
26485
26486 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26487 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26488 deleted.
26489
26490 @smallexample
26491 (gdb)
26492 -break-watch C
26493 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26494 (gdb)
26495 -break-list
26496 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26497 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26498 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26499 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26500 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26501 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26502 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26503 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26504 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26505 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26506 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26507 times="1"@},
26508 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26509 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26510 (gdb)
26511 -exec-continue
26512 ^running
26513 (gdb)
26514 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26515 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26516 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26517 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26518 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26519 (gdb)
26520 -break-list
26521 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26522 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26523 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26524 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26525 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26526 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26527 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26528 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26529 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26530 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26531 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26532 times="1"@},
26533 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26534 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26535 (gdb)
26536 -exec-continue
26537 ^running
26538 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26539 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26540 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26541 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26542 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26543 (gdb)
26544 -break-list
26545 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26546 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26547 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26548 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26549 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26550 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26551 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26552 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26553 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26554 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26555 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26556 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26557 (gdb)
26558 @end smallexample
26559
26560
26561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26562 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26563 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26564
26565 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26566 catchpoints.
26567
26568 @menu
26569 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26570 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26571 @end menu
26572
26573 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26574 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26575
26576 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26577 @findex -catch-load
26578
26579 @subsubheading Synopsis
26580
26581 @smallexample
26582 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26583 @end smallexample
26584
26585 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26586 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26587 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26588 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26589 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26590
26591
26592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26593
26594 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26595
26596 @subsubheading Example
26597
26598 @smallexample
26599 -catch-load -t foo.so
26600 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26601 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26602 (gdb)
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605
26606 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26607 @findex -catch-unload
26608
26609 @subsubheading Synopsis
26610
26611 @smallexample
26612 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26613 @end smallexample
26614
26615 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26616 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26617 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26618 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26619 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26620
26621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26622
26623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26624
26625 @subsubheading Example
26626
26627 @smallexample
26628 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26629 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26630 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26631 (gdb)
26632 @end smallexample
26633
26634 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26635 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26636
26637 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26638 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26639
26640 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26641 @findex -catch-assert
26642
26643 @subsubheading Synopsis
26644
26645 @smallexample
26646 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26647 @end smallexample
26648
26649 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26650
26651 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26652
26653 @table @samp
26654 @item -c @var{condition}
26655 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26656 @item -d
26657 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26658 @item -t
26659 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26660 @end table
26661
26662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26663
26664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26665
26666 @subsubheading Example
26667
26668 @smallexample
26669 -catch-assert
26670 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26671 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26672 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26673 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26674 (gdb)
26675 @end smallexample
26676
26677 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26678 @findex -catch-exception
26679
26680 @subsubheading Synopsis
26681
26682 @smallexample
26683 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26684 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26685 @end smallexample
26686
26687 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26688 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26689 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26690 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26691 catchpoints.
26692
26693 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26694
26695 @table @samp
26696 @item -c @var{condition}
26697 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26698 @item -d
26699 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26700 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26701 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26702 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26703 @item -t
26704 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26705 @item -u
26706 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26707 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26708 @end table
26709
26710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26711
26712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26713 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26714
26715 @subsubheading Example
26716
26717 @smallexample
26718 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26719 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26720 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26721 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26722 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26723 (gdb)
26724 @end smallexample
26725
26726 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26727 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26728 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26729
26730 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26731 @findex -exec-arguments
26732
26733
26734 @subsubheading Synopsis
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26738 @end smallexample
26739
26740 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26741 @samp{-exec-run}.
26742
26743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26744
26745 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26746
26747 @subsubheading Example
26748
26749 @smallexample
26750 (gdb)
26751 -exec-arguments -v word
26752 ^done
26753 (gdb)
26754 @end smallexample
26755
26756
26757 @ignore
26758 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26759 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26760
26761 @subsubheading Synopsis
26762
26763 @smallexample
26764 -exec-show-arguments
26765 @end smallexample
26766
26767 Print the arguments of the program.
26768
26769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26770
26771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26772
26773 @subsubheading Example
26774 N.A.
26775 @end ignore
26776
26777
26778 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26779 @findex -environment-cd
26780
26781 @subsubheading Synopsis
26782
26783 @smallexample
26784 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26785 @end smallexample
26786
26787 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26788
26789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26790
26791 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26792
26793 @subsubheading Example
26794
26795 @smallexample
26796 (gdb)
26797 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26798 ^done
26799 (gdb)
26800 @end smallexample
26801
26802
26803 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26804 @findex -environment-directory
26805
26806 @subsubheading Synopsis
26807
26808 @smallexample
26809 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26810 @end smallexample
26811
26812 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26813 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26814 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26815 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26816 occurs as normal.
26817 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26818 multiple directories in a single command
26819 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26820 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26821 If blanks are needed as
26822 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26823 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26824 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26825 character must not be used
26826 in any directory name.
26827 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26828
26829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26830
26831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26832
26833 @subsubheading Example
26834
26835 @smallexample
26836 (gdb)
26837 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26838 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26839 (gdb)
26840 -environment-directory ""
26841 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26842 (gdb)
26843 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26844 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26845 (gdb)
26846 -environment-directory -r
26847 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26848 (gdb)
26849 @end smallexample
26850
26851
26852 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26853 @findex -environment-path
26854
26855 @subsubheading Synopsis
26856
26857 @smallexample
26858 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26859 @end smallexample
26860
26861 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26862 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26863 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26864 supplied in addition to the
26865 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26866 occurs as normal.
26867 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26868 multiple directories in a single command
26869 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26870 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26871 If blanks are needed as
26872 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26873 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26874 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26875 character must not be used
26876 in any directory name.
26877 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26878
26879
26880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26881
26882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26883
26884 @subsubheading Example
26885
26886 @smallexample
26887 (gdb)
26888 -environment-path
26889 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26890 (gdb)
26891 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26892 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26893 (gdb)
26894 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26895 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26896 (gdb)
26897 @end smallexample
26898
26899
26900 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26901 @findex -environment-pwd
26902
26903 @subsubheading Synopsis
26904
26905 @smallexample
26906 -environment-pwd
26907 @end smallexample
26908
26909 Show the current working directory.
26910
26911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26912
26913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26914
26915 @subsubheading Example
26916
26917 @smallexample
26918 (gdb)
26919 -environment-pwd
26920 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26921 (gdb)
26922 @end smallexample
26923
26924 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26925 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26926 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26927
26928
26929 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26930 @findex -thread-info
26931
26932 @subsubheading Synopsis
26933
26934 @smallexample
26935 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26936 @end smallexample
26937
26938 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26939 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26940 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26941 also reports the current thread.
26942
26943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26944
26945 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26946 about all threads.
26947
26948 @subsubheading Result
26949
26950 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26951 defined for a given thread:
26952
26953 @table @samp
26954 @item current
26955 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26956
26957 @item id
26958 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26959
26960 @item target-id
26961 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26962
26963 @item details
26964 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26965 field is optional.
26966
26967 @item name
26968 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26969 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26970 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26971 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26972 field is omitted.
26973
26974 @item frame
26975 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26976
26977 @item state
26978 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26979 values:
26980
26981 @table @code
26982 @item stopped
26983 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26984 threads.
26985
26986 @item running
26987 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26988 threads.
26989
26990 @end table
26991
26992 @item core
26993 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26994 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26995
26996 @end table
26997
26998 @subsubheading Example
26999
27000 @smallexample
27001 -thread-info
27002 ^done,threads=[
27003 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27004 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27005 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27006 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27007 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27008 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27009 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27010 state="running"@}],
27011 current-thread-id="1"
27012 (gdb)
27013 @end smallexample
27014
27015 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27016 @findex -thread-list-ids
27017
27018 @subsubheading Synopsis
27019
27020 @smallexample
27021 -thread-list-ids
27022 @end smallexample
27023
27024 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27025 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27026
27027 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27028 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27029
27030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27031
27032 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27033
27034 @subsubheading Example
27035
27036 @smallexample
27037 (gdb)
27038 -thread-list-ids
27039 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27040 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27041 (gdb)
27042 @end smallexample
27043
27044
27045 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27046 @findex -thread-select
27047
27048 @subsubheading Synopsis
27049
27050 @smallexample
27051 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27052 @end smallexample
27053
27054 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27055 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27056
27057 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27058 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27059
27060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27061
27062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27063
27064 @subsubheading Example
27065
27066 @smallexample
27067 (gdb)
27068 -exec-next
27069 ^running
27070 (gdb)
27071 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27072 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27073 (gdb)
27074 -thread-list-ids
27075 ^done,
27076 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27077 number-of-threads="3"
27078 (gdb)
27079 -thread-select 3
27080 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27081 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27082 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27083 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27084 (gdb)
27085 @end smallexample
27086
27087 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27088 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27089 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27090
27091 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27092 @findex -ada-task-info
27093
27094 @subsubheading Synopsis
27095
27096 @smallexample
27097 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27098 @end smallexample
27099
27100 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27101 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27102
27103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27104
27105 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27106 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27107
27108 @subsubheading Result
27109
27110 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27111 defined for each Ada task:
27112
27113 @table @samp
27114 @item current
27115 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27116
27117 @item id
27118 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27119
27120 @item task-id
27121 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27122
27123 @item thread-id
27124 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27125
27126 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27127 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27128 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27129
27130 @item parent-id
27131 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27132 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27133
27134 @item priority
27135 The base priority of the task.
27136
27137 @item state
27138 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27139 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27140
27141 @item name
27142 The name of the task.
27143
27144 @end table
27145
27146 @subsubheading Example
27147
27148 @smallexample
27149 -ada-task-info
27150 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27151 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27152 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27153 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27154 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27155 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27156 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27157 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27158 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27159 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27160 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27161 (gdb)
27162 @end smallexample
27163
27164 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27165 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27166 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27167
27168 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27169 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27170 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27171 other cases.
27172
27173 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27174 @findex -exec-continue
27175
27176 @subsubheading Synopsis
27177
27178 @smallexample
27179 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27180 @end smallexample
27181
27182 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27183 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27184 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27185 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27186 @itemize @bullet
27187 @item
27188 breakpoints or watchpoints
27189 @item
27190 signals or exceptions
27191 @item
27192 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27193 @item
27194 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27195 @end itemize
27196 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27197 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27198 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27199 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27200 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27201 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27202
27203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27204
27205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27206
27207 @subsubheading Example
27208
27209 @smallexample
27210 -exec-continue
27211 ^running
27212 (gdb)
27213 @@Hello world
27214 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27215 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27216 line="13"@}
27217 (gdb)
27218 @end smallexample
27219
27220
27221 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27222 @findex -exec-finish
27223
27224 @subsubheading Synopsis
27225
27226 @smallexample
27227 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27228 @end smallexample
27229
27230 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27231 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27232 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27233 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27234 function was called.
27235
27236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27237
27238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27239
27240 @subsubheading Example
27241
27242 Function returning @code{void}.
27243
27244 @smallexample
27245 -exec-finish
27246 ^running
27247 (gdb)
27248 @@hello from foo
27249 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27250 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27251 (gdb)
27252 @end smallexample
27253
27254 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27255 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27256 value itself.
27257
27258 @smallexample
27259 -exec-finish
27260 ^running
27261 (gdb)
27262 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27263 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27264 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27265 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27266 (gdb)
27267 @end smallexample
27268
27269
27270 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27271 @findex -exec-interrupt
27272
27273 @subsubheading Synopsis
27274
27275 @smallexample
27276 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27277 @end smallexample
27278
27279 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27280 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27281 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27282 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27283 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27284
27285 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27286 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27287 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27288 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27289
27290 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27291 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27292 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27293 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27294
27295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27296
27297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27298
27299 @subsubheading Example
27300
27301 @smallexample
27302 (gdb)
27303 111-exec-continue
27304 111^running
27305
27306 (gdb)
27307 222-exec-interrupt
27308 222^done
27309 (gdb)
27310 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27311 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27312 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27313 (gdb)
27314
27315 (gdb)
27316 -exec-interrupt
27317 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27318 (gdb)
27319 @end smallexample
27320
27321 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27322 @findex -exec-jump
27323
27324 @subsubheading Synopsis
27325
27326 @smallexample
27327 -exec-jump @var{location}
27328 @end smallexample
27329
27330 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27331 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27332 different forms of @var{location}.
27333
27334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27335
27336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27337
27338 @subsubheading Example
27339
27340 @smallexample
27341 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27342 *running,thread-id="all"
27343 ^running
27344 @end smallexample
27345
27346
27347 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27348 @findex -exec-next
27349
27350 @subsubheading Synopsis
27351
27352 @smallexample
27353 -exec-next [--reverse]
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27357 of the next source line is reached.
27358
27359 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27360 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27361 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27362 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27363 source line where the function was called.
27364
27365
27366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27367
27368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27369
27370 @subsubheading Example
27371
27372 @smallexample
27373 -exec-next
27374 ^running
27375 (gdb)
27376 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27377 (gdb)
27378 @end smallexample
27379
27380
27381 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27382 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27383
27384 @subsubheading Synopsis
27385
27386 @smallexample
27387 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27388 @end smallexample
27389
27390 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27391 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27392 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27393 printed as well.
27394
27395 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27396 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27397 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27398 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27399 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27400
27401 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27402
27403 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27404
27405 @subsubheading Example
27406
27407 @smallexample
27408 (gdb)
27409 -exec-next-instruction
27410 ^running
27411
27412 (gdb)
27413 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27414 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27415 (gdb)
27416 @end smallexample
27417
27418
27419 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27420 @findex -exec-return
27421
27422 @subsubheading Synopsis
27423
27424 @smallexample
27425 -exec-return
27426 @end smallexample
27427
27428 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27429 Displays the new current frame.
27430
27431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27432
27433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27434
27435 @subsubheading Example
27436
27437 @smallexample
27438 (gdb)
27439 200-break-insert callee4
27440 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27441 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27442 (gdb)
27443 000-exec-run
27444 000^running
27445 (gdb)
27446 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27447 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27448 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27449 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27450 (gdb)
27451 205-break-delete
27452 205^done
27453 (gdb)
27454 111-exec-return
27455 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27456 args=[@{name="strarg",
27457 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27458 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27459 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27460 (gdb)
27461 @end smallexample
27462
27463
27464 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27465 @findex -exec-run
27466
27467 @subsubheading Synopsis
27468
27469 @smallexample
27470 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27471 @end smallexample
27472
27473 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27474 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27475 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27476 the program has exited exceptionally.
27477
27478 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27479 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27480 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27481 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27482 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27483
27484 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27485 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27486 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27487 (@pxref{Starting}).
27488
27489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27490
27491 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27492
27493 @subsubheading Examples
27494
27495 @smallexample
27496 (gdb)
27497 -break-insert main
27498 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27499 (gdb)
27500 -exec-run
27501 ^running
27502 (gdb)
27503 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27504 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27505 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27506 (gdb)
27507 @end smallexample
27508
27509 @noindent
27510 Program exited normally:
27511
27512 @smallexample
27513 (gdb)
27514 -exec-run
27515 ^running
27516 (gdb)
27517 x = 55
27518 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27519 (gdb)
27520 @end smallexample
27521
27522 @noindent
27523 Program exited exceptionally:
27524
27525 @smallexample
27526 (gdb)
27527 -exec-run
27528 ^running
27529 (gdb)
27530 x = 55
27531 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27532 (gdb)
27533 @end smallexample
27534
27535 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27536 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27537
27538 @smallexample
27539 (gdb)
27540 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27541 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27542 @end smallexample
27543
27544
27545 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27546
27547
27548 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27549 @findex -exec-step
27550
27551 @subsubheading Synopsis
27552
27553 @smallexample
27554 -exec-step [--reverse]
27555 @end smallexample
27556
27557 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27558 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27559 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27560 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27561 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27562 previously executed source line.
27563
27564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27565
27566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27567
27568 @subsubheading Example
27569
27570 Stepping into a function:
27571
27572 @smallexample
27573 -exec-step
27574 ^running
27575 (gdb)
27576 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27577 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27578 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27579 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27580 (gdb)
27581 @end smallexample
27582
27583 Regular stepping:
27584
27585 @smallexample
27586 -exec-step
27587 ^running
27588 (gdb)
27589 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27590 (gdb)
27591 @end smallexample
27592
27593
27594 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27595 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27596
27597 @subsubheading Synopsis
27598
27599 @smallexample
27600 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27601 @end smallexample
27602
27603 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27604 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27605 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27606 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27607 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27608 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27609 as well.
27610
27611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27612
27613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27614
27615 @subsubheading Example
27616
27617 @smallexample
27618 (gdb)
27619 -exec-step-instruction
27620 ^running
27621
27622 (gdb)
27623 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27624 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27625 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27626 (gdb)
27627 -exec-step-instruction
27628 ^running
27629
27630 (gdb)
27631 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27632 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27633 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27634 (gdb)
27635 @end smallexample
27636
27637
27638 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27639 @findex -exec-until
27640
27641 @subsubheading Synopsis
27642
27643 @smallexample
27644 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27648 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27649 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27650 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27651
27652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27653
27654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27655
27656 @subsubheading Example
27657
27658 @smallexample
27659 (gdb)
27660 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27661 ^running
27662 (gdb)
27663 x = 55
27664 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27665 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27666 (gdb)
27667 @end smallexample
27668
27669 @ignore
27670 @subheading -file-clear
27671 Is this going away????
27672 @end ignore
27673
27674 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27675 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27676 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27677
27678 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27679 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27680
27681 @smallexample
27682 -enable-frame-filters
27683 @end smallexample
27684
27685 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27686 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27687 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27688 request that this functionality be enabled.
27689
27690 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27691
27692 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27693 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27694
27695 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27696 @findex -stack-info-frame
27697
27698 @subsubheading Synopsis
27699
27700 @smallexample
27701 -stack-info-frame
27702 @end smallexample
27703
27704 Get info on the selected frame.
27705
27706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27707
27708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27709 (without arguments).
27710
27711 @subsubheading Example
27712
27713 @smallexample
27714 (gdb)
27715 -stack-info-frame
27716 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27717 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27718 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27719 (gdb)
27720 @end smallexample
27721
27722 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27723 @findex -stack-info-depth
27724
27725 @subsubheading Synopsis
27726
27727 @smallexample
27728 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27729 @end smallexample
27730
27731 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27732 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27733
27734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27735
27736 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27737
27738 @subsubheading Example
27739
27740 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27741
27742 @smallexample
27743 (gdb)
27744 -stack-info-depth
27745 ^done,depth="12"
27746 (gdb)
27747 -stack-info-depth 4
27748 ^done,depth="4"
27749 (gdb)
27750 -stack-info-depth 12
27751 ^done,depth="12"
27752 (gdb)
27753 -stack-info-depth 11
27754 ^done,depth="11"
27755 (gdb)
27756 -stack-info-depth 13
27757 ^done,depth="12"
27758 (gdb)
27759 @end smallexample
27760
27761 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27762 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27763 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27764
27765 @subsubheading Synopsis
27766
27767 @smallexample
27768 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27769 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27770 @end smallexample
27771
27772 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27773 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27774 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27775 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27776 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27777 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27778 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27779 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27780
27781 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27782 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27783 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27784 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27785 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27786 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27787
27788 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27789 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27790 are still displayed, however.
27791
27792 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27793 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27794
27795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27796
27797 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27798 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27799 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27800
27801 @subsubheading Example
27802
27803 @smallexample
27804 (gdb)
27805 -stack-list-frames
27806 ^done,
27807 stack=[
27808 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27809 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27810 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27811 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27812 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27813 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27814 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27815 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27816 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27817 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27818 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27819 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27820 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27821 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27822 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27823 (gdb)
27824 -stack-list-arguments 0
27825 ^done,
27826 stack-args=[
27827 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27828 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27829 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27830 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27831 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27832 (gdb)
27833 -stack-list-arguments 1
27834 ^done,
27835 stack-args=[
27836 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27837 frame=@{level="1",
27838 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27839 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27840 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27841 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27842 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27843 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27844 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27845 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27846 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27847 (gdb)
27848 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27849 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27850 (gdb)
27851 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27852 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27853 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27854 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27855 (gdb)
27856 @end smallexample
27857
27858 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27859
27860
27861 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27862 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27863 @findex -stack-list-frames
27864
27865 @subsubheading Synopsis
27866
27867 @smallexample
27868 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27869 @end smallexample
27870
27871 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27872 following info:
27873
27874 @table @samp
27875 @item @var{level}
27876 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27877 @item @var{addr}
27878 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27879 @item @var{func}
27880 Function name.
27881 @item @var{file}
27882 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27883 @item @var{fullname}
27884 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27885 @item @var{line}
27886 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27887 @item @var{from}
27888 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27889 if the frame's function is not known.
27890 @end table
27891
27892 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27893 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27894 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27895 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27896 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27897 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27898 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27899 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27900 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27901
27902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27903
27904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27905
27906 @subsubheading Example
27907
27908 Full stack backtrace:
27909
27910 @smallexample
27911 (gdb)
27912 -stack-list-frames
27913 ^done,stack=
27914 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27915 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27916 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27917 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27918 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27919 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27920 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27921 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27922 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27923 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27924 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27925 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27926 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27927 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27928 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27929 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27930 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27931 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27932 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27933 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27934 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27935 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27936 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27937 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27938 (gdb)
27939 @end smallexample
27940
27941 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27942
27943 @smallexample
27944 (gdb)
27945 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27946 ^done,stack=
27947 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27948 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27949 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27950 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27951 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27952 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27953 (gdb)
27954 @end smallexample
27955
27956 Show a single frame:
27957
27958 @smallexample
27959 (gdb)
27960 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27961 ^done,stack=
27962 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27963 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27964 (gdb)
27965 @end smallexample
27966
27967
27968 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27969 @findex -stack-list-locals
27970 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27971
27972 @subsubheading Synopsis
27973
27974 @smallexample
27975 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27976 @end smallexample
27977
27978 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27979 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27980 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27981 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27982 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27983 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27984 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27985 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27986 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27987 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27988
27989 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27990 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27991 variables are still displayed, however.
27992
27993 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27994 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27995
27996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27997
27998 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27999
28000 @subsubheading Example
28001
28002 @smallexample
28003 (gdb)
28004 -stack-list-locals 0
28005 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28006 (gdb)
28007 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28008 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28009 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28010 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28011 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28012 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28013 (gdb)
28014 @end smallexample
28015
28016 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28017 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28018 @findex -stack-list-variables
28019
28020 @subsubheading Synopsis
28021
28022 @smallexample
28023 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28024 @end smallexample
28025
28026 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28027 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28028 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28029 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28030 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28031 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28032 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28033
28034 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28035 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28036 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28037
28038 @subsubheading Example
28039
28040 @smallexample
28041 (gdb)
28042 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28043 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28044 (gdb)
28045 @end smallexample
28046
28047
28048 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28049 @findex -stack-select-frame
28050
28051 @subsubheading Synopsis
28052
28053 @smallexample
28054 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28055 @end smallexample
28056
28057 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28058 the stack.
28059
28060 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28061 option to every command.
28062
28063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28064
28065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28066 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28067
28068 @subsubheading Example
28069
28070 @smallexample
28071 (gdb)
28072 -stack-select-frame 2
28073 ^done
28074 (gdb)
28075 @end smallexample
28076
28077 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28078 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28079 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28080
28081 @ignore
28082
28083 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28084
28085 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28086 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28087 used by @code{Insight}.
28088
28089 The two main reasons for that are:
28090
28091 @enumerate 1
28092 @item
28093 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28094
28095 @item
28096 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28097 now).
28098 @end enumerate
28099
28100 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28101 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28102 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28103 hints about their use.
28104
28105 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28106 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28107 least, the following operations:
28108
28109 @itemize @bullet
28110 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28111 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28112 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28113 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28114 @end itemize
28115
28116 @end ignore
28117
28118 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28119
28120 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28121
28122 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28123 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28124 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28125 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28126 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28127 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28128 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28129 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28130 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28131 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28132 object, or to change display format.
28133
28134 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28135 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28136 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28137 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28138 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28139 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28140 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28141 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28142 child will be created.
28143
28144 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28145 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28146 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28147 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28148 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28149
28150 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28151 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28152 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28153 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28154 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28155 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28156 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28157 variables that frontend has created.
28158
28159 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28160 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28161 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28162 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28163 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28164 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28165 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28166 implicitly updated.
28167
28168 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28169 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28170 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28171 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28172 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28173 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28174 frame. Consider this example:
28175
28176 @smallexample
28177 void do_work(...)
28178 @{
28179 struct work_state state;
28180
28181 if (...)
28182 do_work(...);
28183 @}
28184 @end smallexample
28185
28186 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28187 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28188 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28189 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28190 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28191
28192 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28193 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28194 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28195 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28196 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28197 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28198
28199 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28200 access this functionality:
28201
28202 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28203 @item @strong{Operation}
28204 @tab @strong{Description}
28205
28206 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28207 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28208 @item @code{-var-create}
28209 @tab create a variable object
28210 @item @code{-var-delete}
28211 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28212 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28213 @tab set the display format of this variable
28214 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28215 @tab show the display format of this variable
28216 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28217 @tab tells how many children this object has
28218 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28219 @tab return a list of the object's children
28220 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28221 @tab show the type of this variable object
28222 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28223 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28224 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28225 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28226 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28227 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28228 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28229 @tab get the value of this variable
28230 @item @code{-var-assign}
28231 @tab set the value of this variable
28232 @item @code{-var-update}
28233 @tab update the variable and its children
28234 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28235 @tab set frozeness attribute
28236 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28237 @tab set range of children to display on update
28238 @end multitable
28239
28240 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28241 how it can be used.
28242
28243 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28244
28245 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28246 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28247
28248 @smallexample
28249 -enable-pretty-printing
28250 @end smallexample
28251
28252 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28253 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28254 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28255 request that this functionality be enabled.
28256
28257 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28258
28259 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28260 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28261
28262 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28263 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28264
28265 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28266 @findex -var-create
28267
28268 @subsubheading Synopsis
28269
28270 @smallexample
28271 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28272 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28273 @end smallexample
28274
28275 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28276 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28277 register.
28278
28279 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28280 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28281 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28282 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28283 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28284
28285 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28286 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28287 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28288 object must be created.
28289
28290 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28291 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28292
28293 @itemize @bullet
28294 @item
28295 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28296
28297 @item
28298 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28299
28300 @item
28301 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28302 @end itemize
28303
28304 @cindex dynamic varobj
28305 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28306 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28307 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28308 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28309 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28310 compatibility for existing clients.
28311
28312 @subsubheading Result
28313
28314 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28315 are:
28316
28317 @table @samp
28318 @item name
28319 The name of the varobj.
28320
28321 @item numchild
28322 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28323 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28324 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28325
28326 @item value
28327 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28328 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28329 will not be interesting.
28330
28331 @item type
28332 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28333 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28334 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28335 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28336 @emph{declared} one.
28337
28338 @item thread-id
28339 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28340 thread's identifier.
28341
28342 @item has_more
28343 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28344 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28345
28346 @item dynamic
28347 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28348 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28349 then this attribute will not be present.
28350
28351 @item displayhint
28352 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28353 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28354 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28355 @end table
28356
28357 Typical output will look like this:
28358
28359 @smallexample
28360 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28361 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28362 @end smallexample
28363
28364
28365 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28366 @findex -var-delete
28367
28368 @subsubheading Synopsis
28369
28370 @smallexample
28371 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28372 @end smallexample
28373
28374 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28375 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28376
28377 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28378
28379
28380 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28381 @findex -var-set-format
28382
28383 @subsubheading Synopsis
28384
28385 @smallexample
28386 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28387 @end smallexample
28388
28389 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28390 @var{format-spec}.
28391
28392 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28393 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28394
28395 @smallexample
28396 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28397 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28398 @end smallexample
28399
28400 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28401 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28402 for pointers, etc.).
28403
28404 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28405 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28406
28407 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28408 @findex -var-show-format
28409
28410 @subsubheading Synopsis
28411
28412 @smallexample
28413 -var-show-format @var{name}
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28417
28418 @smallexample
28419 @var{format} @expansion{}
28420 @var{format-spec}
28421 @end smallexample
28422
28423
28424 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28425 @findex -var-info-num-children
28426
28427 @subsubheading Synopsis
28428
28429 @smallexample
28430 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28431 @end smallexample
28432
28433 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28434
28435 @smallexample
28436 numchild=@var{n}
28437 @end smallexample
28438
28439 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28440 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28441 be available.
28442
28443
28444 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28445 @findex -var-list-children
28446
28447 @subsubheading Synopsis
28448
28449 @smallexample
28450 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28451 @end smallexample
28452 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28453
28454 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28455 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28456 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28457 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28458 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28459 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28460 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28461 and unions.
28462
28463 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28464 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28465 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28466 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28467 reported.
28468
28469 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28470 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28471 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28472 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28473 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28474 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28475 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28476 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28477 the visible items.
28478
28479 For each child the following results are returned:
28480
28481 @table @var
28482
28483 @item name
28484 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28485
28486 @item exp
28487 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28488 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28489
28490 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28491 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28492
28493 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28494 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28495 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28496 type and value are not present.
28497
28498 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28499 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28500 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28501
28502 @item numchild
28503 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28504 0.
28505
28506 @item type
28507 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28508 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28509 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28510 @emph{declared} one.
28511
28512 @item value
28513 If values were requested, this is the value.
28514
28515 @item thread-id
28516 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28517 Otherwise this result is not present.
28518
28519 @item frozen
28520 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28521
28522 @item displayhint
28523 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28524 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28525 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28526
28527 @item dynamic
28528 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28529 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28530 then this attribute will not be present.
28531
28532 @end table
28533
28534 The result may have its own attributes:
28535
28536 @table @samp
28537 @item displayhint
28538 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28539 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28540 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28541
28542 @item has_more
28543 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28544 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28545 @end table
28546
28547 @subsubheading Example
28548
28549 @smallexample
28550 (gdb)
28551 -var-list-children n
28552 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28553 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28554 (gdb)
28555 -var-list-children --all-values n
28556 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28557 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28558 @end smallexample
28559
28560
28561 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28562 @findex -var-info-type
28563
28564 @subsubheading Synopsis
28565
28566 @smallexample
28567 -var-info-type @var{name}
28568 @end smallexample
28569
28570 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28571 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28572 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28573
28574 @smallexample
28575 type=@var{typename}
28576 @end smallexample
28577
28578
28579 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28580 @findex -var-info-expression
28581
28582 @subsubheading Synopsis
28583
28584 @smallexample
28585 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28586 @end smallexample
28587
28588 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28589 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28590 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28591
28592 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28593 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28594
28595 @smallexample
28596 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28597 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28598 @end smallexample
28599
28600 @noindent
28601 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28602 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28603
28604 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28605 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28606 is of limited use.
28607
28608 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28609 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28610
28611 @subsubheading Synopsis
28612
28613 @smallexample
28614 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28615 @end smallexample
28616
28617 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28618 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28619 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28620 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28621 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28622 watchpoint from a variable object.
28623
28624 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28625 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28626
28627 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28628 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28629 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28630 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28631 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28632 @smallexample
28633 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28634 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28635 @end smallexample
28636
28637 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28638 @findex -var-show-attributes
28639
28640 @subsubheading Synopsis
28641
28642 @smallexample
28643 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28644 @end smallexample
28645
28646 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28647
28648 @smallexample
28649 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28650 @end smallexample
28651
28652 @noindent
28653 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28654
28655 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28656 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28657
28658 @subsubheading Synopsis
28659
28660 @smallexample
28661 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28662 @end smallexample
28663
28664 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28665 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28666 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28667 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28668 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28669 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28670 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28671
28672 @smallexample
28673 value=@var{value}
28674 @end smallexample
28675
28676 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28677 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28678
28679 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28680 @findex -var-assign
28681
28682 @subsubheading Synopsis
28683
28684 @smallexample
28685 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28686 @end smallexample
28687
28688 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28689 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28690 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28691 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28692
28693 @subsubheading Example
28694
28695 @smallexample
28696 (gdb)
28697 -var-assign var1 3
28698 ^done,value="3"
28699 (gdb)
28700 -var-update *
28701 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28702 (gdb)
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28706 @findex -var-update
28707
28708 @subsubheading Synopsis
28709
28710 @smallexample
28711 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28712 @end smallexample
28713
28714 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28715 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28716 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28717 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28718 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28719 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28720 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28721 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28722 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28723 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28724 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28725 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28726 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28727
28728 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28729 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28730 diagnostic.
28731
28732 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28733 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28734
28735 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28736 @samp{changelist}.
28737
28738 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28739
28740 @table @samp
28741 @item name
28742 The name of the varobj.
28743
28744 @item value
28745 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28746 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28747
28748 @item in_scope
28749 @anchor{-var-update}
28750 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28751
28752 @table @code
28753 @item "true"
28754 The variable object's current value is valid.
28755
28756 @item "false"
28757 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28758 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28759 scope.
28760
28761 @item "invalid"
28762 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28763 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28764 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28765 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28766 objects.
28767 @end table
28768
28769 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28770 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28771
28772 @item type_changed
28773 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28774 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28775 be @samp{false}.
28776
28777 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28778 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28779 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28780 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28781 unset.
28782
28783 @item new_type
28784 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28785 hold the new type.
28786
28787 @item new_num_children
28788 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28789 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28790
28791 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28792 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28793 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28794 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28795 children which may be available.
28796
28797 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28798 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28799 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28800 only happen at the end of the update range).
28801
28802 @item displayhint
28803 The display hint, if any.
28804
28805 @item has_more
28806 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28807 available outside the varobj's update range.
28808
28809 @item dynamic
28810 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28811 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28812 then this attribute will not be present.
28813
28814 @item new_children
28815 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28816 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28817 be listed in this attribute.
28818 @end table
28819
28820 @subsubheading Example
28821
28822 @smallexample
28823 (gdb)
28824 -var-assign var1 3
28825 ^done,value="3"
28826 (gdb)
28827 -var-update --all-values var1
28828 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28829 type_changed="false"@}]
28830 (gdb)
28831 @end smallexample
28832
28833 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28834 @findex -var-set-frozen
28835 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28836
28837 @subsubheading Synopsis
28838
28839 @smallexample
28840 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28841 @end smallexample
28842
28843 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28844 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28845 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28846 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28847 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28848 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28849 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28850 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28851 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28852 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28853 @code{-var-update} does.
28854
28855 @subsubheading Example
28856
28857 @smallexample
28858 (gdb)
28859 -var-set-frozen V 1
28860 ^done
28861 (gdb)
28862 @end smallexample
28863
28864 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28865 @findex -var-set-update-range
28866 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28867
28868 @subsubheading Synopsis
28869
28870 @smallexample
28871 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28872 @end smallexample
28873
28874 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28875 @code{-var-update}.
28876
28877 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28878 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28879 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28880 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28881
28882 @subsubheading Example
28883
28884 @smallexample
28885 (gdb)
28886 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28887 ^done
28888 @end smallexample
28889
28890 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28891 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28892 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28893
28894 @subsubheading Synopsis
28895
28896 @smallexample
28897 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28898 @end smallexample
28899
28900 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28901
28902 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28903 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28904
28905 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28906 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28907 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28908 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28909 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28910 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28911 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28912
28913 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28914 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28915 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28916 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28917
28918 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28919 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28920 can be used to check this.
28921
28922 @subsubheading Example
28923
28924 Resetting the visualizer:
28925
28926 @smallexample
28927 (gdb)
28928 -var-set-visualizer V None
28929 ^done
28930 @end smallexample
28931
28932 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28933
28934 @smallexample
28935 (gdb)
28936 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28937 ^done
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28941 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28942
28943 @smallexample
28944 (gdb)
28945 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28946 ^done
28947 @end smallexample
28948
28949 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28950 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28951 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28952
28953 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28954 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28955 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28956 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28957
28958 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28959 @c @subheading -data-assign
28960 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28961 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28962 @c set variable
28963 @c @subsubheading Example
28964 @c N.A.
28965
28966 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28967 @findex -data-disassemble
28968
28969 @subsubheading Synopsis
28970
28971 @smallexample
28972 -data-disassemble
28973 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28974 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28975 -- @var{mode}
28976 @end smallexample
28977
28978 @noindent
28979 Where:
28980
28981 @table @samp
28982 @item @var{start-addr}
28983 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28984 @item @var{end-addr}
28985 is the end address
28986 @item @var{filename}
28987 is the name of the file to disassemble
28988 @item @var{linenum}
28989 is the line number to disassemble around
28990 @item @var{lines}
28991 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28992 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28993 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28994 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28995 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28996 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28997 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28998 are displayed.
28999 @item @var{mode}
29000 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29001 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29002 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29003 @end table
29004
29005 @subsubheading Result
29006
29007 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29008 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29009 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29010
29011 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29012 following fields:
29013
29014 @table @code
29015 @item address
29016 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29017
29018 @item func-name
29019 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29020
29021 @item offset
29022 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29023
29024 @item inst
29025 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29026
29027 @item opcodes
29028 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29029 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29030
29031 @end table
29032
29033 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29034 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29035
29036 @table @code
29037 @item line
29038 The line number within @samp{file}.
29039
29040 @item file
29041 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29042 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29043 used.
29044
29045 @item fullname
29046 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29047 using the source file search path
29048 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29049 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29050
29051 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29052 present in the debug information.
29053
29054 @item line_asm_insn
29055 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29056 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29057 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29058 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29059 @samp{opcodes}.
29060
29061 @end table
29062
29063 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29064 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29065 adjust its format.
29066
29067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29068
29069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29070
29071 @subsubheading Example
29072
29073 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29074
29075 @smallexample
29076 (gdb)
29077 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29078 ^done,
29079 asm_insns=[
29080 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29081 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29082 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29083 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29084 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29085 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29086 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29087 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29088 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29089 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29090 (gdb)
29091 @end smallexample
29092
29093 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29094 @code{main}.
29095
29096 @smallexample
29097 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29098 ^done,asm_insns=[
29099 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29100 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29101 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29102 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29103 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29104 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29105 [@dots{}]
29106 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29107 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29108 (gdb)
29109 @end smallexample
29110
29111 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29112
29113 @smallexample
29114 (gdb)
29115 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29116 ^done,asm_insns=[
29117 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29118 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29119 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29120 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29121 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29122 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29123 (gdb)
29124 @end smallexample
29125
29126 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29127
29128 @smallexample
29129 (gdb)
29130 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29131 ^done,asm_insns=[
29132 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29133 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29134 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29135 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29136 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29137 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29138 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29139 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29140 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29141 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29142 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29143 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29144 (gdb)
29145 @end smallexample
29146
29147
29148 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29149 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29150
29151 @subsubheading Synopsis
29152
29153 @smallexample
29154 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29155 @end smallexample
29156
29157 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29158 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29159 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29160
29161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29162
29163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29164 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29165 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29166
29167 @subsubheading Example
29168
29169 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29170 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29171 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29172 output.
29173
29174 @smallexample
29175 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29176 211^done,value="1"
29177 (gdb)
29178 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29179 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29180 (gdb)
29181 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29182 411^done,value="4"
29183 (gdb)
29184 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29185 511^done,value="4"
29186 (gdb)
29187 @end smallexample
29188
29189
29190 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29191 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29192
29193 @subsubheading Synopsis
29194
29195 @smallexample
29196 -data-list-changed-registers
29197 @end smallexample
29198
29199 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29200
29201 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29202
29203 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29204 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29205
29206 @subsubheading Example
29207
29208 On a PPC MBX board:
29209
29210 @smallexample
29211 (gdb)
29212 -exec-continue
29213 ^running
29214
29215 (gdb)
29216 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29217 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29218 line="5"@}
29219 (gdb)
29220 -data-list-changed-registers
29221 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29222 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29223 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29224 (gdb)
29225 @end smallexample
29226
29227
29228 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29229 @findex -data-list-register-names
29230
29231 @subsubheading Synopsis
29232
29233 @smallexample
29234 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29235 @end smallexample
29236
29237 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29238 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29239 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29240 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29241 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29242 include empty register names.
29243
29244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29245
29246 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29247 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29248 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29249
29250 @subsubheading Example
29251
29252 For the PPC MBX board:
29253 @smallexample
29254 (gdb)
29255 -data-list-register-names
29256 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29257 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29258 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29259 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29260 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29261 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29262 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29263 (gdb)
29264 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29265 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29266 (gdb)
29267 @end smallexample
29268
29269 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29270 @findex -data-list-register-values
29271
29272 @subsubheading Synopsis
29273
29274 @smallexample
29275 -data-list-register-values
29276 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29277 @end smallexample
29278
29279 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29280 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29281 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29282 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29283 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29284 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29285
29286 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29287
29288 @table @code
29289 @item x
29290 Hexadecimal
29291 @item o
29292 Octal
29293 @item t
29294 Binary
29295 @item d
29296 Decimal
29297 @item r
29298 Raw
29299 @item N
29300 Natural
29301 @end table
29302
29303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29304
29305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29306 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29307
29308 @subsubheading Example
29309
29310 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29311 don't appear in the actual output):
29312
29313 @smallexample
29314 (gdb)
29315 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29316 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29317 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29318 (gdb)
29319 -data-list-register-values x
29320 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29321 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29322 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29323 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29324 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29325 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29326 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29327 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29328 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29329 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29330 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29331 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29332 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29333 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29334 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29335 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29336 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29337 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29338 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29339 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29340 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29341 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29342 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29343 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29344 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29345 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29346 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29347 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29348 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29349 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29350 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29351 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29352 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29353 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29354 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29355 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29356 (gdb)
29357 @end smallexample
29358
29359
29360 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29361 @findex -data-read-memory
29362
29363 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29364
29365 @subsubheading Synopsis
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29369 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29370 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29371 @end smallexample
29372
29373 @noindent
29374 where:
29375
29376 @table @samp
29377 @item @var{address}
29378 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29379 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29380 quoted using the C convention.
29381
29382 @item @var{word-format}
29383 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29384 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29385 ,Output Formats}).
29386
29387 @item @var{word-size}
29388 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29389
29390 @item @var{nr-rows}
29391 The number of rows in the output table.
29392
29393 @item @var{nr-cols}
29394 The number of columns in the output table.
29395
29396 @item @var{aschar}
29397 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29398 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29399 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29400 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29401
29402 @item @var{byte-offset}
29403 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29404 @end table
29405
29406 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29407 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29408 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29409 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29410 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29411 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29412 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29413 @samp{addr}.
29414
29415 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29416 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29417 @samp{prev-page}.
29418
29419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29420
29421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29422 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29423
29424 @subsubheading Example
29425
29426 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29427 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29428 word. Display each word in hex.
29429
29430 @smallexample
29431 (gdb)
29432 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29433 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29434 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29435 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29436 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29437 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29438 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29439 (gdb)
29440 @end smallexample
29441
29442 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29443 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29444
29445 @smallexample
29446 (gdb)
29447 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29448 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29449 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29450 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29451 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29452 (gdb)
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29456 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29457 used as the non-printable character.
29458
29459 @smallexample
29460 (gdb)
29461 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29462 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29463 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29464 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29465 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29466 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29467 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29468 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29469 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29470 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29471 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29472 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29473 (gdb)
29474 @end smallexample
29475
29476 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29477 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29478
29479 @subsubheading Synopsis
29480
29481 @smallexample
29482 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29483 @var{address} @var{count}
29484 @end smallexample
29485
29486 @noindent
29487 where:
29488
29489 @table @samp
29490 @item @var{address}
29491 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29492 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29493 quoted using the C convention.
29494
29495 @item @var{count}
29496 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29497
29498 @item @var{byte-offset}
29499 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29500 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29501 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29502 perform address arithmetics itself.
29503
29504 @end table
29505
29506 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29507 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29508 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29509 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29510 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29511 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29512
29513 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29514 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29515 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29516 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29517 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29518 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29519 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29520 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29521
29522 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29523 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29524 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29525 and has the following fields:
29526
29527 @table @code
29528 @item begin
29529 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29530
29531 @item end
29532 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29533
29534 @item offset
29535 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29536 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29537
29538 @item contents
29539 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29540
29541 @end table
29542
29543
29544
29545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29546
29547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29548
29549 @subsubheading Example
29550
29551 @smallexample
29552 (gdb)
29553 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29554 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29555 end="0xbffff15e",
29556 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29557 (gdb)
29558 @end smallexample
29559
29560
29561 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29562 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29563
29564 @subsubheading Synopsis
29565
29566 @smallexample
29567 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29568 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29569 @end smallexample
29570
29571 @noindent
29572 where:
29573
29574 @table @samp
29575 @item @var{address}
29576 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29577 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29578 quoted using the C convention.
29579
29580 @item @var{contents}
29581 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29582
29583 @item @var{count}
29584 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29585 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29586 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29587
29588 @end table
29589
29590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29591
29592 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29593
29594 @subsubheading Example
29595
29596 @smallexample
29597 (gdb)
29598 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29599 ^done
29600 (gdb)
29601 @end smallexample
29602
29603 @smallexample
29604 (gdb)
29605 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29606 ^done
29607 (gdb)
29608 @end smallexample
29609
29610 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29611 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29612 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29613
29614 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29615 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29616
29617 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29618 @findex -trace-find
29619
29620 @subsubheading Synopsis
29621
29622 @smallexample
29623 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29624 @end smallexample
29625
29626 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29627 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29628 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29629
29630 @table @samp
29631
29632 @item none
29633 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29634
29635 @item frame-number
29636 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29637 that index.
29638
29639 @item tracepoint-number
29640 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29641 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29642
29643 @item pc
29644 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29645 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29646 address.
29647
29648 @item pc-inside-range
29649 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29650 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29651 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29652
29653 @item pc-outside-range
29654 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29655 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29656 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29657
29658 @item line
29659 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29660 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29661 the specified location.
29662
29663 @end table
29664
29665 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29666 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29667
29668 @table @samp
29669 @item found
29670 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29671 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29672
29673 @item traceframe
29674 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29675 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29676
29677 @item tracepoint
29678 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29679 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29680
29681 @item frame
29682 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29683 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29684 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29685
29686 @end table
29687
29688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29689
29690 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29691
29692 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29693 @findex -trace-define-variable
29694
29695 @subsubheading Synopsis
29696
29697 @smallexample
29698 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29699 @end smallexample
29700
29701 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29702 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29703 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29704 with the @samp{$} character.
29705
29706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29707
29708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29709
29710 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29711 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29712
29713 @subsubheading Synopsis
29714
29715 @smallexample
29716 -trace-frame-collected
29717 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29718 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29719 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29720 [--memory-contents]
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29724 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29725 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29726 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29727 See the output description table below for more details.
29728
29729 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29730 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29731 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29732 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29733 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29734
29735 For instance, if the actions were
29736 @smallexample
29737 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29738 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29739 @end smallexample
29740
29741 @noindent
29742 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29743 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29744 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29745 objects would be computed expressions.
29746
29747 An example output would be:
29748
29749 @smallexample
29750 (gdb)
29751 -trace-frame-collected
29752 ^done,
29753 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29754 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29755 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29756 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29757 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29758 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29759 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29760 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29761 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29762 ...
29763 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29764 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29765 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29766 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29767 (gdb)
29768 @end smallexample
29769
29770 Where:
29771
29772 @table @code
29773 @item explicit-variables
29774 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29775 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29776 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29777 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29778 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29779 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29780 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29781 arrays, structures and unions.
29782
29783 @item computed-expressions
29784 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29785 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29786 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29787 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29788
29789 @item registers
29790 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29791 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29792 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29793 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29794 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29795
29796 @item tvars
29797 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29798 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29799 current value are returned.
29800
29801 @item memory
29802 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29803 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29804 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29805
29806 @table @code
29807 @item address
29808 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29809
29810 @item length
29811 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29812
29813 @item contents
29814 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29815 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29816
29817 @end table
29818
29819 @end table
29820
29821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29822
29823 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29824
29825 @subsubheading Example
29826
29827 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29828 @findex -trace-list-variables
29829
29830 @subsubheading Synopsis
29831
29832 @smallexample
29833 -trace-list-variables
29834 @end smallexample
29835
29836 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29837 table has the following fields:
29838
29839 @table @samp
29840 @item name
29841 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29842
29843 @item initial
29844 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29845 field is always present.
29846
29847 @item current
29848 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29849 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29850 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29851 presently running.
29852
29853 @end table
29854
29855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29856
29857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29858
29859 @subsubheading Example
29860
29861 @smallexample
29862 (gdb)
29863 -trace-list-variables
29864 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29865 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29866 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29867 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29868 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29869 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29870 (gdb)
29871 @end smallexample
29872
29873 @subheading -trace-save
29874 @findex -trace-save
29875
29876 @subsubheading Synopsis
29877
29878 @smallexample
29879 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29880 @end smallexample
29881
29882 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29883 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29884 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29885 to perform the save.
29886
29887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29888
29889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29890
29891
29892 @subheading -trace-start
29893 @findex -trace-start
29894
29895 @subsubheading Synopsis
29896
29897 @smallexample
29898 -trace-start
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29902 have any fields.
29903
29904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29905
29906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29907
29908 @subheading -trace-status
29909 @findex -trace-status
29910
29911 @subsubheading Synopsis
29912
29913 @smallexample
29914 -trace-status
29915 @end smallexample
29916
29917 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29918 the following fields:
29919
29920 @table @samp
29921
29922 @item supported
29923 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29924 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29925 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29926 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29927 started. This field is always present.
29928
29929 @item running
29930 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29931 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29932 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29933
29934 @item stop-reason
29935 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29936 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29937 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29938 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29939 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29940 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29941 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29942 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29943 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29944
29945 @item stopping-tracepoint
29946 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29947 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29948 @samp{passcount}.
29949
29950 @item frames
29951 @itemx frames-created
29952 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29953 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29954 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29955 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29956
29957 @item buffer-size
29958 @itemx buffer-free
29959 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29960 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29961
29962 @item circular
29963 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29964 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29965 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29966 and may fill up.
29967
29968 @item disconnected
29969 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29970 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29971 that the trace run will stop.
29972
29973 @item trace-file
29974 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29975 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29976
29977 @end table
29978
29979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29980
29981 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29982
29983 @subheading -trace-stop
29984 @findex -trace-stop
29985
29986 @subsubheading Synopsis
29987
29988 @smallexample
29989 -trace-stop
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29993 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29994 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29995
29996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29997
29998 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29999
30000
30001 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30002 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30003 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30004
30005
30006 @ignore
30007 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30008 @findex -symbol-info-address
30009
30010 @subsubheading Synopsis
30011
30012 @smallexample
30013 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30014 @end smallexample
30015
30016 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30017
30018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30019
30020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30021
30022 @subsubheading Example
30023 N.A.
30024
30025
30026 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30027 @findex -symbol-info-file
30028
30029 @subsubheading Synopsis
30030
30031 @smallexample
30032 -symbol-info-file
30033 @end smallexample
30034
30035 Show the file for the symbol.
30036
30037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30038
30039 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30040 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30041
30042 @subsubheading Example
30043 N.A.
30044
30045
30046 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30047 @findex -symbol-info-function
30048
30049 @subsubheading Synopsis
30050
30051 @smallexample
30052 -symbol-info-function
30053 @end smallexample
30054
30055 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30056
30057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30058
30059 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30060
30061 @subsubheading Example
30062 N.A.
30063
30064
30065 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30066 @findex -symbol-info-line
30067
30068 @subsubheading Synopsis
30069
30070 @smallexample
30071 -symbol-info-line
30072 @end smallexample
30073
30074 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30075
30076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30077
30078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30079 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30080
30081 @subsubheading Example
30082 N.A.
30083
30084
30085 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30086 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30087
30088 @subsubheading Synopsis
30089
30090 @smallexample
30091 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30092 @end smallexample
30093
30094 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30095
30096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30097
30098 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30099
30100 @subsubheading Example
30101 N.A.
30102
30103
30104 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30105 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30106
30107 @subsubheading Synopsis
30108
30109 @smallexample
30110 -symbol-list-functions
30111 @end smallexample
30112
30113 List the functions in the executable.
30114
30115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30116
30117 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30118 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30119
30120 @subsubheading Example
30121 N.A.
30122 @end ignore
30123
30124
30125 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30126 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30127
30128 @subsubheading Synopsis
30129
30130 @smallexample
30131 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30132 @end smallexample
30133
30134 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30135 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30136 ascending PC order.
30137
30138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30139
30140 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30141
30142 @subsubheading Example
30143 @smallexample
30144 (gdb)
30145 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30146 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30147 (gdb)
30148 @end smallexample
30149
30150
30151 @ignore
30152 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30153 @findex -symbol-list-types
30154
30155 @subsubheading Synopsis
30156
30157 @smallexample
30158 -symbol-list-types
30159 @end smallexample
30160
30161 List all the type names.
30162
30163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30164
30165 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30166 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30167
30168 @subsubheading Example
30169 N.A.
30170
30171
30172 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30173 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30174
30175 @subsubheading Synopsis
30176
30177 @smallexample
30178 -symbol-list-variables
30179 @end smallexample
30180
30181 List all the global and static variable names.
30182
30183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30184
30185 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30186
30187 @subsubheading Example
30188 N.A.
30189
30190
30191 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30192 @findex -symbol-locate
30193
30194 @subsubheading Synopsis
30195
30196 @smallexample
30197 -symbol-locate
30198 @end smallexample
30199
30200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30201
30202 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30203
30204 @subsubheading Example
30205 N.A.
30206
30207
30208 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30209 @findex -symbol-type
30210
30211 @subsubheading Synopsis
30212
30213 @smallexample
30214 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30215 @end smallexample
30216
30217 Show type of @var{variable}.
30218
30219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30220
30221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30222 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30223
30224 @subsubheading Example
30225 N.A.
30226 @end ignore
30227
30228
30229 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30230 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30231 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30232
30233 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30234 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30235
30236 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30237 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30238
30239 @subsubheading Synopsis
30240
30241 @smallexample
30242 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30243 @end smallexample
30244
30245 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30246 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30247 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30248 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30249 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30250 notification.
30251
30252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30253
30254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30255
30256 @subsubheading Example
30257
30258 @smallexample
30259 (gdb)
30260 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30261 ^done
30262 (gdb)
30263 @end smallexample
30264
30265
30266 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30267 @findex -file-exec-file
30268
30269 @subsubheading Synopsis
30270
30271 @smallexample
30272 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30273 @end smallexample
30274
30275 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30276 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30277 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30278 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30279 notification.
30280
30281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30282
30283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30284
30285 @subsubheading Example
30286
30287 @smallexample
30288 (gdb)
30289 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30290 ^done
30291 (gdb)
30292 @end smallexample
30293
30294
30295 @ignore
30296 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30297 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30298
30299 @subsubheading Synopsis
30300
30301 @smallexample
30302 -file-list-exec-sections
30303 @end smallexample
30304
30305 List the sections of the current executable file.
30306
30307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30308
30309 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30310 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30311 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30312
30313 @subsubheading Example
30314 N.A.
30315 @end ignore
30316
30317
30318 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30319 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30320
30321 @subsubheading Synopsis
30322
30323 @smallexample
30324 -file-list-exec-source-file
30325 @end smallexample
30326
30327 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30328 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30329 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30330 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30331
30332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30333
30334 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30335
30336 @subsubheading Example
30337
30338 @smallexample
30339 (gdb)
30340 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30341 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30342 (gdb)
30343 @end smallexample
30344
30345
30346 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30347 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30348
30349 @subsubheading Synopsis
30350
30351 @smallexample
30352 -file-list-exec-source-files
30353 @end smallexample
30354
30355 List the source files for the current executable.
30356
30357 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30358 name) of a source file.
30359
30360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30361
30362 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30363 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30364
30365 @subsubheading Example
30366 @smallexample
30367 (gdb)
30368 -file-list-exec-source-files
30369 ^done,files=[
30370 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30371 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30372 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30373 (gdb)
30374 @end smallexample
30375
30376 @ignore
30377 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30378 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30379
30380 @subsubheading Synopsis
30381
30382 @smallexample
30383 -file-list-shared-libraries
30384 @end smallexample
30385
30386 List the shared libraries in the program.
30387
30388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30389
30390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30391
30392 @subsubheading Example
30393 N.A.
30394
30395
30396 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30397 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30398
30399 @subsubheading Synopsis
30400
30401 @smallexample
30402 -file-list-symbol-files
30403 @end smallexample
30404
30405 List symbol files.
30406
30407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30408
30409 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30410
30411 @subsubheading Example
30412 N.A.
30413 @end ignore
30414
30415
30416 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30417 @findex -file-symbol-file
30418
30419 @subsubheading Synopsis
30420
30421 @smallexample
30422 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30423 @end smallexample
30424
30425 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30426 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30427 produced, except for a completion notification.
30428
30429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30430
30431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30432
30433 @subsubheading Example
30434
30435 @smallexample
30436 (gdb)
30437 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30438 ^done
30439 (gdb)
30440 @end smallexample
30441
30442 @ignore
30443 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30444 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30445 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30446
30447 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30448
30449 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30450
30451 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30452
30453 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30454
30455 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30456
30457 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30458
30459 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30460
30461 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30462
30463 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30464 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30465 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30466
30467 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30468
30469 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30470
30471 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30472
30473 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30474 @end ignore
30475
30476
30477 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30478 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30479 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30480
30481
30482 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30483 @findex -target-attach
30484
30485 @subsubheading Synopsis
30486
30487 @smallexample
30488 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30489 @end smallexample
30490
30491 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30492 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30493 group, the id previously returned by
30494 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30495
30496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30497
30498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30499
30500 @subsubheading Example
30501 @smallexample
30502 (gdb)
30503 -target-attach 34
30504 =thread-created,id="1"
30505 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30506 ^done
30507 (gdb)
30508 @end smallexample
30509
30510 @ignore
30511 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30512 @findex -target-compare-sections
30513
30514 @subsubheading Synopsis
30515
30516 @smallexample
30517 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30518 @end smallexample
30519
30520 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30521 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30522
30523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30524
30525 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30526
30527 @subsubheading Example
30528 N.A.
30529 @end ignore
30530
30531
30532 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30533 @findex -target-detach
30534
30535 @subsubheading Synopsis
30536
30537 @smallexample
30538 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30539 @end smallexample
30540
30541 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30542 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30543 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30544
30545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30546
30547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30548
30549 @subsubheading Example
30550
30551 @smallexample
30552 (gdb)
30553 -target-detach
30554 ^done
30555 (gdb)
30556 @end smallexample
30557
30558
30559 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30560 @findex -target-disconnect
30561
30562 @subsubheading Synopsis
30563
30564 @smallexample
30565 -target-disconnect
30566 @end smallexample
30567
30568 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30569 generally not resumed.
30570
30571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30572
30573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30574
30575 @subsubheading Example
30576
30577 @smallexample
30578 (gdb)
30579 -target-disconnect
30580 ^done
30581 (gdb)
30582 @end smallexample
30583
30584
30585 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30586 @findex -target-download
30587
30588 @subsubheading Synopsis
30589
30590 @smallexample
30591 -target-download
30592 @end smallexample
30593
30594 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30595 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30596
30597 @table @samp
30598 @item section
30599 The name of the section.
30600 @item section-sent
30601 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30602 @item section-size
30603 The size of the section.
30604 @item total-sent
30605 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30606 @item total-size
30607 The size of the overall executable to download.
30608 @end table
30609
30610 @noindent
30611 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30612 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30613
30614 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30615 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30616
30617 @table @samp
30618 @item section
30619 The name of the section.
30620 @item section-size
30621 The size of the section.
30622 @item total-size
30623 The size of the overall executable to download.
30624 @end table
30625
30626 @noindent
30627 At the end, a summary is printed.
30628
30629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30630
30631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30632
30633 @subsubheading Example
30634
30635 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30636 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30637
30638 @smallexample
30639 (gdb)
30640 -target-download
30641 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30642 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30643 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30644 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30645 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30646 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30647 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30648 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30649 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30650 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30651 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30652 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30653 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30654 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30655 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30656 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30657 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30658 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30659 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30660 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30661 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30662 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30663 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30664 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30665 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30666 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30667 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30668 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30669 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30670 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30671 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30672 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30673 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30674 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30675 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30676 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30677 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30678 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30679 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30680 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30681 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30682 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30683 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30684 write-rate="429"
30685 (gdb)
30686 @end smallexample
30687
30688
30689 @ignore
30690 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30691 @findex -target-exec-status
30692
30693 @subsubheading Synopsis
30694
30695 @smallexample
30696 -target-exec-status
30697 @end smallexample
30698
30699 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30700 not, for instance).
30701
30702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30703
30704 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30705
30706 @subsubheading Example
30707 N.A.
30708
30709
30710 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30711 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30712
30713 @subsubheading Synopsis
30714
30715 @smallexample
30716 -target-list-available-targets
30717 @end smallexample
30718
30719 List the possible targets to connect to.
30720
30721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30722
30723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30724
30725 @subsubheading Example
30726 N.A.
30727
30728
30729 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30730 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30731
30732 @subsubheading Synopsis
30733
30734 @smallexample
30735 -target-list-current-targets
30736 @end smallexample
30737
30738 Describe the current target.
30739
30740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30741
30742 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30743 other things).
30744
30745 @subsubheading Example
30746 N.A.
30747
30748
30749 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30750 @findex -target-list-parameters
30751
30752 @subsubheading Synopsis
30753
30754 @smallexample
30755 -target-list-parameters
30756 @end smallexample
30757
30758 @c ????
30759 @end ignore
30760
30761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30762
30763 No equivalent.
30764
30765 @subsubheading Example
30766 N.A.
30767
30768
30769 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30770 @findex -target-select
30771
30772 @subsubheading Synopsis
30773
30774 @smallexample
30775 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30776 @end smallexample
30777
30778 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30779
30780 @table @samp
30781 @item @var{type}
30782 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30783 @item @var{parameters}
30784 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30785 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30786 @end table
30787
30788 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30789 which the target program is, in the following form:
30790
30791 @smallexample
30792 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30793 args=[@var{arg list}]
30794 @end smallexample
30795
30796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30797
30798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30799
30800 @subsubheading Example
30801
30802 @smallexample
30803 (gdb)
30804 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30805 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30806 (gdb)
30807 @end smallexample
30808
30809 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30810 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30811 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30812
30813
30814 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30815 @findex -target-file-put
30816
30817 @subsubheading Synopsis
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30824 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30825
30826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30827
30828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30829
30830 @subsubheading Example
30831
30832 @smallexample
30833 (gdb)
30834 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30835 ^done
30836 (gdb)
30837 @end smallexample
30838
30839
30840 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30841 @findex -target-file-get
30842
30843 @subsubheading Synopsis
30844
30845 @smallexample
30846 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30847 @end smallexample
30848
30849 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30850 on the host system.
30851
30852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30853
30854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30855
30856 @subsubheading Example
30857
30858 @smallexample
30859 (gdb)
30860 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30861 ^done
30862 (gdb)
30863 @end smallexample
30864
30865
30866 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30867 @findex -target-file-delete
30868
30869 @subsubheading Synopsis
30870
30871 @smallexample
30872 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30873 @end smallexample
30874
30875 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30876
30877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30878
30879 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30880
30881 @subsubheading Example
30882
30883 @smallexample
30884 (gdb)
30885 -target-file-delete remotefile
30886 ^done
30887 (gdb)
30888 @end smallexample
30889
30890
30891 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30892 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30893 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30894
30895 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30896 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30897
30898 @subsubheading Synopsis
30899
30900 @smallexample
30901 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30902 @end smallexample
30903
30904 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30905 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30906 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30907
30908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30909
30910 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30911
30912 @subsubheading Result
30913
30914 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30915 defined for each exception:
30916
30917 @table @samp
30918 @item name
30919 The name of the exception.
30920
30921 @item address
30922 The address of the exception.
30923
30924 @end table
30925
30926 @subsubheading Example
30927
30928 @smallexample
30929 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30930 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30931 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30932 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30933 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30934 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30935 @end smallexample
30936
30937 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30938
30939 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30940 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30941 Catchpoint Commands}.
30942
30943
30944 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30945 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30946 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30947
30948 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30949 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30950 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30951 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30952
30953 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30954 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30955 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30956
30957 @subsubheading Synopsis
30958
30959 @smallexample
30960 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30961 @end smallexample
30962
30963 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30964
30965 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30966 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30967 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30968 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30969 dash.
30970
30971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30972
30973 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30974
30975 @subsubheading Result
30976
30977 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30978
30979 @table @samp
30980 @item exists
30981 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30982 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30983
30984 @end table
30985
30986 @subsubheading Example
30987
30988 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30989
30990 @smallexample
30991 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30992 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30993 @end smallexample
30994
30995 @noindent
30996 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30997 to the debugger:
30998
30999 @smallexample
31000 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31001 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31002 @end smallexample
31003
31004 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31005 @findex -list-features
31006 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31007
31008 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31009 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31010 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31011 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31012 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31013 startup.
31014
31015 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31016 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31017 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31018 is given below.
31019
31020 Example output:
31021
31022 @smallexample
31023 (gdb) -list-features
31024 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31025 @end smallexample
31026
31027 The current list of features is:
31028
31029 @ftable @samp
31030 @item frozen-varobjs
31031 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31032 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31033 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31034 @item pending-breakpoints
31035 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31036 command.
31037 @item python
31038 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31039 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31040 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31041 @item thread-info
31042 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31043 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31044 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31045 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31046 @item breakpoint-notifications
31047 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31048 CLI will be announced via async records.
31049 @item ada-task-info
31050 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31051 @item language-option
31052 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31053 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31054 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31055 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31056 @item undefined-command-error-code
31057 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31058 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31059 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31060 @item exec-run-start-option
31061 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31062 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31063 @end ftable
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31066 @findex -list-target-features
31067
31068 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31069 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31070 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31071 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31072 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31073 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31074 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31075 Example output:
31076
31077 @smallexample
31078 (gdb) -list-target-features
31079 ^done,result=["async"]
31080 @end smallexample
31081
31082 The current list of features is:
31083
31084 @table @samp
31085 @item async
31086 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31087 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31088 while the target is running.
31089
31090 @item reverse
31091 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31092 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31093
31094 @end table
31095
31096 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31097 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31098 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31099
31100 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31101
31102 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31103 @findex -gdb-exit
31104
31105 @subsubheading Synopsis
31106
31107 @smallexample
31108 -gdb-exit
31109 @end smallexample
31110
31111 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31112
31113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31114
31115 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31116
31117 @subsubheading Example
31118
31119 @smallexample
31120 (gdb)
31121 -gdb-exit
31122 ^exit
31123 @end smallexample
31124
31125
31126 @ignore
31127 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31128 @findex -exec-abort
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -exec-abort
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 Kill the inferior running program.
31137
31138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31139
31140 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31141
31142 @subsubheading Example
31143 N.A.
31144 @end ignore
31145
31146
31147 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31148 @findex -gdb-set
31149
31150 @subsubheading Synopsis
31151
31152 @smallexample
31153 -gdb-set
31154 @end smallexample
31155
31156 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31157 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31158
31159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31160
31161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31162
31163 @subsubheading Example
31164
31165 @smallexample
31166 (gdb)
31167 -gdb-set $foo=3
31168 ^done
31169 (gdb)
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172
31173 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31174 @findex -gdb-show
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -gdb-show
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31183
31184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31185
31186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31187
31188 @subsubheading Example
31189
31190 @smallexample
31191 (gdb)
31192 -gdb-show annotate
31193 ^done,value="0"
31194 (gdb)
31195 @end smallexample
31196
31197 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31198
31199
31200 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31201 @findex -gdb-version
31202
31203 @subsubheading Synopsis
31204
31205 @smallexample
31206 -gdb-version
31207 @end smallexample
31208
31209 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31210
31211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31212
31213 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31214 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31215
31216 @subsubheading Example
31217
31218 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31219 @c box in TeX.
31220 @smallexample
31221 (gdb)
31222 -gdb-version
31223 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31224 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31225 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31226 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31227 ~ certain conditions.
31228 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31229 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31230 ~ details.
31231 ~This GDB was configured as
31232 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31233 ^done
31234 (gdb)
31235 @end smallexample
31236
31237 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31238 @findex -list-thread-groups
31239
31240 @subheading Synopsis
31241
31242 @smallexample
31243 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31244 @end smallexample
31245
31246 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31247 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31248 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31249 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31250 top-level thread groups.
31251
31252 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31253 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31254 available on the target.
31255
31256 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31257 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31258 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31259 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31260 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31261 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31262 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31263 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31264
31265 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31266 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31267 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31268 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31269 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31270 @samp{threads} field.
31271
31272 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31273 the following caveats:
31274
31275 @itemize @bullet
31276 @item
31277 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31278 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31279 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31280
31281 @item
31282 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31283 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31284 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31285 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31286 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31287 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31288
31289 @end itemize
31290
31291 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31292 have the following fields:
31293
31294 @table @code
31295 @item id
31296 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31297 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31298 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31299
31300 @item type
31301 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31302 valid type.
31303
31304 @item pid
31305 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31306 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31307
31308 @item num_children
31309 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31310 absent for an available thread group.
31311
31312 @item threads
31313 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31314 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31315 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31316
31317 @item cores
31318 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31319 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31320 such information is not available.
31321
31322 @item executable
31323 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31324 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31325 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31326
31327 @end table
31328
31329 @subheading Example
31330
31331 @smallexample
31332 @value{GDBP}
31333 -list-thread-groups
31334 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31335 -list-thread-groups 17
31336 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31337 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31338 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31339 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31340 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31341 -list-thread-groups --available
31342 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31343 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31344 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31345 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31346 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31347 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31348 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31349 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31350 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31351 @end smallexample
31352
31353 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31354 @findex -info-os
31355
31356 @subsubheading Synopsis
31357
31358 @smallexample
31359 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31360 @end smallexample
31361
31362 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31363 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31364 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31365 of data of that type.
31366
31367 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31368 system.
31369
31370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31371
31372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31373
31374 @subsubheading Example
31375
31376 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31377 like this:
31378
31379 @smallexample
31380 @value{GDBP}
31381 -info-os
31382 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31383 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31384 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31385 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31386 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31387 col2="Processes"@},
31388 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31389 col2="Process groups"@},
31390 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31391 col2="Threads"@},
31392 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31393 col2="File descriptors"@},
31394 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31395 col2="Sockets"@},
31396 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31397 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31398 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31399 col2="Semaphores"@},
31400 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31401 col2="Message queues"@},
31402 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31403 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31404 @value{GDBP}
31405 -info-os processes
31406 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31407 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31408 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31409 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31410 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31411 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31412 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31413 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31414 ...
31415 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31416 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31417 (gdb)
31418 @end smallexample
31419
31420 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31421 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31422 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31423 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31424 @code{info os} omits it.)
31425
31426 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31427 @findex -add-inferior
31428
31429 @subheading Synopsis
31430
31431 @smallexample
31432 -add-inferior
31433 @end smallexample
31434
31435 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31436 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31437 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31438 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31439 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31440 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31441
31442 @subheading Example
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 @value{GDBP}
31446 -add-inferior
31447 ^done,inferior="i3"
31448 @end smallexample
31449
31450 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31451 @findex -interpreter-exec
31452
31453 @subheading Synopsis
31454
31455 @smallexample
31456 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31457 @end smallexample
31458 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31459
31460 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31461
31462 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31463
31464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31465
31466 @subheading Example
31467
31468 @smallexample
31469 (gdb)
31470 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31471 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31472 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31473 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31474 ^done
31475 (gdb)
31476 @end smallexample
31477
31478 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31479 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31480
31481 @subheading Synopsis
31482
31483 @smallexample
31484 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31485 @end smallexample
31486
31487 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31488
31489 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31490
31491 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31492
31493 @subheading Example
31494
31495 @smallexample
31496 (gdb)
31497 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31498 ^done
31499 (gdb)
31500 @end smallexample
31501
31502 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31503 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31504
31505 @subheading Synopsis
31506
31507 @smallexample
31508 -inferior-tty-show
31509 @end smallexample
31510
31511 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31512
31513 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31514
31515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31516
31517 @subheading Example
31518
31519 @smallexample
31520 (gdb)
31521 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31522 ^done
31523 (gdb)
31524 -inferior-tty-show
31525 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31526 (gdb)
31527 @end smallexample
31528
31529 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31530 @findex -enable-timings
31531
31532 @subheading Synopsis
31533
31534 @smallexample
31535 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31536 @end smallexample
31537
31538 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31539 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31540 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31541 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31542
31543 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31544
31545 No equivalent.
31546
31547 @subheading Example
31548
31549 @smallexample
31550 (gdb)
31551 -enable-timings
31552 ^done
31553 (gdb)
31554 -break-insert main
31555 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31556 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31557 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31558 times="0"@},
31559 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31560 (gdb)
31561 -enable-timings no
31562 ^done
31563 (gdb)
31564 -exec-run
31565 ^running
31566 (gdb)
31567 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31568 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31569 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31570 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31571 (gdb)
31572 @end smallexample
31573
31574 @node Annotations
31575 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31576
31577 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31578 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31579 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31580 relatively high level.
31581
31582 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31583 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31584
31585 @ignore
31586 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31587 @end ignore
31588
31589 @menu
31590 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31591 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31592 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31593 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31594 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31595 * Annotations for Running::
31596 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31597 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31598 @end menu
31599
31600 @node Annotations Overview
31601 @section What is an Annotation?
31602 @cindex annotations
31603
31604 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31605 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31606 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31607 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31608 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31609 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31610 cannot contain newline characters.
31611
31612 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31613 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31614 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31615 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31616 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31617 means those three characters as output.
31618
31619 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31620 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31621 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31622 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31623 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31624 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31625 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31626 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31627 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31628
31629 @table @code
31630 @kindex set annotate
31631 @item set annotate @var{level}
31632 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31633 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31634
31635 @item show annotate
31636 @kindex show annotate
31637 Show the current annotation level.
31638 @end table
31639
31640 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31641
31642 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31643
31644 @smallexample
31645 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31646 GNU gdb 6.0
31647 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31648 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31649 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31650 under certain conditions.
31651 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31652 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31653 for details.
31654 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31655
31656 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31657 (@value{GDBP})
31658 ^Z^Zprompt
31659 @kbd{quit}
31660
31661 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31662 $
31663 @end smallexample
31664
31665 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31666 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31667 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31668 output from @value{GDBN}.
31669
31670 @node Server Prefix
31671 @section The Server Prefix
31672 @cindex server prefix
31673
31674 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31675 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31676 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31677 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31678 a transparent manner.
31679
31680 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31681 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31682 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31683 @code{print} command.
31684
31685 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31686 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31687
31688 @node Prompting
31689 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31690
31691 @cindex annotations for prompts
31692 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31693 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31694 over, etc.
31695
31696 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31697 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31698 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31699 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31700 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31701 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31702 features the following annotations:
31703
31704 @smallexample
31705 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31706 ^Z^Zprompt
31707 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31708 @end smallexample
31709
31710 The input types are
31711
31712 @table @code
31713 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31714 @findex prompt annotation
31715 @findex post-prompt annotation
31716 @item prompt
31717 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31718
31719 @findex pre-commands annotation
31720 @findex commands annotation
31721 @findex post-commands annotation
31722 @item commands
31723 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31724 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31725
31726 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31727 @findex overload-choice annotation
31728 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31729 @item overload-choice
31730 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31731
31732 @findex pre-query annotation
31733 @findex query annotation
31734 @findex post-query annotation
31735 @item query
31736 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31737
31738 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31739 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31740 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31741 @item prompt-for-continue
31742 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31743 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31744 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31745 presence of annotations.
31746 @end table
31747
31748 @node Errors
31749 @section Errors
31750 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31751
31752 @findex quit annotation
31753 @smallexample
31754 ^Z^Zquit
31755 @end smallexample
31756
31757 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31758
31759 @findex error annotation
31760 @smallexample
31761 ^Z^Zerror
31762 @end smallexample
31763
31764 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31765
31766 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31767 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31768 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31769 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31770 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31771 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31772 to the top level.
31773
31774 @findex error-begin annotation
31775 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31776
31777 @smallexample
31778 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31779 @end smallexample
31780
31781 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31782 message.
31783
31784 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31785 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31786 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31787
31788 @node Invalidation
31789 @section Invalidation Notices
31790
31791 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31792 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31793 changed.
31794
31795 @table @code
31796 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31797 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31798
31799 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31800 have changed.
31801
31802 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31803 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31804
31805 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31806 deleted a breakpoint.
31807 @end table
31808
31809 @node Annotations for Running
31810 @section Running the Program
31811 @cindex annotations for running programs
31812
31813 @findex starting annotation
31814 @findex stopping annotation
31815 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31816 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31817
31818 @smallexample
31819 ^Z^Zstarting
31820 @end smallexample
31821
31822 is output. When the program stops,
31823
31824 @smallexample
31825 ^Z^Zstopped
31826 @end smallexample
31827
31828 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31829 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31830
31831 @table @code
31832 @findex exited annotation
31833 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31834 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31835 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31836
31837 @findex signalled annotation
31838 @findex signal-name annotation
31839 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31840 @findex signal-string annotation
31841 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31842 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31843 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31844 annotation continues:
31845
31846 @smallexample
31847 @var{intro-text}
31848 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31849 @var{name}
31850 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31851 @var{middle-text}
31852 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31853 @var{string}
31854 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31855 @var{end-text}
31856 @end smallexample
31857
31858 @noindent
31859 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31860 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31861 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
31862 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31863 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31864
31865 @findex signal annotation
31866 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31867 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31868 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31869 terminated with it.
31870
31871 @findex breakpoint annotation
31872 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31873 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31874
31875 @findex watchpoint annotation
31876 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31877 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31878 @end table
31879
31880 @node Source Annotations
31881 @section Displaying Source
31882 @cindex annotations for source display
31883
31884 @findex source annotation
31885 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31886
31887 @smallexample
31888 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31889 @end smallexample
31890
31891 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31892 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31893 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31894 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31895 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31896 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31897 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31898 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31899 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31900 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31901 depend on the language).
31902
31903 @node JIT Interface
31904 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31905 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31906 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31907
31908 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31909 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31910 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31911 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31912
31913 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31914 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31915 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31916 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31917 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31918 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31919
31920 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31921 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31922 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31923 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31924 LLVM JIT.
31925
31926 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31927 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31928 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31929 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31930 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31931 out about additional code.
31932
31933 @menu
31934 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31935 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31936 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31937 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31938 @end menu
31939
31940 @node Declarations
31941 @section JIT Declarations
31942
31943 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31944 implement the interface:
31945
31946 @smallexample
31947 typedef enum
31948 @{
31949 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31950 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31951 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31952 @} jit_actions_t;
31953
31954 struct jit_code_entry
31955 @{
31956 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31957 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31958 const char *symfile_addr;
31959 uint64_t symfile_size;
31960 @};
31961
31962 struct jit_descriptor
31963 @{
31964 uint32_t version;
31965 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31966 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31967 uint32_t action_flag;
31968 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31969 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31970 @};
31971
31972 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31973 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31974
31975 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31976 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31977 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31978 @end smallexample
31979
31980 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31981 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31982 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31983
31984 @node Registering Code
31985 @section Registering Code
31986
31987 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31988
31989 @itemize @bullet
31990 @item
31991 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31992 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31993
31994 @item
31995 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31996 file.
31997
31998 @item
31999 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32000
32001 @item
32002 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32003
32004 @item
32005 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32006 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32007 @end itemize
32008
32009 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32010 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32011 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32012 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32013
32014 @node Unregistering Code
32015 @section Unregistering Code
32016
32017 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32018
32019 @itemize @bullet
32020 @item
32021 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32022
32023 @item
32024 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32025
32026 @item
32027 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32028 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32029 @end itemize
32030
32031 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32032 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32033
32034 @node Custom Debug Info
32035 @section Custom Debug Info
32036 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32037 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32038
32039 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32040 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32041 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32042 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32043 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32044 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32045 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32046 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32047 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32048
32049 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32050 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32051 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32052 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32053 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32054 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32055 compiler.
32056
32057 @menu
32058 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32059 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32060 @end menu
32061
32062 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32063 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32064 @kindex jit-reader-load
32065 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32066
32067 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32068 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32069
32070 @table @code
32071 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32072 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32073 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32074 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32075 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32076 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32077 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32078
32079 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32080 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32081 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32082 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32083 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32084
32085 @item jit-reader-unload
32086 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32087
32088 @end table
32089
32090 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32091 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32092 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32093
32094 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32095 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32096
32097 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32098 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32099 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32100 the system include directory.
32101
32102 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32103 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32104 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32105
32106 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32107 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32108
32109 @findex gdb_init_reader
32110 @smallexample
32111 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32112 @end smallexample
32113
32114 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32115
32116 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32117 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32118 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32119 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32120 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32121 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32122
32123 @smallexample
32124 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32125 @{
32126 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32127 int reader_version;
32128
32129 /* For use by the reader. */
32130 void *priv_data;
32131
32132 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32133 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32134 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32135 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32136 @};
32137 @end smallexample
32138
32139 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32140 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32141
32142 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32143 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32144 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32145 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32146 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32147 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32148 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32149 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32150 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32151 target's address space.
32152
32153 @node In-Process Agent
32154 @chapter In-Process Agent
32155 @cindex debugging agent
32156 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32157 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32158 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32159 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32160 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32161 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32162 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32163 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32164 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32165 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32166 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32167 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32168 behavior without interrupting it.
32169
32170 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32171 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32172 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32173 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32174 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32175 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32176 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32177 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32178 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32179
32180 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32181 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32182 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32183 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32184
32185 @anchor{Control Agent}
32186 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32187 debugging with the following commands:
32188
32189 @table @code
32190 @kindex set agent on
32191 @item set agent on
32192 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32193 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32194 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32195 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32196 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32197 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32198
32199 @kindex set agent off
32200 @item set agent off
32201 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32202 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32203
32204 @kindex show agent
32205 @item show agent
32206 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32207 the in-process agent.
32208 @end table
32209
32210 @menu
32211 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32212 @end menu
32213
32214 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32215 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32216 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32217
32218 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32219 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32220 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32221 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32222 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32223 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32224 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32225 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32226 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32227
32228 @menu
32229 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32230 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32231 @end menu
32232
32233 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32234 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32235 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32236
32237 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32238 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32239
32240 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32241 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32242 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32243 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32244
32245 @enumerate
32246 @item
32247 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32248 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32249 @item
32250 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32251 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32252 the other one.
32253 @end enumerate
32254
32255 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32256
32257 @enumerate
32258 @item
32259 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32260 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32261 @anchor{agent expression object}
32262 @item
32263 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32264 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32265 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32266 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32267 @item
32268 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32269 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32270
32271 @end enumerate
32272
32273 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32274 object:
32275
32276 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32277 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32278 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32279 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32280 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32281 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32282 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32283 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32284 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32285 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32286 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32287 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32288 memory address for collecting.
32289 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32290 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32291 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32292 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32293 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32294 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32295 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32296 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32297 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32298 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32299 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32300 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32301 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32302 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32303 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32304 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32305 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32306 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32307 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32308 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32309 @ref{agent expression object}
32310 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32311 @ref{agent expression object}
32312 @item actions @tab variable
32313 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32314 @end multitable
32315
32316 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32317 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32318 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32319
32320 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32321 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32322
32323 @table @samp
32324
32325 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32326 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32327 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32328 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32329 in IPA finally.
32330
32331 Replies:
32332 @table @samp
32333 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32334 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32335 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32336 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32337 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32338 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32339 @item E @var{NN}
32340 for an error
32341
32342 @end table
32343
32344 @item close
32345 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32346 is about to kill inferiors.
32347
32348 @item qTfSTM
32349 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32350 @item qTsSTM
32351 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32352 @item qTSTMat
32353 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32354 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32355 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32356
32357 Replies:
32358 @table @samp
32359 @item E @var{NN}
32360 for an error
32361 @end table
32362 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32363 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32364 @end table
32365
32366 @node GDB Bugs
32367 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32368 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32369 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32370
32371 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32372
32373 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32374 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32375 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32376 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32377
32378 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32379 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32380
32381 @menu
32382 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32383 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32384 @end menu
32385
32386 @node Bug Criteria
32387 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32388 @cindex bug criteria
32389
32390 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32391
32392 @itemize @bullet
32393 @cindex fatal signal
32394 @cindex debugger crash
32395 @cindex crash of debugger
32396 @item
32397 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32398 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32399
32400 @cindex error on valid input
32401 @item
32402 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32403 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32404 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32405
32406 @cindex invalid input
32407 @item
32408 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32409 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32410 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32411 for traditional practice''.
32412
32413 @item
32414 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32415 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32416 @end itemize
32417
32418 @node Bug Reporting
32419 @section How to Report Bugs
32420 @cindex bug reports
32421 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32422
32423 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32424 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32425 contact that organization first.
32426
32427 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32428 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32429 distribution.
32430 @c should add a web page ref...
32431
32432 @ifset BUGURL
32433 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32434 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32435 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32436 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32437 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32438 be used.
32439
32440 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32441 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32442 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32443 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32444
32445 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32446 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32447 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32448 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32449 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32450 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32451 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32452 bug reports to the mailing list.
32453 @end ifset
32454 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32455 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32456 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32457 @end ifclear
32458 @end ifset
32459
32460 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32461 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32462 fact or leave it out, state it!
32463
32464 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32465 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32466 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32467 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32468 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32469 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32470 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32471 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32472 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32473
32474 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32475 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32476 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32477 self-contained.
32478
32479 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32480 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32481 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32482 bugs properly.
32483
32484 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32485
32486 @itemize @bullet
32487 @item
32488 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32489 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32490 version}.
32491
32492 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32493 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32494
32495 @item
32496 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32497 version number.
32498
32499 @item
32500 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32501 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32502 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32503 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32504
32505 @item
32506 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32507 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32508
32509 @item
32510 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32511 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32512 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32513 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32514 those compilers.
32515
32516 @item
32517 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32518 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32519 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32520 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32521
32522 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32523 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32524
32525 @item
32526 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32527 reproduce the bug.
32528
32529 @item
32530 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32531 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32532
32533 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32534 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32535 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32536 a chance to make a mistake.
32537
32538 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32539 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32540 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32541 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32542 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32543 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32544 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32545 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32546
32547 @pindex script
32548 @cindex recording a session script
32549 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32550 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32551 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32552 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32553
32554 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32555 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32556
32557 @item
32558 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32559 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32560 it by context, not by line number.
32561
32562 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32563 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32564
32565 @end itemize
32566
32567 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32568
32569 @itemize @bullet
32570 @item
32571 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32572
32573 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32574 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32575 changes will not affect it.
32576
32577 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32578 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32579 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32580 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32581
32582 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32583 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32584 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32585 less time, and so on.
32586
32587 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32588 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32589
32590 @item
32591 A patch for the bug.
32592
32593 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32594 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32595 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32596 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32597
32598 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32599 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32600 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32601 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32602
32603 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32604 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32605 help us to understand.
32606
32607 @item
32608 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32609
32610 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32611 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32612 @end itemize
32613
32614 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32615 @c and consists of the two following files:
32616 @c rluser.texi
32617 @c hsuser.texi
32618 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32619 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32620 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32621 @include rluser.texi
32622 @include hsuser.texi
32623 @end ifclear
32624
32625 @node In Memoriam
32626 @appendix In Memoriam
32627
32628 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32629 contributors:
32630
32631 @table @code
32632 @item Fred Fish
32633 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32634 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32635 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32636
32637 @item Michael Snyder
32638 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32639 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32640 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32641 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32642 @end table
32643
32644 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32645 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32646
32647 @node Formatting Documentation
32648 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32649
32650 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32651 @cindex reference card
32652 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32653 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32654 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32655 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32656 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32657 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32658
32659 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32660 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32661
32662 @smallexample
32663 make refcard.dvi
32664 @end smallexample
32665
32666 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32667 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32668 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32669 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32670 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32671
32672 @cindex documentation
32673
32674 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32675 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32676 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32677 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32678 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32679 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32680
32681 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32682 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32683 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32684 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32685 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32686 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32687 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32688 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32689
32690 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32691 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32692 @code{makeinfo}.
32693
32694 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32695 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32696 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32697
32698 @smallexample
32699 cd gdb
32700 make gdb.info
32701 @end smallexample
32702
32703 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32704 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32705 Texinfo definitions file.
32706
32707 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32708 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32709 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32710 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32711 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32712 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32713 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32714
32715 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32716 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32717 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32718 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32719 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32720 directory.
32721
32722 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32723 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32724 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32725 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32726
32727 @smallexample
32728 make gdb.dvi
32729 @end smallexample
32730
32731 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32732
32733 @node Installing GDB
32734 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32735 @cindex installation
32736
32737 @menu
32738 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32739 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32740 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32741 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32742 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32743 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32744 @end menu
32745
32746 @node Requirements
32747 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32748 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32749
32750 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32751 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32752
32753 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32754 @table @asis
32755 @item ISO C90 compiler
32756 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32757 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32758
32759 @end table
32760
32761 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32762 @table @asis
32763 @item Expat
32764 @anchor{Expat}
32765 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32766 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32767 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32768 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32769 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32770 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32771
32772 Expat is used for:
32773
32774 @itemize @bullet
32775 @item
32776 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32777 @item
32778 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32779 @item
32780 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32781 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32782 @item
32783 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32784 @item
32785 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32786 @item
32787 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32788 @end itemize
32789
32790 @item zlib
32791 @cindex compressed debug sections
32792 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32793 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32794 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32795 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32796 information in such binaries.
32797
32798 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32799 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32800 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32801
32802 @item iconv
32803 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32804 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32805 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32806 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32807
32808 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32809 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32810 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32811 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32812
32813 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32814 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32815 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32816
32817 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32818 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32819 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32820 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32821 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32822 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32823 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32824 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32825 @end table
32826
32827 @node Running Configure
32828 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32829 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32830 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32831 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32832 build the @code{gdb} program.
32833 @iftex
32834 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32835 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32836 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32837 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32838 @end iftex
32839
32840 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32841 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32842 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32843
32844 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32845 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32846
32847 @table @code
32848 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32849 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32850
32851 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32852 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32853
32854 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32855 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32856
32857 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32858 @sc{gnu} include files
32859
32860 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32861 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32862
32863 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32864 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32865
32866 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32867 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32868
32869 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32870 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32871
32872 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32873 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32874 @end table
32875
32876 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32877 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32878 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32879
32880 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32881 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32882 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32883 argument.
32884
32885 For example:
32886
32887 @smallexample
32888 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32889 ./configure @var{host}
32890 make
32891 @end smallexample
32892
32893 @noindent
32894 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32895 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32896 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32897 correct value by examining your system.)
32898
32899 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32900 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32901 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32902 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32903
32904 @need 750
32905 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32906 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32907 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32908
32909 @smallexample
32910 sh configure @var{host}
32911 @end smallexample
32912
32913 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32914 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32915 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32916 @file{configure}
32917 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32918 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32919
32920 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32921 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32922 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32923 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32924 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32925 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32926 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32927 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32928 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32929
32930 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32931 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32932 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32933 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32934 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32935
32936 @node Separate Objdir
32937 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32938
32939 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32940 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32941 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32942 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32943 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32944 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32945 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32946 program specified there.
32947
32948 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32949 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32950 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32951 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32952 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32953 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32954
32955 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32956 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32957
32958 @smallexample
32959 @group
32960 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32961 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32962 cd ../gdb-sun4
32963 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32964 make
32965 @end group
32966 @end smallexample
32967
32968 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32969 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32970 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32971 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32972 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32973 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32974
32975 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32976 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32977 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32978 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32979 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32980
32981 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32982 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32983 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32984 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32985 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32986 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32987
32988 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32989 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32990 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32991
32992 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32993 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32994 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32995 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32996 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32997
32998 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32999 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33000 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33001 with each other.
33002
33003 @node Config Names
33004 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33005
33006 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33007 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33008 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33009 of information in the following pattern:
33010
33011 @smallexample
33012 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33013 @end smallexample
33014
33015 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33016 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33017 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33018
33019 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33020 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33021 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33022 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33023 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33024 abbreviations---for example:
33025
33026 @smallexample
33027 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33028 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33029 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33030 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33031 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33032 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33033 % sh config.sub sun4
33034 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33035 % sh config.sub sun3
33036 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33037 % sh config.sub i986v
33038 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33039 @end smallexample
33040
33041 @noindent
33042 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33043 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33044
33045 @node Configure Options
33046 @section @file{configure} Options
33047
33048 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33049 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33050 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33051 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33052
33053 @smallexample
33054 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33055 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33056 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33057 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33058 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33059 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33060 @var{host}
33061 @end smallexample
33062
33063 @noindent
33064 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33065 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33066 @samp{--}.
33067
33068 @table @code
33069 @item --help
33070 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33071
33072 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33073 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33074 @file{@var{dir}}.
33075
33076 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33077 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33078 @file{@var{dir}}.
33079
33080 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33081 @need 2000
33082 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33083 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33084 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33085 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33086 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33087 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33088 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33089 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33090 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33091 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33092 @var{dirname}.
33093
33094 @item --norecursion
33095 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33096 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33097
33098 @item --target=@var{target}
33099 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33100 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33101 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33102
33103 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33104
33105 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33106 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33107
33108 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33109 @end table
33110
33111 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33112 needed for special purposes only.
33113
33114 @node System-wide configuration
33115 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33116 @cindex system-wide init file
33117
33118 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33119 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33120 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33121
33122 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33123
33124 @table @code
33125 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33126 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33127 @var{file}.
33128 @end table
33129
33130 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33131 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33132
33133 @itemize @bullet
33134 @item
33135 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33136 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33137 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33138 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33139 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33140 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33141
33142 @item
33143 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33144 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33145 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33146 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33147 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33148 @end itemize
33149
33150 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33151 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33152 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33153 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33154 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33155 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33156 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33157 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33158 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33159 reread.
33160
33161 @menu
33162 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33163 @end menu
33164
33165 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33166 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33167 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33168
33169 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33170 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33171 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33172 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33173 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33174 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33175
33176 The following scripts are currently available:
33177 @itemize @bullet
33178
33179 @item @file{elinos.py}
33180 @pindex elinos.py
33181 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33182 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33183 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33184 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33185 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33186 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33187
33188 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33189 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33190 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33191 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33192 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33193 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33194
33195 @end itemize
33196
33197 @node Maintenance Commands
33198 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33199 @cindex maintenance commands
33200 @cindex internal commands
33201
33202 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33203 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33204 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33205 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33206 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33207
33208 @table @code
33209 @kindex maint agent
33210 @kindex maint agent-eval
33211 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33212 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33213 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33214 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33215 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33216 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33217 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33218 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33219 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33220 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33221 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33222 addition and return the sum.
33223 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33224 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33225
33226 @kindex maint agent-printf
33227 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33228 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33229 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33230 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33231 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33232
33233 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33234 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33235 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33236 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33237 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33238 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33239 is shown:
33240
33241 @table @code
33242 @item breakpoint
33243 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33244
33245 @item watchpoint
33246 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33247
33248 @item longjmp
33249 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33250 @code{longjmp} calls.
33251
33252 @item longjmp resume
33253 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33254
33255 @item until
33256 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33257
33258 @item finish
33259 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33260
33261 @item shlib events
33262 Shared library events.
33263
33264 @end table
33265
33266 @kindex maint info bfds
33267 @item maint info bfds
33268 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33269 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33270
33271 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33272 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33273 @cindex displaced stepping support
33274 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33275 @item set displaced-stepping
33276 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33277 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33278 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33279 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33280 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33281 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33282
33283 @table @code
33284 @item set displaced-stepping on
33285 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33286 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33287
33288 @item set displaced-stepping off
33289 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33290 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33291
33292 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33293 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33294 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33295 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33296 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33297 @end table
33298
33299 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33300 @item maint check-psymtabs
33301 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33302 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33303
33304 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33305 @item maint check-symtabs
33306 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33307
33308 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33309 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33310 Expand symbol tables.
33311 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33312 names matching @var{regexp}.
33313
33314 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33315 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33316 @cindex demangler crashes
33317 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33318 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33319 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33320 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33321 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33322 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33323 option to terminate the current session.
33324
33325 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33326 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33327 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33328
33329 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33330 @item maint cplus namespace
33331 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33332
33333 @kindex maint demangle
33334 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33335 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33336
33337 @kindex maint deprecate
33338 @kindex maint undeprecate
33339 @cindex deprecated commands
33340 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33341 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33342 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33343 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33344 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33345 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33346 the replacement as part of the warning.
33347
33348 @kindex maint dump-me
33349 @item maint dump-me
33350 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33351 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33352 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33353 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33354
33355 @kindex maint internal-error
33356 @kindex maint internal-warning
33357 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33358 @cindex demangler crashes
33359 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33360 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33361 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33362
33363 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33364 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33365 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33366 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33367 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33368 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33369 @value{GDBN} session.
33370
33371 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33372 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33373
33374 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33375
33376 @smallexample
33377 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33378 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33379 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33380 debugging may prove unreliable.
33381 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33382 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33383 (@value{GDBP})
33384 @end smallexample
33385
33386 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33387 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33388 @cindex demangler crashes
33389
33390 @kindex maint set internal-error
33391 @kindex maint show internal-error
33392 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33393 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33394 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33395 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33396 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33397 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33398 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33399 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33400 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33401 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33402 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33403 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33404 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33405 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33406 described in the table below.
33407
33408 @table @samp
33409 @item quit
33410 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33411 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33412
33413 @item corefile
33414 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33415 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33416 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33417 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33418 disabled.
33419 @end table
33420
33421 @kindex maint packet
33422 @item maint packet @var{text}
33423 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33424 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33425 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33426 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33427 checksum.
33428
33429 @kindex maint print architecture
33430 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33431 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33432 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33433
33434 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33435 @item maint print c-tdesc
33436 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33437 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33438 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33439
33440 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33441 @item maint print dummy-frames
33442 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33443
33444 @smallexample
33445 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33446 @dots{}
33447 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33448 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33449 58 return (a + b);
33450 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33451 @dots{}
33452 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33453 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33454 (@value{GDBP})
33455 @end smallexample
33456
33457 Takes an optional file parameter.
33458
33459 @kindex maint print registers
33460 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33461 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33462 @kindex maint print register-groups
33463 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33464 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33465 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33466 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33467 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33468 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33469 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33470
33471 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33472 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33473 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33474 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33475 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33476 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33477 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33478 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33479
33480 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33481 write the information.
33482
33483 @kindex maint print reggroups
33484 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33485 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33486 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33487 information.
33488
33489 The register groups info looks like this:
33490
33491 @smallexample
33492 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33493 Group Type
33494 general user
33495 float user
33496 all user
33497 vector user
33498 system user
33499 save internal
33500 restore internal
33501 @end smallexample
33502
33503 @kindex flushregs
33504 @item flushregs
33505 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33506
33507 @kindex maint print objfiles
33508 @cindex info for known object files
33509 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33510 Print a dump of all known object files.
33511 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33512 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33513 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33514
33515 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33516 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33517 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33518 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33519 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33520 matching @var{regexp}.
33521 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33522 and the full path if known.
33523 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33524
33525 @kindex maint print statistics
33526 @cindex bcache statistics
33527 @item maint print statistics
33528 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33529 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33530 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33531 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33532 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33533 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33534 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33535 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33536 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33537 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33538 lengths.
33539
33540 @kindex maint print target-stack
33541 @cindex target stack description
33542 @item maint print target-stack
33543 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33544 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33545 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33546 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33547 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33548 address.
33549
33550 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33551 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33552
33553 @kindex maint print type
33554 @cindex type chain of a data type
33555 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33556 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33557 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33558 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33559 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33560 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33561
33562 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33563 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33564 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33565 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33566 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33567 information.
33568
33569 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33570 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33571 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33572 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33573 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33574 always see the disassembly form.
33575
33576 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33577
33578 @smallexample
33579 (gdb) info addr argc
33580 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33581 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33582 @end smallexample
33583
33584 For more information on these expressions, see
33585 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33586
33587 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33588 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33589 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33590 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33591 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33592
33593 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33594 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33595 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33596 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33597 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33598 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33599 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33600 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33601 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33602
33603 @kindex maint set profile
33604 @kindex maint show profile
33605 @cindex profiling GDB
33606 @item maint set profile
33607 @itemx maint show profile
33608 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33609
33610 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33611 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33612 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33613 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33614 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33615 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33616 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33617
33618 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33619 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33620
33621 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33622 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33623 @cindex hardware debug registers
33624 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33625 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33626 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33627 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33628 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33629 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33630 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33631
33632 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33633 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33634 @item maint set show-all-tib
33635 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33636 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33637 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33638 command.
33639
33640 @kindex maint set target-async
33641 @kindex maint show target-async
33642 @item maint set target-async
33643 @itemx maint show target-async
33644 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
33645 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
33646 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
33647 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
33648
33649 @kindex maint set per-command
33650 @kindex maint show per-command
33651 @item maint set per-command
33652 @itemx maint show per-command
33653 @cindex resources used by commands
33654
33655 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33656 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33657
33658 @table @code
33659 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33660 @itemx maint show per-command space
33661 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33662 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33663 took, following the command's own output.
33664 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33665 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33666
33667 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33668 @itemx maint show per-command time
33669 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33670 for each command.
33671 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33672 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33673 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33674 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33675 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33676 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33677 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33678 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33679 spent by the program been debugged.
33680 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33681 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33682
33683 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33684 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33685 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33686 for each command.
33687 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33688
33689 @enumerate a
33690 @item
33691 number of symbol tables
33692 @item
33693 number of primary symbol tables
33694 @item
33695 number of blocks in the blockvector
33696 @end enumerate
33697 @end table
33698
33699 @kindex maint space
33700 @cindex memory used by commands
33701 @item maint space @var{value}
33702 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33703 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33704
33705 @kindex maint time
33706 @cindex time of command execution
33707 @item maint time @var{value}
33708 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33709 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33710
33711 @kindex maint translate-address
33712 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33713 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33714 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33715 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33716 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33717 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33718 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33719
33720 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33721 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33722 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33723
33724 @end table
33725
33726 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33727 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33728
33729 @table @code
33730 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33731 @kindex set watchdog
33732 @cindex watchdog timer
33733 @cindex timeout for commands
33734 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33735 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33736 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33737
33738 @item show watchdog
33739 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33740 @end table
33741
33742 @node Remote Protocol
33743 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33744
33745 @menu
33746 * Overview::
33747 * Packets::
33748 * Stop Reply Packets::
33749 * General Query Packets::
33750 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33751 * Tracepoint Packets::
33752 * Host I/O Packets::
33753 * Interrupts::
33754 * Notification Packets::
33755 * Remote Non-Stop::
33756 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33757 * Examples::
33758 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33759 * Library List Format::
33760 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33761 * Memory Map Format::
33762 * Thread List Format::
33763 * Traceframe Info Format::
33764 * Branch Trace Format::
33765 @end menu
33766
33767 @node Overview
33768 @section Overview
33769
33770 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33771 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33772 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33773 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33774
33775 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33776 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33777
33778 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33779 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33780 @cindex remote serial protocol
33781 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33782 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33783 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33784 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33785 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33786
33787 @smallexample
33788 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33789 @end smallexample
33790 @noindent
33791
33792 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33793 @noindent
33794 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33795 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33796 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33797
33798 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33799 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33800
33801 @smallexample
33802 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33803 @end smallexample
33804
33805 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33806 @noindent
33807 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33808 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33809 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33810
33811 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33812 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33813 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33814 retransmission):
33815
33816 @smallexample
33817 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33818 <- @code{+}
33819 @end smallexample
33820 @noindent
33821
33822 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33823 once a connection is established.
33824 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33825
33826 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33827 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33828 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33829 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33830 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33831 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33832 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33833
33834 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33835 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33836 exceptions).
33837
33838 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33839 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33840 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33841 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33842
33843 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33844 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33845 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33846
33847 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33848 @anchor{Binary Data}
33849 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33850 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33851 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33852 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33853 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33854 binary data.
33855
33856 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33857 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33858 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33859 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33860 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33861 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33862 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33863 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33864 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33865 (described next).
33866
33867 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33868 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33869 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33870 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33871 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33872 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33873 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33874 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33875 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33876 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33877 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33878 3}} more times.
33879
33880 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33881 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33882 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33883 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33884 @samp{0*"00}.
33885
33886 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33887 error number. That number is not well defined.
33888
33889 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33890 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33891 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33892 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33893 on that response.
33894
33895 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33896 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33897 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33898 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33899 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33900 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33901
33902 @node Packets
33903 @section Packets
33904
33905 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33906 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33907 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33908 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33909
33910 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33911 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33912 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33913 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33914 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33915 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33916 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33917 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33918 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33919 @var{baz}.
33920
33921 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33922 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33923 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33924 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33925 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33926 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33927 pick any thread.
33928
33929 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33930 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33931 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33932 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33933 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33934 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33935 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33936 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33937 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33938 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33939 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33940 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33941 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33942
33943 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33944 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33945 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33946 more information.
33947
33948 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33949 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33950
33951 Here are the packet descriptions.
33952
33953 @table @samp
33954
33955 @item !
33956 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33957 @anchor{extended mode}
33958 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33959 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33960 debugged.
33961
33962 Reply:
33963 @table @samp
33964 @item OK
33965 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33966 @end table
33967
33968 @item ?
33969 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33970 @anchor{? packet}
33971 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33972 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33973 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33974
33975 Reply:
33976 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33977
33978 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33979 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33980 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33981 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33982 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33983
33984 Reply:
33985 @table @samp
33986 @item OK
33987 The arguments were set.
33988 @item E @var{NN}
33989 An error occurred.
33990 @end table
33991
33992 @item b @var{baud}
33993 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33994 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33995 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33996
33997 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33998 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33999 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34000
34001 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34002 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34003 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34004 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34005 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34006
34007 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34008 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34009 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34010 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34011
34012 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34013 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34014
34015 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34016 @anchor{bc}
34017 @item bc
34018 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34019 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34020
34021 Reply:
34022 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34023
34024 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34025 @anchor{bs}
34026 @item bs
34027 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34028 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34029
34030 Reply:
34031 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34032
34033 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34034 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34035 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34036 is omitted, resume at current address.
34037
34038 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34039 packet}.
34040
34041 Reply:
34042 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34043
34044 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34045 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34046 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34047 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34048
34049 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34050 packet}.
34051
34052 Reply:
34053 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34054
34055 @item d
34056 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34057 Toggle debug flag.
34058
34059 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34060 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34061
34062 @item D
34063 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34064 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34065 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34066 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34067 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34068
34069 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34070 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34071 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34072 big-endian hex string.
34073
34074 Reply:
34075 @table @samp
34076 @item OK
34077 for success
34078 @item E @var{NN}
34079 for an error
34080 @end table
34081
34082 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34083 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34084 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34085 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34086 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34087
34088 @item g
34089 @anchor{read registers packet}
34090 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34091 Read general registers.
34092
34093 Reply:
34094 @table @samp
34095 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34096 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34097 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34098 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34099 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34100 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34101 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34102
34103 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34104 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34105 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34106 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34107 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34108 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34109 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34110 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34111
34112 @smallexample
34113 -> @code{g}
34114 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34115 @end smallexample
34116
34117 @item E @var{NN}
34118 for an error.
34119 @end table
34120
34121 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34122 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34123 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34124 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34125
34126 Reply:
34127 @table @samp
34128 @item OK
34129 for success
34130 @item E @var{NN}
34131 for an error
34132 @end table
34133
34134 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34135 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34136 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34137 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34138 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34139 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34140 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34141 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34142 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34143
34144 Reply:
34145 @table @samp
34146 @item OK
34147 for success
34148 @item E @var{NN}
34149 for an error
34150 @end table
34151
34152 @c FIXME: JTC:
34153 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34154 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34155 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34156 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34157 @c described. For example:
34158 @c
34159 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34160 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34161 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34162 @c
34163 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34164 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34165 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34166
34167 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34168 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34169 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34170 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34171 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34172 step starting at that address.
34173
34174 @item I
34175 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34176 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34177 step packet}.
34178
34179 @item k
34180 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34181 Kill request.
34182
34183 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34184
34185 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34186 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34187
34188 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34189
34190 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34191 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34192 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34193
34194 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34195 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34196 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34197
34198 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34199 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34200 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34201 (@pxref{? packet}).
34202
34203 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34204 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34205 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34206 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34207
34208 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34209 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34210 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34211 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34212 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34213 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34214 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34215 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34216
34217 Reply:
34218 @table @samp
34219 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34220 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34221 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34222 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34223 @item E @var{NN}
34224 @var{NN} is errno
34225 @end table
34226
34227 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34228 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34229 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34230 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34231 hexadecimal number.
34232
34233 Reply:
34234 @table @samp
34235 @item OK
34236 for success
34237 @item E @var{NN}
34238 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34239 written).
34240 @end table
34241
34242 @item p @var{n}
34243 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34244 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34245 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34246 register value is encoded.
34247
34248 Reply:
34249 @table @samp
34250 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34251 the register's value
34252 @item E @var{NN}
34253 for an error
34254 @item @w{}
34255 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34256 @end table
34257
34258 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34259 @anchor{write register packet}
34260 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34261 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34262 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34263 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34264
34265 Reply:
34266 @table @samp
34267 @item OK
34268 for success
34269 @item E @var{NN}
34270 for an error
34271 @end table
34272
34273 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34274 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34275 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34276 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34277 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34278 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34279
34280 @item r
34281 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34282 Reset the entire system.
34283
34284 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34285
34286 @item R @var{XX}
34287 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34288 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34289 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34290
34291 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34292
34293 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34294 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34295 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34296 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34297
34298 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34299 packet}.
34300
34301 Reply:
34302 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34303
34304 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34305 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34306 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34307 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34308 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34309
34310 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34311 packet}.
34312
34313 Reply:
34314 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34315
34316 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34317 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34318 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34319 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34320 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34321
34322 @item T @var{thread-id}
34323 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34324 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34325
34326 Reply:
34327 @table @samp
34328 @item OK
34329 thread is still alive
34330 @item E @var{NN}
34331 thread is dead
34332 @end table
34333
34334 @item v
34335 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34336 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34337
34338 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34339 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34340 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34341 The process ID is a
34342 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34343 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34344 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34345
34346 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34347 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34348 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34349 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34350 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34351 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34352 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34353 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34354
34355 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34356
34357 Reply:
34358 @table @samp
34359 @item E @var{nn}
34360 for an error
34361 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34362 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34363 @item OK
34364 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34365 @end table
34366
34367 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34368 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34369 @anchor{vCont packet}
34370 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34371 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34372 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34373 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34374 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34375 Specifying multiple
34376 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34377 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34378
34379 Currently supported actions are:
34380
34381 @table @samp
34382 @item c
34383 Continue.
34384 @item C @var{sig}
34385 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34386 @item s
34387 Step.
34388 @item S @var{sig}
34389 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34390 @item t
34391 Stop.
34392 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34393 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34394 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34395 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34396 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34397 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34398
34399 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34400 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34401 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34402 jumps to @var{start}).
34403
34404 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34405 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34406 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34407
34408 @end table
34409
34410 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34411 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34412 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34413
34414 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34415 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34416 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34417 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34418 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34419 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34420 as an implementation detail.
34421
34422 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34423 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34424 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34425 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34426 @var{thread-id}.
34427
34428 Reply:
34429 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34430
34431 @item vCont?
34432 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34433 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34434
34435 Reply:
34436 @table @samp
34437 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34438 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34439 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34440 @item @w{}
34441 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34442 @end table
34443
34444 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34445 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34446 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34447 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34448
34449 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34450 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34451 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34452 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34453 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34454 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34455 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34456 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34457 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34458 packet is received.
34459
34460 Reply:
34461 @table @samp
34462 @item OK
34463 for success
34464 @item E @var{NN}
34465 for an error
34466 @end table
34467
34468 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34469 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34470 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34471 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34472 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34473 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34474 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34475 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34476 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34477 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34478 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34479 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34480
34481
34482 Reply:
34483 @table @samp
34484 @item OK
34485 for success
34486 @item E.memtype
34487 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34488 @item E @var{NN}
34489 for an error
34490 @end table
34491
34492 @item vFlashDone
34493 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34494 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34495 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34496 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34497 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34498 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34499 request is completed.
34500
34501 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34502 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34503 @anchor{vKill packet}
34504 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34505 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34506 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34507 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34508
34509 Reply:
34510 @table @samp
34511 @item E @var{nn}
34512 for an error
34513 @item OK
34514 for success
34515 @end table
34516
34517 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34518 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34519 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34520 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34521 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34522 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34523 state.
34524
34525 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34526
34527 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34528
34529 Reply:
34530 @table @samp
34531 @item E @var{nn}
34532 for an error
34533 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34534 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34535 @end table
34536
34537 @item vStopped
34538 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34539 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34540
34541 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34542 @anchor{X packet}
34543 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34544 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34545 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34546 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34547
34548 Reply:
34549 @table @samp
34550 @item OK
34551 for success
34552 @item E @var{NN}
34553 for an error
34554 @end table
34555
34556 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34557 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34558 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34559 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34560 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34561 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34562 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34563
34564 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34565 separately.
34566
34567 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34568 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34569 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34570 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34571 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34572 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34573
34574 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34575 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34576 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34577 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34578 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34579 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34580
34581 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34582 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34583 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34584 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34585 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34586 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34587 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34588 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34589 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34590 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34591
34592 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34593 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34594
34595 @table @samp
34596
34597 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34598 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34599 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34600
34601 @end table
34602
34603 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34604 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34605 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34606 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34607 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34608 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34609 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34610
34611 @table @samp
34612
34613 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34614 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34615 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34616
34617 @end table
34618
34619 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34620
34621 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34622 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34623 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34624 target, is not defined.}
34625
34626 Reply:
34627 @table @samp
34628 @item OK
34629 success
34630 @item @w{}
34631 not supported
34632 @item E @var{NN}
34633 for an error
34634 @end table
34635
34636 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34637 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34638 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34639 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34640 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34641 address @var{addr}.
34642
34643 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34644 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
34645 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34646
34647 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34648 movement.}
34649
34650 Reply:
34651 @table @samp
34652 @item OK
34653 success
34654 @item @w{}
34655 not supported
34656 @item E @var{NN}
34657 for an error
34658 @end table
34659
34660 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34661 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34662 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34663 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34664 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34665 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34666
34667 Reply:
34668 @table @samp
34669 @item OK
34670 success
34671 @item @w{}
34672 not supported
34673 @item E @var{NN}
34674 for an error
34675 @end table
34676
34677 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34678 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34679 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34680 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34681 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34682 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34683
34684 Reply:
34685 @table @samp
34686 @item OK
34687 success
34688 @item @w{}
34689 not supported
34690 @item E @var{NN}
34691 for an error
34692 @end table
34693
34694 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34695 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34696 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34697 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34698 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34699 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34700
34701 Reply:
34702 @table @samp
34703 @item OK
34704 success
34705 @item @w{}
34706 not supported
34707 @item E @var{NN}
34708 for an error
34709 @end table
34710
34711 @end table
34712
34713 @node Stop Reply Packets
34714 @section Stop Reply Packets
34715 @cindex stop reply packets
34716
34717 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34718 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34719 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34720 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34721 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34722 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34723 @value{GDBN} source code.
34724
34725 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34726 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34727 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34728 components.
34729
34730 @table @samp
34731
34732 @item S @var{AA}
34733 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34734 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34735 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34736
34737 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34738 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34739 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34740 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34741 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34742 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34743 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34744 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34745
34746 @itemize @bullet
34747 @item
34748 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34749 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
34750 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34751 two-digit hex number.
34752
34753 @item
34754 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34755 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34756
34757 @item
34758 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34759 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34760
34761 @item
34762 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34763 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34764 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34765 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34766
34767 @item
34768 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34769 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34770 future.
34771 @end itemize
34772
34773 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34774
34775 @table @samp
34776 @item watch
34777 @itemx rwatch
34778 @itemx awatch
34779 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34780 hex.
34781
34782 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34783 @item library
34784 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34785 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34786 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
34787
34788 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34789 @item replaylog
34790 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34791 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34792 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34793 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34794 for more information.
34795 @end table
34796
34797 @item W @var{AA}
34798 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34799 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34800 applicable to certain targets.
34801
34802 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34803 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34804 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34805 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34806
34807 @item X @var{AA}
34808 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34809 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34810
34811 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34812 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34813 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34814 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34815
34816 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34817 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34818 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34819 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34820 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34821
34822 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34823 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34824 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34825 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34826 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34827 system calls.
34828
34829 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34830 this very system call.
34831
34832 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34833 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34834 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34835 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34836 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34837 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34838
34839 @end table
34840
34841 @node General Query Packets
34842 @section General Query Packets
34843 @cindex remote query requests
34844
34845 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34846 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34847 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34848 sending information to and from the stub.
34849
34850 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34851 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34852 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34853 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34854 conventions:
34855
34856 @itemize @bullet
34857 @item
34858 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34859 @item
34860 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34861 letter.
34862 @item
34863 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34864 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34865 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34866 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34867 @end itemize
34868
34869 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34870 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34871 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34872 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34873 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34874 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34875 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34876 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34877 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34878 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34879 packet.}.
34880
34881 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34882 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34883 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34884 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34885 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34886
34887 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34888
34889 @table @samp
34890
34891 @item QAgent:1
34892 @itemx QAgent:0
34893 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34894 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34895
34896 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34897 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34898 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34899 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34900 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34901 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34902 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34903 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34904 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34905 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34906 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34907
34908 @item qC
34909 @cindex current thread, remote request
34910 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34911 Return the current thread ID.
34912
34913 Reply:
34914 @table @samp
34915 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34916 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34917 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34918 @item @r{(anything else)}
34919 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34920 @end table
34921
34922 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34923 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34924 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34925 @anchor{qCRC packet}
34926 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34927 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34928 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34929 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34930
34931 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34932 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34933 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34934 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34935 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34936 detect trailing zeros.
34937
34938 Reply:
34939 @table @samp
34940 @item E @var{NN}
34941 An error (such as memory fault)
34942 @item C @var{crc32}
34943 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34944 @end table
34945
34946 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34947 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34948 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34949 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34950 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34951 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34952 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34953 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34954 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34955 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34956 randomization.
34957
34958 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34959
34960 Reply:
34961 @table @samp
34962 @item OK
34963 The request succeeded.
34964
34965 @item E @var{nn}
34966 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34967
34968 @item @w{}
34969 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34970 by the stub.
34971 @end table
34972
34973 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34974 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34975 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34976 address space randomization.
34977
34978 @item qfThreadInfo
34979 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34980 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34981 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34982 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34983 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34984 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34985 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34986 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34987 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34988 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34989
34990 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34991
34992 Reply:
34993 @table @samp
34994 @item m @var{thread-id}
34995 A single thread ID
34996 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34997 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34998 @item l
34999 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35000 @end table
35001
35002 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35003 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35004 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35005 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35006 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35007 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35008 fields.
35009
35010 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35011 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35012 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35013 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35014 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35015
35016 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35017 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35018 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35019 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35020 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35021
35022 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35023 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35024
35025 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35026 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35027 information associated with the variable.)
35028
35029 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35030 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35031 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35032 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35033 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35034 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35035
35036 Reply:
35037 @table @samp
35038 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35039 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35040 local storage requested.
35041
35042 @item E @var{nn}
35043 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35044
35045 @item @w{}
35046 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35047 @end table
35048
35049 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35050 @cindex get thread information block address
35051 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35052 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35053
35054 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35055
35056 Reply:
35057 @table @samp
35058 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35059 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35060 thread information block.
35061
35062 @item E @var{nn}
35063 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35064 address could not be retrieved.
35065
35066 @item @w{}
35067 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35068 @end table
35069
35070 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35071 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35072 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35073 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35074 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35075 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35076 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35077
35078 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35079
35080 Reply:
35081 @table @samp
35082 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35083 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35084 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35085 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35086 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35087 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35088 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35089 @end table
35090
35091 @item qOffsets
35092 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35093 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35094 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35095 image.
35096
35097 Reply:
35098 @table @samp
35099 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35100 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35101 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35102 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35103 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35104 segments by the supplied offsets.
35105
35106 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35107 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35108 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35109
35110 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35111 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35112 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35113 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35114 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35115 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35116 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35117 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35118 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35119 @end table
35120
35121 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35122 @cindex thread information, remote request
35123 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35124 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35125 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35126 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35127
35128 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35129 (see below).
35130
35131 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35132
35133 @item QNonStop:1
35134 @itemx QNonStop:0
35135 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35136 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35137 @anchor{QNonStop}
35138 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35139 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35140
35141 Reply:
35142 @table @samp
35143 @item OK
35144 The request succeeded.
35145
35146 @item E @var{nn}
35147 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35148
35149 @item @w{}
35150 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35151 the stub.
35152 @end table
35153
35154 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35155 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35156 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35157 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35158
35159 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35160 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35161 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35162 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35163 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35164 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35165 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35166 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35167 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35168 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35169 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35170 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35171 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35172
35173 Reply:
35174 @table @samp
35175 @item OK
35176 The request succeeded.
35177
35178 @item E @var{nn}
35179 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35180
35181 @item @w{}
35182 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35183 the stub.
35184 @end table
35185
35186 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35187 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35188 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35189 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35190
35191 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35192 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35193 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35194 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35195 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35196 Others should be silently discarded.
35197
35198 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35199 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35200 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35201 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35202 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35203 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35204 signals.
35205
35206 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35207 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35208
35209 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35210 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35211 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35212 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35213 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35214
35215 Reply:
35216 @table @samp
35217 @item OK
35218 The request succeeded.
35219
35220 @item E @var{nn}
35221 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35222
35223 @item @w{}
35224 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35225 by the stub.
35226 @end table
35227
35228 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35229 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35230 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35231 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35232
35233 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35234 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35235 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35236 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35237 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35238 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35239 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35240 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35241 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35242
35243 Reply:
35244 @table @samp
35245 @item OK
35246 A command response with no output.
35247 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35248 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35249 @item E @var{NN}
35250 Indicate a badly formed request.
35251 @item @w{}
35252 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35253 @end table
35254
35255 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35256 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35257 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35258 packets.)
35259
35260 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35261 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35262 @ifnotinfo
35263 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35264 @end ifnotinfo
35265 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35266 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35267 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35268 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35269 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35270
35271 Reply:
35272 @table @samp
35273 @item 0
35274 The pattern was not found.
35275 @item 1,address
35276 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35277 @item E @var{NN}
35278 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35279 @item @w{}
35280 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35281 @end table
35282
35283 @item QStartNoAckMode
35284 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35285 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35286 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35287 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35288
35289 Reply:
35290 @table @samp
35291 @item OK
35292 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35293 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35294 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35295 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35296 @item @w{}
35297 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35298 @end table
35299
35300 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35301 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35302 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35303 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35304 @anchor{qSupported}
35305 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35306 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35307 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35308 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35309 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35310 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35311 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35312 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35313 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35314 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35315 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35316 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35317 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35318 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35319
35320 Reply:
35321 @table @samp
35322 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35323 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35324 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35325 possible forms).
35326 @item @w{}
35327 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35328 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35329 @end table
35330
35331 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35332 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35333 are:
35334
35335 @table @samp
35336 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35337 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35338 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35339 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35340 @item @var{name}+
35341 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35342 need an associated value.
35343 @item @var{name}-
35344 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35345 @item @var{name}?
35346 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35347 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35348 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35349 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35350 @end table
35351
35352 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35353 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35354 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35355 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35356 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35357
35358 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35359 are defined:
35360
35361 @table @samp
35362 @item multiprocess
35363 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35364 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35365 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35366 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35367 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35368
35369 @item xmlRegisters
35370 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35371 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35372 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35373 description.
35374
35375 @item qRelocInsn
35376 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35377 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35378 instruction reply packet}).
35379 @end table
35380
35381 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35382 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35383 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35384 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35385 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35386 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35387 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35388 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35389 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35390 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35391 all the features it supports.
35392
35393 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35394 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35395
35396 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35397 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35398 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35399 form response.
35400
35401 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35402 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35403 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35404 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35405
35406 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35407 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35408 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35409 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35410 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35411
35412 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35413
35414 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35415 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35416 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35417 @item Feature Name
35418 @tab Value Required
35419 @tab Default
35420 @tab Probe Allowed
35421
35422 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35423 @tab Yes
35424 @tab @samp{-}
35425 @tab No
35426
35427 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35428 @tab No
35429 @tab @samp{-}
35430 @tab Yes
35431
35432 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35433 @tab No
35434 @tab @samp{-}
35435 @tab Yes
35436
35437 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35438 @tab No
35439 @tab @samp{-}
35440 @tab Yes
35441
35442 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35443 @tab No
35444 @tab @samp{-}
35445 @tab Yes
35446
35447 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35448 @tab No
35449 @tab @samp{-}
35450 @tab Yes
35451
35452 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35453 @tab No
35454 @tab @samp{-}
35455 @tab No
35456
35457 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35458 @tab No
35459 @tab @samp{-}
35460 @tab Yes
35461
35462 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35463 @tab No
35464 @tab @samp{-}
35465 @tab Yes
35466
35467 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35468 @tab No
35469 @tab @samp{-}
35470 @tab Yes
35471
35472 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35473 @tab No
35474 @tab @samp{-}
35475 @tab Yes
35476
35477 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35478 @tab No
35479 @tab @samp{-}
35480 @tab Yes
35481
35482 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35483 @tab No
35484 @tab @samp{-}
35485 @tab Yes
35486
35487 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35488 @tab No
35489 @tab @samp{-}
35490 @tab Yes
35491
35492 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35493 @tab No
35494 @tab @samp{-}
35495 @tab Yes
35496
35497 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35498 @tab No
35499 @tab @samp{-}
35500 @tab Yes
35501
35502 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35503 @tab No
35504 @tab @samp{-}
35505 @tab Yes
35506
35507 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35508 @tab Yes
35509 @tab @samp{-}
35510 @tab Yes
35511
35512 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35513 @tab Yes
35514 @tab @samp{-}
35515 @tab Yes
35516
35517 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35518 @tab No
35519 @tab @samp{-}
35520 @tab Yes
35521
35522 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35523 @tab No
35524 @tab @samp{-}
35525 @tab Yes
35526
35527 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35528 @tab No
35529 @tab @samp{-}
35530 @tab Yes
35531
35532 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35533 @tab No
35534 @tab @samp{-}
35535 @tab No
35536
35537 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35538 @tab No
35539 @tab @samp{-}
35540 @tab No
35541
35542 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35543 @tab No
35544 @tab @samp{-}
35545 @tab No
35546
35547 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35548 @tab No
35549 @tab @samp{-}
35550 @tab No
35551
35552 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35553 @tab No
35554 @tab @samp{-}
35555 @tab No
35556
35557 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35558 @tab No
35559 @tab @samp{-}
35560 @tab No
35561
35562 @item @samp{QAgent}
35563 @tab No
35564 @tab @samp{-}
35565 @tab No
35566
35567 @item @samp{QAllow}
35568 @tab No
35569 @tab @samp{-}
35570 @tab No
35571
35572 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35573 @tab No
35574 @tab @samp{-}
35575 @tab No
35576
35577 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35578 @tab No
35579 @tab @samp{-}
35580 @tab No
35581
35582 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35583 @tab No
35584 @tab @samp{-}
35585 @tab No
35586
35587 @item @samp{tracenz}
35588 @tab No
35589 @tab @samp{-}
35590 @tab No
35591
35592 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35593 @tab No
35594 @tab @samp{-}
35595 @tab No
35596
35597 @end multitable
35598
35599 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35600
35601 @table @samp
35602 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35603 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35604 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35605 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35606 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35607 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35608 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35609 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35610 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35611 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35612
35613 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35614 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35615 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35616
35617 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35618 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35619 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35620
35621 @item qXfer:features:read
35622 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35623 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35624
35625 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35626 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35627 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35628
35629 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35630 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35631 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35632
35633 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35634 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35635 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35636 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35637
35638 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35639 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35640 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35641
35642 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35643 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35644 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35645
35646 @item qXfer:spu:read
35647 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35648 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35649
35650 @item qXfer:spu:write
35651 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35652 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35653
35654 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35655 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35656 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35657
35658 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35659 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35660 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35661
35662 @item qXfer:threads:read
35663 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35664 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35665
35666 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35667 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35668 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35669
35670 @item qXfer:uib:read
35671 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35672 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35673
35674 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35675 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35676 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35677
35678 @item QNonStop
35679 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35680 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35681
35682 @item QPassSignals
35683 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35684 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35685
35686 @item QStartNoAckMode
35687 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35688 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35689
35690 @item multiprocess
35691 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35692 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35693 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35694 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35695 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35696 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35697 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35698 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35699 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35700 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35701 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35702
35703 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35704 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35705 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35706
35707 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35708 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35709 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35710 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35711
35712 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35713 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35714 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35715
35716 @item ReverseContinue
35717 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35718 (@pxref{bc}).
35719
35720 @item ReverseStep
35721 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35722 (@pxref{bs}).
35723
35724 @item TracepointSource
35725 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35726 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35727
35728 @item QAgent
35729 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35730
35731 @item QAllow
35732 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35733
35734 @item QDisableRandomization
35735 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35736
35737 @item StaticTracepoint
35738 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35739 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35740
35741 @item InstallInTrace
35742 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35743 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35744
35745 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35746 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35747 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35748 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35749
35750 @item QTBuffer:size
35751 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35752 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35753
35754 @item tracenz
35755 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35756 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35757 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35758
35759 @item BreakpointCommands
35760 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35761 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35762 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35763
35764 @item Qbtrace:off
35765 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35766
35767 @item Qbtrace:bts
35768 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35769
35770 @end table
35771
35772 @item qSymbol::
35773 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35774 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35775 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35776 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35777
35778 Reply:
35779 @table @samp
35780 @item OK
35781 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35782 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35783 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35784 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35785 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35786 below.
35787 @end table
35788
35789 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35790 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35791
35792 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35793 target has previously requested.
35794
35795 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35796 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35797 will be empty.
35798
35799 Reply:
35800 @table @samp
35801 @item OK
35802 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35803 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35804 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35805 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35806 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35807 @end table
35808
35809 @item qTBuffer
35810 @itemx QTBuffer
35811 @itemx QTDisconnected
35812 @itemx QTDP
35813 @itemx QTDPsrc
35814 @itemx QTDV
35815 @itemx qTfP
35816 @itemx qTfV
35817 @itemx QTFrame
35818 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35819
35820 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35821
35822 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35823 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35824 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35825 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
35826 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
35827 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
35828 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35829 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35830 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35831 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35832 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35833
35834 Reply:
35835 @table @samp
35836 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35837 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35838 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35839 the thread's attributes.
35840 @end table
35841
35842 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35843 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35844 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35845 packets.)
35846
35847 @item QTNotes
35848 @itemx qTP
35849 @itemx QTSave
35850 @itemx qTsP
35851 @itemx qTsV
35852 @itemx QTStart
35853 @itemx QTStop
35854 @itemx QTEnable
35855 @itemx QTDisable
35856 @itemx QTinit
35857 @itemx QTro
35858 @itemx qTStatus
35859 @itemx qTV
35860 @itemx qTfSTM
35861 @itemx qTsSTM
35862 @itemx qTSTMat
35863 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35864
35865 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35866 @cindex read special object, remote request
35867 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35868 @anchor{qXfer read}
35869 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35870 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35871 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35872 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35873 additional details about what data to access.
35874
35875 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35876 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35877 formats, listed below.
35878
35879 @table @samp
35880 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35881 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35882 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35883 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35884
35885 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35886 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35887
35888 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35889 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35890
35891 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35892 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35893 packet may have one of the following values:
35894
35895 @table @code
35896 @item all
35897 Returns all available branch trace.
35898
35899 @item new
35900 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35901 the last read request.
35902
35903 @item delta
35904 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35905 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35906 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35907 used to stitch traces together.
35908
35909 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35910 @end table
35911
35912 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35913 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35914
35915 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35916 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35917 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35918 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35919 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35920
35921 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35922 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35923
35924 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35925 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35926 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35927 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35928 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35929
35930 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35931 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35932 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35933
35934 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35935 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35936
35937 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35938 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35939 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35940 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35941 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35942 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35943 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35944 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35945
35946 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35947 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35948
35949 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35950 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35951
35952 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35953 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35954 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35955 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35956
35957 @table @code
35958 @item start=@var{address}
35959 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35960 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35961 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35962 chosen as the starting point.
35963
35964 @item prev=@var{address}
35965 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35966 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35967 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35968 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35969 exists prior to the starting point.
35970
35971 @end table
35972
35973 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35974 ignored.
35975
35976 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35977 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35978 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35979 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35980 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35981
35982 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35983 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35984
35985 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35986 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35987
35988 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35989 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35990 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35991 Action Lists}.
35992
35993 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35994 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35995 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35996
35997 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35998 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35999 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36000 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36001 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36002
36003 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36004 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36005 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36006
36007 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36008 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36009 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36010 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36011 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36012 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36013 in that context to be accessed.
36014
36015 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36016 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36017 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36018
36019 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36020 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36021 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36022 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36023 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36024
36025 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36026 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36027
36028 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36029 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36030
36031 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36032 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36033 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36034
36035 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36036 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36037
36038 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36039 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36040
36041 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36042 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36043
36044 This packet is not probed by default.
36045
36046 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36047 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36048 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36049 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36050 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36051
36052 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36053 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36054
36055 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36056 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36057 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36058 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36059
36060 @end table
36061
36062 Reply:
36063 @table @samp
36064 @item m @var{data}
36065 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36066 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36067 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36068 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36069 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36070 request.
36071
36072 @item l @var{data}
36073 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36074 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36075 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36076
36077 @item l
36078 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36079 There is no more data to be read.
36080
36081 @item E00
36082 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36083
36084 @item E @var{nn}
36085 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36086 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36087
36088 @item @w{}
36089 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36090 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36091 @end table
36092
36093 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36094 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36095 @anchor{qXfer write}
36096 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36097 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36098 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36099 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36100 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36101 to access.
36102
36103 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36104 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36105 formats, listed below.
36106
36107 @table @samp
36108 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36109 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36110 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36111 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36112 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36113
36114 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36115 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36116 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36117
36118 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36119 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36120 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36121 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36122 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36123 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36124 in that context to be accessed.
36125
36126 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36127 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36128 @end table
36129
36130 Reply:
36131 @table @samp
36132 @item @var{nn}
36133 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36134 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36135
36136 @item E00
36137 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36138
36139 @item E @var{nn}
36140 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36141 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36142
36143 @item @w{}
36144 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36145 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36146 @end table
36147
36148 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36149 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36150 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36151 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36152 must respond with an empty packet.
36153
36154 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36155 @cindex query attached, remote request
36156 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36157 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36158 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36159 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36160 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36161 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36162 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36163
36164 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36165 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36166 the @code{quit} command.
36167
36168 Reply:
36169 @table @samp
36170 @item 1
36171 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36172 @item 0
36173 The remote server created a new process.
36174 @item E @var{NN}
36175 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36176 @end table
36177
36178 @item Qbtrace:bts
36179 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36180
36181 Reply:
36182 @table @samp
36183 @item OK
36184 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36185 @item E.errtext
36186 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36187 @end table
36188
36189 @item Qbtrace:off
36190 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36191
36192 Reply:
36193 @table @samp
36194 @item OK
36195 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36196 @item E.errtext
36197 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36198 @end table
36199
36200 @end table
36201
36202 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36203 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36204
36205 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36206 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36207 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36208
36209 @menu
36210 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36211 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36212 @end menu
36213
36214 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36215 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36216
36217 @menu
36218 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36219 @end menu
36220
36221 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36222 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36223 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36224
36225 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36226
36227 @table @r
36228
36229 @item 2
36230 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36231
36232 @item 3
36233 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36234
36235 @item 4
36236 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36237
36238 @end table
36239
36240 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36241 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36242
36243 @menu
36244 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36245 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36246 @end menu
36247
36248 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36249 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36250 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36251
36252 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36253 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36254 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36255 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36256 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36257 most-significant -- least-significant.
36258
36259 @table @r
36260
36261 @item MIPS32
36262 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36263 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36264 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36265
36266 @item MIPS64
36267 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36268 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36269 as @code{MIPS32}.
36270
36271 @end table
36272
36273 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36274 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36275 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36276
36277 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36278
36279 @table @r
36280
36281 @item 2
36282 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36283
36284 @item 3
36285 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36286
36287 @item 4
36288 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36289
36290 @item 5
36291 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36292
36293 @end table
36294
36295 @node Tracepoint Packets
36296 @section Tracepoint Packets
36297 @cindex tracepoint packets
36298 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36299
36300 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36301 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36302
36303 @table @samp
36304
36305 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36306 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36307 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36308 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36309 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36310 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36311 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36312 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36313 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36314 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36315 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36316 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36317 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36318 actions.
36319
36320 Replies:
36321 @table @samp
36322 @item OK
36323 The packet was understood and carried out.
36324 @item qRelocInsn
36325 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36326 @item @w{}
36327 The packet was not recognized.
36328 @end table
36329
36330 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36331 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36332 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36333 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36334 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36335 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36336 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36337
36338 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36339 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36340 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36341 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36342 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36343 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36344 tracepoint actions.
36345
36346 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36347 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36348 following forms:
36349
36350 @table @samp
36351
36352 @item R @var{mask}
36353 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36354 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36355 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36356 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36357 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36358
36359 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36360 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36361 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36362 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36363 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36364 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36365 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36366
36367 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36368 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36369 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36370 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36371 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36372 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36373 packet).
36374
36375 @end table
36376
36377 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36378 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36379 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36380 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36381 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36382 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36383 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36384 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36385
36386 Replies:
36387 @table @samp
36388 @item OK
36389 The packet was understood and carried out.
36390 @item qRelocInsn
36391 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36392 @item @w{}
36393 The packet was not recognized.
36394 @end table
36395
36396 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36397 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36398 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36399 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36400 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36401 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36402 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36403 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36404
36405 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36406 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36407 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36408 fit in a single packet.
36409 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36410 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36411
36412 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36413 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36414 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36415 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36416
36417 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36418 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36419 query packets.
36420
36421 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36422 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36423 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36424 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36425 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36426 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36427 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36428 be found.
36429
36430 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36431 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36432 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36433 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36434 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36435 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36436 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36437 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36438 mentioned in expressions.
36439
36440 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36441 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36442 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36443 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36444 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36445
36446 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36447 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36448 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36449 one of the following forms:
36450
36451 @table @samp
36452 @item F @var{f}
36453 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36454 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36455 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36456
36457 @item T @var{t}
36458 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36459 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36460
36461 @end table
36462
36463 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36464 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36465 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36466 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36467
36468 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36469 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36470 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36471 is a hexadecimal number.
36472
36473 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36474 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36475 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36476 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36477 numbers.
36478
36479 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36480 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36481 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36482
36483 @item qTMinFTPILen
36484 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36485 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36486 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36487 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36488 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36489 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36490 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36491 arrange for that.
36492
36493 Replies:
36494
36495 @table @samp
36496 @item 0
36497 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36498 @item @var{length}
36499 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36500 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36501 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36502 regardless of size.
36503 @item E
36504 An error has occurred.
36505 @item @w{}
36506 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36507 @end table
36508
36509 @item QTStart
36510 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36511 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36512 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36513 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36514 instruction reply packet}).
36515
36516 @item QTStop
36517 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36518 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36519
36520 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36521 @anchor{QTEnable}
36522 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36523 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36524 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36525 of data from it will resume.
36526
36527 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36528 @anchor{QTDisable}
36529 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36530 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36531 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36532 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36533
36534 @item QTinit
36535 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36536 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36537
36538 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36539 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36540 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36541 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36542 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36543
36544 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36545 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36546 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36547 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36548
36549 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36550 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36551 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36552 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36553 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36554 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36555
36556 @item qTStatus
36557 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36558 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36559
36560 The reply has the form:
36561
36562 @table @samp
36563
36564 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36565 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36566 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36567 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36568
36569 @end table
36570
36571 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36572 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36573
36574 @table @samp
36575
36576 @item tnotrun:0
36577 No trace has been run yet.
36578
36579 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36580 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36581 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36582 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36583 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36584
36585 @item tfull:0
36586 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36587
36588 @item tdisconnected:0
36589 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36590
36591 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36592 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36593
36594 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36595 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36596 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36597 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
36598 is hex encoded.
36599
36600 @item tunknown:0
36601 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36602
36603 @end table
36604
36605 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36606 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36607 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36608 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36609 trace.
36610
36611 @table @samp
36612
36613 @item tframes:@var{n}
36614 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36615
36616 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36617 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36618 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36619
36620 @item tsize:@var{n}
36621 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36622
36623 @item tfree:@var{n}
36624 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36625
36626 @item circular:@var{n}
36627 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36628 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36629 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36630 and may fill up.
36631
36632 @item disconn:@var{n}
36633 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36634 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36635 that the trace run will stop.
36636
36637 @end table
36638
36639 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36640 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36641 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36642 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36643 address @var{addr}.
36644
36645 Replies:
36646 @table @samp
36647 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36648 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36649 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36650 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36651 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36652
36653 @end table
36654
36655 @item qTV:@var{var}
36656 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36657 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36658 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36659
36660 Replies:
36661 @table @samp
36662 @item V@var{value}
36663 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36664 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36665 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36666 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36667 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36668 program is running.
36669
36670 @item U
36671 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36672 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36673 was not collected.
36674 @end table
36675
36676 @item qTfP
36677 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36678 @itemx qTsP
36679 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36680 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36681 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36682 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36683 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36684 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36685
36686 @item qTfV
36687 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36688 @itemx qTsV
36689 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36690 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36691 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36692 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36693 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36694 trace state variables.
36695
36696 @item qTfSTM
36697 @itemx qTsSTM
36698 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36699 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36700 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36701 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36702 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36703 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36704 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36705 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36706
36707 Reply:
36708 @table @samp
36709 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36710 A single marker
36711 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36712 a comma-separated list of markers
36713 @item l
36714 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36715 @item E @var{nn}
36716 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36717 @item @w{}
36718 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36719 stub.
36720 @end table
36721
36722 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
36723 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36724
36725 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36726 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36727 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36728 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36729 @dfn{last}).
36730
36731 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36732 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36733 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36734 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36735 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36736 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36737 tracepoint markers.
36738
36739 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36740 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36741 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36742 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
36743 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36744 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36745
36746 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36747 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36748 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36749 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36750 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36751 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36752 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36753 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36754 available.
36755
36756 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36757 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36758 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36759
36760 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36761 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36762 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36763 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36764 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36765 use whatever size it prefers.
36766
36767 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36768 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36769 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36770 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36771 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36772
36773 @end table
36774
36775 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36776 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36777 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36778 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36779 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36780 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36781 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36782 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36783 it had executed in the original location.
36784
36785 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36786 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36787 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36788 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36789 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36790 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36791 format of the request is:
36792
36793 @table @samp
36794 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36795
36796 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36797 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36798 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36799 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36800 memory starting at @var{to}.
36801 @end table
36802
36803 Replies:
36804 @table @samp
36805 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36806 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
36807 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36808 @item E @var{NN}
36809 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36810 relocating the instruction.
36811 @end table
36812
36813 @node Host I/O Packets
36814 @section Host I/O Packets
36815 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36816 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36817
36818 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36819 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36820 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36821 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36822 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36823 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36824 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36825 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36826 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36827 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36828
36829 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36830 its arguments. They have this format:
36831
36832 @table @samp
36833
36834 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36835 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36836 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36837 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36838 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36839 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36840 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36841 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36842 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36843
36844 @end table
36845
36846 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36847
36848 @table @samp
36849
36850 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36851 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36852 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36853 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
36854 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36855 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36856 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36857 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36858 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36859 @var{attachment}.
36860
36861 @item @w{}
36862 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36863
36864 @end table
36865
36866 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36867
36868 @table @samp
36869 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36870 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36871 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
36872 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36873 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36874 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36875 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36876
36877 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36878 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36879 -1 if an error occurs.
36880
36881 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36882 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36883 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36884 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36885 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36886 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36887 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36888 @var{count} was zero.
36889
36890 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36891 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36892 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36893 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36894 some characters were escaped.
36895
36896 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36897 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36898 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36899 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36900 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36901 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36902 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36903 error occurred.
36904
36905 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
36906 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
36907 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
36908
36909 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36910 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36911 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36912
36913 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36914 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36915 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36916 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36917 some characters were escaped.
36918
36919 @end table
36920
36921 @node Interrupts
36922 @section Interrupts
36923 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36924
36925 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36926 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36927 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36928 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36929
36930 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36931 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36932 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36933 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36934 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36935
36936 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36937 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36938 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36939 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36940 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36941 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36942 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36943 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36944
36945 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36946 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36947 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36948
36949 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36950 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36951 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36952 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36953 currently-executing threads and processes.
36954 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36955 running program, it should send one of the stop
36956 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36957 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36958 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36959 Interrupts received while the
36960 program is stopped are discarded.
36961
36962 @node Notification Packets
36963 @section Notification Packets
36964 @cindex notification packets
36965 @cindex packets, notification
36966
36967 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36968 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36969 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36970 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36971 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36972 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36973 is not a problem.
36974
36975 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36976 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36977 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36978 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36979 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36980 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36981 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36982
36983 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36984 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36985
36986 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36987 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36988 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36989 not they understand it.
36990
36991 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36992 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36993 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36994 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36995 recipients.
36996
36997 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36998 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36999 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37000 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37001 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37002
37003 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37004 @table @samp
37005 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37006 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37007 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37008 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37009 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37010 @item @var{ack}
37011 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37012 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37013 @end table
37014
37015 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37016 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37017
37018 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37019 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37020 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37021 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37022 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37023 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37024 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37025 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37026 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37027 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37028
37029 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37030 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37031 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37032 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37033 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37034 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37035
37036 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37037 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37038 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37039 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37040 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37041
37042 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37043 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37044 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37045 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37046 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37047 normally.
37048
37049 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37050 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37051 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37052 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37053 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37054 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37055 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37056 the process shall be repeated.
37057
37058 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37059 following example:
37060 @smallexample
37061 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37062 @code{...}
37063 -> @code{vStopped}
37064 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37065 -> @code{vStopped}
37066 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37067 -> @code{vStopped}
37068 <- @code{OK}
37069 @end smallexample
37070
37071 The following notifications are defined:
37072 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37073
37074 @item Notification
37075 @tab Ack
37076 @tab Event
37077 @tab Description
37078
37079 @item Stop
37080 @tab vStopped
37081 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37082 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37083 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37084 @value{GDBN}.
37085 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37086
37087 @end multitable
37088
37089 @node Remote Non-Stop
37090 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37091
37092 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37093 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37094 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37095 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37096
37097 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37098 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37099 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37100 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37101 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37102 probe the target state after a mode change.
37103
37104 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37105 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37106 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37107 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37108 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37109 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37110 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37111 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37112 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37113 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37114 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37115
37116 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37117 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37118 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37119 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37120 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37121 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37122 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37123 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37124 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37125 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37126 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37127 @samp{OK}.
37128
37129 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37130 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37131
37132 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37133 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37134 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37135 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37136 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37137 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37138 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37139
37140 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37141 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37142 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37143 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37144 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37145
37146 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37147 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37148 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37149 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37150
37151 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37152 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37153 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37154 @pxref{qSupported}.
37155 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37156 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37157 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37158 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37159 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37160 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37161 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37162
37163 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37164 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37165 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37166 connection.
37167 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37168 new connection is established,
37169 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37170 for the current connection, once disabled.
37171
37172 @node Examples
37173 @section Examples
37174
37175 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37176 does not get any direct output:
37177
37178 @smallexample
37179 -> @code{R00}
37180 <- @code{+}
37181 @emph{target restarts}
37182 -> @code{?}
37183 <- @code{+}
37184 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37185 -> @code{+}
37186 @end smallexample
37187
37188 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37189
37190 @smallexample
37191 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37192 <- @code{+}
37193 -> @code{s}
37194 <- @code{+}
37195 @emph{time passes}
37196 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37197 -> @code{+}
37198 -> @code{g}
37199 <- @code{+}
37200 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37201 -> @code{+}
37202 @end smallexample
37203
37204 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37205 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37206 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37207
37208 @menu
37209 * File-I/O Overview::
37210 * Protocol Basics::
37211 * The F Request Packet::
37212 * The F Reply Packet::
37213 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37214 * Console I/O::
37215 * List of Supported Calls::
37216 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37217 * Constants::
37218 * File-I/O Examples::
37219 @end menu
37220
37221 @node File-I/O Overview
37222 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37223 @cindex file-i/o overview
37224
37225 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37226 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37227 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37228 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37229 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37230 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37231
37232 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37233 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37234 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37235 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37236 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37237
37238 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37239 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37240 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37241 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37242 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37243 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37244 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37245
37246 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37247 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37248 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37249 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37250 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37251
37252 @smallexample
37253 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37254 <- target requests 'system call X'
37255 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37256 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37257 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37258 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37259 @end smallexample
37260
37261 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37262 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37263 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37264 system are not supported by this protocol.
37265
37266 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37267
37268 @node Protocol Basics
37269 @subsection Protocol Basics
37270 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37271
37272 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37273 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37274 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37275 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37276 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37277 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37278 to call the appropriate host system call:
37279
37280 @itemize @bullet
37281 @item
37282 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37283
37284 @item
37285 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37286 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37287 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37288 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37289
37290 @end itemize
37291
37292 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37293
37294 @itemize @bullet
37295 @item
37296 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37297 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37298 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37299 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37300 packet.
37301
37302 @item
37303 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37304 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37305
37306 @item
37307 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37308
37309 @item
37310 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37311
37312 @item
37313 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37314 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37315 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37316 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37317 packet.
37318
37319 @end itemize
37320
37321 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37322 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37323
37324 @itemize @bullet
37325 @item
37326 Return value.
37327
37328 @item
37329 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37330
37331 @item
37332 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37333
37334 @end itemize
37335
37336 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37337 the latest continue or step action.
37338
37339 @node The F Request Packet
37340 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37341 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37342 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37343
37344 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37345
37346 @table @samp
37347 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37348
37349 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37350 This is just the name of the function.
37351
37352 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37353 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37354 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37355 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37356 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37357 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37358 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37359
37360 @end table
37361
37362
37363
37364 @node The F Reply Packet
37365 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37366 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37367 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37368
37369 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37370
37371 @table @samp
37372
37373 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37374
37375 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37376
37377 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37378 representation.
37379 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37380
37381 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37382 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37383 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37384
37385 @smallexample
37386 F0,0,C
37387 @end smallexample
37388
37389 @noindent
37390 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37391
37392 @smallexample
37393 F-1,4,C
37394 @end smallexample
37395
37396 @noindent
37397 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37398
37399 @end table
37400
37401
37402 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37403 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37404 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37405
37406 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37407 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37408 the target should behave as if it had
37409 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37410 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37411 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37412 packet.
37413
37414 It's important for the target to know in which
37415 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37416
37417 @itemize @bullet
37418 @item
37419 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37420
37421 @item
37422 The system call on the host has been finished.
37423
37424 @end itemize
37425
37426 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37427 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37428 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37429 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37430 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37431 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37432
37433 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37434 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37435 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37436 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37437 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37438 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37439 or the full action has been completed.
37440
37441 @node Console I/O
37442 @subsection Console I/O
37443 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37444
37445 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37446 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37447 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37448 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37449 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37450 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37451 conditions is met:
37452
37453 @itemize @bullet
37454 @item
37455 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37456 @code{read}
37457 system call is treated as finished.
37458
37459 @item
37460 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37461 newline.
37462
37463 @item
37464 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37465 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37466
37467 @end itemize
37468
37469 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37470 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37471 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37472 is stopped at the user's request.
37473
37474
37475 @node List of Supported Calls
37476 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37477 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37478
37479 @menu
37480 * open::
37481 * close::
37482 * read::
37483 * write::
37484 * lseek::
37485 * rename::
37486 * unlink::
37487 * stat/fstat::
37488 * gettimeofday::
37489 * isatty::
37490 * system::
37491 @end menu
37492
37493 @node open
37494 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37495 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37496
37497 @table @asis
37498 @item Synopsis:
37499 @smallexample
37500 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37501 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37502 @end smallexample
37503
37504 @item Request:
37505 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37506
37507 @noindent
37508 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37509
37510 @table @code
37511 @item O_CREAT
37512 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37513 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37514 are concerned.
37515
37516 @item O_EXCL
37517 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37518 an error and open() fails.
37519
37520 @item O_TRUNC
37521 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37522 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37523 truncated to zero length.
37524
37525 @item O_APPEND
37526 The file is opened in append mode.
37527
37528 @item O_RDONLY
37529 The file is opened for reading only.
37530
37531 @item O_WRONLY
37532 The file is opened for writing only.
37533
37534 @item O_RDWR
37535 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37536 @end table
37537
37538 @noindent
37539 Other bits are silently ignored.
37540
37541
37542 @noindent
37543 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37544
37545 @table @code
37546 @item S_IRUSR
37547 User has read permission.
37548
37549 @item S_IWUSR
37550 User has write permission.
37551
37552 @item S_IRGRP
37553 Group has read permission.
37554
37555 @item S_IWGRP
37556 Group has write permission.
37557
37558 @item S_IROTH
37559 Others have read permission.
37560
37561 @item S_IWOTH
37562 Others have write permission.
37563 @end table
37564
37565 @noindent
37566 Other bits are silently ignored.
37567
37568
37569 @item Return value:
37570 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37571 occurred.
37572
37573 @item Errors:
37574
37575 @table @code
37576 @item EEXIST
37577 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37578
37579 @item EISDIR
37580 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37581
37582 @item EACCES
37583 The requested access is not allowed.
37584
37585 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37586 @var{pathname} was too long.
37587
37588 @item ENOENT
37589 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37590
37591 @item ENODEV
37592 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37593
37594 @item EROFS
37595 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37596 write access was requested.
37597
37598 @item EFAULT
37599 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37600
37601 @item ENOSPC
37602 No space on device to create the file.
37603
37604 @item EMFILE
37605 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37606
37607 @item ENFILE
37608 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37609 has been reached.
37610
37611 @item EINTR
37612 The call was interrupted by the user.
37613 @end table
37614
37615 @end table
37616
37617 @node close
37618 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37619 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37620
37621 @table @asis
37622 @item Synopsis:
37623 @smallexample
37624 int close(int fd);
37625 @end smallexample
37626
37627 @item Request:
37628 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37629
37630 @item Return value:
37631 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37632
37633 @item Errors:
37634
37635 @table @code
37636 @item EBADF
37637 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37638
37639 @item EINTR
37640 The call was interrupted by the user.
37641 @end table
37642
37643 @end table
37644
37645 @node read
37646 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37647 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37648
37649 @table @asis
37650 @item Synopsis:
37651 @smallexample
37652 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37653 @end smallexample
37654
37655 @item Request:
37656 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37657
37658 @item Return value:
37659 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37660 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37661 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37662
37663 @item Errors:
37664
37665 @table @code
37666 @item EBADF
37667 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37668 reading.
37669
37670 @item EFAULT
37671 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37672
37673 @item EINTR
37674 The call was interrupted by the user.
37675 @end table
37676
37677 @end table
37678
37679 @node write
37680 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37681 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37682
37683 @table @asis
37684 @item Synopsis:
37685 @smallexample
37686 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37687 @end smallexample
37688
37689 @item Request:
37690 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37691
37692 @item Return value:
37693 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37694 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37695 is returned.
37696
37697 @item Errors:
37698
37699 @table @code
37700 @item EBADF
37701 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37702 writing.
37703
37704 @item EFAULT
37705 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37706
37707 @item EFBIG
37708 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37709 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37710
37711 @item ENOSPC
37712 No space on device to write the data.
37713
37714 @item EINTR
37715 The call was interrupted by the user.
37716 @end table
37717
37718 @end table
37719
37720 @node lseek
37721 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37722 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37723
37724 @table @asis
37725 @item Synopsis:
37726 @smallexample
37727 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37728 @end smallexample
37729
37730 @item Request:
37731 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37732
37733 @var{flag} is one of:
37734
37735 @table @code
37736 @item SEEK_SET
37737 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37738
37739 @item SEEK_CUR
37740 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37741 bytes.
37742
37743 @item SEEK_END
37744 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37745 bytes.
37746 @end table
37747
37748 @item Return value:
37749 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37750 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37751 value of -1 is returned.
37752
37753 @item Errors:
37754
37755 @table @code
37756 @item EBADF
37757 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37758
37759 @item ESPIPE
37760 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37761
37762 @item EINVAL
37763 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37764
37765 @item EINTR
37766 The call was interrupted by the user.
37767 @end table
37768
37769 @end table
37770
37771 @node rename
37772 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37773 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37774
37775 @table @asis
37776 @item Synopsis:
37777 @smallexample
37778 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37779 @end smallexample
37780
37781 @item Request:
37782 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37783
37784 @item Return value:
37785 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37786
37787 @item Errors:
37788
37789 @table @code
37790 @item EISDIR
37791 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37792 directory.
37793
37794 @item EEXIST
37795 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37796
37797 @item EBUSY
37798 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37799 process.
37800
37801 @item EINVAL
37802 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37803 of itself.
37804
37805 @item ENOTDIR
37806 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37807 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37808 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37809
37810 @item EFAULT
37811 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37812
37813 @item EACCES
37814 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37815
37816 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37817
37818 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37819
37820 @item ENOENT
37821 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37822
37823 @item EROFS
37824 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37825
37826 @item ENOSPC
37827 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37828 directory entry.
37829
37830 @item EINTR
37831 The call was interrupted by the user.
37832 @end table
37833
37834 @end table
37835
37836 @node unlink
37837 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37838 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37839
37840 @table @asis
37841 @item Synopsis:
37842 @smallexample
37843 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37844 @end smallexample
37845
37846 @item Request:
37847 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37848
37849 @item Return value:
37850 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37851
37852 @item Errors:
37853
37854 @table @code
37855 @item EACCES
37856 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37857
37858 @item EPERM
37859 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37860
37861 @item EBUSY
37862 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37863 being used by another process.
37864
37865 @item EFAULT
37866 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37867
37868 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37869 @var{pathname} was too long.
37870
37871 @item ENOENT
37872 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37873
37874 @item ENOTDIR
37875 A component of the path is not a directory.
37876
37877 @item EROFS
37878 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37879
37880 @item EINTR
37881 The call was interrupted by the user.
37882 @end table
37883
37884 @end table
37885
37886 @node stat/fstat
37887 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37888 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37889 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37890
37891 @table @asis
37892 @item Synopsis:
37893 @smallexample
37894 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37895 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37896 @end smallexample
37897
37898 @item Request:
37899 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37900 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37901
37902 @item Return value:
37903 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37904
37905 @item Errors:
37906
37907 @table @code
37908 @item EBADF
37909 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37910
37911 @item ENOENT
37912 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37913 path is an empty string.
37914
37915 @item ENOTDIR
37916 A component of the path is not a directory.
37917
37918 @item EFAULT
37919 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37920
37921 @item EACCES
37922 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37923
37924 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37925 @var{pathname} was too long.
37926
37927 @item EINTR
37928 The call was interrupted by the user.
37929 @end table
37930
37931 @end table
37932
37933 @node gettimeofday
37934 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37935 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37936
37937 @table @asis
37938 @item Synopsis:
37939 @smallexample
37940 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37941 @end smallexample
37942
37943 @item Request:
37944 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37945
37946 @item Return value:
37947 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37948
37949 @item Errors:
37950
37951 @table @code
37952 @item EINVAL
37953 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37954
37955 @item EFAULT
37956 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37957 @end table
37958
37959 @end table
37960
37961 @node isatty
37962 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37963 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37964
37965 @table @asis
37966 @item Synopsis:
37967 @smallexample
37968 int isatty(int fd);
37969 @end smallexample
37970
37971 @item Request:
37972 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37973
37974 @item Return value:
37975 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37976
37977 @item Errors:
37978
37979 @table @code
37980 @item EINTR
37981 The call was interrupted by the user.
37982 @end table
37983
37984 @end table
37985
37986 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37987 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37988 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37989 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37990 needed.
37991
37992
37993 @node system
37994 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37995 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37996
37997 @table @asis
37998 @item Synopsis:
37999 @smallexample
38000 int system(const char *command);
38001 @end smallexample
38002
38003 @item Request:
38004 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38005
38006 @item Return value:
38007 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38008 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38009 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38010 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38011 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38012 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38013 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38014
38015 @item Errors:
38016
38017 @table @code
38018 @item EINTR
38019 The call was interrupted by the user.
38020 @end table
38021
38022 @end table
38023
38024 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38025 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38026 the host is simplified before it's returned
38027 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38028 is discarded, and the return value consists
38029 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38030
38031 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38032 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38033 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38034
38035 @table @code
38036 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38037 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38038 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38039 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38040
38041 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38042 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38043 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38044 protocol.
38045 @end table
38046
38047 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38048 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38049 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38050
38051 @menu
38052 * Integral Datatypes::
38053 * Pointer Values::
38054 * Memory Transfer::
38055 * struct stat::
38056 * struct timeval::
38057 @end menu
38058
38059 @node Integral Datatypes
38060 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38061 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38062
38063 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38064 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38065 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38066
38067 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38068 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38069
38070 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38071
38072 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38073 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38074
38075 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38076
38077 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38078 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38079 byte order.
38080
38081 @node Pointer Values
38082 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38083 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38084
38085 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38086 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38087 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38088 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38089
38090 @smallexample
38091 @code{1aaf/12}
38092 @end smallexample
38093
38094 @noindent
38095 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38096 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38097 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38098 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38099
38100 @smallexample
38101 @code{123456/d}
38102 @end smallexample
38103
38104 @node Memory Transfer
38105 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38106 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38107
38108 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38109 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38110 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38111 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38112 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38113 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38114 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38115
38116
38117 @node struct stat
38118 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38119 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38120
38121 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38122 is defined as follows:
38123
38124 @smallexample
38125 struct stat @{
38126 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38127 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38128 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38129 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38130 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38131 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38132 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38133 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38134 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38135 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38136 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38137 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38138 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38139 @};
38140 @end smallexample
38141
38142 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38143 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38144 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38145
38146 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38147 range of values.
38148
38149 @table @code
38150
38151 @item st_dev
38152 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38153
38154 @item st_ino
38155 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38156
38157 @item st_mode
38158 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38159 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38160
38161 @item st_uid
38162 @itemx st_gid
38163 @itemx st_rdev
38164 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38165
38166 @item st_atime
38167 @itemx st_mtime
38168 @itemx st_ctime
38169 These values have a host and file system dependent
38170 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38171 support exact timing values.
38172 @end table
38173
38174 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38175 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38176 continuing.
38177
38178 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38179 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38180 get truncated on the target.
38181
38182 @node struct timeval
38183 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38184 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38185
38186 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38187 is defined as follows:
38188
38189 @smallexample
38190 struct timeval @{
38191 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38192 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38193 @};
38194 @end smallexample
38195
38196 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38197 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38198 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38199
38200 @node Constants
38201 @subsection Constants
38202 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38203
38204 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38205 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38206 values before and after the call as needed.
38207
38208 @menu
38209 * Open Flags::
38210 * mode_t Values::
38211 * Errno Values::
38212 * Lseek Flags::
38213 * Limits::
38214 @end menu
38215
38216 @node Open Flags
38217 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38218 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38219
38220 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38221
38222 @smallexample
38223 O_RDONLY 0x0
38224 O_WRONLY 0x1
38225 O_RDWR 0x2
38226 O_APPEND 0x8
38227 O_CREAT 0x200
38228 O_TRUNC 0x400
38229 O_EXCL 0x800
38230 @end smallexample
38231
38232 @node mode_t Values
38233 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38234 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38235
38236 All values are given in octal representation.
38237
38238 @smallexample
38239 S_IFREG 0100000
38240 S_IFDIR 040000
38241 S_IRUSR 0400
38242 S_IWUSR 0200
38243 S_IXUSR 0100
38244 S_IRGRP 040
38245 S_IWGRP 020
38246 S_IXGRP 010
38247 S_IROTH 04
38248 S_IWOTH 02
38249 S_IXOTH 01
38250 @end smallexample
38251
38252 @node Errno Values
38253 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38254 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38255
38256 All values are given in decimal representation.
38257
38258 @smallexample
38259 EPERM 1
38260 ENOENT 2
38261 EINTR 4
38262 EBADF 9
38263 EACCES 13
38264 EFAULT 14
38265 EBUSY 16
38266 EEXIST 17
38267 ENODEV 19
38268 ENOTDIR 20
38269 EISDIR 21
38270 EINVAL 22
38271 ENFILE 23
38272 EMFILE 24
38273 EFBIG 27
38274 ENOSPC 28
38275 ESPIPE 29
38276 EROFS 30
38277 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38278 EUNKNOWN 9999
38279 @end smallexample
38280
38281 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38282 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38283
38284 @node Lseek Flags
38285 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38286 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38287
38288 @smallexample
38289 SEEK_SET 0
38290 SEEK_CUR 1
38291 SEEK_END 2
38292 @end smallexample
38293
38294 @node Limits
38295 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38296 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38297
38298 All values are given in decimal representation.
38299
38300 @smallexample
38301 INT_MIN -2147483648
38302 INT_MAX 2147483647
38303 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38304 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38305 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38306 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38307 @end smallexample
38308
38309 @node File-I/O Examples
38310 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38311 @cindex file-i/o examples
38312
38313 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38314 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38315
38316 @smallexample
38317 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38318 @emph{request memory read from target}
38319 -> @code{m1234,6}
38320 <- XXXXXX
38321 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38322 -> @code{F6}
38323 @end smallexample
38324
38325 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38326 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38327
38328 @smallexample
38329 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38330 @emph{request memory write to target}
38331 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38332 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38333 -> @code{F6}
38334 @end smallexample
38335
38336 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38337 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38338
38339 @smallexample
38340 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38341 -> @code{F-1,9}
38342 @end smallexample
38343
38344 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38345 host is called:
38346
38347 @smallexample
38348 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38349 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38350 <- @code{T02}
38351 @end smallexample
38352
38353 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38354 host is called:
38355
38356 @smallexample
38357 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38358 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38359 <- @code{T02}
38360 @end smallexample
38361
38362 @node Library List Format
38363 @section Library List Format
38364 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38365
38366 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38367 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38368 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38369 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38370 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38371 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38372 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38373 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38374 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38375 are loaded.
38376
38377 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38378 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38379 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38380 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38381
38382 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38383 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38384 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38385 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38386 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38387 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38388
38389 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38390 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38391
38392 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38393 offset, looks like this:
38394
38395 @smallexample
38396 <library-list>
38397 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38398 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38399 </library>
38400 </library-list>
38401 @end smallexample
38402
38403 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38404 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38405
38406 @smallexample
38407 <library-list>
38408 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38409 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38410 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38411 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38412 </library>
38413 </library-list>
38414 @end smallexample
38415
38416 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38417
38418 @smallexample
38419 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38420 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38421 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38422 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38423 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38424 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38425 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38426 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38427 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38428 @end smallexample
38429
38430 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38431 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38432 section for each library.
38433
38434 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38435 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38436 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38437
38438 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38439 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38440 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38441 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38442
38443 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38444 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38445 target, the following parameters are reported:
38446
38447 @itemize @minus
38448 @item
38449 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38450 @code{struct link_map}.
38451 @item
38452 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38453 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38454 @item
38455 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38456 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38457 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38458 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38459 @item
38460 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38461 @end itemize
38462
38463 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38464 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38465 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38466
38467 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38468 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38469
38470 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38471 looks like this:
38472
38473 @smallexample
38474 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38475 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38476 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38477 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38478 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38479 </library-list-svr>
38480 @end smallexample
38481
38482 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38483
38484 @smallexample
38485 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38486 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38487 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38488 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38489 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38490 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38491 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38492 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38493 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38494 @end smallexample
38495
38496 @node Memory Map Format
38497 @section Memory Map Format
38498 @cindex memory map format
38499
38500 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38501 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38502 memory map.
38503
38504 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38505 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38506 lists memory regions.
38507
38508 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38509 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38510
38511 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38512
38513 @smallexample
38514 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38515 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38516 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38517 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38518 <memory-map>
38519 region...
38520 </memory-map>
38521 @end smallexample
38522
38523 Each region can be either:
38524
38525 @itemize
38526
38527 @item
38528 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38529 bytes from there:
38530
38531 @smallexample
38532 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38533 @end smallexample
38534
38535
38536 @item
38537 A region of read-only memory:
38538
38539 @smallexample
38540 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38541 @end smallexample
38542
38543
38544 @item
38545 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38546 bytes in length:
38547
38548 @smallexample
38549 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38550 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38551 </memory>
38552 @end smallexample
38553
38554 @end itemize
38555
38556 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38557 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38558 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38559
38560 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38561
38562 @smallexample
38563 <!-- ................................................... -->
38564 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38565 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38566 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38567 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38568 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38569 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38570 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38571 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38572 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38573 and its type, or device. -->
38574 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38575 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38576 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38577 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38578 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38579 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38580 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38581 @end smallexample
38582
38583 @node Thread List Format
38584 @section Thread List Format
38585 @cindex thread list format
38586
38587 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38588 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38589 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38590 the following structure:
38591
38592 @smallexample
38593 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38594 <threads>
38595 <thread id="id" core="0">
38596 ... description ...
38597 </thread>
38598 </threads>
38599 @end smallexample
38600
38601 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38602 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38603 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38604 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38605 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38606
38607 @node Traceframe Info Format
38608 @section Traceframe Info Format
38609 @cindex traceframe info format
38610
38611 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38612 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38613 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38614 collected in a traceframe.
38615
38616 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38617 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38618
38619 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38620 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38621
38622 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38623
38624 @smallexample
38625 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38626 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38627 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38628 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38629 <traceframe-info>
38630 block...
38631 </traceframe-info>
38632 @end smallexample
38633
38634 Each traceframe block can be either:
38635
38636 @itemize
38637
38638 @item
38639 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38640 @var{length} bytes from there:
38641
38642 @smallexample
38643 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38644 @end smallexample
38645
38646 @item
38647 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38648 collected:
38649
38650 @smallexample
38651 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38652 @end smallexample
38653
38654 @end itemize
38655
38656 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38657
38658 @smallexample
38659 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38660 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38661
38662 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38663 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38664 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38665 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38666 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38667 @end smallexample
38668
38669 @node Branch Trace Format
38670 @section Branch Trace Format
38671 @cindex branch trace format
38672
38673 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38674 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38675 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38676 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38677
38678 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38679 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38680
38681 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38682 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38683
38684 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38685
38686 @smallexample
38687 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38688 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38689 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38690 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38691 <btrace>
38692 block...
38693 </btrace>
38694 @end smallexample
38695
38696 @itemize
38697
38698 @item
38699 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38700 and ending at @var{end}:
38701
38702 @smallexample
38703 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38704 @end smallexample
38705
38706 @end itemize
38707
38708 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38709
38710 @smallexample
38711 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38712 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38713
38714 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38715 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38716 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38717 @end smallexample
38718
38719 @include agentexpr.texi
38720
38721 @node Target Descriptions
38722 @appendix Target Descriptions
38723 @cindex target descriptions
38724
38725 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38726 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38727 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38728 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38729 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38730 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38731 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38732
38733 @itemize @bullet
38734 @item
38735 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38736 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38737 @item
38738 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38739 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38740 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38741 @item
38742 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38743 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38744 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38745 @end itemize
38746
38747 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38748 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38749 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38750 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38751 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38752
38753 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38754 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38755
38756 @menu
38757 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38758 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38759 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38760 descriptions.
38761 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38762 @end menu
38763
38764 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38765 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38766
38767 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38768 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38769 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38770 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38771 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38772 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38773 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38774 Format}.
38775
38776 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38777 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38778 specify a file are:
38779
38780 @table @code
38781 @cindex set tdesc filename
38782 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38783 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38784
38785 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38786 @item unset tdesc filename
38787 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38788 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38789
38790 @cindex show tdesc filename
38791 @item show tdesc filename
38792 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38793 @end table
38794
38795
38796 @node Target Description Format
38797 @section Target Description Format
38798 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38799
38800 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38801 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38802 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38803 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38804 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38805 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38806 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38807
38808 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38809 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38810 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38811 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38812 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38813
38814 Here is a simple target description:
38815
38816 @smallexample
38817 <target version="1.0">
38818 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38819 </target>
38820 @end smallexample
38821
38822 @noindent
38823 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38824 the x86-64 architecture.
38825
38826 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38827 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38828 are explained further below.
38829
38830 @smallexample
38831 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38832 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38833 <target version="1.0">
38834 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38835 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38836 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38837 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38838 </target>
38839 @end smallexample
38840
38841 @noindent
38842 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38843 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38844 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38845 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38846 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38847 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38848 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38849 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38850 the version mismatch.
38851
38852 @subsection Inclusion
38853 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38854 @cindex XInclude
38855 @ifnotinfo
38856 @cindex <xi:include>
38857 @end ifnotinfo
38858
38859 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38860 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38861 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38862 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38863 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38864
38865 @smallexample
38866 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38867 @end smallexample
38868
38869 @noindent
38870 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38871 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38872 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38873 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38874 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38875 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38876 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38877 original description.
38878
38879 @subsection Architecture
38880 @cindex <architecture>
38881
38882 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38883
38884 @smallexample
38885 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38886 @end smallexample
38887
38888 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38889 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38890
38891 @subsection OS ABI
38892 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38893
38894 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38895 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38896
38897 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38898
38899 @smallexample
38900 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38901 @end smallexample
38902
38903 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38904 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38905
38906 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38907 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38908
38909 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38910 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38911
38912 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38913
38914 @smallexample
38915 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38916 @end smallexample
38917
38918 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38919 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38920
38921 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38922 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38923 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38924 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38925 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38926 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38927 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38928
38929 @smallexample
38930 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38931 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38932 @end smallexample
38933
38934 @subsection Features
38935 @cindex <feature>
38936
38937 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38938 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38939 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38940 has this form:
38941
38942 @smallexample
38943 <feature name="@var{name}">
38944 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38945 @var{reg}@dots{}
38946 </feature>
38947 @end smallexample
38948
38949 @noindent
38950 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38951 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38952 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38953 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38954
38955 @subsection Types
38956
38957 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38958 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38959 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38960 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38961 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38962
38963 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38964 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38965 Types must be defined before they are used.
38966
38967 @cindex <vector>
38968 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38969 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38970 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38971 @var{count}:
38972
38973 @smallexample
38974 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38975 @end smallexample
38976
38977 @cindex <union>
38978 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38979 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38980 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38981 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38982
38983 @smallexample
38984 <union id="@var{id}">
38985 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38986 @dots{}
38987 </union>
38988 @end smallexample
38989
38990 @cindex <struct>
38991 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38992 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38993 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38994 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38995 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38996 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38997 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38998 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38999
39000 @smallexample
39001 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39002 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39003 @dots{}
39004 </struct>
39005 @end smallexample
39006
39007 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39008 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39009
39010 @smallexample
39011 <struct id="@var{id}">
39012 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39013 @dots{}
39014 </struct>
39015 @end smallexample
39016
39017 @cindex <flags>
39018 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39019 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39020 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39021 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39022 are supported.
39023
39024 @smallexample
39025 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39026 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39027 @dots{}
39028 </flags>
39029 @end smallexample
39030
39031 @subsection Registers
39032 @cindex <reg>
39033
39034 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39035
39036 @smallexample
39037 <reg name="@var{name}"
39038 bitsize="@var{size}"
39039 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39040 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39041 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39042 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39043 @end smallexample
39044
39045 @noindent
39046 The components are as follows:
39047
39048 @table @var
39049
39050 @item name
39051 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39052
39053 @item bitsize
39054 The register's size, in bits.
39055
39056 @item regnum
39057 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39058 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39059 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39060 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39061 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39062 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39063 in order of increasing register number.
39064
39065 @item save-restore
39066 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39067 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39068 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39069 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39070 ABI.
39071
39072 @item type
39073 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39074 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39075 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39076 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39077 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39078 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39079
39080 @item group
39081 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39082 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39083 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39084 in @code{info registers}.
39085
39086 @end table
39087
39088 @node Predefined Target Types
39089 @section Predefined Target Types
39090 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39091
39092 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39093 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39094 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39095 types. The currently supported types are:
39096
39097 @table @code
39098
39099 @item int8
39100 @itemx int16
39101 @itemx int32
39102 @itemx int64
39103 @itemx int128
39104 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39105
39106 @item uint8
39107 @itemx uint16
39108 @itemx uint32
39109 @itemx uint64
39110 @itemx uint128
39111 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39112
39113 @item code_ptr
39114 @itemx data_ptr
39115 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39116 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39117 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39118 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39119 may be marked as data pointers.
39120
39121 @item ieee_single
39122 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39123
39124 @item ieee_double
39125 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39126
39127 @item arm_fpa_ext
39128 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39129
39130 @item i387_ext
39131 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39132
39133 @item i386_eflags
39134 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39135
39136 @item i386_mxcsr
39137 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39138
39139 @end table
39140
39141 @node Standard Target Features
39142 @section Standard Target Features
39143 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39144
39145 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39146 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39147 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39148 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39149 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39150 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39151 can recognize them.
39152
39153 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39154 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39155 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39156 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39157 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39158 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39159 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39160 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39161
39162 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39163 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39164 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39165
39166 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39167 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39168 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39169 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39170
39171 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39172 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39173 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39174
39175 @menu
39176 * AArch64 Features::
39177 * ARM Features::
39178 * i386 Features::
39179 * MicroBlaze Features::
39180 * MIPS Features::
39181 * M68K Features::
39182 * Nios II Features::
39183 * PowerPC Features::
39184 * S/390 and System z Features::
39185 * TIC6x Features::
39186 @end menu
39187
39188
39189 @node AArch64 Features
39190 @subsection AArch64 Features
39191 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39192
39193 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39194 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39195 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39196
39197 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39198 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39199 and @samp{fpcr}.
39200
39201 @node ARM Features
39202 @subsection ARM Features
39203 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39204
39205 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39206 ARM targets.
39207 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39208 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39209
39210 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39211 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39212 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39213 and @samp{xpsr}.
39214
39215 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39216 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39217
39218 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39219 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39220 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39221 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39222
39223 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39224 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39225 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39226 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39227 halves of the double-precision registers.
39228
39229 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39230 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39231 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39232 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39233 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39234 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39235
39236 @node i386 Features
39237 @subsection i386 Features
39238 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39239
39240 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39241 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39242
39243 @itemize @minus
39244 @item
39245 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39246 @item
39247 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39248 @item
39249 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39250 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39251 @item
39252 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39253 @item
39254 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39255 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39256 @end itemize
39257
39258 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39259
39260 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39261 describe registers:
39262
39263 @itemize @minus
39264 @item
39265 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39266 @item
39267 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39268 @item
39269 @samp{mxcsr}
39270 @end itemize
39271
39272 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39273 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39274 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39275
39276 @itemize @minus
39277 @item
39278 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39279 @item
39280 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39281 @end itemize
39282
39283 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39284 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39285
39286 @itemize @minus
39287 @item
39288 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39289 @item
39290 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39291 @end itemize
39292
39293 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39294 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39295
39296 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39297 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39298 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39299
39300 @itemize @minus
39301 @item
39302 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39303 @end itemize
39304
39305 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39306
39307 @itemize @minus
39308 @item
39309 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39310 @end itemize
39311
39312 It should
39313 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39314
39315 @itemize @minus
39316 @item
39317 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39318 @item
39319 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39320 @end itemize
39321
39322 It should
39323 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39324
39325 @itemize @minus
39326 @item
39327 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39328 @end itemize
39329
39330 @node MicroBlaze Features
39331 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
39332 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
39333
39334 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
39335 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39336 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
39337 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
39338 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
39339
39340 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
39341 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
39342
39343 @node MIPS Features
39344 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39345 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39346
39347 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39348 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39349 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39350 on the target.
39351
39352 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39353 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39354 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39355
39356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39357 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39358 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39359 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39360
39361 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39362 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39363 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39364 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39365
39366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39367 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39368 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39369
39370 @node M68K Features
39371 @subsection M68K Features
39372 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39373
39374 @table @code
39375 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39376 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39377 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39378 One of those features must be always present.
39379 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39380 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39381 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39382 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39383
39384 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39385 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39386 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39387 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39388 @end table
39389
39390 @node Nios II Features
39391 @subsection Nios II Features
39392 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39393
39394 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39395 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39396 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39397 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39398 @samp{mpuacc}).
39399
39400 @node PowerPC Features
39401 @subsection PowerPC Features
39402 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39403
39404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39405 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39406 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39407 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39408
39409 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39410 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39411
39412 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39413 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39414 and @samp{vrsave}.
39415
39416 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39417 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39418 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39419 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39420 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39421 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39422
39423 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39424 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39425 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39426 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39427 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39428 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39429 user.
39430
39431 @node S/390 and System z Features
39432 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39433 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39434 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39435
39436 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39437 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39438 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39439 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39440 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39441 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39442 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39443 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39444 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39445
39446 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39447 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39448 @samp{fpc}.
39449
39450 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39451 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39452
39453 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39454 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39455 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39456 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39457 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39458 32-bit wide.
39459
39460 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39461 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39462 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39463
39464 @node TIC6x Features
39465 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39466 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39467 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39468 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39469 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39470 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39471
39472 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39473 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39474 through @samp{B31}.
39475
39476 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39477 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39478
39479 @node Operating System Information
39480 @appendix Operating System Information
39481 @cindex operating system information
39482
39483 @menu
39484 * Process list::
39485 @end menu
39486
39487 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39488 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39489 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39490 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39491 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39492 on a different aspect of target.
39493
39494 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39495 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39496 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39497 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39498
39499 @node Process list
39500 @appendixsection Process list
39501 @cindex operating system information, process list
39502
39503 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39504 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39505 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39506 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39507
39508 An example document is:
39509
39510 @smallexample
39511 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39512 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39513 <osdata type="processes">
39514 <item>
39515 <column name="pid">1</column>
39516 <column name="user">root</column>
39517 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39518 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39519 </item>
39520 </osdata>
39521 @end smallexample
39522
39523 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39524 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39525 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39526 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39527 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39528 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39529 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39530
39531 @node Trace File Format
39532 @appendix Trace File Format
39533 @cindex trace file format
39534
39535 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39536 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39537
39538 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39539 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39540 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39541 in the future.
39542
39543 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39544 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39545 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39546 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39547 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39548 of this section.
39549
39550 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39551
39552 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39553 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39554 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39555 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39556 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39557 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39558 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39559 endianness.
39560
39561 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39562
39563 @table @code
39564 @item R @var{bytes}
39565 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39566 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39567 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39568 hexadecimal encoding.
39569
39570 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39571 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39572 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39573 @var{length} bytes.
39574
39575 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39576 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39577 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39578
39579 @end table
39580
39581 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39582 of blocks.
39583
39584 @node Index Section Format
39585 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39586 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39587 @cindex index section format
39588
39589 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39590 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39591 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39592 description.
39593
39594 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39595 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39596 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39597 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39598 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39599 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39600
39601 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39602
39603 @enumerate
39604 @item
39605 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39606 unless otherwise noted:
39607
39608 @enumerate
39609 @item
39610 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39611 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39612 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39613 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39614 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39615 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39616 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39617
39618 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39619 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39620 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39621 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39622
39623 @item
39624 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39625
39626 @item
39627 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39628 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39629 to the next offset.
39630
39631 @item
39632 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39633
39634 @item
39635 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39636
39637 @item
39638 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39639 @end enumerate
39640
39641 @item
39642 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39643 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39644 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39645 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39646 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39647 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39648 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39649 CU indices.
39650
39651 @item
39652 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39653 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39654 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39655 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39656
39657 @item
39658 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39659 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39660
39661 @enumerate
39662 @item
39663 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39664
39665 @item
39666 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39667 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39668
39669 @item
39670 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39671 @end enumerate
39672
39673 @item
39674 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39675 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39676
39677 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39678 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39679 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39680 constant pool.
39681
39682 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39683 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39684 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39685
39686 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39687 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39688 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39689 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39690 index version:
39691
39692 @table @asis
39693 @item Version 4
39694 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39695
39696 @item Versions 5 to 7
39697 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39698 @end table
39699
39700 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39701
39702 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39703 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39704 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39705 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39706 collision.
39707
39708 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39709 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39710 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39711 the code.
39712
39713 @item
39714 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39715 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39716 strings.
39717
39718 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39719 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39720 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39721 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39722 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39723 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39724
39725 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39726 @end enumerate
39727
39728 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39729 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39730 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39731
39732 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39733 (bit 0 = LSB):
39734
39735 @table @asis
39736
39737 @item Bits 0-23
39738 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39739 @item Bits 24-27
39740 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39741 @item Bits 28-30
39742 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39743
39744 @table @asis
39745 @item 0
39746 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39747 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39748 with previous versions of the index.
39749 @item 1
39750 The symbol is a type.
39751 @item 2
39752 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39753 @item 3
39754 The symbol is a function.
39755 @item 4
39756 Any other kind of symbol.
39757 @item 5,6,7
39758 These values are reserved.
39759 @end table
39760
39761 @item Bit 31
39762 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39763
39764 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39765 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39766 @value{GDBN} sources.
39767
39768 @end table
39769
39770 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39771 global/static attributes in the index.
39772
39773 @smallexample
39774 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39775 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39776 switch (die->tag)
39777 @{
39778 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39779 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39780 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39781 kind = TYPE;
39782 is_static = 1;
39783 break;
39784 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39785 kind = VARIABLE;
39786 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39787 break;
39788 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39789 kind = FUNCTION;
39790 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39791 break;
39792 case DW_TAG_constant:
39793 kind = VARIABLE;
39794 is_static = ! is_external;
39795 break;
39796 case DW_TAG_variable:
39797 kind = VARIABLE;
39798 is_static = ! is_external;
39799 break;
39800 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39801 kind = TYPE;
39802 is_static = 0;
39803 break;
39804 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39805 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39806 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39807 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39808 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39809 kind = TYPE;
39810 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39811 break;
39812 default:
39813 assert (0);
39814 @}
39815 @end smallexample
39816
39817 @node Man Pages
39818 @appendix Manual pages
39819 @cindex Man pages
39820
39821 @menu
39822 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39823 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39824 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39825 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39826 @end menu
39827
39828 @node gdb man
39829 @heading gdb man
39830
39831 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39832
39833 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39834 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39835 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39836 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39837 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39838 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39839 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39840 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39841 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39842 @c man end
39843
39844 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39845 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39846 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39847 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39848
39849 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39850 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39851
39852 @itemize @bullet
39853 @item
39854 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39855
39856 @item
39857 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39858
39859 @item
39860 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39861
39862 @item
39863 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39864 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39865 @end itemize
39866
39867 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39868 Modula-2.
39869
39870 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39871 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39872 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39873 by using the command @code{help}.
39874
39875 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39876 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39877 executable program as the argument:
39878
39879 @smallexample
39880 gdb program
39881 @end smallexample
39882
39883 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39884
39885 @smallexample
39886 gdb program core
39887 @end smallexample
39888
39889 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39890 to debug a running process:
39891
39892 @smallexample
39893 gdb program 1234
39894 gdb -p 1234
39895 @end smallexample
39896
39897 @noindent
39898 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39899 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39900 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39901
39902 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39903
39904 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39905 @table @env
39906 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39907 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39908
39909 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39910 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39911
39912 @item bt
39913 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39914
39915 @item print @var{expr}
39916 Display the value of an expression.
39917
39918 @item c
39919 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39920
39921 @item next
39922 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39923 function calls in the line.
39924
39925 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39926 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39927
39928 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39929 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39930
39931 @item step
39932 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39933 function calls in the line.
39934
39935 @item help [@var{name}]
39936 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39937 about using @value{GDBN}.
39938
39939 @item quit
39940 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39941 @end table
39942
39943 @ifset man
39944 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39945 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39946 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39947 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39948 @end ifset
39949 @c man end
39950
39951 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39952 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39953 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39954 encountered with no
39955 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39956 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39957 Many options have
39958 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39959 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39960 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39961 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39962 more usual convention.)
39963
39964 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39965 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39966 option is used.
39967
39968 @table @env
39969 @item -help
39970 @itemx -h
39971 List all options, with brief explanations.
39972
39973 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39974 @itemx -s @var{file}
39975 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39976
39977 @item -write
39978 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39979
39980 @item -exec=@var{file}
39981 @itemx -e @var{file}
39982 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39983 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39984 dump.
39985
39986 @item -se=@var{file}
39987 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39988 file.
39989
39990 @item -core=@var{file}
39991 @itemx -c @var{file}
39992 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39993
39994 @item -command=@var{file}
39995 @itemx -x @var{file}
39996 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39997
39998 @item -ex @var{command}
39999 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40000
40001 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40002 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40003 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40004
40005 @item -nh
40006 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40007
40008 @item -nx
40009 @itemx -n
40010 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40011
40012 @item -quiet
40013 @itemx -q
40014 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40015 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40016
40017 @item -batch
40018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40019 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40020 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40021 commands in the command files.
40022
40023 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40024 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40025 more useful, the message
40026
40027 @smallexample
40028 Program exited normally.
40029 @end smallexample
40030
40031 @noindent
40032 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40033 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40034
40035 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40036 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40037 instead of the current directory.
40038
40039 @item -fullname
40040 @itemx -f
40041 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40042 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40043 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40044 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40045 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40046 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40047 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40048 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40049
40050 @item -b @var{bps}
40051 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40052 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40053
40054 @item -tty=@var{device}
40055 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40056 @end table
40057 @c man end
40058
40059 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40060 @ifset man
40061 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40062 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40063 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40064
40065 @smallexample
40066 info gdb
40067 @end smallexample
40068
40069 @noindent
40070 should give you access to the complete manual.
40071
40072 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40073 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40074 @end ifset
40075 @c man end
40076
40077 @node gdbserver man
40078 @heading gdbserver man
40079
40080 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40081 @format
40082 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40083 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40084
40085 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40086
40087 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40088 @c man end
40089 @end format
40090
40091 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40092 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40093 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40094
40095 @ifclear man
40096 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40097 @end ifclear
40098 @ifset man
40099 Usage (server (target) side):
40100 @end ifset
40101
40102 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40103 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40104 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40105 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40106
40107 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40108 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40109 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40110
40111 @smallexample
40112 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40113 @end smallexample
40114
40115 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40116
40117 @smallexample
40118 @ifset man
40119 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40120 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40121 @end ifset
40122 @ifclear man
40123 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40124 @end ifclear
40125 @end smallexample
40126
40127 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40128 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40129 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40130
40131 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40132
40133 @smallexample
40134 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40135 @end smallexample
40136
40137 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40138 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40139 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40140 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40141 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40142 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40143 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40144 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40145 print an error message and exit.
40146
40147 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40148 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40149
40150 @smallexample
40151 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40152 @end smallexample
40153
40154 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40155 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40156
40157 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40158 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40159 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40160 the program you want to debug.
40161
40162 @smallexample
40163 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40164 @end smallexample
40165
40166 @ifclear man
40167 @subheading Usage (host side)
40168 @end ifclear
40169 @ifset man
40170 Usage (host side):
40171 @end ifset
40172
40173 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40174 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40175 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40176 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40177 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40178 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40179 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40180 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40181 descriptor. For example:
40182
40183 @smallexample
40184 @ifset man
40185 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40186 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40187 @end ifset
40188 @ifclear man
40189 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40190 @end ifclear
40191 @end smallexample
40192
40193 @noindent
40194 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40195
40196 @smallexample
40197 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40198 @end smallexample
40199
40200 @noindent
40201 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40202 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40203 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40204 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40205 `Connection refused'.
40206
40207 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40208 described in
40209 @ifset man
40210 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40211 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40212 @end ifset
40213 @ifclear man
40214 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40215 @end ifclear
40216 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40217
40218 @smallexample
40219 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40220 @end smallexample
40221
40222 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40223 case.
40224 @c man end
40225
40226 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40227 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40228
40229 @itemize @bullet
40230
40231 @item
40232 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40233
40234 @smallexample
40235 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40236 @end smallexample
40237
40238 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40239 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40240 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40241 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40242 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40243 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40244 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40245
40246 @item
40247 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40248 program:
40249
40250 @smallexample
40251 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40252 @end smallexample
40253
40254 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40255 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40256 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40257 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40258
40259 @item
40260 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40261
40262 @smallexample
40263 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40264 @end smallexample
40265
40266 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40267 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40268 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40269 debug several processes in the same session.
40270 @end itemize
40271
40272 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40273
40274 @table @env
40275
40276 @item --help
40277 List all options, with brief explanations.
40278
40279 @item --version
40280 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40281
40282 @item --attach
40283 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40284
40285 @smallexample
40286 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40287 @end smallexample
40288
40289 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40290 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40291
40292 @item --multi
40293 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40294 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40295 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40296 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40297
40298 @smallexample
40299 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40300 @end smallexample
40301
40302 @item --debug
40303 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40304 process.
40305 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40306 the developers.
40307
40308 @item --remote-debug
40309 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40310 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40311 the developers.
40312
40313 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40314 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40315 of debugging output.
40316 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40317
40318 @item --wrapper
40319 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40320 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40321 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40322 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40323
40324 @item --once
40325 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40326 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40327 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40328 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40329
40330 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40331
40332 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40333 @c QDisableRandomization.
40334
40335 @end table
40336 @c man end
40337
40338 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40339 @ifset man
40340 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40341 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40342 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40343
40344 @smallexample
40345 info gdb
40346 @end smallexample
40347
40348 should give you access to the complete manual.
40349
40350 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40351 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40352 @end ifset
40353 @c man end
40354
40355 @node gcore man
40356 @heading gcore
40357
40358 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40359
40360 @format
40361 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40362 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40363 @c man end
40364 @end format
40365
40366 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40367 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40368 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40369 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40370 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40371 running without any change.
40372 @c man end
40373
40374 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40375 @table @env
40376 @item -o @var{filename}
40377 The optional argument
40378 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40379 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40380 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40381 @end table
40382 @c man end
40383
40384 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40385 @ifset man
40386 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40387 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40388 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40389
40390 @smallexample
40391 info gdb
40392 @end smallexample
40393
40394 @noindent
40395 should give you access to the complete manual.
40396
40397 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40398 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40399 @end ifset
40400 @c man end
40401
40402 @node gdbinit man
40403 @heading gdbinit
40404
40405 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40406
40407 @format
40408 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40409 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40410 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40411 @end ifset
40412
40413 ~/.gdbinit
40414
40415 ./.gdbinit
40416 @c man end
40417 @end format
40418
40419 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40420 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40421 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40422 described in
40423 @ifset man
40424 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40425 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40426 @end ifset
40427 @ifclear man
40428 @ref{Sequences}.
40429 @end ifclear
40430
40431 Please read more in
40432 @ifset man
40433 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40434 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40435 @end ifset
40436 @ifclear man
40437 @ref{Startup}.
40438 @end ifclear
40439
40440 @table @env
40441 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40442 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40443 @end ifset
40444 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40445 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40446 @end ifclear
40447 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40448 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40449 See more in
40450 @ifset man
40451 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40452 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40453 @end ifset
40454 @ifclear man
40455 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40456 @end ifclear
40457
40458 @item ~/.gdbinit
40459 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40460 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40461
40462 @item ./.gdbinit
40463 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40464 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40465 See more in
40466 @ifset man
40467 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40468 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40469 @end ifset
40470 @ifclear man
40471 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40472 @end ifclear
40473 @end table
40474 @c man end
40475
40476 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40477 @ifset man
40478 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40479
40480 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40481 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40482 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40483
40484 @smallexample
40485 info gdb
40486 @end smallexample
40487
40488 should give you access to the complete manual.
40489
40490 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40491 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40492 @end ifset
40493 @c man end
40494
40495 @include gpl.texi
40496
40497 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40498 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40499 @include fdl.texi
40500
40501 @node Concept Index
40502 @unnumbered Concept Index
40503
40504 @printindex cp
40505
40506 @node Command and Variable Index
40507 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40508
40509 @printindex fn
40510
40511 @tex
40512 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40513 % meantime:
40514 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40515 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40516 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40517 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40518 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40519 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40520 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40521 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40522 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40523 \page\colophon
40524 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40525 @end tex
40526
40527 @bye
This page took 0.919709 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.